1 <?xml version='
1.0' encoding='UTF-
8'
?>
2 <!-- Converted to DocBook by Hans Schou 2004-03-29 -->
6 * replace '. . .' with something else
9 <!DOCTYPE book PUBLIC
"-//OASIS//DTD DocBook XML V4.3//EN"
10 "http://www.oasis-open.org/docbook/xml/4.3/docbookx.dtd"
13 <!ENTITY translationblock
"">
18 <book id=
"index" lang=
"en">
20 <title>Free Culture
</title>
22 <abbrev>"freeculture"</abbrev>
24 <subtitle>HOW BIG MEDIA USES TECHNOLOGY AND THE LAW TO LOCK DOWN
25 CULTURE AND CONTROL CREATIVITY
</subtitle>
27 <pubdate>2004-
03-
25</pubdate>
29 <releaseinfo>Version
2004-
02-
10</releaseinfo>
33 <firstname>Lawrence
</firstname>
34 <surname>Lessig
</surname>
40 <holder>Lawrence Lessig
</holder>
45 This version of
<citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle> is licensed under
46 a Creative Commons license. This license permits non-commercial use of
47 this work, so long as attribution is given. For more information
48 about the license, click the icon above, or visit
49 <ulink url=
"http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/1.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-nc/
1.0/
</ulink>
54 <title>ABOUT THE AUTHOR
</title>
57 (
<ulink url=
"http://www.lessig.org/">http://www.lessig.org
</ulink>),
58 professor of law and a John A. Wilson Distinguished Faculty Scholar
59 at Stanford Law School, is founder of the Stanford Center for Internet
60 and Society and is chairman of the Creative Commons
61 (
<ulink url=
"http://creativecommons.org/">http://creativecommons.org
</ulink>).
62 The author of The Future of Ideas (Random House,
2001) and Code: And
63 Other Laws of Cyberspace (Basic Books,
1999), Lessig is a member of
64 the boards of the Public Library of Science, the Electronic Frontier
65 Foundation, and Public Knowledge. He was the winner of the Free
66 Software Foundation's Award for the Advancement of Free Software,
67 twice listed in BusinessWeek's "e.biz
25," and named one of Scientific
68 American's "
50 visionaries." A graduate of the University of
69 Pennsylvania, Cambridge University, and Yale Law School, Lessig
70 clerked for Judge Richard Posner of the U.S. Seventh Circuit Court of
80 You can buy a copy of this book by clicking on one of the links below:
82 <itemizedlist mark=
"number" spacing=
"compact">
83 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.amazon.com/">Amazon
</ulink></para></listitem>
84 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.barnesandnoble.com/">B
&N
</ulink></para></listitem>
85 <listitem><para><ulink url=
"http://www.penguin.com/">Penguin
</ulink></para></listitem>
86 <!-- <ulink url="">Local Bookstore</ulink> -->
92 ALSO BY LAWRENCE LESSIG
95 The Future of Ideas: The Fate of the Commons in a Connected World
98 Code: And Other Laws of Cyberspace
101 <!-- PAGE BREAK 4 -->
103 THE PENGUIN PRESS, NEW YORK
106 <!-- PAGE BREAK 5 -->
112 HOW BIG MEDIA USES TECHNOLOGY AND
113 THE LAW TO LOCK DOWN CULTURE
114 AND CONTROL CREATIVITY
121 <!-- PAGE BREAK 6 -->
123 THE PENGUIN PRESS, a member of Penguin Group (USA) Inc.
375 Hudson Street New
127 Copyright
© Lawrence Lessig. All rights reserved.
130 Excerpt from an editorial titled "The Coming of Copyright Perpetuity,"
131 <citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>, January
16,
2003. Copyright
132 © 2003 by The New York Times Co. Reprinted with permission.
135 Cartoon in
<xref linkend=
"fig-1711"/> by Paul Conrad, copyright Tribune
136 Media Services, Inc. All rights reserved. Reprinted with permission.
139 Diagram in
<xref linkend=
"fig-1761"/> courtesy of the office of FCC
140 Commissioner, Michael J. Copps.
143 Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data
147 Free culture : how big media uses technology and the law to lock down
148 culture and control creativity / Lawrence Lessig.
157 ISBN
1-
59420-
006-
8 (hardcover)
160 1. Intellectual property
—United States.
2. Mass media
—United States.
163 3. Technological innovations
—United States.
4. Art
—United States. I. Title.
169 343.7309'
9—dc22
172 This book is printed on acid-free paper.
175 Printed in the United States of America
181 Designed by Marysarah Quinn
189 Without limiting the rights under copyright reserved above, no part of
190 this publication may be reproduced, stored in or introduced into a
191 retrieval system, or transmitted, in any form or by any means
192 (electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise),
193 without the prior written permission of both the copyright owner and
194 the above publisher of this book. The scanning, uploading, and
195 distribution of this book via the Internet or via any other means
196 without the permission of the publisher is illegal and punishable by
197 law. Please purchase only authorized electronic editions and do not
198 participate in or encourage electronic piracy of copyrighted
199 materials. Your support of the author's rights is appreciated.
203 <!-- PAGE BREAK 7 -->
206 To Eric Eldred
—whose work first drew me to this cause, and for whom
211 <figure id=
"CreativeCommons">
212 <title>Creative Commons, Some rights reserved
</title>
213 <graphic fileref=
"images/cc.png"></graphic>
221 <title>List of figures
</title>
228 1 CHAPTER ONE: Creators
229 1 CHAPTER TWO: "Mere Copyists"
230 1 CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
231 1 CHAPTER FOUR: "Pirates"
236 1 CHAPTER FIVE: "Piracy"
240 1 CHAPTER SIX: Founders
241 1 CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
242 1 CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
243 1 CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
244 1 CHAPTER TEN: "Property"
245 2 Why Hollywood Is Right
249 2 Law and Architecture: Reach
250 2 Architecture and Law: Force
251 2 Market: Concentration
254 1 CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
255 1 CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
256 2 Constraining Creators
257 2 Constraining Innovators
258 2 Corrupting Citizens
260 1 CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
261 1 CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
265 2 Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
266 2 Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
268 2 1. More Formalities
269 3 Registration and Renewal
272 2 3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
273 2 4. Liberate the Music- -Again
274 2 5. Fire Lots of Lawyers 304
280 <!-- PAGE BREAK 11 -->
282 <preface id=
"preface">
283 <title>PREFACE
</title>
284 <indexterm id=
"idxpoguedavid" class='startofrange'
>
285 <primary>Pogue, David
</primary>
288 At the end of his review of my first book,
<citetitle>Code: And Other
289 Laws of Cyberspace
</citetitle>, David Pogue, a brilliant writer and
290 author of countless technical and computer-related texts, wrote this:
294 Unlike actual law, Internet software has no capacity to punish. It
295 doesn't affect people who aren't online (and only a tiny minority
296 of the world population is). And if you don't like the Internet's
297 system, you can always flip off the modem.
<footnote id=
"preface01"><para>
298 David Pogue, "Don't Just Chat, Do Something,"
<citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
30 January
2000.
303 Pogue was skeptical of the core argument of the book
—that
304 software, or "code," functioned as a kind of law
—and his review
305 suggested the happy thought that if life in cyberspace got bad, we
306 could always "drizzle, drazzle, druzzle, drome"-like simply flip a
307 switch and be back home. Turn off the modem, unplug the computer, and
308 any troubles that exist in
<emphasis>that
</emphasis> space wouldn't
312 Pogue might have been right in
1999—I'm skeptical, but maybe.
313 But even if he was right then, the point is not right now:
314 <citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle> is about the troubles the Internet
315 causes even after the modem is turned
316 <!-- PAGE BREAK 12 -->
317 off. It is an argument about how the battles that now rage regarding life
318 on-line have fundamentally affected "people who aren't online." There
319 is no switch that will insulate us from the Internet's effect.
321 <indexterm startref=
"idxpoguedavid" class='endofrange'
/>
323 But unlike
<citetitle>Code
</citetitle>, the argument here is not much
324 about the Internet itself. It is instead about the consequence of the
325 Internet to a part of our tradition that is much more fundamental,
326 and, as hard as this is for a geek-wanna-be to admit, much more
330 That tradition is the way our culture gets made. As I explain in the
331 pages that follow, we come from a tradition of "free culture"
—not
332 "free" as in "free beer" (to borrow a phrase from the founder of the
333 free software movement
<footnote>
335 Richard M. Stallman,
<citetitle>Free Software, Free Societies
</citetitle> 57 (Joshua Gay, ed.
2002).
336 </para></footnote>), but "free" as in "free speech," "free markets,"
337 "free trade," "free enterprise," "free will," and "free elections." A
338 free culture supports and protects creators and innovators. It does
339 this directly by granting intellectual property rights. But it does so
340 indirectly by limiting the reach of those rights, to guarantee that
341 follow-on creators and innovators remain
<emphasis>as free as
342 possible
</emphasis> from the control of the past. A free culture is
343 not a culture without property, just as a free market is not a market
344 in which everything is free. The opposite of a free culture is a
345 "permission culture"
—a culture in which creators get to create
346 only with the permission of the powerful, or of creators from the
350 If we understood this change, I believe we would resist it. Not "we"
351 on the Left or "you" on the Right, but we who have no stake in the
352 particular industries of culture that defined the twentieth century.
353 Whether you are on the Left or the Right, if you are in this sense
354 disinterested, then the story I tell here will trouble you. For the
355 changes I describe affect values that both sides of our political
356 culture deem fundamental.
358 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace
</primary></indexterm>
360 We saw a glimpse of this bipartisan outrage in the early summer of
361 2003. As the FCC considered changes in media ownership rules that
362 would relax limits on media concentration, an extraordinary coalition
363 generated more than
700,
000 letters to the FCC opposing the change.
364 As William Safire described marching "uncomfortably alongside CodePink
365 Women for Peace and the National Rifle Association, between liberal
366 Olympia Snowe and conservative Ted Stevens," he formulated perhaps
367 most simply just what was at stake: the concentration of power. And as
369 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
373 Does that sound unconservative? Not to me. The concentration of
374 power
—political, corporate, media, cultural
—should be anathema to
375 conservatives. The diffusion of power through local control, thereby
376 encouraging individual participation, is the essence of federalism and
377 the greatest expression of democracy.
<footnote><para> William Safire,
378 "The Great Media Gulp,"
<citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
22 May
2003.
379 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
384 This idea is an element of the argument of
<citetitle>Free Culture
</citetitle>, though my
385 focus is not just on the concentration of power produced by
386 concentrations in ownership, but more importantly, if because less
387 visibly, on the concentration of power produced by a radical change in
388 the effective scope of the law. The law is changing; that change is
389 altering the way our culture gets made; that change should worry
390 you
—whether or not you care about the Internet, and whether you're on
391 Safire's left or on his right. The inspiration for the title and for
392 much of the argument of this book comes from the work of Richard
393 Stallman and the Free Software Foundation. Indeed, as I reread
394 Stallman's own work, especially the essays in
<citetitle>Free Software, Free
395 Society
</citetitle>, I realize that all of the theoretical insights I develop here
396 are insights Stallman described decades ago. One could thus well argue
397 that this work is "merely" derivative.
400 I accept that criticism, if indeed it is a criticism. The work of a
401 lawyer is always derivative, and I mean to do nothing more in this
402 book than to remind a culture about a tradition that has always been
403 its own. Like Stallman, I defend that tradition on the basis of
404 values. Like Stallman, I believe those are the values of freedom. And
405 like Stallman, I believe those are values of our past that will need
406 to be defended in our future. A free culture has been our past, but it
407 will only be our future if we change the path we are on right now.
409 <!-- PAGE BREAK 14 -->
410 Like Stallman's arguments for free software, an argument for free
411 culture stumbles on a confusion that is hard to avoid, and even harder
412 to understand. A free culture is not a culture without property; it is not
413 a culture in which artists don't get paid. A culture without property, or
414 in which creators can't get paid, is anarchy, not freedom. Anarchy is not
418 Instead, the free culture that I defend in this book is a balance
419 between anarchy and control. A free culture, like a free market, is
420 filled with property. It is filled with rules of property and contract
421 that get enforced by the state. But just as a free market is perverted
422 if its property becomes feudal, so too can a free culture be queered
423 by extremism in the property rights that define it. That is what I
424 fear about our culture today. It is against that extremism that this
429 <!-- PAGE BREAK 15 -->
431 <!-- PAGE BREAK 16 -->
432 <chapter id=
"c-introduction">
433 <title>INTRODUCTION
</title>
435 On December
17,
1903, on a windy North Carolina beach for just
436 shy of one hundred seconds, the Wright brothers demonstrated that a
437 heavier-than-air, self-propelled vehicle could fly. The moment was electric
438 and its importance widely understood. Almost immediately, there
439 was an explosion of interest in this newfound technology of manned
440 flight, and a gaggle of innovators began to build upon it.
443 At the time the Wright brothers invented the airplane, American
444 law held that a property owner presumptively owned not just the surface
445 of his land, but all the land below, down to the center of the earth,
446 and all the space above, to "an indefinite extent, upwards."
<footnote><para>
447 St. George Tucker,
<citetitle>Blackstone's Commentaries
</citetitle> 3 (South Hackensack, N.J.:
448 Rothman Reprints,
1969),
18.
451 years, scholars had puzzled about how best to interpret the idea that
452 rights in land ran to the heavens. Did that mean that you owned the
453 stars? Could you prosecute geese for their willful and regular trespass?
456 Then came airplanes, and for the first time, this principle of American
457 law
—deep within the foundations of our tradition, and acknowledged
458 by the most important legal thinkers of our past
—mattered. If
459 my land reaches to the heavens, what happens when United flies over
460 my field? Do I have the right to banish it from my property? Am I allowed
461 to enter into an exclusive license with Delta Airlines? Could we
462 set up an auction to decide how much these rights are worth?
464 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
465 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
467 In
1945, these questions became a federal case. When North Carolina
468 farmers Thomas Lee and Tinie Causby started losing chickens
469 because of low-flying military aircraft (the terrified chickens apparently
470 flew into the barn walls and died), the Causbys filed a lawsuit saying
471 that the government was trespassing on their land. The airplanes,
472 of course, never touched the surface of the Causbys' land. But if, as
473 Blackstone, Kent, and Coke had said, their land reached to "an indefinite
474 extent, upwards," then the government was trespassing on their
475 property, and the Causbys wanted it to stop.
477 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
478 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
480 The Supreme Court agreed to hear the Causbys' case. Congress had
481 declared the airways public, but if one's property really extended to the
482 heavens, then Congress's declaration could well have been an unconstitutional
483 "taking" of property without compensation. The Court acknowledged
484 that "it is ancient doctrine that common law ownership of
485 the land extended to the periphery of the universe." But Justice Douglas
486 had no patience for ancient doctrine. In a single paragraph, hundreds of
487 years of property law were erased. As he wrote for the Court,
491 [The] doctrine has no place in the modern world. The air is a
492 public highway, as Congress has declared. Were that not true,
493 every transcontinental flight would subject the operator to countless
494 trespass suits. Common sense revolts at the idea. To recognize
495 such private claims to the airspace would clog these highways,
496 seriously interfere with their control and development in the public
497 interest, and transfer into private ownership that to which only
498 the public has a just claim.
<footnote>
500 United States v. Causby, U.S.
328 (
1946):
256,
261. The Court did find
501 that there could be a "taking" if the government's use of its land
502 effectively destroyed the value of the Causbys' land. This example was
503 suggested to me by Keith Aoki's wonderful piece, "(Intellectual)
504 Property and Sovereignty: Notes Toward a Cultural Geography of
505 Authorship,"
<citetitle>Stanford Law Review
</citetitle> 48 (
1996):
1293,
1333. See also Paul
506 Goldstein,
<citetitle>Real Property
</citetitle> (Mineola, N.Y.: Foundation Press,
1984),
508 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
509 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
514 "Common sense revolts at the idea."
517 This is how the law usually works. Not often this abruptly or
518 impatiently, but eventually, this is how it works. It was Douglas's style not to
519 dither. Other justices would have blathered on for pages to reach the
520 <!-- PAGE BREAK 18 -->
521 conclusion that Douglas holds in a single line: "Common sense revolts
522 at the idea." But whether it takes pages or a few words, it is the special
523 genius of a common law system, as ours is, that the law adjusts to the
524 technologies of the time. And as it adjusts, it changes. Ideas that were
525 as solid as rock in one age crumble in another.
527 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
528 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
530 Or at least, this is how things happen when there's no one powerful
531 on the other side of the change. The Causbys were just farmers. And
532 though there were no doubt many like them who were upset by the
533 growing traffic in the air (though one hopes not many chickens flew
534 themselves into walls), the Causbys of the world would find it very
535 hard to unite and stop the idea, and the technology, that the Wright
536 brothers had birthed. The Wright brothers spat airplanes into the
537 technological meme pool; the idea then spread like a virus in a chicken
538 coop; farmers like the Causbys found themselves surrounded by "what
539 seemed reasonable" given the technology that the Wrights had produced.
540 They could stand on their farms, dead chickens in hand, and
541 shake their fists at these newfangled technologies all they wanted.
542 They could call their representatives or even file a lawsuit. But in the
543 end, the force of what seems "obvious" to everyone else
—the power of
544 "common sense"
—would prevail. Their "private interest" would not be
545 allowed to defeat an obvious public gain.
548 Edwin Howard Armstrong is one of America's forgotten inventor
549 geniuses. He came to the great American inventor scene just after the
550 titans Thomas Edison and Alexander Graham Bell. But his work in
551 the area of radio technology was perhaps the most important of any
552 single inventor in the first fifty years of radio. He was better educated
553 than Michael Faraday, who as a bookbinder's apprentice had discovered
554 electric induction in
1831. But he had the same intuition about
555 how the world of radio worked, and on at least three occasions,
556 Armstrong invented profoundly important technologies that advanced our
557 understanding of radio.
558 <!-- PAGE BREAK 19 -->
559 <indexterm><primary>Bell, Alexander Graham
</primary></indexterm>
560 <indexterm><primary>Edison, Thomas
</primary></indexterm>
561 <indexterm><primary>Faraday, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
564 On the day after Christmas,
1933, four patents were issued to Armstrong
565 for his most significant invention
—FM radio. Until then, consumer radio
566 had been amplitude-modulated (AM) radio. The theorists
567 of the day had said that frequency-modulated (FM) radio could never
568 work. They were right about FM radio in a narrow band of spectrum.
569 But Armstrong discovered that frequency-modulated radio in a wide
570 band of spectrum would deliver an astonishing fidelity of sound, with
571 much less transmitter power and static.
574 On November
5,
1935, he demonstrated the technology at a meeting of
575 the Institute of Radio Engineers at the Empire State Building in New
576 York City. He tuned his radio dial across a range of AM stations,
577 until the radio locked on a broadcast that he had arranged from
578 seventeen miles away. The radio fell totally silent, as if dead, and
579 then with a clarity no one else in that room had ever heard from an
580 electrical device, it produced the sound of an announcer's voice:
581 "This is amateur station W2AG at Yonkers, New York, operating on
582 frequency modulation at two and a half meters."
585 The audience was hearing something no one had thought possible:
589 A glass of water was poured before the microphone in Yonkers; it
590 sounded like a glass of water being poured. . . . A paper was crumpled
591 and torn; it sounded like paper and not like a crackling forest
592 fire. . . . Sousa marches were played from records and a piano solo
593 and guitar number were performed. . . . The music was projected with a
594 live-ness rarely if ever heard before from a radio "music
595 box."
<footnote><para>
596 Lawrence Lessing,
<citetitle>Man of High Fidelity: Edwin Howard Armstrong
</citetitle>
597 (Philadelphia: J. B. Lipincott Company,
1956),
209.
602 As our own common sense tells us, Armstrong had discovered a vastly
603 superior radio technology. But at the time of his invention, Armstrong
604 was working for RCA. RCA was the dominant player in the then dominant
605 AM radio market. By
1935, there were a thousand radio stations across
606 the United States, but the stations in large cities were all owned by
607 a handful of networks.
608 <!-- PAGE BREAK 20 -->
611 RCA's president, David Sarnoff, a friend of Armstrong's, was eager
612 that Armstrong discover a way to remove static from AM radio. So
613 Sarnoff was quite excited when Armstrong told him he had a device
614 that removed static from "radio." But when Armstrong demonstrated
615 his invention, Sarnoff was not pleased.
616 <indexterm><primary>Sarnoff, David
</primary></indexterm>
620 I thought Armstrong would invent some kind of a filter to remove
621 static from our AM radio. I didn't think he'd start a
622 revolution
— start up a whole damn new industry to compete with
623 RCA.
<footnote><para> See "Saints: The Heroes and Geniuses of the
624 Electronic Era," First Electronic Church of America, at
625 www.webstationone.com/fecha, available at
627 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
1</ulink>.
632 Armstrong's invention threatened RCA's AM empire, so the company
633 launched a campaign to smother FM radio. While FM may have been a
634 superior technology, Sarnoff was a superior tactician. As one author
636 <indexterm><primary>Sarnoff, David
</primary></indexterm>
640 The forces for FM, largely engineering, could not overcome the weight
641 of strategy devised by the sales, patent, and legal offices to subdue
642 this threat to corporate position. For FM, if allowed to develop
643 unrestrained, posed . . . a complete reordering of radio power
644 . . . and the eventual overthrow of the carefully restricted AM system
645 on which RCA had grown to power.
<footnote><para>Lessing,
226.
650 RCA at first kept the technology in house, insisting that further
651 tests were needed. When, after two years of testing, Armstrong grew
652 impatient, RCA began to use its power with the government to stall
653 FM radio's deployment generally. In
1936, RCA hired the former head
654 of the FCC and assigned him the task of assuring that the FCC assign
655 spectrum in a way that would castrate FM
—principally by moving FM
656 radio to a different band of spectrum. At first, these efforts failed. But
657 when Armstrong and the nation were distracted by World War II,
658 RCA's work began to be more successful. Soon after the war ended, the
659 FCC announced a set of policies that would have one clear effect: FM
660 radio would be crippled. As Lawrence Lessing described it,
662 <!-- PAGE BREAK 21 -->
665 The series of body blows that FM radio received right after the
666 war, in a series of rulings manipulated through the FCC by the
667 big radio interests, were almost incredible in their force and
668 deviousness.
<footnote><para>
673 <indexterm><primary>AT
&T
</primary></indexterm>
675 To make room in the spectrum for RCA's latest gamble, television,
676 FM radio users were to be moved to a totally new spectrum band. The
677 power of FM radio stations was also cut, meaning FM could no longer
678 be used to beam programs from one part of the country to another.
679 (This change was strongly supported by AT
&T, because the loss of
680 FM relaying stations would mean radio stations would have to buy
681 wired links from AT
&T.) The spread of FM radio was thus choked, at
685 Armstrong resisted RCA's efforts. In response, RCA resisted
686 Armstrong's patents. After incorporating FM technology into the
687 emerging standard for television, RCA declared the patents
688 invalid
—baselessly, and almost fifteen years after they were
689 issued. It thus refused to pay him royalties. For six years, Armstrong
690 fought an expensive war of litigation to defend the patents. Finally,
691 just as the patents expired, RCA offered a settlement so low that it
692 would not even cover Armstrong's lawyers' fees. Defeated, broken, and
693 now broke, in
1954 Armstrong wrote a short note to his wife and then
694 stepped out of a thirteenth-story window to his death.
697 This is how the law sometimes works. Not often this tragically, and
698 rarely with heroic drama, but sometimes, this is how it works. From
699 the beginning, government and government agencies have been subject to
700 capture. They are more likely captured when a powerful interest is
701 threatened by either a legal or technical change. That powerful
702 interest too often exerts its influence within the government to get
703 the government to protect it. The rhetoric of this protection is of
704 course always public spirited; the reality is something
705 different. Ideas that were as solid as rock in one age, but that, left
706 to themselves, would crumble in
707 <!-- PAGE BREAK 22 -->
708 another, are sustained through this subtle corruption of our political
709 process. RCA had what the Causbys did not: the power to stifle the
710 effect of technological change.
713 There's no single inventor of the Internet. Nor is there any good date
714 upon which to mark its birth. Yet in a very short time, the Internet
715 has become part of ordinary American life. According to the Pew
716 Internet and American Life Project,
58 percent of Americans had access
717 to the Internet in
2002, up from
49 percent two years
718 before.
<footnote><para>
719 Amanda Lenhart, "The Ever-Shifting Internet Population: A New Look at
720 Internet Access and the Digital Divide," Pew Internet and American
721 Life Project,
15 April
2003:
6, available at
722 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
2</ulink>.
724 That number could well exceed two thirds of the nation by the end
728 As the Internet has been integrated into ordinary life, it has
729 changed things. Some of these changes are technical
—the Internet has
730 made communication faster, it has lowered the cost of gathering data,
731 and so on. These technical changes are not the focus of this book. They
732 are important. They are not well understood. But they are the sort of
733 thing that would simply go away if we all just switched the Internet off.
734 They don't affect people who don't use the Internet, or at least they
735 don't affect them directly. They are the proper subject of a book about
736 the Internet. But this is not a book about the Internet.
739 Instead, this book is about an effect of the Internet beyond the
740 Internet itself: an effect upon how culture is made. My claim is that
741 the Internet has induced an important and unrecognized change in that
742 process. That change will radically transform a tradition that is as
743 old as the Republic itself. Most, if they recognized this change,
744 would reject it. Yet most don't even see the change that the Internet
748 We can glimpse a sense of this change by distinguishing between
749 commercial and noncommercial culture, and by mapping the law's
750 regulation of each. By "commercial culture" I mean that part of our
751 culture that is produced and sold or produced to be sold. By
752 "noncommercial culture" I mean all the rest. When old men sat around
754 <!-- PAGE BREAK 23 -->
755 street corners telling stories that kids and others consumed, that was
756 noncommercial culture. When Noah Webster published his "Reader," or
757 Joel Barlow his poetry, that was commercial culture.
760 At the beginning of our history, and for just about the whole of our
761 tradition, noncommercial culture was essentially unregulated. Of
762 course, if your stories were lewd, or if your song disturbed the
763 peace, then the law might intervene. But the law was never directly
764 concerned with the creation or spread of this form of culture, and it
765 left this culture "free." The ordinary ways in which ordinary
766 individuals shared and transformed their culture
—telling
767 stories, reenacting scenes from plays or TV, participating in fan
768 clubs, sharing music, making tapes
—were left alone by the law.
771 The focus of the law was on commercial creativity. At first slightly,
772 then quite extensively, the law protected the incentives of creators by
773 granting them exclusive rights to their creative work, so that they could
774 sell those exclusive rights in a commercial
775 marketplace.
<footnote>
777 This is not the only purpose of copyright, though it is the overwhelmingly
778 primary purpose of the copyright established in the federal constitution.
779 State copyright law historically protected not just the commercial interest in
780 publication, but also a privacy interest. By granting authors the exclusive
781 right to first publication, state copyright law gave authors the power to
782 control the spread of facts about them. See Samuel D. Warren and Louis
783 D. Brandeis, "The Right to Privacy," Harvard Law Review
4 (
1890):
193,
785 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
787 This is also, of course, an important part of creativity and culture,
788 and it has become an increasingly important part in America. But in no
789 sense was it dominant within our tradition. It was instead just one
790 part, a controlled part, balanced with the free.
793 This rough divide between the free and the controlled has now
794 been erased.
<footnote><para>
795 See Jessica Litman,
<citetitle>Digital Copyright
</citetitle> (New York: Prometheus Books,
797 <indexterm><primary>Litman, Jessica
</primary></indexterm>
799 The Internet has set the stage for this erasure and, pushed by big
800 media, the law has now affected it. For the first time in our
801 tradition, the ordinary ways in which individuals create and share
802 culture fall within the reach of the regulation of the law, which has
803 expanded to draw within its control a vast amount of culture and
804 creativity that it never reached before. The technology that preserved
805 the balance of our history
—between uses of our culture that were
806 free and uses of our culture that were only upon permission
—has
807 been undone. The consequence is that we are less and less a free
808 culture, more and more a permission culture.
810 <!-- PAGE BREAK 24 -->
812 This change gets justified as necessary to protect commercial
813 creativity. And indeed, protectionism is precisely its
814 motivation. But the protectionism that justifies the changes that I
815 will describe below is not the limited and balanced sort that has
816 defined the law in the past. This is not a protectionism to protect
817 artists. It is instead a protectionism to protect certain forms of
818 business. Corporations threatened by the potential of the Internet to
819 change the way both commercial and noncommercial culture are made and
820 shared have united to induce lawmakers to use the law to protect
821 them. It is the story of RCA and Armstrong; it is the dream of the
825 For the Internet has unleashed an extraordinary possibility for many
826 to participate in the process of building and cultivating a culture
827 that reaches far beyond local boundaries. That power has changed the
828 marketplace for making and cultivating culture generally, and that
829 change in turn threatens established content industries. The Internet
830 is thus to the industries that built and distributed content in the
831 twentieth century what FM radio was to AM radio, or what the truck was
832 to the railroad industry of the nineteenth century: the beginning of
833 the end, or at least a substantial transformation. Digital
834 technologies, tied to the Internet, could produce a vastly more
835 competitive and vibrant market for building and cultivating culture;
836 that market could include a much wider and more diverse range of
837 creators; those creators could produce and distribute a much more
838 vibrant range of creativity; and depending upon a few important
839 factors, those creators could earn more on average from this system
840 than creators do today
—all so long as the RCAs of our day don't
841 use the law to protect themselves against this competition.
844 Yet, as I argue in the pages that follow, that is precisely what is
845 happening in our culture today. These modern-day equivalents of the
846 early twentieth-century radio or nineteenth-century railroads are
847 using their power to get the law to protect them against this new,
848 more efficient, more vibrant technology for building culture. They are
849 succeeding in their plan to remake the Internet before the Internet
853 It doesn't seem this way to many. The battles over copyright and the
854 <!-- PAGE BREAK 25 -->
855 Internet seem remote to most. To the few who follow them, they seem
856 mainly about a much simpler brace of questions
—whether "piracy" will
857 be permitted, and whether "property" will be protected. The "war" that
858 has been waged against the technologies of the Internet
—what
859 Motion Picture Association of America (MPAA) president Jack Valenti
860 calls his "own terrorist war"
<footnote><para>
861 Amy Harmon, "Black Hawk Download: Moving Beyond Music, Pirates
862 Use New Tools to Turn the Net into an Illicit Video Club,"
<citetitle>New York
863 Times
</citetitle>,
17 January
2002.
864 </para></footnote>—has been framed as a battle about the
865 rule of law and respect for property. To know which side to take in this
866 war, most think that we need only decide whether we're for property or
870 If those really were the choices, then I would be with Jack Valenti
871 and the content industry. I, too, am a believer in property, and
872 especially in the importance of what Mr. Valenti nicely calls
873 "creative property." I believe that "piracy" is wrong, and that the
874 law, properly tuned, should punish "piracy," whether on or off the
878 But those simple beliefs mask a much more fundamental question
879 and a much more dramatic change. My fear is that unless we come to see
880 this change, the war to rid the world of Internet "pirates" will also rid our
881 culture of values that have been integral to our tradition from the start.
884 These values built a tradition that, for at least the first
180 years of
885 our Republic, guaranteed creators the right to build freely upon their
886 past, and protected creators and innovators from either state or private
887 control. The First Amendment protected creators against state control.
888 And as Professor Neil Netanel powerfully argues,
<footnote>
890 Neil W. Netanel, "Copyright and a Democratic Civil Society,"
<citetitle>Yale Law
891 Journal
</citetitle> 106 (
1996):
283.
892 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock
</primary></indexterm>
894 copyright law, properly balanced, protected creators against private
895 control. Our tradition was thus neither Soviet nor the tradition of
896 patrons. It instead carved out a wide berth within which creators
897 could cultivate and extend our culture.
900 Yet the law's response to the Internet, when tied to changes in the
901 technology of the Internet itself, has massively increased the
902 effective regulation of creativity in America. To build upon or
903 critique the culture around us one must ask, Oliver Twist
–like,
904 for permission first. Permission is, of course, often
905 granted
—but it is not often granted to the critical or the
906 independent. We have built a kind of cultural nobility; those within
907 the noble class live easily; those outside it don't. But it is
908 nobility of any form that is alien to our tradition.
910 <!-- PAGE BREAK 26. FIXME: Should "Is it" be "It is" ? -->
912 The story that follows is about this war. Is it not about the
913 "centrality of technology" to ordinary life. I don't believe in gods,
914 digital or otherwise. Nor is it an effort to demonize any individual
915 or group, for neither do I believe in a devil, corporate or
916 otherwise. It is not a morality tale. Nor is it a call to jihad
920 It is instead an effort to understand a hopelessly destructive war
921 inspired by the technologies of the Internet but reaching far beyond
922 its code. And by understanding this battle, it is an effort to map
923 peace. There is no good reason for the current struggle around
924 Internet technologies to continue. There will be great harm to our
925 tradition and culture if it is allowed to continue unchecked. We must
926 come to understand the source of this war. We must resolve it soon.
928 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
929 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
931 Like the Causbys' battle, this war is, in part, about "property." The
932 property of this war is not as tangible as the Causbys', and no
933 innocent chicken has yet to lose its life. Yet the ideas surrounding
934 this "property" are as obvious to most as the Causbys' claim about the
935 sacredness of their farm was to them. We are the Causbys. Most of us
936 take for granted the extraordinarily powerful claims that the owners
937 of "intellectual property" now assert. Most of us, like the Causbys,
938 treat these claims as obvious. And hence we, like the Causbys, object
939 when a new technology interferes with this property. It is as plain to
940 us as it was to them that the new technologies of the Internet are
941 "trespassing" upon legitimate claims of "property." It is as plain to
942 us as it was to them that the law should intervene to stop this
945 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
946 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
948 And thus, when geeks and technologists defend their Armstrong or
949 Wright brothers technology, most of us are simply unsympathetic.
950 Common sense does not revolt. Unlike in the case of the unlucky
951 Causbys, common sense is on the side of the property owners in this
953 <!-- PAGE BREAK 27 -->
954 the lucky Wright brothers, the Internet has not inspired a revolution
958 My hope is to push this common sense along. I have become increasingly
959 amazed by the power of this idea of intellectual property and, more
960 importantly, its power to disable critical thought by policy makers
961 and citizens. There has never been a time in our history when more of
962 our "culture" was as "owned" as it is now. And yet there has never
963 been a time when the concentration of power to control the
964 <emphasis>uses
</emphasis> of culture has been as unquestioningly
965 accepted as it is now.
968 The puzzle is, Why? Is it because we have come to understand a truth
969 about the value and importance of absolute property over ideas and
970 culture? Is it because we have discovered that our tradition of
971 rejecting such an absolute claim was wrong?
974 Or is it because the idea of absolute property over ideas and culture
975 benefits the RCAs of our time and fits our own unreflective intuitions?
978 Is the radical shift away from our tradition of free culture an instance
979 of America correcting a mistake from its past, as we did after a bloody
980 war with slavery, and as we are slowly doing with inequality? Or is the
981 radical shift away from our tradition of free culture yet another example
982 of a political system captured by a few powerful special interests?
985 Does common sense lead to the extremes on this question because common
986 sense actually believes in these extremes? Or does common sense stand
987 silent in the face of these extremes because, as with Armstrong versus
988 RCA, the more powerful side has ensured that it has the more powerful
991 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
992 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
994 I don't mean to be mysterious. My own views are resolved. I believe it
995 was right for common sense to revolt against the extremism of the
996 Causbys. I believe it would be right for common sense to revolt
997 against the extreme claims made today on behalf of "intellectual
998 property." What the law demands today is increasingly as silly as a
999 sheriff arresting an airplane for trespass. But the consequences of
1000 this silliness will be much more profound.
1001 <!-- PAGE BREAK 28 -->
1004 The struggle that rages just now centers on two ideas: "piracy" and
1005 "property." My aim in this book's next two parts is to explore these two
1009 My method is not the usual method of an academic. I don't want to
1010 plunge you into a complex argument, buttressed with references to
1011 obscure French theorists
—however natural that is for the weird
1012 sort we academics have become. Instead I begin in each part with a
1013 collection of stories that set a context within which these apparently
1014 simple ideas can be more fully understood.
1017 The two sections set up the core claim of this book: that while the
1018 Internet has indeed produced something fantastic and new, our
1019 government, pushed by big media to respond to this "something new," is
1020 destroying something very old. Rather than understanding the changes
1021 the Internet might permit, and rather than taking time to let "common
1022 sense" resolve how best to respond, we are allowing those most
1023 threatened by the changes to use their power to change the
1024 law
—and more importantly, to use their power to change something
1025 fundamental about who we have always been.
1028 We allow this, I believe, not because it is right, and not because
1029 most of us really believe in these changes. We allow it because the
1030 interests most threatened are among the most powerful players in our
1031 depressingly compromised process of making law. This book is the story
1032 of one more consequence of this form of corruption
—a consequence
1033 to which most of us remain oblivious.
1036 <!-- PAGE BREAK 29 -->
1037 <part id=
"c-piracy">
1038 <title>"PIRACY"</title>
1040 <!-- PAGE BREAK 30 -->
1041 <indexterm id=
"idxmansfield1" class='startofrange'
>
1042 <primary>Mansfield, William Murray, Lord
</primary>
1045 Since the inception of the law regulating creative property, there has
1046 been a war against "piracy." The precise contours of this concept,
1047 "piracy," are hard to sketch, but the animating injustice is easy to
1048 capture. As Lord Mansfield wrote in a case that extended the reach of
1049 English copyright law to include sheet music,
1053 A person may use the copy by playing it, but he has no right to
1054 rob the author of the profit, by multiplying copies and disposing
1055 of them for his own use.
<footnote><para>
1057 <citetitle>Bach
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Longman
</citetitle>,
98 Eng. Rep.
1274 (
1777) (Mansfield).
1060 <indexterm startref=
"idxmansfield1" class='endofrange'
/>
1063 Today we are in the middle of another "war" against "piracy." The
1064 Internet has provoked this war. The Internet makes possible the
1065 efficient spread of content. Peer-to-peer (p2p) file sharing is among
1066 the most efficient of the efficient technologies the Internet
1067 enables. Using distributed intelligence, p2p systems facilitate the
1068 easy spread of content in a way unimagined a generation ago.
1069 <!-- PAGE BREAK 31 -->
1072 This efficiency does not respect the traditional lines of copyright.
1073 The network doesn't discriminate between the sharing of copyrighted
1074 and uncopyrighted content. Thus has there been a vast amount of
1075 sharing of copyrighted content. That sharing in turn has excited the
1076 war, as copyright owners fear the sharing will "rob the author of the
1080 The warriors have turned to the courts, to the legislatures, and
1081 increasingly to technology to defend their "property" against this
1082 "piracy." A generation of Americans, the warriors warn, is being
1083 raised to believe that "property" should be "free." Forget tattoos,
1084 never mind body piercing
—our kids are becoming
1085 <emphasis>thieves
</emphasis>!
1088 There's no doubt that "piracy" is wrong, and that pirates should be
1089 punished. But before we summon the executioners, we should put this
1090 notion of "piracy" in some context. For as the concept is increasingly
1091 used, at its core is an extraordinary idea that is almost certainly wrong.
1094 The idea goes something like this:
1098 Creative work has value; whenever I use, or take, or build upon
1099 the creative work of others, I am taking from them something of
1100 value. Whenever I take something of value from someone else, I
1101 should have their permission. The taking of something of value
1102 from someone else without permission is wrong. It is a form of
1106 <indexterm><primary>Dreyfuss, Rochelle
</primary></indexterm>
1108 This view runs deep within the current debates. It is what NYU law
1109 professor Rochelle Dreyfuss criticizes as the "if value, then right"
1110 theory of creative property
<footnote><para>
1112 See Rochelle Dreyfuss, "Expressive Genericity: Trademarks as Language
1113 in the Pepsi Generation,"
<citetitle>Notre Dame Law Review
</citetitle> 65 (
1990):
397.
1115 —if there is value, then someone must have a
1116 right to that value. It is the perspective that led a composers' rights
1117 organization, ASCAP, to sue the Girl Scouts for failing to pay for the
1118 songs that girls sang around Girl Scout campfires.
<footnote><para>
1120 Lisa Bannon, "The Birds May Sing, but Campers Can't Unless They Pay
1121 Up,"
<citetitle>Wall Street Journal
</citetitle>,
21 August
1996, available at
1122 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
3</ulink>; Jonathan
1123 Zittrain, "Calling Off the Copyright War: In Battle of Property vs. Free
1124 Speech, No One Wins,"
<citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
24 November
2002.
1125 <indexterm><primary>Zittrain, Jonathan
</primary></indexterm>
1127 There was "value" (the songs) so there must have been a
1128 "right"
—even against the Girl Scouts.
1130 <indexterm><primary>ASCAP
</primary></indexterm>
1132 This idea is certainly a possible understanding of how creative
1133 property should work. It might well be a possible design for a system
1134 <!-- PAGE BREAK 32 -->
1135 of law protecting creative property. But the "if value, then right"
1136 theory of creative property has never been America's theory of
1137 creative property. It has never taken hold within our law.
1140 Instead, in our tradition, intellectual property is an instrument. It
1141 sets the groundwork for a richly creative society but remains
1142 subservient to the value of creativity. The current debate has this
1143 turned around. We have become so concerned with protecting the
1144 instrument that we are losing sight of the value.
1147 The source of this confusion is a distinction that the law no longer
1148 takes care to draw
—the distinction between republishing someone's
1149 work on the one hand and building upon or transforming that work on
1150 the other. Copyright law at its birth had only publishing as its concern;
1151 copyright law today regulates both.
1154 Before the technologies of the Internet, this conflation didn't matter
1155 all that much. The technologies of publishing were expensive; that
1156 meant the vast majority of publishing was commercial. Commercial
1157 entities could bear the burden of the law
—even the burden of the
1158 Byzantine complexity that copyright law has become. It was just one
1159 more expense of doing business.
1161 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
1163 But with the birth of the Internet, this natural limit to the reach of
1164 the law has disappeared. The law controls not just the creativity of
1165 commercial creators but effectively that of anyone. Although that
1166 expansion would not matter much if copyright law regulated only
1167 "copying," when the law regulates as broadly and obscurely as it does,
1168 the extension matters a lot. The burden of this law now vastly
1169 outweighs any original benefit
—certainly as it affects
1170 noncommercial creativity, and increasingly as it affects commercial
1171 creativity as well. Thus, as we'll see more clearly in the chapters
1172 below, the law's role is less and less to support creativity, and more
1173 and more to protect certain industries against competition. Just at
1174 the time digital technology could unleash an extraordinary range of
1175 commercial and noncommercial creativity, the law burdens this
1176 creativity with insanely complex and vague rules and with the threat
1177 of obscenely severe penalties. We may
1178 <!-- PAGE BREAK 33 -->
1179 be seeing, as Richard Florida writes, the "Rise of the Creative Class."
<footnote>
1182 In
<citetitle>The Rise of the Creative Class
</citetitle> (New York: Basic Books,
2002),
1183 Richard Florida documents a shift in the nature of labor toward a
1184 labor of creativity. His work, however, doesn't directly address the
1185 legal conditions under which that creativity is enabled or stifled. I
1186 certainly agree with him about the importance and significance of this
1187 change, but I also believe the conditions under which it will be
1188 enabled are much more tenuous.
1189 <indexterm><primary>Florida, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
1191 Unfortunately, we are also seeing an extraordinary rise of regulation of
1192 this creative class.
1195 These burdens make no sense in our tradition. We should begin by
1196 understanding that tradition a bit more and by placing in their proper
1197 context the current battles about behavior labeled "piracy."
1201 <!-- PAGE BREAK 34 -->
1202 <chapter id=
"creators">
1203 <title>CHAPTER ONE: Creators
</title>
1205 In
1928, a cartoon character was born. An early Mickey Mouse
1206 made his debut in May of that year, in a silent flop called
<citetitle>Plane Crazy
</citetitle>.
1207 In November, in New York City's Colony Theater, in the first widely
1208 distributed cartoon synchronized with sound,
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle> brought
1209 to life the character that would become Mickey Mouse.
1212 Synchronized sound had been introduced to film a year earlier in the
1213 movie
<citetitle>The Jazz Singer
</citetitle>. That success led Walt Disney to copy the
1214 technique and mix sound with cartoons. No one knew whether it would
1215 work or, if it did work, whether it would win an audience. But when
1216 Disney ran a test in the summer of
1928, the results were unambiguous.
1217 As Disney describes that first experiment,
1221 A couple of my boys could read music, and one of them could play
1222 a mouth organ. We put them in a room where they could not see
1223 the screen and arranged to pipe their sound into the room where
1224 our wives and friends were going to see the picture.
1225 <!-- PAGE BREAK 35 -->
1228 The boys worked from a music and sound-effects score. After several
1229 false starts, sound and action got off with the gun. The mouth
1230 organist played the tune, the rest of us in the sound department
1231 bammed tin pans and blew slide whistles on the beat. The
1232 synchronization was pretty close.
1235 The effect on our little audience was nothing less than electric.
1236 They responded almost instinctively to this union of sound and
1237 motion. I thought they were kidding me. So they put me in the audience
1238 and ran the action again. It was terrible, but it was wonderful! And
1239 it was something new!
<footnote><para>
1241 Leonard Maltin,
<citetitle>Of Mice and Magic: A History of American Animated
1242 Cartoons
</citetitle> (New York: Penguin Books,
1987),
34–35.
1247 Disney's then partner, and one of animation's most extraordinary
1248 talents, Ub Iwerks, put it more strongly: "I have never been so thrilled
1249 in my life. Nothing since has ever equaled it."
1250 <indexterm><primary>Iwerks, Ub
</primary></indexterm>
1253 Disney had created something very new, based upon something relatively
1254 new. Synchronized sound brought life to a form of creativity that had
1255 rarely
—except in Disney's hands
—been anything more than
1256 filler for other films. Throughout animation's early history, it was
1257 Disney's invention that set the standard that others struggled to
1258 match. And quite often, Disney's great genius, his spark of
1259 creativity, was built upon the work of others.
1262 This much is familiar. What you might not know is that
1928 also marks
1263 another important transition. In that year, a comic (as opposed to
1264 cartoon) genius created his last independently produced silent film.
1265 That genius was Buster Keaton. The film was
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>.
1268 Keaton was born into a vaudeville family in
1895. In the era of silent
1269 film, he had mastered using broad physical comedy as a way to spark
1270 uncontrollable laughter from his audience.
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill,
1271 Jr
</citetitle>. was a classic of this form, famous among film buffs for its
1272 incredible stunts. The film was classic Keaton
—wildly popular
1273 and among the best of its genre.
1276 <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>. appeared before Disney's cartoon Steamboat
1278 <!-- PAGE BREAK 36 -->
1279 The coincidence of titles is not coincidental. Steamboat Willie is a
1280 direct cartoon parody of Steamboat Bill,
<footnote><para>
1282 I am grateful to David Gerstein and his careful history, described at
1283 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
4</ulink>.
1284 According to Dave Smith of the Disney Archives, Disney paid royalties to
1285 use the music for five songs in
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle>: "Steamboat Bill," "The
1286 Simpleton" (Delille), "Mischief Makers" (Carbonara), "Joyful Hurry No.
1"
1287 (Baron), and "Gawky Rube" (Lakay). A sixth song, "The Turkey in the
1288 Straw," was already in the public domain. Letter from David Smith to
1289 Harry Surden,
10 July
2003, on file with author.
1291 and both are built upon a common song as a source. It is not just from
1292 the invention of synchronized sound in
<citetitle>The Jazz Singer
</citetitle> that we
1293 get
<citetitle>Steamboat Willie
</citetitle>. It is also from Buster Keaton's invention of
1294 Steamboat Bill, Jr., itself inspired by the song "Steamboat Bill,"
1295 that we get Steamboat Willie, and then from Steamboat Willie, Mickey
1299 This "borrowing" was nothing unique, either for Disney or for the
1300 industry. Disney was always parroting the feature-length mainstream
1301 films of his day.
<footnote><para>
1303 He was also a fan of the public domain. See Chris Sprigman, "The Mouse
1304 that Ate the Public Domain," Findlaw,
5 March
2002, at
1305 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
5</ulink>.
1307 So did many others. Early cartoons are filled with
1308 knockoffs
—slight variations on winning themes; retellings of
1309 ancient stories. The key to success was the brilliance of the
1310 differences. With Disney, it was sound that gave his animation its
1311 spark. Later, it was the quality of his work relative to the
1312 production-line cartoons with which he competed. Yet these additions
1313 were built upon a base that was borrowed. Disney added to the work of
1314 others before him, creating something new out of something just barely
1318 Sometimes this borrowing was slight. Sometimes it was significant.
1319 Think about the fairy tales of the Brothers Grimm. If you're as
1320 oblivious as I was, you're likely to think that these tales are happy,
1321 sweet stories, appropriate for any child at bedtime. In fact, the
1322 Grimm fairy tales are, well, for us, grim. It is a rare and perhaps
1323 overly ambitious parent who would dare to read these bloody,
1324 moralistic stories to his or her child, at bedtime or anytime.
1327 Disney took these stories and retold them in a way that carried them
1328 into a new age. He animated the stories, with both characters and
1329 light. Without removing the elements of fear and danger altogether, he
1330 made funny what was dark and injected a genuine emotion of compassion
1331 where before there was fear. And not just with the work of the
1332 Brothers Grimm. Indeed, the catalog of Disney work drawing upon the
1333 work of others is astonishing when set together:
<citetitle>Snow White
</citetitle>
1334 (
1937),
<citetitle>Fantasia
</citetitle> (
1940),
<citetitle>Pinocchio
</citetitle> (
1940),
<citetitle>Dumbo
</citetitle>
1335 (
1941),
<citetitle>Bambi
</citetitle> (
1942),
<citetitle>Song of the South
</citetitle> (
1946),
1336 <citetitle>Cinderella
</citetitle> (
1950),
<citetitle>Alice in Wonderland
</citetitle> (
1951),
<citetitle>Robin
1337 Hood
</citetitle> (
1952),
<citetitle>Peter Pan
</citetitle> (
1953),
<citetitle>Lady and the Tramp
</citetitle>
1338 <!-- PAGE BREAK 37 -->
1339 (
1955),
<citetitle>Mulan
</citetitle> (
1998),
<citetitle>Sleeping Beauty
</citetitle> (
1959),
<citetitle>101
1340 Dalmatians
</citetitle> (
1961),
<citetitle>The Sword in the Stone
</citetitle> (
1963), and
1341 <citetitle>The Jungle Book
</citetitle> (
1967)
—not to mention a recent example
1342 that we should perhaps quickly forget,
<citetitle>Treasure Planet
</citetitle>
1343 (
2003). In all of these cases, Disney (or Disney, Inc.) ripped
1344 creativity from the culture around him, mixed that creativity with his
1345 own extraordinary talent, and then burned that mix into the soul of
1346 his culture. Rip, mix, and burn.
1349 This is a kind of creativity. It is a creativity that we should
1350 remember and celebrate. There are some who would say that there is no
1351 creativity except this kind. We don't need to go that far to recognize
1352 its importance. We could call this "Disney creativity," though that
1353 would be a bit misleading. It is, more precisely, "Walt Disney
1354 creativity"
—a form of expression and genius that builds upon the
1355 culture around us and makes it something different.
1357 <para> In
1928, the culture that Disney was free to draw upon was
1358 relatively fresh. The public domain in
1928 was not very old and was
1359 therefore quite vibrant. The average term of copyright was just around
1360 thirty years
—for that minority of creative work that was in fact
1361 copyrighted.
<footnote><para>
1363 Until
1976, copyright law granted an author the possibility of two terms: an
1364 initial term and a renewal term. I have calculated the "average" term by
1366 the weighted average of total registrations for any particular year,
1367 and the proportion renewing. Thus, if
100 copyrights are registered in year
1368 1, and only
15 are renewed, and the renewal term is
28 years, then the
1370 term is
32.2 years. For the renewal data and other relevant data, see the
1371 Web site associated with this book, available at
1372 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
6</ulink>.
1374 That means that for thirty years, on average, the authors or
1375 copyright holders of a creative work had an "exclusive right" to control
1376 certain uses of the work. To use this copyrighted work in limited ways
1377 required the permission of the copyright owner.
1380 At the end of a copyright term, a work passes into the public domain.
1381 No permission is then needed to draw upon or use that work. No
1382 permission and, hence, no lawyers. The public domain is a "lawyer-free
1383 zone." Thus, most of the content from the nineteenth century was free
1384 for Disney to use and build upon in
1928. It was free for
1385 anyone
— whether connected or not, whether rich or not, whether
1386 approved or not
—to use and build upon.
1389 This is the ways things always were
—until quite recently. For most
1390 of our history, the public domain was just over the horizon. From
1391 until
1978, the average copyright term was never more than thirty-two
1392 years, meaning that most culture just a generation and a half old was
1394 <!-- PAGE BREAK 38 -->
1395 free for anyone to build upon without the permission of anyone else.
1396 Today's equivalent would be for creative work from the
1960s and
1970s
1397 to now be free for the next Walt Disney to build upon without
1398 permission. Yet today, the public domain is presumptive only for
1399 content from before the Great Depression.
1402 Of course, Walt Disney had no monopoly on "Walt Disney creativity."
1403 Nor does America. The norm of free culture has, until recently, and
1404 except within totalitarian nations, been broadly exploited and quite
1408 Consider, for example, a form of creativity that seems strange to many
1409 Americans but that is inescapable within Japanese culture:
<citetitle>manga
</citetitle>, or
1410 comics. The Japanese are fanatics about comics. Some
40 percent of
1411 publications are comics, and
30 percent of publication revenue derives
1412 from comics. They are everywhere in Japanese society, at every
1413 magazine stand, carried by a large proportion of commuters on Japan's
1414 extraordinary system of public transportation.
1417 Americans tend to look down upon this form of culture. That's an
1418 unattractive characteristic of ours. We're likely to misunderstand
1419 much about manga, because few of us have ever read anything close to
1420 the stories that these "graphic novels" tell. For the Japanese, manga
1421 cover every aspect of social life. For us, comics are "men in tights."
1422 And anyway, it's not as if the New York subways are filled with
1423 readers of Joyce or even Hemingway. People of different cultures
1424 distract themselves in different ways, the Japanese in this
1425 interestingly different way.
1428 But my purpose here is not to understand manga. It is to describe a
1429 variant on manga that from a lawyer's perspective is quite odd, but
1430 from a Disney perspective is quite familiar.
1433 This is the phenomenon of
<citetitle>doujinshi
</citetitle>. Doujinshi are also comics, but
1434 they are a kind of copycat comic. A rich ethic governs the creation of
1435 doujinshi. It is not doujinshi if it is
<emphasis>just
</emphasis> a
1436 copy; the artist must make a contribution to the art he copies, by
1437 transforming it either subtly or
1438 <!-- PAGE BREAK 39 -->
1439 significantly. A doujinshi comic can thus take a mainstream comic and
1440 develop it differently
—with a different story line. Or the comic can
1441 keep the character in character but change its look slightly. There is no
1442 formula for what makes the doujinshi sufficiently "different." But they
1443 must be different if they are to be considered true doujinshi. Indeed,
1444 there are committees that review doujinshi for inclusion within shows
1445 and reject any copycat comic that is merely a copy.
1448 These copycat comics are not a tiny part of the manga market. They are
1449 huge. More than
33,
000 "circles" of creators from across Japan produce
1450 these bits of Walt Disney creativity. More than
450,
000 Japanese come
1451 together twice a year, in the largest public gathering in the country,
1452 to exchange and sell them. This market exists in parallel to the
1453 mainstream commercial manga market. In some ways, it obviously
1454 competes with that market, but there is no sustained effort by those
1455 who control the commercial manga market to shut the doujinshi market
1456 down. It flourishes, despite the competition and despite the law.
1459 The most puzzling feature of the doujinshi market, for those trained
1460 in the law, at least, is that it is allowed to exist at all. Under
1461 Japanese copyright law, which in this respect (on paper) mirrors
1462 American copyright law, the doujinshi market is an illegal
1463 one. Doujinshi are plainly "derivative works." There is no general
1464 practice by doujinshi artists of securing the permission of the manga
1465 creators. Instead, the practice is simply to take and modify the
1466 creations of others, as Walt Disney did with
<citetitle>Steamboat Bill,
1467 Jr
</citetitle>. Under both Japanese and American law, that "taking" without
1468 the permission of the original copyright owner is illegal. It is an
1469 infringement of the original copyright to make a copy or a derivative
1470 work without the original copyright owner's permission.
1472 <indexterm id=
"idxwinickjudd" class='startofrange'
>
1473 <primary>Winick, Judd
</primary>
1476 Yet this illegal market exists and indeed flourishes in Japan, and in
1477 the view of many, it is precisely because it exists that Japanese manga
1478 flourish. As American graphic novelist Judd Winick said to me, "The
1479 early days of comics in America are very much like what's going on
1480 in Japan now. . . . American comics were born out of copying each
1481 <!-- PAGE BREAK 40 -->
1482 other. . . . That's how [the artists] learn to draw
—by going into comic
1483 books and not tracing them, but looking at them and copying them"
1484 and building from them.
<footnote><para>
1486 For an excellent history, see Scott McCloud,
<citetitle>Reinventing Comics
</citetitle> (New
1487 York: Perennial,
2000).
1491 American comics now are quite different, Winick explains, in part
1492 because of the legal difficulty of adapting comics the way doujinshi are
1493 allowed. Speaking of Superman, Winick told me, "there are these rules
1494 and you have to stick to them." There are things Superman "cannot"
1495 do. "As a creator, it's frustrating having to stick to some parameters
1496 which are fifty years old."
1498 <indexterm startref=
"idxwinickjudd" class='endofrange'
/>
1500 The norm in Japan mitigates this legal difficulty. Some say it is
1501 precisely the benefit accruing to the Japanese manga market that
1502 explains the mitigation. Temple University law professor Salil Mehra,
1503 for example, hypothesizes that the manga market accepts these
1504 technical violations because they spur the manga market to be more
1505 wealthy and productive. Everyone would be worse off if doujinshi were
1506 banned, so the law does not ban doujinshi.
<footnote><para>
1508 See Salil K. Mehra, "Copyright and Comics in Japan: Does Law Explain
1509 Why All the Comics My Kid Watches Are Japanese Imports?"
<citetitle>Rutgers Law
1510 Review
</citetitle> 55 (
2002):
155,
182.
"[T]here might be a collective economic
1511 rationality that would lead manga and anime artists to forgo bringing
1512 legal actions for infringement. One hypothesis is that all manga
1513 artists may be better off collectively if they set aside their
1514 individual self-interest and decide not to press their legal
1515 rights. This is essentially a prisoner's dilemma solved."
1519 The problem with this story, however, as Mehra plainly acknowledges,
1520 is that the mechanism producing this laissez faire response is not
1521 clear. It may well be that the market as a whole is better off if
1522 doujinshi are permitted rather than banned, but that doesn't explain
1523 why individual copyright owners don't sue nonetheless. If the law has
1524 no general exception for doujinshi, and indeed in some cases
1525 individual manga artists have sued doujinshi artists, why is there not
1526 a more general pattern of blocking this "free taking" by the doujinshi
1530 I spent four wonderful months in Japan, and I asked this question
1531 as often as I could. Perhaps the best account in the end was offered by
1532 a friend from a major Japanese law firm. "We don't have enough
1533 lawyers," he told me one afternoon. There "just aren't enough resources
1534 to prosecute cases like this."
1537 This is a theme to which we will return: that regulation by law is a
1538 function of both the words on the books and the costs of making those
1539 words have effect. For now, focus on the obvious question that is
1540 begged: Would Japan be better off with more lawyers? Would manga
1541 <!-- PAGE BREAK 41 -->
1542 be richer if doujinshi artists were regularly prosecuted? Would the
1543 Japanese gain something important if they could end this practice of
1544 uncompensated sharing? Does piracy here hurt the victims of the
1545 piracy, or does it help them? Would lawyers fighting this piracy help
1546 their clients or hurt them?
1547 Let's pause for a moment.
1550 If you're like I was a decade ago, or like most people are when they
1551 first start thinking about these issues, then just about now you should
1552 be puzzled about something you hadn't thought through before.
1555 We live in a world that celebrates "property." I am one of those
1556 celebrants. I believe in the value of property in general, and I also
1557 believe in the value of that weird form of property that lawyers call
1558 "intellectual property."
<footnote><para>
1560 The term
<citetitle>intellectual property
</citetitle> is of relatively recent origin. See
1561 Siva Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
11 (New York: New York
1562 University Press,
2001). See also Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle>
1563 (New York: Random House,
2001),
293 n.
26. The term accurately
1564 describes a set of "property" rights
—copyright, patents,
1565 trademark, and trade-secret
—but the nature of those rights is
1567 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
1569 A large, diverse society cannot survive without property; a large,
1570 diverse, and modern society cannot flourish without intellectual
1574 But it takes just a second's reflection to realize that there is
1575 plenty of value out there that "property" doesn't capture. I don't
1576 mean "money can't buy you love," but rather, value that is plainly
1577 part of a process of production, including commercial as well as
1578 noncommercial production. If Disney animators had stolen a set of
1579 pencils to draw Steamboat Willie, we'd have no hesitation in
1580 condemning that taking as wrong
— even though trivial, even if
1581 unnoticed. Yet there was nothing wrong, at least under the law of the
1582 day, with Disney's taking from Buster Keaton or from the Brothers
1583 Grimm. There was nothing wrong with the taking from Keaton because
1584 Disney's use would have been considered "fair." There was nothing
1585 wrong with the taking from the Grimms because the Grimms' work was in
1589 Thus, even though the things that Disney took
—or more generally,
1590 the things taken by anyone exercising Walt Disney creativity
—are
1591 valuable, our tradition does not treat those takings as wrong. Some
1593 <!-- PAGE BREAK 42 -->
1594 things remain free for the taking within a free culture, and that
1598 The same with the doujinshi culture. If a doujinshi artist broke into
1599 a publisher's office and ran off with a thousand copies of his latest
1600 work
—or even one copy
—without paying, we'd have no hesitation in
1601 saying the artist was wrong. In addition to having trespassed, he would
1602 have stolen something of value. The law bans that stealing in whatever
1603 form, whether large or small.
1606 Yet there is an obvious reluctance, even among Japanese lawyers, to
1607 say that the copycat comic artists are "stealing." This form of Walt
1608 Disney creativity is seen as fair and right, even if lawyers in
1609 particular find it hard to say why.
1612 It's the same with a thousand examples that appear everywhere once you
1613 begin to look. Scientists build upon the work of other scientists
1614 without asking or paying for the privilege. ("Excuse me, Professor
1615 Einstein, but may I have permission to use your theory of relativity
1616 to show that you were wrong about quantum physics?") Acting companies
1617 perform adaptations of the works of Shakespeare without securing
1618 permission from anyone. (Does
<emphasis>anyone
</emphasis> believe
1619 Shakespeare would be better spread within our culture if there were a
1620 central Shakespeare rights clearinghouse that all productions of
1621 Shakespeare must appeal to first?) And Hollywood goes through cycles
1622 with a certain kind of movie: five asteroid films in the late
1990s;
1623 two volcano disaster films in
1997.
1626 Creators here and everywhere are always and at all times building
1627 upon the creativity that went before and that surrounds them now.
1628 That building is always and everywhere at least partially done without
1629 permission and without compensating the original creator. No society,
1630 free or controlled, has ever demanded that every use be paid for or that
1631 permission for Walt Disney creativity must always be sought. Instead,
1632 every society has left a certain bit of its culture free for the taking
—free
1633 societies more fully than unfree, perhaps, but all societies to some degree.
1634 <!-- PAGE BREAK 43 -->
1637 The hard question is therefore not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis> a
1638 culture is free. All cultures are free to some degree. The hard
1639 question instead is "
<emphasis>How
</emphasis> free is this culture?"
1640 How much, and how broadly, is the culture free for others to take and
1641 build upon? Is that freedom limited to party members? To members of
1642 the royal family? To the top ten corporations on the New York Stock
1643 Exchange? Or is that freedom spread broadly? To artists generally,
1644 whether affiliated with the Met or not? To musicians generally,
1645 whether white or not? To filmmakers generally, whether affiliated with
1649 Free cultures are cultures that leave a great deal open for others to
1650 build upon; unfree, or permission, cultures leave much less. Ours was a
1651 free culture. It is becoming much less so.
1654 <!-- PAGE BREAK 44 -->
1656 <chapter id=
"mere-copyists">
1657 <title>CHAPTER TWO: "Mere Copyists"
</title>
1658 <indexterm><primary>Daguerre, Louis
</primary></indexterm>
1660 In
1839, Louis Daguerre invented the first practical technology for
1661 producing what we would call "photographs." Appropriately enough, they
1662 were called "daguerreotypes." The process was complicated and
1663 expensive, and the field was thus limited to professionals and a few
1664 zealous and wealthy amateurs. (There was even an American Daguerre
1665 Association that helped regulate the industry, as do all such
1666 associations, by keeping competition down so as to keep prices up.)
1669 Yet despite high prices, the demand for daguerreotypes was strong.
1670 This pushed inventors to find simpler and cheaper ways to make
1671 "automatic pictures." William Talbot soon discovered a process for
1672 making "negatives." But because the negatives were glass, and had to
1673 be kept wet, the process still remained expensive and cumbersome. In
1674 the
1870s, dry plates were developed, making it easier to separate the
1675 taking of a picture from its developing. These were still plates of
1676 glass, and thus it was still not a process within reach of most
1679 <indexterm id=
"idxeastmangeorge" class='startofrange'
>
1680 <primary>Eastman, George
</primary>
1683 The technological change that made mass photography possible
1684 didn't happen until
1888, and was the creation of a single man. George
1685 <!-- PAGE BREAK 45 -->
1686 Eastman, himself an amateur photographer, was frustrated by the
1687 technology of photographs made with plates. In a flash of insight (so
1688 to speak), Eastman saw that if the film could be made to be flexible,
1689 it could be held on a single spindle. That roll could then be sent to
1690 a developer, driving the costs of photography down substantially. By
1691 lowering the costs, Eastman expected he could dramatically broaden the
1692 population of photographers.
1695 Eastman developed flexible, emulsion-coated paper film and placed
1696 rolls of it in small, simple cameras: the Kodak. The device was
1697 marketed on the basis of its simplicity. "You press the button and we
1698 do the rest."
<footnote><para>
1700 Reese V. Jenkins,
<citetitle>Images and Enterprise
</citetitle> (Baltimore: Johns Hopkins University Press,
1975),
112.
1701 </para></footnote> As he described in
<citetitle>The Kodak Primer
</citetitle>:
1705 The principle of the Kodak system is the separation of the work that
1706 any person whomsoever can do in making a photograph, from the work
1707 that only an expert can do. . . . We furnish anybody, man, woman or
1708 child, who has sufficient intelligence to point a box straight and
1709 press a button, with an instrument which altogether removes from the
1710 practice of photography the necessity for exceptional facilities or,
1711 in fact, any special knowledge of the art. It can be employed without
1712 preliminary study, without a darkroom and without
1713 chemicals.
<footnote>
1716 Brian Coe,
<citetitle>The Birth of Photography
</citetitle> (New York: Taplinger Publishing,
1718 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian
</primary></indexterm>
1723 For $
25, anyone could make pictures. The camera came preloaded
1724 with film, and when it had been used, the camera was returned to an
1725 Eastman factory, where the film was developed. Over time, of course,
1726 the cost of the camera and the ease with which it could be used both
1727 improved. Roll film thus became the basis for the explosive growth of
1728 popular photography. Eastman's camera first went on sale in
1888; one
1729 year later, Kodak was printing more than six thousand negatives a day.
1730 From
1888 through
1909, while industrial production was rising by
4.7
1731 percent, photographic equipment and material sales increased by
1732 percent.
<footnote><para>
1735 </para></footnote> Eastman Kodak's sales during the same period experienced
1736 an average annual increase of over
17 percent.
<footnote><para>
1738 Based on a chart in Jenkins, p.
178.
1741 <indexterm><primary>Coe, Brian
</primary></indexterm>
1744 <!-- PAGE BREAK 46 -->
1745 The real significance of Eastman's invention, however, was not
1746 economic. It was social. Professional photography gave individuals a
1747 glimpse of places they would never otherwise see. Amateur photography
1748 gave them the ability to record their own lives in a way they had
1749 never been able to do before. As author Brian Coe notes, "For the
1750 first time the snapshot album provided the man on the street with a
1751 permanent record of his family and its activities. . . . For the first
1752 time in history there exists an authentic visual record of the
1753 appearance and activities of the common man made without [literary]
1754 interpretation or bias."
<footnote><para>
1760 In this way, the Kodak camera and film were technologies of
1761 expression. The pencil or paintbrush was also a technology of
1762 expression, of course. But it took years of training before they could
1763 be deployed by amateurs in any useful or effective way. With the
1764 Kodak, expression was possible much sooner and more simply. The
1765 barrier to expression was lowered. Snobs would sneer at its "quality";
1766 professionals would discount it as irrelevant. But watch a child study
1767 how best to frame a picture and you get a sense of the experience of
1768 creativity that the Kodak enabled. Democratic tools gave ordinary
1769 people a way to express themselves more easily than any tools could
1773 What was required for this technology to flourish? Obviously,
1774 Eastman's genius was an important part. But also important was the
1775 legal environment within which Eastman's invention grew. For early in
1776 the history of photography, there was a series of judicial decisions
1777 that could well have changed the course of photography substantially.
1778 Courts were asked whether the photographer, amateur or professional,
1779 required permission before he could capture and print whatever image
1780 he wanted. Their answer was no.
<footnote><para>
1782 For illustrative cases, see, for example,
<citetitle>Pavesich
</citetitle>
1783 v.
<citetitle>N.E. Life Ins. Co
</citetitle>.,
50 S.E.
68 (Ga.
1905);
1784 <citetitle>Foster-Milburn Co
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Chinn
</citetitle>,
123090 S.W.
364,
366
1785 (Ky.
1909);
<citetitle>Corliss
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Walker
</citetitle>,
64 F.
280 (Mass.
1790 The arguments in favor of requiring permission will sound surprisingly
1791 familiar. The photographer was "taking" something from the person or
1792 building whose photograph he shot
—pirating something of
1793 value. Some even thought he was taking the target's soul. Just as
1794 Disney was not free to take the pencils that his animators used to
1796 <!-- PAGE BREAK 47 -->
1797 Mickey, so, too, should these photographers not be free to take images
1798 that they thought valuable.
1800 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
1802 On the other side was an argument that should be familiar, as well.
1803 Sure, there may be something of value being used. But citizens should
1804 have the right to capture at least those images that stand in public view.
1805 (Louis Brandeis, who would become a Supreme Court Justice, thought
1806 the rule should be different for images from private spaces.
<footnote>
1809 Samuel D. Warren and Louis D. Brandeis, "The Right to Privacy,"
1810 <citetitle>Harvard Law Review
</citetitle> 4 (
1890):
193.
1811 <indexterm><primary>Brandeis, Louis D.
</primary></indexterm>
1812 <indexterm><primary>Warren, Samuel D.
</primary></indexterm>
1813 </para></footnote>) It may be that this means that the photographer
1814 gets something for nothing. Just as Disney could take inspiration from
1815 <citetitle>Steamboat Bill, Jr
</citetitle>. or the Brothers Grimm, the photographer should be
1816 free to capture an image without compensating the source.
1819 Fortunately for Mr. Eastman, and for photography in general, these
1820 early decisions went in favor of the pirates. In general, no
1821 permission would be required before an image could be captured and
1822 shared with others. Instead, permission was presumed. Freedom was the
1823 default. (The law would eventually craft an exception for famous
1824 people: commercial photographers who snap pictures of famous people
1825 for commercial purposes have more restrictions than the rest of
1826 us. But in the ordinary case, the image can be captured without
1827 clearing the rights to do the capturing.
<footnote><para>
1829 See Melville B. Nimmer, "The Right of Publicity,"
<citetitle>Law and Contemporary
1830 Problems
</citetitle> 19 (
1954):
203; William L. Prosser,
"Privacy," <citetitle>California Law
1831 Review
</citetitle> 48 (
1960)
398–407;
<citetitle>White
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Samsung Electronics America,
1832 Inc
</citetitle>.,
971 F.
2d
1395 (
9th Cir.
1992), cert. denied,
508 U.S.
951
1837 We can only speculate about how photography would have developed had
1838 the law gone the other way. If the presumption had been against the
1839 photographer, then the photographer would have had to demonstrate
1840 permission. Perhaps Eastman Kodak would have had to demonstrate
1841 permission, too, before it developed the film upon which images were
1842 captured. After all, if permission were not granted, then Eastman
1843 Kodak would be benefiting from the "theft" committed by the
1844 photographer. Just as Napster benefited from the copyright
1845 infringements committed by Napster users, Kodak would be benefiting
1846 from the "image-right" infringement of its photographers. We could
1847 imagine the law then requiring that some form of permission be
1848 demonstrated before a company developed pictures. We could imagine a
1849 system developing to demonstrate that permission.
1853 <!-- PAGE BREAK 48 -->
1854 But though we could imagine this system of permission, it would be
1855 very hard to see how photography could have flourished as it did if
1856 the requirement for permission had been built into the rules that
1857 govern it. Photography would have existed. It would have grown in
1858 importance over time. Professionals would have continued to use the
1859 technology as they did
—since professionals could have more
1860 easily borne the burdens of the permission system. But the spread of
1861 photography to ordinary people would not have occurred. Nothing like
1862 that growth would have been realized. And certainly, nothing like that
1863 growth in a democratic technology of expression would have been
1864 realized. If you drive through San Francisco's Presidio, you might
1865 see two gaudy yellow school buses painted over with colorful and
1866 striking images, and the logo "Just Think!" in place of the name of a
1867 school. But there's little that's "just" cerebral in the projects that
1868 these busses enable. These buses are filled with technologies that
1869 teach kids to tinker with film. Not the film of Eastman. Not even the
1870 film of your VCR. Rather the "film" of digital cameras. Just Think!
1871 is a project that enables kids to make films, as a way to understand
1872 and critique the filmed culture that they find all around them. Each
1873 year, these busses travel to more than thirty schools and enable three
1874 hundred to five hundred children to learn something about media by
1875 doing something with media. By doing, they think. By tinkering, they
1878 <indexterm startref=
"idxeastmangeorge" class='endofrange'
/>
1880 These buses are not cheap, but the technology they carry is
1881 increasingly so. The cost of a high-quality digital video system has
1882 fallen dramatically. As one analyst puts it, "Five years ago, a good
1883 real-time digital video editing system cost $
25,
000. Today you can get
1884 professional quality for $
595."
<footnote><para>
1886 H. Edward Goldberg, "Essential Presentation Tools: Hardware and
1887 Software You Need to Create Digital Multimedia Presentations,"
1888 cadalyst, February
2002, available at
1889 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
7</ulink>.
1891 These buses are filled with technology that would have cost hundreds
1892 of thousands just ten years ago. And it is now feasible to imagine not
1893 just buses like this, but classrooms across the country where kids are
1894 learning more and more of something teachers call "media literacy."
1897 <!-- PAGE BREAK 49 -->
1898 "Media literacy," as Dave Yanofsky, the executive director of Just
1899 Think!, puts it, "is the ability . . . to understand, analyze, and
1900 deconstruct media images. Its aim is to make [kids] literate about the
1901 way media works, the way it's constructed, the way it's delivered, and
1902 the way people access it."
1903 <indexterm><primary>Yanofsky, Dave
</primary></indexterm>
1906 This may seem like an odd way to think about "literacy." For most
1907 people, literacy is about reading and writing. Faulkner and Hemingway
1908 and noticing split infinitives are the things that "literate" people know
1912 Maybe. But in a world where children see on average
390 hours of
1913 television commercials per year, or between
20,
000 and
45,
000
1914 commercials generally,
<footnote><para>
1916 Judith Van Evra,
<citetitle>Television and Child Development
</citetitle> (Hillsdale, N.J.:
1917 Lawrence Erlbaum Associates,
1990); "Findings on Family and TV
1918 Study,"
<citetitle>Denver Post
</citetitle>,
25 May
1997, B6.
1920 it is increasingly important to understand the "grammar" of media. For
1921 just as there is a grammar for the written word, so, too, is there one
1922 for media. And just as kids learn how to write by writing lots of
1923 terrible prose, kids learn how to write media by constructing lots of
1924 (at least at first) terrible media.
1927 A growing field of academics and activists sees this form of literacy
1928 as crucial to the next generation of culture. For though anyone who
1929 has written understands how difficult writing is
—how difficult
1930 it is to sequence the story, to keep a reader's attention, to craft
1931 language to be understandable
—few of us have any real sense of
1932 how difficult media is. Or more fundamentally, few of us have a sense
1933 of how media works, how it holds an audience or leads it through a
1934 story, how it triggers emotion or builds suspense.
1937 It took filmmaking a generation before it could do these things well.
1938 But even then, the knowledge was in the filming, not in writing about
1939 the film. The skill came from experiencing the making of a film, not
1940 from reading a book about it. One learns to write by writing and then
1941 reflecting upon what one has written. One learns to write with images
1942 by making them and then reflecting upon what one has created.
1944 <indexterm><primary>Crichton, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
1946 This grammar has changed as media has changed. When it was just film,
1947 as Elizabeth Daley, executive director of the University of Southern
1948 California's Annenberg Center for Communication and dean of the
1950 <!-- PAGE BREAK 50 -->
1951 USC School of Cinema-Television, explained to me, the grammar was
1952 about "the placement of objects, color, . . . rhythm, pacing, and
1956 Interview with Elizabeth Daley and Stephanie Barish,
13 December
1958 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
1959 <indexterm><primary>Daley, Elizabeth
</primary></indexterm>
1961 But as computers open up an interactive space where a story is
1962 "played" as well as experienced, that grammar changes. The simple
1963 control of narrative is lost, and so other techniques are necessary. Author
1964 Michael Crichton had mastered the narrative of science fiction.
1965 But when he tried to design a computer game based on one of his
1966 works, it was a new craft he had to learn. How to lead people through
1967 a game without their feeling they have been led was not obvious, even
1968 to a wildly successful author.
<footnote><para>
1970 See Scott Steinberg, "Crichton Gets Medieval on PCs," E!online,
4
1971 November
2000, available at
1972 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
8</ulink>; "Timeline,"
22 November
2000,
1974 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
9</ulink>.
1977 <indexterm><primary>computer games
</primary></indexterm>
1979 This skill is precisely the craft a filmmaker learns. As Daley
1980 describes, "people are very surprised about how they are led through a
1981 film. [I]t is perfectly constructed to keep you from seeing it, so you
1982 have no idea. If a filmmaker succeeds you do not know how you were
1983 led." If you know you were led through a film, the film has failed.
1986 Yet the push for an expanded literacy
—one that goes beyond text
1987 to include audio and visual elements
—is not about making better
1988 film directors. The aim is not to improve the profession of
1989 filmmaking at all. Instead, as Daley explained,
1993 From my perspective, probably the most important digital divide
1994 is not access to a box. It's the ability to be empowered with the
1995 language that that box works in. Otherwise only a very few people
1996 can write with this language, and all the rest of us are reduced to
2001 "Read-only." Passive recipients of culture produced elsewhere.
2002 Couch potatoes. Consumers. This is the world of media from the
2006 The twenty-first century could be different. This is the crucial
2007 point: It could be both read and write. Or at least reading and better
2008 understanding the craft of writing. Or best, reading and understanding
2009 the tools that enable the writing to lead or mislead. The aim of any
2011 <!-- PAGE BREAK 51 -->
2012 and this literacy in particular, is to "empower people to choose the
2013 appropriate language for what they need to create or
2017 Interview with Daley and Barish.
2018 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2019 </para></footnote> It is to enable students "to communicate in the
2020 language of the twenty-first century."
<footnote><para>
2025 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2027 As with any language, this language comes more easily to some than to
2028 others. It doesn't necessarily come more easily to those who excel in
2029 written language. Daley and Stephanie Barish, director of the
2030 Institute for Multimedia Literacy at the Annenberg Center, describe
2031 one particularly poignant example of a project they ran in a high
2032 school. The high school was a very poor inner-city Los Angeles
2033 school. In all the traditional measures of success, this school was a
2034 failure. But Daley and Barish ran a program that gave kids an
2035 opportunity to use film to express meaning about something the
2036 students know something about
—gun violence.
2039 The class was held on Friday afternoons, and it created a relatively
2040 new problem for the school. While the challenge in most classes was
2041 getting the kids to come, the challenge in this class was keeping them
2042 away. The "kids were showing up at
6 A.M. and leaving at
5 at night,"
2043 said Barish. They were working harder than in any other class to do
2044 what education should be about
—learning how to express themselves.
2047 Using whatever "free web stuff they could find," and relatively simple
2048 tools to enable the kids to mix "image, sound, and text," Barish said
2049 this class produced a series of projects that showed something about
2050 gun violence that few would otherwise understand. This was an issue
2051 close to the lives of these students. The project "gave them a tool
2052 and empowered them to be able to both understand it and talk about
2053 it," Barish explained. That tool succeeded in creating
2054 expression
—far more successfully and powerfully than could have
2055 been created using only text. "If you had said to these students, `you
2056 have to do it in text,' they would've just thrown their hands up and
2057 gone and done something else," Barish described, in part, no doubt,
2058 because expressing themselves in text is not something these students
2059 can do well. Yet neither is text a form in which
2060 <emphasis>these
</emphasis> ideas can be expressed well. The power of
2061 this message depended upon its connection to this form of expression.
2065 <!-- PAGE BREAK 52 -->
2066 "But isn't education about teaching kids to write?" I asked. In part,
2067 of course, it is. But why are we teaching kids to write? Education,
2068 Daley explained, is about giving students a way of "constructing
2069 meaning." To say that that means just writing is like saying teaching
2070 writing is only about teaching kids how to spell. Text is one
2071 part
—and increasingly, not the most powerful part
—of
2072 constructing meaning. As Daley explained in the most moving part of
2077 What you want is to give these students ways of constructing
2078 meaning. If all you give them is text, they're not going to do it.
2079 Because they can't. You know, you've got Johnny who can look at a
2080 video, he can play a video game, he can do graffiti all over your
2081 walls, he can take your car apart, and he can do all sorts of other
2082 things. He just can't read your text. So Johnny comes to school and
2083 you say, "Johnny, you're illiterate. Nothing you can do matters."
2084 Well, Johnny then has two choices: He can dismiss you or he [can]
2085 dismiss himself. If his ego is healthy at all, he's going to dismiss
2086 you. [But i]nstead, if you say, "Well, with all these things that you
2087 can do, let's talk about this issue. Play for me music that you think
2088 reflects that, or show me images that you think reflect that, or draw
2089 for me something that reflects that." Not by giving a kid a video
2090 camera and . . . saying, "Let's go have fun with the video camera and
2091 make a little movie." But instead, really help you take these elements
2092 that you understand, that are your language, and construct meaning
2093 about the topic. . . .
2096 That empowers enormously. And then what happens, of
2097 course, is eventually, as it has happened in all these classes, they
2098 bump up against the fact, "I need to explain this and I really need
2099 to write something." And as one of the teachers told Stephanie,
2100 they would rewrite a paragraph
5,
6,
7,
8 times, till they got it right.
2103 Because they needed to. There was a reason for doing it. They
2104 needed to say something, as opposed to just jumping through
2105 your hoops. They actually needed to use a language that they
2106 <!-- PAGE BREAK 53 -->
2107 didn't speak very well. But they had come to understand that they
2108 had a lot of power with this language."
2112 When two planes crashed into the World Trade Center, another into the
2113 Pentagon, and a fourth into a Pennsylvania field, all media around the
2114 world shifted to this news. Every moment of just about every day for
2115 that week, and for weeks after, television in particular, and media
2116 generally, retold the story of the events we had just witnessed. The
2117 telling was a retelling, because we had seen the events that were
2118 described. The genius of this awful act of terrorism was that the
2119 delayed second attack was perfectly timed to assure that the whole
2120 world would be watching.
2123 These retellings had an increasingly familiar feel. There was music
2124 scored for the intermissions, and fancy graphics that flashed across
2125 the screen. There was a formula to interviews. There was "balance,"
2126 and seriousness. This was news choreographed in the way we have
2127 increasingly come to expect it, "news as entertainment," even if the
2128 entertainment is tragedy.
2130 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
2131 <indexterm><primary>CBS
</primary></indexterm>
2133 But in addition to this produced news about the "tragedy of September
2134 11," those of us tied to the Internet came to see a very different
2135 production as well. The Internet was filled with accounts of the same
2136 events. Yet these Internet accounts had a very different flavor. Some
2137 people constructed photo pages that captured images from around the
2138 world and presented them as slide shows with text. Some offered open
2139 letters. There were sound recordings. There was anger and frustration.
2140 There were attempts to provide context. There was, in short, an
2141 extraordinary worldwide barn raising, in the sense Mike Godwin uses
2142 the term in his book
<citetitle>Cyber Rights
</citetitle>, around a news event that had
2143 captured the attention of the world. There was ABC and CBS, but there
2144 was also the Internet.
2147 I don't mean simply to praise the Internet
—though I do think the
2148 people who supported this form of speech should be praised. I mean
2149 instead to point to a significance in this form of speech. For like a
2150 Kodak, the Internet enables people to capture images. And like in a
2152 <!-- PAGE BREAK 54 -->
2153 by a student on the "Just Think!" bus, the visual images could be mixed
2157 But unlike any technology for simply capturing images, the Internet
2158 allows these creations to be shared with an extraordinary number of
2159 people, practically instantaneously. This is something new in our
2160 tradition
—not just that culture can be captured mechanically,
2161 and obviously not just that events are commented upon critically, but
2162 that this mix of captured images, sound, and commentary can be widely
2163 spread practically instantaneously.
2166 September
11 was not an aberration. It was a beginning. Around the
2167 same time, a form of communication that has grown dramatically was
2168 just beginning to come into public consciousness: the Web-log, or
2169 blog. The blog is a kind of public diary, and within some cultures,
2170 such as in Japan, it functions very much like a diary. In those
2171 cultures, it records private facts in a public way
—it's a kind
2172 of electronic
<citetitle>Jerry Springer
</citetitle>, available anywhere in the world.
2175 But in the United States, blogs have taken on a very different
2176 character. There are some who use the space simply to talk about
2177 their private life. But there are many who use the space to engage in
2178 public discourse. Discussing matters of public import, criticizing
2179 others who are mistaken in their views, criticizing politicians about
2180 the decisions they make, offering solutions to problems we all see:
2181 blogs create the sense of a virtual public meeting, but one in which
2182 we don't all hope to be there at the same time and in which
2183 conversations are not necessarily linked. The best of the blog entries
2184 are relatively short; they point directly to words used by others,
2185 criticizing with or adding to them. They are arguably the most
2186 important form of unchoreographed public discourse that we have.
2189 That's a strong statement. Yet it says as much about our democracy as
2190 it does about blogs. This is the part of America that is most
2191 difficult for those of us who love America to accept: Our democracy
2192 has atrophied. Of course we have elections, and most of the time the
2193 courts allow those elections to count. A relatively small number of
2195 <!-- PAGE BREAK 55 -->
2196 in those elections. The cycle of these elections has become totally
2197 professionalized and routinized. Most of us think this is democracy.
2200 But democracy has never just been about elections. Democracy
2201 means rule by the people, but rule means something more than mere
2202 elections. In our tradition, it also means control through reasoned
2203 discourse. This was the idea that captured the imagination of Alexis
2204 de Tocqueville, the nineteenth-century French lawyer who wrote the
2205 most important account of early "Democracy in America." It wasn't
2206 popular elections that fascinated him
—it was the jury, an
2207 institution that gave ordinary people the right to choose life or
2208 death for other citizens. And most fascinating for him was that the
2209 jury didn't just vote about the outcome they would impose. They
2210 deliberated. Members argued about the "right" result; they tried to
2211 persuade each other of the "right" result, and in criminal cases at
2212 least, they had to agree upon a unanimous result for the process to
2213 come to an end.
<footnote><para>
2215 See, for example, Alexis de Tocqueville,
<citetitle>Democracy in America
</citetitle>,
2216 bk.
1, trans. Henry Reeve (New York: Bantam Books,
2000), ch.
16.
2220 Yet even this institution flags in American life today. And in its
2221 place, there is no systematic effort to enable citizen deliberation. Some
2222 are pushing to create just such an institution.
<footnote><para>
2224 Bruce Ackerman and James Fishkin, "Deliberation Day,"
<citetitle>Journal of
2225 Political Philosophy
</citetitle> 10 (
2) (
2002):
129.
2227 And in some towns in New England, something close to deliberation
2228 remains. But for most of us for most of the time, there is no time or
2229 place for "democratic deliberation" to occur.
2232 More bizarrely, there is generally not even permission for it to
2233 occur. We, the most powerful democracy in the world, have developed a
2234 strong norm against talking about politics. It's fine to talk about
2235 politics with people you agree with. But it is rude to argue about
2236 politics with people you disagree with. Political discourse becomes
2237 isolated, and isolated discourse becomes more extreme.
<footnote><para>
2239 Cass Sunstein,
<citetitle>Republic.com
</citetitle> (Princeton: Princeton University Press,
2001),
2240 65–80,
175,
182,
183,
192.
2241 </para></footnote> We say what our friends want to hear, and hear very
2242 little beyond what our friends say.
2245 Enter the blog. The blog's very architecture solves one part of this
2246 problem. People post when they want to post, and people read when they
2247 want to read. The most difficult time is synchronous time.
2248 Technologies that enable asynchronous communication, such as e-mail,
2249 increase the opportunity for communication. Blogs allow for public
2251 <!-- PAGE BREAK 56 -->
2252 discourse without the public ever needing to gather in a single public
2256 But beyond architecture, blogs also have solved the problem of
2257 norms. There's no norm (yet) in blog space not to talk about politics.
2258 Indeed, the space is filled with political speech, on both the right and
2259 the left. Some of the most popular sites are conservative or libertarian,
2260 but there are many of all political stripes. And even blogs that are not
2261 political cover political issues when the occasion merits.
2264 The significance of these blogs is tiny now, though not so tiny. The
2265 name Howard Dean may well have faded from the
2004 presidential race
2266 but for blogs. Yet even if the number of readers is small, the reading
2267 is having an effect.
2268 <indexterm><primary>Dean, Howard
</primary></indexterm>
2271 One direct effect is on stories that had a different life cycle in the
2272 mainstream media. The Trent Lott affair is an example. When Lott
2273 "misspoke" at a party for Senator Strom Thurmond, essentially praising
2274 Thurmond's segregationist policies, he calculated correctly that this
2275 story would disappear from the mainstream press within forty-eight
2276 hours. It did. But he didn't calculate its life cycle in blog
2277 space. The bloggers kept researching the story. Over time, more and
2278 more instances of the same "misspeaking" emerged. Finally, the story
2279 broke back into the mainstream press. In the end, Lott was forced to
2280 resign as senate majority leader.
<footnote><para>
2282 Noah Shachtman, "With Incessant Postings, a Pundit Stirs the Pot," New
2283 York Times,
16 January
2003, G5.
2285 <indexterm><primary>Lott, Trent
</primary></indexterm>
2288 This different cycle is possible because the same commercial pressures
2289 don't exist with blogs as with other ventures. Television and
2290 newspapers are commercial entities. They must work to keep attention.
2291 If they lose readers, they lose revenue. Like sharks, they must move
2295 But bloggers don't have a similar constraint. They can obsess, they
2296 can focus, they can get serious. If a particular blogger writes a
2297 particularly interesting story, more and more people link to that
2298 story. And as the number of links to a particular story increases, it
2299 rises in the ranks of stories. People read what is popular; what is
2300 popular has been selected by a very democratic process of
2301 peer-generated rankings.
2303 <indexterm id=
"idxwinerdave" class='startofrange'
>
2304 <primary>Winer, Dave
</primary>
2307 There's a second way, as well, in which blogs have a different cycle
2308 <!-- PAGE BREAK 57 -->
2309 from the mainstream press. As Dave Winer, one of the fathers of this
2310 movement and a software author for many decades, told me, another
2311 difference is the absence of a financial "conflict of interest." "I think you
2312 have to take the conflict of interest" out of journalism, Winer told me.
2313 "An amateur journalist simply doesn't have a conflict of interest, or the
2314 conflict of interest is so easily disclosed that you know you can sort of
2315 get it out of the way."
2317 <indexterm><primary>CNN
</primary></indexterm>
2319 These conflicts become more important as media becomes more
2320 concentrated (more on this below). A concentrated media can hide more
2321 from the public than an unconcentrated media can
—as CNN admitted
2322 it did after the Iraq war because it was afraid of the consequences to
2323 its own employees.
<footnote><para>
2325 Telephone interview with David Winer,
16 April
2003.
2327 It also needs to sustain a more coherent account. (In the middle of
2328 the Iraq war, I read a post on the Internet from someone who was at
2329 that time listening to a satellite uplink with a reporter in Iraq. The
2330 New York headquarters was telling the reporter over and over that her
2331 account of the war was too bleak: She needed to offer a more
2332 optimistic story. When she told New York that wasn't warranted, they
2333 told her
<emphasis>that
</emphasis> they were writing "the story.")
2335 <para> Blog space gives amateurs a way to enter the
2336 debate
—"amateur" not in the sense of inexperienced, but in the
2337 sense of an Olympic athlete, meaning not paid by anyone to give their
2338 reports. It allows for a much broader range of input into a story, as
2339 reporting on the Columbia disaster revealed, when hundreds from across
2340 the southwest United States turned to the Internet to retell what they
2341 had seen.
<footnote><para>
2343 John Schwartz, "Loss of the Shuttle: The Internet; A Wealth of
2344 Information Online,"
<citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
2 February
2003, A28; Staci
2345 D. Kramer, "Shuttle Disaster Coverage Mixed, but Strong Overall,"
2346 Online Journalism Review,
2 February
2003, available at
2347 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
10</ulink>.
2349 And it drives readers to read across the range of accounts and
2350 "triangulate," as Winer puts it, the truth. Blogs, Winer says, are
2351 "communicating directly with our constituency, and the middle man is
2352 out of it"
—with all the benefits, and costs, that might entail.
2355 Winer is optimistic about the future of journalism infected
2356 with blogs. "It's going to become an essential skill," Winer predicts,
2357 for public figures and increasingly for private figures as well. It's
2358 not clear that "journalism" is happy about this
—some journalists
2359 have been told to curtail their blogging.
<footnote>
2362 See Michael Falcone, "Does an Editor's Pencil Ruin a Web Log?"
<citetitle>New
2363 York Times
</citetitle>,
29 September
2003, C4. ("Not all news organizations have
2364 been as accepting of employees who blog. Kevin Sites, a CNN
2365 correspondent in Iraq who started a blog about his reporting of the
2366 war on March
9, stopped posting
12 days later at his bosses'
2367 request. Last year Steve Olafson, a
<citetitle>Houston Chronicle
</citetitle> reporter, was
2368 fired for keeping a personal Web log, published under a pseudonym,
2369 that dealt with some of the issues and people he was covering.")
2370 <indexterm><primary>CNN
</primary></indexterm>
2372 But it is clear that we are still in transition. "A
2374 <!-- PAGE BREAK 58 -->
2375 lot of what we are doing now is warm-up exercises," Winer told me.
2376 There is a lot that must mature before this space has its mature effect.
2377 And as the inclusion of content in this space is the least infringing use
2378 of the Internet (meaning infringing on copyright), Winer said, "we will
2379 be the last thing that gets shut down."
2382 This speech affects democracy. Winer thinks that happens because "you
2383 don't have to work for somebody who controls, [for] a gatekeeper."
2384 That is true. But it affects democracy in another way as well. As
2385 more and more citizens express what they think, and defend it in
2386 writing, that will change the way people understand public issues. It
2387 is easy to be wrong and misguided in your head. It is harder when the
2388 product of your mind can be criticized by others. Of course, it is a
2389 rare human who admits that he has been persuaded that he is wrong. But
2390 it is even rarer for a human to ignore when he has been proven wrong.
2391 The writing of ideas, arguments, and criticism improves democracy.
2392 Today there are probably a couple of million blogs where such writing
2393 happens. When there are ten million, there will be something
2394 extraordinary to report.
2396 <indexterm startref=
"idxwinerdave" class='endofrange'
/>
2397 <indexterm id=
"idxbrownjohnseely" class='startofrange'
>
2398 <primary>Brown, John Seely
</primary>
2401 John Seely Brown is the chief scientist of the Xerox Corporation.
2402 His work, as his Web site describes it, is "human learning and . . . the
2403 creation of knowledge ecologies for creating . . . innovation."
2406 Brown thus looks at these technologies of digital creativity a bit
2407 differently from the perspectives I've sketched so far. I'm sure he
2408 would be excited about any technology that might improve
2409 democracy. But his real excitement comes from how these technologies
2413 As Brown believes, we learn by tinkering. When "a lot of us grew up,"
2414 he explains, that tinkering was done "on motorcycle engines, lawnmower
2415 engines, automobiles, radios, and so on." But digital technologies
2416 enable a different kind of tinkering
—with abstract ideas though
2417 in concrete form. The kids at Just Think! not only think about how a
2418 commercial portrays a politician; using digital technology, they can
2419 <!-- PAGE BREAK 59 -->
2420 take the commercial apart and manipulate it, tinker with it to see how
2421 it does what it does. Digital technologies launch a kind of bricolage,
2422 or "free collage," as Brown calls it. Many get to add to or transform
2423 the tinkering of many others.
2426 The best large-scale example of this kind of tinkering so far is free
2427 software or open-source software (FS/OSS). FS/OSS is software whose
2428 source code is shared. Anyone can download the technology that makes a
2429 FS/OSS program run. And anyone eager to learn how a particular bit of
2430 FS/OSS technology works can tinker with the code.
2433 This opportunity creates a "completely new kind of learning platform,"
2434 as Brown describes. "As soon as you start doing that, you . . .
2435 unleash a free collage on the community, so that other people can
2436 start looking at your code, tinkering with it, trying it out, seeing
2437 if they can improve it." Each effort is a kind of
2438 apprenticeship. "Open source becomes a major apprenticeship platform."
2441 In this process, "the concrete things you tinker with are abstract.
2442 They are code." Kids are "shifting to the ability to tinker in the
2443 abstract, and this tinkering is no longer an isolated activity that
2444 you're doing in your garage. You are tinkering with a community
2445 platform. . . . You are tinkering with other people's stuff. The more
2446 you tinker the more you improve." The more you improve, the more you
2450 This same thing happens with content, too. And it happens in the same
2451 collaborative way when that content is part of the Web. As Brown puts
2452 it, "the Web [is] the first medium that truly honors multiple forms of
2453 intelligence." Earlier technologies, such as the typewriter or word
2454 processors, helped amplify text. But the Web amplifies much more than
2455 text. "The Web . . . says if you are musical, if you are artistic, if
2456 you are visual, if you are interested in film . . . [then] there is a
2457 lot you can start to do on this medium. [It] can now amplify and honor
2458 these multiple forms of intelligence."
2460 <indexterm><primary>Barish, Stephanie
</primary></indexterm>
2462 Brown is talking about what Elizabeth Daley, Stephanie Barish, and
2463 Just Think! teach: that this tinkering with culture teaches as well
2465 <!-- PAGE BREAK 60 -->
2466 as creates. It develops talents differently, and it builds a different
2467 kind of recognition.
2470 Yet the freedom to tinker with these objects is not guaranteed.
2471 Indeed, as we'll see through the course of this book, that freedom is
2472 increasingly highly contested. While there's no doubt that your father
2473 had the right to tinker with the car engine, there's great doubt that
2474 your child will have the right to tinker with the images she finds all
2475 around. The law and, increasingly, technology interfere with a
2476 freedom that technology, and curiosity, would otherwise ensure.
2479 These restrictions have become the focus of researchers and scholars.
2480 Professor Ed Felten of Princeton (whom we'll see more of in chapter
2481 10) has developed a powerful argument in favor of the "right to
2482 tinker" as it applies to computer science and to knowledge in
2483 general.
<footnote><para>
2485 See, for example, Edward Felten and Andrew Appel, "Technological Access
2486 Control Interferes with Noninfringing Scholarship,"
<citetitle>Communications
2487 of the Association for Computer Machinery
</citetitle> 43 (
2000):
9.
2489 But Brown's concern is earlier, or younger, or more fundamental. It is
2490 about the learning that kids can do, or can't do, because of the law.
2493 "This is where education in the twenty-first century is going," Brown
2494 explains. We need to "understand how kids who grow up digital think
2498 "Yet," as Brown continued, and as the balance of this book will
2499 evince, "we are building a legal system that completely suppresses the
2500 natural tendencies of today's digital kids. . . . We're building an
2501 architecture that unleashes
60 percent of the brain [and] a legal
2502 system that closes down that part of the brain."
2504 <indexterm startref=
"idxbrownjohnseely" class='endofrange'
/>
2506 We're building a technology that takes the magic of Kodak, mixes
2507 moving images and sound, and adds a space for commentary and an
2508 opportunity to spread that creativity everywhere. But we're building
2509 the law to close down that technology.
2512 "No way to run a culture," as Brewster Kahle, whom we'll meet in
2513 chapter
9, quipped to me in a rare moment of despondence.
2515 <!-- PAGE BREAK 61 -->
2517 <chapter id=
"catalogs">
2518 <title>CHAPTER THREE: Catalogs
</title>
2520 In the fall of
2002, Jesse Jordan of Oceanside, New York, enrolled as
2521 a freshman at Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute, in Troy, New York.
2522 His major at RPI was information technology. Though he is not a
2523 programmer, in October Jesse decided to begin to tinker with search
2524 engine technology that was available on the RPI network.
2527 RPI is one of America's foremost technological research institutions.
2528 It offers degrees in fields ranging from architecture and engineering
2529 to information sciences. More than
65 percent of its five thousand
2530 undergraduates finished in the top
10 percent of their high school
2531 class. The school is thus a perfect mix of talent and experience to
2532 imagine and then build, a generation for the network age.
2535 RPI's computer network links students, faculty, and administration to
2536 one another. It also links RPI to the Internet. Not everything
2537 available on the RPI network is available on the Internet. But the
2538 network is designed to enable students to get access to the Internet,
2539 as well as more intimate access to other members of the RPI community.
2542 Search engines are a measure of a network's intimacy. Google
2543 <!-- PAGE BREAK 62 -->
2544 brought the Internet much closer to all of us by fantastically
2545 improving the quality of search on the network. Specialty search
2546 engines can do this even better. The idea of "intranet" search
2547 engines, search engines that search within the network of a particular
2548 institution, is to provide users of that institution with better
2549 access to material from that institution. Businesses do this all the
2550 time, enabling employees to have access to material that people
2551 outside the business can't get. Universities do it as well.
2554 These engines are enabled by the network technology itself.
2555 Microsoft, for example, has a network file system that makes it very
2556 easy for search engines tuned to that network to query the system for
2557 information about the publicly (within that network) available
2558 content. Jesse's search engine was built to take advantage of this
2559 technology. It used Microsoft's network file system to build an index
2560 of all the files available within the RPI network.
2563 Jesse's wasn't the first search engine built for the RPI network.
2564 Indeed, his engine was a simple modification of engines that others
2565 had built. His single most important improvement over those engines
2566 was to fix a bug within the Microsoft file-sharing system that could
2567 cause a user's computer to crash. With the engines that existed
2568 before, if you tried to access a file through a Windows browser that
2569 was on a computer that was off-line, your computer could crash. Jesse
2570 modified the system a bit to fix that problem, by adding a button that
2571 a user could click to see if the machine holding the file was still
2575 Jesse's engine went on-line in late October. Over the following six
2576 months, he continued to tweak it to improve its functionality. By
2577 March, the system was functioning quite well. Jesse had more than one
2578 million files in his directory, including every type of content that might
2579 be on users' computers.
2582 Thus the index his search engine produced included pictures, which
2583 students could use to put on their own Web sites; copies of notes or
2584 research; copies of information pamphlets; movie clips that students
2585 might have created; university brochures
—basically anything that
2586 <!-- PAGE BREAK 63 -->
2587 users of the RPI network made available in a public folder of their
2591 But the index also included music files. In fact, one quarter of the
2592 files that Jesse's search engine listed were music files. But that
2593 means, of course, that three quarters were not, and
—so that this
2594 point is absolutely clear
—Jesse did nothing to induce people to
2595 put music files in their public folders. He did nothing to target the
2596 search engine to these files. He was a kid tinkering with a
2597 Google-like technology at a university where he was studying
2598 information science, and hence, tinkering was the aim. Unlike Google,
2599 or Microsoft, for that matter, he made no money from this tinkering;
2600 he was not connected to any business that would make any money from
2601 this experiment. He was a kid tinkering with technology in an
2602 environment where tinkering with technology was precisely what he was
2606 On April
3,
2003, Jesse was contacted by the dean of students at
2607 RPI. The dean informed Jesse that the Recording Industry Association
2608 of America, the RIAA, would be filing a lawsuit against him and three
2609 other students whom he didn't even know, two of them at other
2610 universities. A few hours later, Jesse was served with papers from
2611 the suit. As he read these papers and watched the news reports about
2612 them, he was increasingly astonished.
2615 "It was absurd," he told me. "I don't think I did anything
2616 wrong. . . . I don't think there's anything wrong with the search
2617 engine that I ran or . . . what I had done to it. I mean, I hadn't
2618 modified it in any way that promoted or enhanced the work of
2619 pirates. I just modified the search engine in a way that would make it
2620 easier to use"
—again, a
<emphasis>search engine
</emphasis>,
2621 which Jesse had not himself built, using the Windows filesharing
2622 system, which Jesse had not himself built, to enable members of the
2623 RPI community to get access to content, which Jesse had not himself
2624 created or posted, and the vast majority of which had nothing to do
2628 But the RIAA branded Jesse a pirate. They claimed he operated a
2629 network and had therefore "willfully" violated copyright laws. They
2630 <!-- PAGE BREAK 64 -->
2631 demanded that he pay them the damages for his wrong. For cases of
2632 "willful infringement," the Copyright Act specifies something lawyers
2633 call "statutory damages." These damages permit a copyright owner to
2634 claim $
150,
000 per infringement. As the RIAA alleged more than one
2635 hundred specific copyright infringements, they therefore demanded that
2636 Jesse pay them at least $
15,
000,
000.
2639 Similar lawsuits were brought against three other students: one other
2640 student at RPI, one at Michigan Technical University, and one at
2641 Princeton. Their situations were similar to Jesse's. Though each case
2642 was different in detail, the bottom line in each was exactly the same:
2643 huge demands for "damages" that the RIAA claimed it was entitled to.
2644 If you added up the claims, these four lawsuits were asking courts in
2645 the United States to award the plaintiffs close to $
100
2646 <emphasis>billion
</emphasis>—six times the
2647 <emphasis>total
</emphasis> profit of the film industry in
2648 2001.
<footnote><para>
2651 Tim Goral, "Recording Industry Goes After Campus P-
2-P Networks:
2652 Suit Alleges $
97.8 Billion in Damages,"
<citetitle>Professional Media Group LCC
</citetitle> 6
2653 (
2003):
5, available at
2003 WL
55179443.
2657 Jesse called his parents. They were supportive but a bit frightened.
2658 An uncle was a lawyer. He began negotiations with the RIAA. They
2659 demanded to know how much money Jesse had. Jesse had saved
2660 $
12,
000 from summer jobs and other employment. They demanded
2661 $
12,
000 to dismiss the case.
2664 The RIAA wanted Jesse to admit to doing something wrong. He
2665 refused. They wanted him to agree to an injunction that would
2666 essentially make it impossible for him to work in many fields of
2667 technology for the rest of his life. He refused. They made him
2668 understand that this process of being sued was not going to be
2669 pleasant. (As Jesse's father recounted to me, the chief lawyer on the
2670 case, Matt Oppenheimer, told Jesse, "You don't want to pay another
2671 visit to a dentist like me.") And throughout, the RIAA insisted it
2672 would not settle the case until it took every penny Jesse had saved.
2675 Jesse's family was outraged at these claims. They wanted to fight.
2676 But Jesse's uncle worked to educate the family about the nature of the
2677 American legal system. Jesse could fight the RIAA. He might even
2678 win. But the cost of fighting a lawsuit like this, Jesse was told, would be
2679 at least $
250,
000. If he won, he would not recover that money. If he
2680 <!-- PAGE BREAK 65 -->
2681 won, he would have a piece of paper saying he had won, and a piece of
2682 paper saying he and his family were bankrupt.
2685 So Jesse faced a mafia-like choice: $
250,
000 and a chance at winning,
2686 or $
12,
000 and a settlement.
2689 The recording industry insists this is a matter of law and morality.
2690 Let's put the law aside for a moment and think about the morality.
2691 Where is the morality in a lawsuit like this? What is the virtue in
2692 scapegoatism? The RIAA is an extraordinarily powerful lobby. The
2693 president of the RIAA is reported to make more than $
1 million a year.
2694 Artists, on the other hand, are not well paid. The average recording
2695 artist makes $
45,
900.
<footnote><para>
2697 Occupational Employment Survey, U.S. Dept. of Labor (
2001)
2698 (
27–2042—Musicians and Singers). See also National Endowment for
2699 the Arts,
<citetitle>More Than One in a Blue Moon
</citetitle> (
2000).
2701 There are plenty of ways for the RIAA to affect
2702 and direct policy. So where is the morality in taking money from a
2703 student for running a search engine?
<footnote><para>
2705 Douglas Lichtman makes a related point in "KaZaA and Punishment,"
2706 <citetitle>Wall Street Journal
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, A24.
2710 On June
23, Jesse wired his savings to the lawyer working for the
2711 RIAA. The case against him was then dismissed. And with this, this
2712 kid who had tinkered a computer into a $
15 million lawsuit became an
2717 I was definitely not an activist [before]. I never really meant to be
2718 an activist. . . . [But] I've been pushed into this. In no way did I
2719 ever foresee anything like this, but I think it's just completely
2720 absurd what the RIAA has done.
2724 Jesse's parents betray a certain pride in their reluctant activist. As
2725 his father told me, Jesse "considers himself very conservative, and so do
2726 I. . . . He's not a tree hugger. . . . I think it's bizarre that they would
2727 pick on him. But he wants to let people know that they're sending the
2728 wrong message. And he wants to correct the record."
2730 <!-- PAGE BREAK 66 -->
2732 <chapter id=
"pirates">
2733 <title>CHAPTER FOUR: "Pirates"
</title>
2735 If "piracy" means using the creative property of others without
2736 their permission
—if "if value, then right" is true
—then the history of
2737 the content industry is a history of piracy. Every important sector of
2738 "big media" today
—film, records, radio, and cable TV
—was born of a
2739 kind of piracy so defined. The consistent story is how last generation's
2740 pirates join this generation's country club
—until now.
2745 The film industry of Hollywood was built by fleeing pirates.
<footnote><para>
2747 I am grateful to Peter DiMauro for pointing me to this extraordinary
2748 history. See also Siva Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
87–93,
2749 which details Edison's "adventures" with copyright and patent.
2750 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
2752 Creators and directors migrated from the East Coast to California in
2753 the early twentieth century in part to escape controls that patents
2754 granted the inventor of filmmaking, Thomas Edison. These controls were
2755 exercised through a monopoly "trust," the Motion Pictures Patents
2756 Company, and were based on Thomas Edison's creative
2757 property
—patents. Edison formed the MPPC to exercise the rights
2758 this creative property
2759 <!-- PAGE BREAK 67 -->
2760 gave him, and the MPPC was serious about the control it demanded.
2763 As one commentator tells one part of the story,
2767 A January
1909 deadline was set for all companies to comply with
2768 the license. By February, unlicensed outlaws, who referred to
2769 themselves as independents protested the trust and carried on
2770 business without submitting to the Edison monopoly. In the
2771 summer of
1909 the independent movement was in full-swing,
2772 with producers and theater owners using illegal equipment and
2773 imported film stock to create their own underground market.
2776 With the country experiencing a tremendous expansion in the number of
2777 nickelodeons, the Patents Company reacted to the independent movement
2778 by forming a strong-arm subsidiary known as the General Film Company
2779 to block the entry of non-licensed independents. With coercive tactics
2780 that have become legendary, General Film confiscated unlicensed
2781 equipment, discontinued product supply to theaters which showed
2782 unlicensed films, and effectively monopolized distribution with the
2783 acquisition of all U.S. film exchanges, except for the one owned by
2784 the independent William Fox who defied the Trust even after his
2785 license was revoked.
<footnote><para>
2787 J. A. Aberdeen,
<citetitle>Hollywood Renegades: The Society of Independent Motion
2788 Picture Producers
</citetitle> (Cobblestone Entertainment,
2000) and expanded texts
2789 posted at "The Edison Movie Monopoly: The Motion Picture Patents
2790 Company vs. the Independent Outlaws," available at
2791 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
11</ulink>. For a
2792 discussion of the economic motive behind both these limits and the
2793 limits imposed by Victor on phonographs, see Randal C. Picker, "From
2794 Edison to the Broadcast Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and
2795 the Propertization of Copyright" (September
2002), University of
2796 Chicago Law School, James M. Olin Program in Law and Economics,
2797 Working Paper No.
159.
</para></footnote>
2798 <indexterm><primary>General Film Company
</primary></indexterm>
2799 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
2803 The Napsters of those days, the "independents," were companies like
2804 Fox. And no less than today, these independents were vigorously
2805 resisted. "Shooting was disrupted by machinery stolen, and
2806 `accidents' resulting in loss of negatives, equipment, buildings and
2807 sometimes life and limb frequently occurred."
<footnote><para>
2809 Marc Wanamaker, "The First Studios,"
<citetitle>The Silents Majority
</citetitle>, archived at
2810 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
12</ulink>.
2812 That led the independents to flee the East
2813 Coast. California was remote enough from Edison's reach that
2814 filmmakers there could pirate his inventions without fear of the
2815 law. And the leaders of Hollywood filmmaking, Fox most prominently,
2819 Of course, California grew quickly, and the effective enforcement
2820 of federal law eventually spread west. But because patents grant the
2821 patent holder a truly "limited" monopoly (just seventeen years at that
2823 <!-- PAGE BREAK 68 -->
2824 time), by the time enough federal marshals appeared, the patents had
2825 expired. A new industry had been born, in part from the piracy of
2826 Edison's creative property.
2829 <section id=
"recordedmusic">
2830 <title>Recorded Music
</title>
2832 The record industry was born of another kind of piracy, though to see
2833 how requires a bit of detail about the way the law regulates music.
2836 At the time that Edison and Henri Fourneaux invented machines
2837 for reproducing music (Edison the phonograph, Fourneaux the player
2838 piano), the law gave composers the exclusive right to control copies of
2839 their music and the exclusive right to control public performances of
2840 their music. In other words, in
1900, if I wanted a copy of Phil Russel's
2841 1899 hit "Happy Mose," the law said I would have to pay for the right
2842 to get a copy of the musical score, and I would also have to pay for the
2843 right to perform it publicly.
2845 <indexterm><primary>Beatles
</primary></indexterm>
2847 But what if I wanted to record "Happy Mose," using Edison's phonograph
2848 or Fourneaux's player piano? Here the law stumbled. It was clear
2849 enough that I would have to buy any copy of the musical score that I
2850 performed in making this recording. And it was clear enough that I
2851 would have to pay for any public performance of the work I was
2852 recording. But it wasn't totally clear that I would have to pay for a
2853 "public performance" if I recorded the song in my own house (even
2854 today, you don't owe the Beatles anything if you sing their songs in
2855 the shower), or if I recorded the song from memory (copies in your
2856 brain are not
—yet
— regulated by copyright law). So if I
2857 simply sang the song into a recording device in the privacy of my own
2858 home, it wasn't clear that I owed the composer anything. And more
2859 importantly, it wasn't clear whether I owed the composer anything if I
2860 then made copies of those recordings. Because of this gap in the law,
2861 then, I could effectively pirate someone else's song without paying
2862 its composer anything.
2865 The composers (and publishers) were none too happy about
2866 <!-- PAGE BREAK 69 -->
2867 this capacity to pirate. As South Dakota senator Alfred Kittredge
2872 Imagine the injustice of the thing. A composer writes a song or an
2873 opera. A publisher buys at great expense the rights to the same and
2874 copyrights it. Along come the phonographic companies and companies who
2875 cut music rolls and deliberately steal the work of the brain of the
2876 composer and publisher without any regard for [their]
2877 rights.
<footnote><para>
2879 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright: Hearings on
2880 S.
6330 and H.R.
19853 Before the ( Joint) Committees on Patents,
59th
2881 Cong.
59,
1st sess. (
1906) (statement of Senator Alfred B. Kittredge,
2882 of South Dakota, chairman), reprinted in
<citetitle>Legislative History of the
2883 Copyright Act
</citetitle>, E. Fulton Brylawski and Abe Goldman, eds. (South
2884 Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints,
1976).
2889 The innovators who developed the technology to record other
2890 people's works were "sponging upon the toil, the work, the talent, and
2891 genius of American composers,"
<footnote><para>
2893 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
223
2894 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
2896 and the "music publishing industry"
2897 was thereby "at the complete mercy of this one pirate."
<footnote><para>
2899 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
226
2900 (statement of Nathan Burkan, attorney for the Music Publishers Association).
2903 Sousa put it, in as direct a way as possible, "When they make money
2904 out of my pieces, I want a share of it."
<footnote><para>
2906 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
23
2907 (statement of John Philip Sousa, composer).
2911 These arguments have familiar echoes in the wars of our day. So, too,
2912 do the arguments on the other side. The innovators who developed the
2913 player piano argued that "it is perfectly demonstrable that the
2914 introduction of automatic music players has not deprived any composer
2915 of anything he had before their introduction." Rather, the machines
2916 increased the sales of sheet music.
<footnote><para>
2919 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
283–84
2920 (statement of Albert Walker, representative of the Auto-Music
2921 Perforating Company of New York).
2922 </para></footnote> In any case, the innovators argued, the job of
2923 Congress was "to consider first the interest of [the public], whom
2924 they represent, and whose servants they are." "All talk about
2925 `theft,'" the general counsel of the American Graphophone Company
2926 wrote, "is the merest claptrap, for there exists no property in ideas
2927 musical, literary or artistic, except as defined by
2928 statute."
<footnote><para>
2930 To Amend and Consolidate the Acts Respecting Copyright,
376 (prepared
2931 memorandum of Philip Mauro, general patent counsel of the American
2932 Graphophone Company Association).
2936 The law soon resolved this battle in favor of the composer
2937 <emphasis>and
</emphasis> the recording artist. Congress amended the
2938 law to make sure that composers would be paid for the "mechanical
2939 reproductions" of their music. But rather than simply granting the
2940 composer complete control over the right to make mechanical
2941 reproductions, Congress gave recording artists a right to record the
2942 music, at a price set by Congress, once the composer allowed it to be
2943 recorded once. This is the part of
2945 <!-- PAGE BREAK 70 -->
2946 copyright law that makes cover songs possible. Once a composer
2947 authorizes a recording of his song, others are free to record the same
2948 song, so long as they pay the original composer a fee set by the law.
2951 American law ordinarily calls this a "compulsory license," but I will
2952 refer to it as a "statutory license." A statutory license is a license
2953 whose key terms are set by law. After Congress's amendment of the
2954 Copyright Act in
1909, record companies were free to distribute copies
2955 of recordings so long as they paid the composer (or copyright holder)
2956 the fee set by the statute.
2959 This is an exception within the law of copyright. When John Grisham
2960 writes a novel, a publisher is free to publish that novel only if
2961 Grisham gives the publisher permission. Grisham, in turn, is free to
2962 charge whatever he wants for that permission. The price to publish
2963 Grisham is thus set by Grisham, and copyright law ordinarily says you
2964 have no permission to use Grisham's work except with permission of
2966 <indexterm><primary>Grisham, John
</primary></indexterm>
2969 But the law governing recordings gives recording artists less. And
2970 thus, in effect, the law
<emphasis>subsidizes
</emphasis> the recording
2971 industry through a kind of piracy
—by giving recording artists a
2972 weaker right than it otherwise gives creative authors. The Beatles
2973 have less control over their creative work than Grisham does. And the
2974 beneficiaries of this less control are the recording industry and the
2975 public. The recording industry gets something of value for less than
2976 it otherwise would pay; the public gets access to a much wider range
2977 of musical creativity. Indeed, Congress was quite explicit about its
2978 reasons for granting this right. Its fear was the monopoly power of
2979 rights holders, and that that power would stifle follow-on
2980 creativity.
<footnote><para>
2983 Copyright Law Revision: Hearings on S.
2499, S.
2900, H.R.
243, and
2984 H.R.
11794 Before the ( Joint) Committee on Patents,
60th Cong.,
1st
2985 sess.,
217 (
1908) (statement of Senator Reed Smoot, chairman), reprinted
2986 in
<citetitle>Legislative History of the
1909 Copyright Act
</citetitle>, E. Fulton Brylawski and
2987 Abe Goldman, eds. (South Hackensack, N.J.: Rothman Reprints,
1976).
2989 <indexterm><primary>Beatles
</primary></indexterm>
2992 While the recording industry has been quite coy about this recently,
2993 historically it has been quite a supporter of the statutory license for
2994 records. As a
1967 report from the House Committee on the Judiciary
2999 the record producers argued vigorously that the compulsory
3000 <!-- PAGE BREAK 71 -->
3001 license system must be retained. They asserted that the record
3002 industry is a half-billion-dollar business of great economic
3003 importance in the United States and throughout the world; records
3004 today are the principal means of disseminating music, and this creates
3005 special problems, since performers need unhampered access to musical
3006 material on nondiscriminatory terms. Historically, the record
3007 producers pointed out, there were no recording rights before
1909 and
3008 the
1909 statute adopted the compulsory license as a deliberate
3009 anti-monopoly condition on the grant of these rights. They argue that
3010 the result has been an outpouring of recorded music, with the public
3011 being given lower prices, improved quality, and a greater
3012 choice.
<footnote><para>
3014 Copyright Law Revision: Report to Accompany H.R.
2512, House Committee
3015 on the Judiciary,
90th Cong.,
1st sess., House Document no.
83, (
8
3016 March
1967). I am grateful to Glenn Brown for drawing my attention to
3017 this report.
</para></footnote>
3021 By limiting the rights musicians have, by partially pirating their
3022 creative work, the record producers, and the public, benefit.
3025 <section id=
"radio">
3026 <title>Radio
</title>
3028 Radio was also born of piracy.
3031 When a radio station plays a record on the air, that constitutes a
3032 "public performance" of the composer's work.
<footnote><para>
3034 See
17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, sections
106 and
110. At the beginning,
3035 record companies printed "Not Licensed for Radio Broadcast" and other
3036 messages purporting to restrict the ability to play a record on a
3037 radio station. Judge Learned Hand rejected the argument that a
3038 warning attached to a record might restrict the rights of the radio
3039 station. See
<citetitle>RCA Manufacturing Co
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Whiteman
</citetitle>,
114 F.
2d
86 (
2nd
3040 Cir.
1940). See also Randal C. Picker, "From Edison to the Broadcast
3041 Flag: Mechanisms of Consent and Refusal and the Propertization of
3042 Copyright,"
<citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
281.
3043 <indexterm><primary>Hand, Learned
</primary></indexterm>
3044 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
3046 As I described above, the law gives the composer (or copyright holder)
3047 an exclusive right to public performances of his work. The radio
3048 station thus owes the composer money for that performance.
3051 But when the radio station plays a record, it is not only performing a
3052 copy of the
<emphasis>composer's
</emphasis> work. The radio station is
3053 also performing a copy of the
<emphasis>recording artist's
</emphasis>
3054 work. It's one thing to have "Happy Birthday" sung on the radio by the
3055 local children's choir; it's quite another to have it sung by the
3056 Rolling Stones or Lyle Lovett. The recording artist is adding to the
3057 value of the composition performed on the radio station. And if the
3058 law were perfectly consistent, the radio station would have to pay the
3059 recording artist for his work, just as it pays the composer of the
3061 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
3063 <!-- PAGE BREAK 72 -->
3066 But it doesn't. Under the law governing radio performances, the radio
3067 station does not have to pay the recording artist. The radio station
3068 need only pay the composer. The radio station thus gets a bit of
3069 something for nothing. It gets to perform the recording artist's work
3070 for free, even if it must pay the composer something for the privilege
3071 of playing the song.
3073 <indexterm id=
"idxmadonna" class='startofrange'
>
3074 <primary>Madonna
</primary>
3077 This difference can be huge. Imagine you compose a piece of music.
3078 Imagine it is your first. You own the exclusive right to authorize
3079 public performances of that music. So if Madonna wants to sing your
3080 song in public, she has to get your permission.
3083 Imagine she does sing your song, and imagine she likes it a lot. She
3084 then decides to make a recording of your song, and it becomes a top
3085 hit. Under our law, every time a radio station plays your song, you
3086 get some money. But Madonna gets nothing, save the indirect effect on
3087 the sale of her CDs. The public performance of her recording is not a
3088 "protected" right. The radio station thus gets to
3089 <emphasis>pirate
</emphasis> the value of Madonna's work without paying
3092 <indexterm startref=
"idxmadonna" class='endofrange'
/>
3094 No doubt, one might argue that, on balance, the recording artists
3095 benefit. On average, the promotion they get is worth more than the
3096 performance rights they give up. Maybe. But even if so, the law
3097 ordinarily gives the creator the right to make this choice. By making
3098 the choice for him or her, the law gives the radio station the right
3099 to take something for nothing.
3102 <section id=
"cabletv">
3103 <title>Cable TV
</title>
3106 Cable TV was also born of a kind of piracy.
3109 When cable entrepreneurs first started wiring communities with cable
3110 television in
1948, most refused to pay broadcasters for the content
3111 that they echoed to their customers. Even when the cable companies
3112 started selling access to television broadcasts, they refused to pay
3113 <!-- PAGE BREAK 73 -->
3114 for what they sold. Cable companies were thus Napsterizing
3115 broadcasters' content, but more egregiously than anything Napster ever
3116 did
— Napster never charged for the content it enabled others to
3119 <indexterm><primary>Anello, Douglas
</primary></indexterm>
3120 <indexterm><primary>Burdick, Quentin
</primary></indexterm>
3122 Broadcasters and copyright owners were quick to attack this theft.
3123 Rosel Hyde, chairman of the FCC, viewed the practice as a kind of
3124 "unfair and potentially destructive competition."
<footnote><para>
3126 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV: Hearing on S.
1006 Before the
3127 Subcommittee on Patents, Trademarks, and Copyrights of the Senate
3128 Committee on the Judiciary,
89th Cong.,
2nd sess.,
78 (
1966)
3129 (statement of Rosel H. Hyde, chairman of the Federal Communications
3132 There may have been a "public interest" in spreading the reach of cable
3133 TV, but as Douglas Anello, general counsel to the National Association
3134 of Broadcasters, asked Senator Quentin Burdick during testimony, "Does public
3135 interest dictate that you use somebody else's property?"
<footnote><para>
3137 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
116 (statement of Douglas A. Anello,
3138 general counsel of the National Association of Broadcasters).
3140 As another broadcaster put it,
3144 The extraordinary thing about the CATV business is that it is the
3145 only business I know of where the product that is being sold is not
3146 paid for.
<footnote><para>
3148 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
126 (statement of Ernest W. Jennes,
3149 general counsel of the Association of Maximum Service Telecasters, Inc.).
3154 Again, the demand of the copyright holders seemed reasonable enough:
3158 All we are asking for is a very simple thing, that people who now
3159 take our property for nothing pay for it. We are trying to stop
3160 piracy and I don't think there is any lesser word to describe it. I
3161 think there are harsher words which would fit it.
<footnote><para>
3163 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
169 (joint statement of Arthur B.
3164 Krim, president of United Artists Corp., and John Sinn, president of
3165 United Artists Television, Inc.).
3170 These were "free-ride[rs]," Screen Actor's Guild president Charlton
3171 Heston said, who were "depriving actors of
3172 compensation."
<footnote><para>
3174 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
209 (statement of Charlton Heston,
3175 president of the Screen Actors Guild).
3179 But again, there was another side to the debate. As Assistant Attorney
3180 General Edwin Zimmerman put it,
3184 Our point here is that unlike the problem of whether you have any
3185 copyright protection at all, the problem here is whether copyright
3186 holders who are already compensated, who already have a monopoly,
3187 should be permitted to extend that monopoly. . . . The
3189 <!-- PAGE BREAK 74 -->
3190 question here is how much compensation they should have and
3191 how far back they should carry their right to compensation.
<footnote><para>
3193 Copyright Law Revision
—CATV,
216 (statement of Edwin M.
3194 Zimmerman, acting assistant attorney general).
3195 <indexterm><primary>Zimmerman, Edwin
</primary></indexterm>
3197 <indexterm><primary>Zimmerman, Edwin
</primary></indexterm>
3201 Copyright owners took the cable companies to court. Twice the Supreme
3202 Court held that the cable companies owed the copyright owners nothing.
3205 It took Congress almost thirty years before it resolved the question
3206 of whether cable companies had to pay for the content they "pirated."
3207 In the end, Congress resolved this question in the same way that it
3208 resolved the question about record players and player pianos. Yes,
3209 cable companies would have to pay for the content that they broadcast;
3210 but the price they would have to pay was not set by the copyright
3211 owner. The price was set by law, so that the broadcasters couldn't
3212 exercise veto power over the emerging technologies of cable. Cable
3213 companies thus built their empire in part upon a "piracy" of the value
3214 created by broadcasters' content.
3217 These separate stories sing a common theme. If "piracy" means
3218 using value from someone else's creative property without permission
3219 from that creator
—as it is increasingly described
3220 today
<footnote><para>
3222 See, for example, National Music Publisher's Association,
<citetitle>The Engine
3223 of Free Expression: Copyright on the Internet
—The Myth of Free
3224 Information
</citetitle>, available at
3225 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
13</ulink>. "The
3226 threat of piracy
—the use of someone else's creative work without
3227 permission or compensation
—has grown with the Internet."
3229 — then
<emphasis>every
</emphasis> industry affected by copyright
3230 today is the product and beneficiary of a certain kind of
3231 piracy. Film, records, radio, cable TV. . . . The list is long and
3232 could well be expanded. Every generation welcomes the pirates from the
3233 last. Every generation
—until now.
3235 <!-- PAGE BREAK 75 -->
3238 <chapter id=
"piracy">
3239 <title>CHAPTER FIVE: "Piracy"
</title>
3241 There is piracy of copyrighted material. Lots of it. This piracy comes
3242 in many forms. The most significant is commercial piracy, the
3243 unauthorized taking of other people's content within a commercial
3244 context. Despite the many justifications that are offered in its
3245 defense, this taking is wrong. No one should condone it, and the law
3249 But as well as copy-shop piracy, there is another kind of "taking"
3250 that is more directly related to the Internet. That taking, too, seems
3251 wrong to many, and it is wrong much of the time. Before we paint this
3252 taking "piracy," however, we should understand its nature a bit more.
3253 For the harm of this taking is significantly more ambiguous than
3254 outright copying, and the law should account for that ambiguity, as it
3255 has so often done in the past.
3256 <!-- PAGE BREAK 76 -->
3258 <section id=
"piracy-i">
3259 <title>Piracy I
</title>
3261 All across the world, but especially in Asia and Eastern Europe, there
3262 are businesses that do nothing but take others people's copyrighted
3263 content, copy it, and sell it
—all without the permission of a copyright
3264 owner. The recording industry estimates that it loses about $
4.6 billion
3265 every year to physical piracy
<footnote><para>
3267 See IFPI (International Federation of the Phonographic Industry),
<citetitle>The
3268 Recording Industry Commercial Piracy Report
2003</citetitle>, July
2003, available
3269 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
14</ulink>. See
3270 also Ben Hunt, "Companies Warned on Music Piracy Risk,"
<citetitle>Financial
3271 Times
</citetitle>,
14 February
2003,
11.
3273 (that works out to one in three CDs sold worldwide). The MPAA
3274 estimates that it loses $
3 billion annually worldwide to piracy.
3277 This is piracy plain and simple. Nothing in the argument of this
3278 book, nor in the argument that most people make when talking about
3279 the subject of this book, should draw into doubt this simple point:
3280 This piracy is wrong.
3283 Which is not to say that excuses and justifications couldn't be made
3284 for it. We could, for example, remind ourselves that for the first one
3285 hundred years of the American Republic, America did not honor foreign
3286 copyrights. We were born, in this sense, a pirate nation. It might
3287 therefore seem hypocritical for us to insist so strongly that other
3288 developing nations treat as wrong what we, for the first hundred years
3289 of our existence, treated as right.
3292 That excuse isn't terribly strong. Technically, our law did not ban
3293 the taking of foreign works. It explicitly limited itself to American
3294 works. Thus the American publishers who published foreign works
3295 without the permission of foreign authors were not violating any rule.
3296 The copy shops in Asia, by contrast, are violating Asian law. Asian
3297 law does protect foreign copyrights, and the actions of the copy shops
3298 violate that law. So the wrong of piracy that they engage in is not
3299 just a moral wrong, but a legal wrong, and not just an internationally
3300 legal wrong, but a locally legal wrong as well.
3303 True, these local rules have, in effect, been imposed upon these
3304 countries. No country can be part of the world economy and choose
3305 <!-- PAGE BREAK 77 -->
3306 not to protect copyright internationally. We may have been born a
3307 pirate nation, but we will not allow any other nation to have a
3311 If a country is to be treated as a sovereign, however, then its laws are
3312 its laws regardless of their source. The international law under which
3313 these nations live gives them some opportunities to escape the burden
3314 of intellectual property law.
<footnote><para>
3316 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite, Information Feudalism:
<citetitle>Who
3317 Owns the Knowledge Economy?
</citetitle> (New York: The New Press,
2003),
10–13,
3318 209. The Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights
3319 (TRIPS) agreement obligates member nations to create administrative
3320 and enforcement mechanisms for intellectual property rights, a costly
3321 proposition for developing countries. Additionally, patent rights may
3322 lead to higher prices for staple industries such as
3323 agriculture. Critics of TRIPS question the disparity between burdens
3324 imposed upon developing countries and benefits conferred to
3325 industrialized nations. TRIPS does permit governments to use patents
3326 for public, noncommercial uses without first obtaining the patent
3327 holder's permission. Developing nations may be able to use this to
3328 gain the benefits of foreign patents at lower prices. This is a
3329 promising strategy for developing nations within the TRIPS framework.
3330 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
3331 </para></footnote> In my view, more developing nations should take
3332 advantage of that opportunity, but when they don't, then their laws
3333 should be respected. And under the laws of these nations, this piracy
3337 Alternatively, we could try to excuse this piracy by noting that in
3338 any case, it does no harm to the industry. The Chinese who get access
3339 to American CDs at
50 cents a copy are not people who would have
3340 bought those American CDs at $
15 a copy. So no one really has any
3341 less money than they otherwise would have had.
<footnote><para>
3343 For an analysis of the economic impact of copying technology, see Stan
3344 Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy
</citetitle> (New York: Amacom,
2002),
3345 144–90. "In some instances . . . the impact of piracy on the
3346 copyright holder's ability to appropriate the value of the work will
3347 be negligible. One obvious instance is the case where the individual
3348 engaging in pirating would not have purchased an original even if
3349 pirating were not an option." Ibid.,
149.
3350 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
3354 This is often true (though I have friends who have purchased many
3355 thousands of pirated DVDs who certainly have enough money to pay
3356 for the content they have taken), and it does mitigate to some degree
3357 the harm caused by such taking. Extremists in this debate love to say,
3358 "You wouldn't go into Barnes
& Noble and take a book off of the shelf
3359 without paying; why should it be any different with on-line music?"
3360 The difference is, of course, that when you take a book from Barnes
&
3361 Noble, it has one less book to sell. By contrast, when you take an MP3
3362 from a computer network, there is not one less CD that can be sold.
3363 The physics of piracy of the intangible are different from the physics of
3364 piracy of the tangible.
3367 This argument is still very weak. However, although copyright is a
3368 property right of a very special sort, it
<emphasis>is
</emphasis> a
3369 property right. Like all property rights, the copyright gives the
3370 owner the right to decide the terms under which content is shared. If
3371 the copyright owner doesn't want to sell, she doesn't have to. There
3372 are exceptions: important statutory licenses that apply to copyrighted
3373 content regardless of the wish of the copyright owner. Those licenses
3374 give people the right to "take" copyrighted content whether or not the
3375 copyright owner wants to sell. But
3377 <!-- PAGE BREAK 78 -->
3378 where the law does not give people the right to take content, it is
3379 wrong to take that content even if the wrong does no harm. If we have
3380 a property system, and that system is properly balanced to the
3381 technology of a time, then it is wrong to take property without the
3382 permission of a property owner. That is exactly what "property" means.
3385 Finally, we could try to excuse this piracy with the argument that the
3386 piracy actually helps the copyright owner. When the Chinese "steal"
3387 Windows, that makes the Chinese dependent on Microsoft. Microsoft
3388 loses the value of the software that was taken. But it gains users who
3389 are used to life in the Microsoft world. Over time, as the nation
3390 grows more wealthy, more and more people will buy software rather than
3391 steal it. And hence over time, because that buying will benefit
3392 Microsoft, Microsoft benefits from the piracy. If instead of pirating
3393 Microsoft Windows, the Chinese used the free GNU/Linux operating
3394 system, then these Chinese users would not eventually be buying
3395 Microsoft. Without piracy, then, Microsoft would lose.
3396 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3398 <primary>Microsoft
</primary>
3399 <secondary>Windows operating system of
</secondary>
3401 <indexterm><primary>Windows
</primary></indexterm>
3404 This argument, too, is somewhat true. The addiction strategy is a good
3405 one. Many businesses practice it. Some thrive because of it. Law
3406 students, for example, are given free access to the two largest legal
3407 databases. The companies marketing both hope the students will become
3408 so used to their service that they will want to use it and not the
3409 other when they become lawyers (and must pay high subscription fees).
3412 Still, the argument is not terribly persuasive. We don't give the
3413 alcoholic a defense when he steals his first beer, merely because that
3414 will make it more likely that he will buy the next three. Instead, we
3415 ordinarily allow businesses to decide for themselves when it is best
3416 to give their product away. If Microsoft fears the competition of
3417 GNU/Linux, then Microsoft can give its product away, as it did, for
3418 example, with Internet Explorer to fight Netscape. A property right
3419 means giving the property owner the right to say who gets access to
3420 what
—at least ordinarily. And if the law properly balances the
3421 rights of the copyright owner with the rights of access, then
3422 violating the law is still wrong.
3423 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
3426 <!-- PAGE BREAK 79 -->
3427 Thus, while I understand the pull of these justifications for piracy,
3428 and I certainly see the motivation, in my view, in the end, these efforts
3429 at justifying commercial piracy simply don't cut it. This kind of piracy
3430 is rampant and just plain wrong. It doesn't transform the content it
3431 steals; it doesn't transform the market it competes in. It merely gives
3432 someone access to something that the law says he should not have.
3433 Nothing has changed to draw that law into doubt. This form of piracy
3437 But as the examples from the four chapters that introduced this part
3438 suggest, even if some piracy is plainly wrong, not all "piracy" is. Or
3439 at least, not all "piracy" is wrong if that term is understood in the
3440 way it is increasingly used today. Many kinds of "piracy" are useful
3441 and productive, to produce either new content or new ways of doing
3442 business. Neither our tradition nor any tradition has ever banned all
3443 "piracy" in that sense of the term.
3446 This doesn't mean that there are no questions raised by the latest
3447 piracy concern, peer-to-peer file sharing. But it does mean that we
3448 need to understand the harm in peer-to-peer sharing a bit more before
3449 we condemn it to the gallows with the charge of piracy.
3452 For (
1) like the original Hollywood, p2p sharing escapes an overly
3453 controlling industry; and (
2) like the original recording industry, it
3454 simply exploits a new way to distribute content; but (
3) unlike cable
3455 TV, no one is selling the content that is shared on p2p services.
3458 These differences distinguish p2p sharing from true piracy. They
3459 should push us to find a way to protect artists while enabling this
3463 <section id=
"piracy-ii">
3464 <title>Piracy II
</title>
3466 The key to the "piracy" that the law aims to quash is a use that "rob[s]
3467 the author of [his] profit."
<footnote><para>
3469 <citetitle>Bach
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Longman
</citetitle>,
98 Eng. Rep.
1274 (
1777).
3471 This means we must determine whether
3472 and how much p2p sharing harms before we know how strongly the
3473 <!-- PAGE BREAK 80 -->
3474 law should seek to either prevent it or find an alternative to assure the
3475 author of his profit.
3478 Peer-to-peer sharing was made famous by Napster. But the inventors of
3479 the Napster technology had not made any major technological
3480 innovations. Like every great advance in innovation on the Internet
3481 (and, arguably, off the Internet as well
<footnote><para>
3483 See Clayton M. Christensen,
<citetitle>The Innovator's Dilemma: The Revolutionary
3484 National Bestseller That Changed the Way We Do Business
</citetitle> (New York:
3485 HarperBusiness,
2000). Professor Christensen examines why companies
3486 that give rise to and dominate a product area are frequently unable to
3487 come up with the most creative, paradigm-shifting uses for their own
3488 products. This job usually falls to outside innovators, who
3489 reassemble existing technology in inventive ways. For a discussion of
3490 Christensen's ideas, see Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>Future
</citetitle>,
89–92,
139.
3492 <indexterm><primary>Christensen, Clayton M.
</primary></indexterm>
3493 </para></footnote>), Shawn Fanning and crew had simply
3494 put together components that had been developed independently.
3495 <indexterm><primary>Fanning, Shawn
</primary></indexterm>
3498 The result was spontaneous combustion. Launched in July
1999,
3499 Napster amassed over
10 million users within nine months. After
3500 eighteen months, there were close to
80 million registered users of the
3501 system.
<footnote><para>
3503 See Carolyn Lochhead, "Silicon Valley Dream, Hollywood Nightmare,"
<citetitle>San
3504 Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
24 September
2002, A1; "Rock 'n' Roll Suicide,"
3505 <citetitle>New Scientist
</citetitle>,
6 July
2002,
42; Benny Evangelista, "Napster Names CEO,
3506 Secures New Financing,"
<citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
23 May
2003, C1;
3507 "Napster's Wake-Up Call,"
<citetitle>Economist
</citetitle>,
24 June
2000,
23; John Naughton,
3508 "Hollywood at War with the Internet" (London)
<citetitle>Times
</citetitle>,
26 July
2002,
18.
3510 Courts quickly shut Napster down, but other services emerged
3511 to take its place. (Kazaa is currently the most popular p2p service. It
3512 boasts over
100 million members.) These services' systems are different
3513 architecturally, though not very different in function: Each enables
3514 users to make content available to any number of other users. With a
3515 p2p system, you can share your favorite songs with your best friend
—
3516 or your
20,
000 best friends.
3519 According to a number of estimates, a huge proportion of Americans
3520 have tasted file-sharing technology. A study by Ipsos-Insight in
3521 September
2002 estimated that
60 million Americans had downloaded
3522 music
—28 percent of Americans older than
12.
<footnote><para>
3525 See Ipsos-Insight,
<citetitle>TEMPO: Keeping Pace with Online Music Distribution
</citetitle>
3526 (September
2002), reporting that
28 percent of Americans aged twelve
3527 and older have downloaded music off of the Internet and
30 percent have
3528 listened to digital music files stored on their computers.
3530 A survey by the NPD group quoted in
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>
3531 estimated that
43 million citizens used file-sharing networks to
3532 exchange content in May
2003.
<footnote><para>
3534 Amy Harmon, "Industry Offers a Carrot in Online Music Fight,"
<citetitle>New
3535 York Times
</citetitle>,
6 June
2003, A1.
3537 The vast majority of these are not kids. Whatever the actual figure, a
3538 massive quantity of content is being "taken" on these networks. The
3539 ease and inexpensiveness of file-sharing networks have inspired
3540 millions to enjoy music in a way that they hadn't before.
3543 Some of this enjoying involves copyright infringement. Some of it does
3544 not. And even among the part that is technically copyright
3545 infringement, calculating the actual harm to copyright owners is more
3546 complicated than one might think. So consider
—a bit more
3547 carefully than the polarized voices around this debate usually
3548 do
—the kinds of sharing that file sharing enables, and the kinds
3552 <!-- PAGE BREAK 81 -->
3553 File sharers share different kinds of content. We can divide these
3554 different kinds into four types.
3556 <orderedlist numeration=
"upperalpha">
3559 There are some who use sharing networks as substitutes for purchasing
3560 content. Thus, when a new Madonna CD is released, rather than buying
3561 the CD, these users simply take it. We might quibble about whether
3562 everyone who takes it would actually have bought it if sharing didn't
3563 make it available for free. Most probably wouldn't have, but clearly
3564 there are some who would. The latter are the target of category A:
3565 users who download instead of purchasing.
3566 <indexterm><primary>Madonna
</primary></indexterm>
3570 There are some who use sharing networks to sample music before
3571 purchasing it. Thus, a friend sends another friend an MP3 of an artist
3572 he's not heard of. The other friend then buys CDs by that artist. This
3573 is a kind of targeted advertising, quite likely to succeed. If the
3574 friend recommending the album gains nothing from a bad recommendation,
3575 then one could expect that the recommendations will actually be quite
3576 good. The net effect of this sharing could increase the quantity of
3581 There are many who use sharing networks to get access to copyrighted
3582 content that is no longer sold or that they would not have purchased
3583 because the transaction costs off the Net are too high. This use of
3584 sharing networks is among the most rewarding for many. Songs that were
3585 part of your childhood but have long vanished from the marketplace
3586 magically appear again on the network. (One friend told me that when
3587 she discovered Napster, she spent a solid weekend "recalling" old
3588 songs. She was astonished at the range and mix of content that was
3589 available.) For content not sold, this is still technically a
3590 violation of copyright, though because the copyright owner is not
3591 selling the content anymore, the economic harm is zero
—the same
3592 harm that occurs when I sell my collection of
1960s
45-rpm records to
3596 <!-- PAGE BREAK 82 -->
3598 Finally, there are many who use sharing networks to get access
3599 to content that is not copyrighted or that the copyright owner
3604 How do these different types of sharing balance out?
3607 Let's start with some simple but important points. From the
3608 perspective of the law, only type D sharing is clearly legal. From the
3609 perspective of economics, only type A sharing is clearly
3610 harmful.
<footnote><para>
3612 See Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy
</citetitle>,
148–49.
3613 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
3615 Type B sharing is illegal but plainly beneficial. Type C sharing is
3616 illegal, yet good for society (since more exposure to music is good)
3617 and harmless to the artist (since the work is not otherwise
3618 available). So how sharing matters on balance is a hard question to
3619 answer
—and certainly much more difficult than the current
3620 rhetoric around the issue suggests.
3623 Whether on balance sharing is harmful depends importantly on how
3624 harmful type A sharing is. Just as Edison complained about Hollywood,
3625 composers complained about piano rolls, recording artists complained
3626 about radio, and broadcasters complained about cable TV, the music
3627 industry complains that type A sharing is a kind of "theft" that is
3628 "devastating" the industry.
3631 While the numbers do suggest that sharing is harmful, how
3632 harmful is harder to reckon. It has long been the recording industry's
3633 practice to blame technology for any drop in sales. The history of
3634 cassette recording is a good example. As a study by Cap Gemini Ernst
3635 & Young put it, "Rather than exploiting this new, popular
3636 technology, the labels fought it."
<footnote><para>
3638 See Cap Gemini Ernst
& Young,
<citetitle>Technology Evolution and the
3639 Music Industry's Business Model Crisis
</citetitle> (
2003),
3. This report
3640 describes the music industry's effort to stigmatize the budding
3641 practice of cassette taping in the
1970s, including an advertising
3642 campaign featuring a cassette-shape skull and the caption "Home taping
3643 is killing music." At the time digital audio tape became a threat,
3644 the Office of Technical Assessment conducted a survey of consumer
3645 behavior. In
1988,
40 percent of consumers older than ten had taped
3646 music to a cassette format. U.S. Congress, Office of Technology
3647 Assessment,
<citetitle>Copyright and Home Copying: Technology Challenges the Law
</citetitle>,
3648 OTA-CIT-
422 (Washington, D.C.: U.S. Government Printing Office,
3649 October
1989),
145–56.
</para></footnote>
3650 The labels claimed that every album taped was an album unsold, and
3651 when record sales fell by
11.4 percent in
1981, the industry claimed
3652 that its point was proved. Technology was the problem, and banning or
3653 regulating technology was the answer.
3656 Yet soon thereafter, and before Congress was given an opportunity
3657 to enact regulation, MTV was launched, and the industry had a record
3658 turnaround. "In the end," Cap Gemini concludes, "the `crisis' . . . was
3659 not the fault of the tapers
—who did not [stop after MTV came into
3660 <!-- PAGE BREAK 83 -->
3661 being]
—but had to a large extent resulted from stagnation in musical
3662 innovation at the major labels."
<footnote><para>
3664 U.S. Congress,
<citetitle>Copyright and Home Copying
</citetitle>,
4.
3668 But just because the industry was wrong before does not mean it is
3669 wrong today. To evaluate the real threat that p2p sharing presents to
3670 the industry in particular, and society in general
—or at least
3671 the society that inherits the tradition that gave us the film
3672 industry, the record industry, the radio industry, cable TV, and the
3673 VCR
—the question is not simply whether type A sharing is
3674 harmful. The question is also
<emphasis>how
</emphasis> harmful type A
3675 sharing is, and how beneficial the other types of sharing are.
3678 We start to answer this question by focusing on the net harm, from the
3679 standpoint of the industry as a whole, that sharing networks cause.
3680 The "net harm" to the industry as a whole is the amount by which type
3681 A sharing exceeds type B. If the record companies sold more records
3682 through sampling than they lost through substitution, then sharing
3683 networks would actually benefit music companies on balance. They would
3684 therefore have little
<emphasis>static
</emphasis> reason to resist
3689 Could that be true? Could the industry as a whole be gaining because
3690 of file sharing? Odd as that might sound, the data about CD sales
3691 actually suggest it might be close.
3694 In
2002, the RIAA reported that CD sales had fallen by
8.9 percent,
3695 from
882 million to
803 million units; revenues fell
6.7
3696 percent.
<footnote><para>
3698 See Recording Industry Association of America,
<citetitle>2002 Yearend Statistics
</citetitle>,
3700 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
15</ulink>. A later
3701 report indicates even greater losses. See Recording Industry
3702 Association of America,
<citetitle>Some Facts About Music Piracy
</citetitle>,
25 June
2003,
3703 available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
3704 #
16</ulink>: "In the past four years, unit shipments of recorded music
3705 have fallen by
26 percent from
1.16 billion units in to
860 million
3706 units in
2002 in the United States (based on units shipped). In terms
3707 of sales, revenues are down
14 percent, from $
14.6 billion in to $
12.6
3708 billion last year (based on U.S. dollar value of shipments). The music
3709 industry worldwide has gone from a $
39 billion industry in
2000 down
3710 to a $
32 billion industry in
2002 (based on U.S. dollar value of
3713 This confirms a trend over the past few years. The RIAA blames
3714 Internet piracy for the trend, though there are many other causes that
3715 could account for this drop. SoundScan, for example, reports a more
3716 than
20 percent drop in the number of CDs released since
1999. That no
3717 doubt accounts for some of the decrease in sales. Rising prices could
3718 account for at least some of the loss. "From
1999 to
2001, the average
3719 price of a CD rose
7.2 percent, from $
13.04 to $
14.19."
<footnote>
3722 Jane Black, "Big Music's Broken Record," BusinessWeek online,
13
3723 February
2003, available at
3724 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
17</ulink>.
3725 <indexterm><primary>Black, Jane
</primary></indexterm>
3728 Competition from other forms of media could also account for some of
3729 the decline. As Jane Black of
<citetitle>BusinessWeek
</citetitle> notes, "The
3730 soundtrack to the film
<citetitle>High Fidelity
</citetitle> has a list price of
3731 $
18.98. You could get the whole movie [on DVD] for
3732 $
19.99."
<footnote><para>
3739 <!-- PAGE BREAK 84 -->
3740 But let's assume the RIAA is right, and all of the decline in CD sales
3741 is because of Internet sharing. Here's the rub: In the same period
3742 that the RIAA estimates that
803 million CDs were sold, the RIAA
3743 estimates that
2.1 billion CDs were downloaded for free. Thus,
3744 although
2.6 times the total number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3745 free, sales revenue fell by just
6.7 percent.
3748 There are too many different things happening at the same time to
3749 explain these numbers definitively, but one conclusion is unavoidable:
3750 The recording industry constantly asks, "What's the difference between
3751 downloading a song and stealing a CD?"
—but their own numbers
3752 reveal the difference. If I steal a CD, then there is one less CD to
3753 sell. Every taking is a lost sale. But on the basis of the numbers the
3754 RIAA provides, it is absolutely clear that the same is not true of
3755 downloads. If every download were a lost sale
—if every use of
3756 Kazaa "rob[bed] the author of [his] profit"
—then the industry
3757 would have suffered a
100 percent drop in sales last year, not a
7
3758 percent drop. If
2.6 times the number of CDs sold were downloaded for
3759 free, and yet sales revenue dropped by just
6.7 percent, then there is
3760 a huge difference between "downloading a song and stealing a CD."
3763 These are the harms
—alleged and perhaps exaggerated but, let's
3764 assume, real. What of the benefits? File sharing may impose costs on
3765 the recording industry. What value does it produce in addition to
3769 One benefit is type C sharing
—making available content that
3770 is technically still under copyright but is no longer commercially
3771 available. This is not a small category of content. There are
3772 millions of tracks that are no longer commercially
3773 available.
<footnote><para>
3775 By one estimate,
75 percent of the music released by the major labels
3776 is no longer in print. See Online Entertainment and Copyright
3777 Law
—Coming Soon to a Digital Device Near You: Hearing Before the
3778 Senate Committee on the Judiciary,
107th Cong.,
1st sess. (
3 April
3779 2001) (prepared statement of the Future of Music Coalition), available
3780 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
18</ulink>.
3782 And while it's conceivable that some of this content is not available
3783 because the artist producing the content doesn't want it to be made
3784 available, the vast majority of it is unavailable solely because the
3785 publisher or the distributor has decided it no longer makes economic
3786 sense
<emphasis>to the company
</emphasis> to make it available.
3789 In real space
—long before the Internet
—the market had a simple
3790 <!-- PAGE BREAK 85 -->
3791 response to this problem: used book and record stores. There are
3792 thousands of used book and used record stores in America
3793 today.
<footnote><para>
3795 While there are not good estimates of the number of used record stores in
3796 existence, in
2002, there were
7,
198 used book dealers in the United States,
3797 an increase of
20 percent since
1993. See Book Hunter Press,
<citetitle>The Quiet
3798 Revolution: The Expansion of the Used Book Market
</citetitle> (
2002), available at
3799 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
19</ulink>. Used records accounted for $
260 million in sales in
2002. See
3801 Association of Recording Merchandisers, "
2002 Annual Survey
3804 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
20</ulink>.
3806 These stores buy content from owners, then sell the content they
3807 buy. And under American copyright law, when they buy and sell this
3808 content,
<emphasis>even if the content is still under
3809 copyright
</emphasis>, the copyright owner doesn't get a dime. Used
3810 book and record stores are commercial entities; their owners make
3811 money from the content they sell; but as with cable companies before
3812 statutory licensing, they don't have to pay the copyright owner for
3813 the content they sell.
3815 <indexterm><primary>Bernstein, Leonard
</primary></indexterm>
3817 Type C sharing, then, is very much like used book stores or used
3818 record stores. It is different, of course, because the person making
3819 the content available isn't making money from making the content
3820 available. It is also different, of course, because in real space,
3821 when I sell a record, I don't have it anymore, while in cyberspace,
3822 when someone shares my
1949 recording of Bernstein's "Two Love Songs,"
3823 I still have it. That difference would matter economically if the
3824 owner of the copyright were selling the record in competition to my
3825 sharing. But we're talking about the class of content that is not
3826 currently commercially available. The Internet is making it available,
3827 through cooperative sharing, without competing with the market.
3830 It may well be, all things considered, that it would be better if the
3831 copyright owner got something from this trade. But just because it may
3832 well be better, it doesn't follow that it would be good to ban used book
3833 stores. Or put differently, if you think that type C sharing should be
3834 stopped, do you think that libraries and used book stores should be
3838 Finally, and perhaps most importantly, file-sharing networks enable
3839 type D sharing to occur
—the sharing of content that copyright owners
3840 want to have shared or for which there is no continuing copyright. This
3841 sharing clearly benefits authors and society. Science fiction author
3842 Cory Doctorow, for example, released his first novel,
<citetitle>Down and Out in
3843 the Magic Kingdom
</citetitle>, both free on-line and in bookstores on the same
3845 <!-- PAGE BREAK 86 -->
3846 day. His (and his publisher's) thinking was that the on-line distribution
3847 would be a great advertisement for the "real" book. People would read
3848 part on-line, and then decide whether they liked the book or not. If
3849 they liked it, they would be more likely to buy it. Doctorow's content is
3850 type D content. If sharing networks enable his work to be spread, then
3851 both he and society are better off. (Actually, much better off: It is a
3855 Likewise for work in the public domain: This sharing benefits society
3856 with no legal harm to authors at all. If efforts to solve the problem
3857 of type A sharing destroy the opportunity for type D sharing, then we
3858 lose something important in order to protect type A content.
3861 The point throughout is this: While the recording industry
3862 understandably says, "This is how much we've lost," we must also ask,
3863 "How much has society gained from p2p sharing? What are the
3864 efficiencies? What is the content that otherwise would be
3868 For unlike the piracy I described in the first section of this
3869 chapter, much of the "piracy" that file sharing enables is plainly
3870 legal and good. And like the piracy I described in chapter
4, much of
3871 this piracy is motivated by a new way of spreading content caused by
3872 changes in the technology of distribution. Thus, consistent with the
3873 tradition that gave us Hollywood, radio, the recording industry, and
3874 cable TV, the question we should be asking about file sharing is how
3875 best to preserve its benefits while minimizing (to the extent
3876 possible) the wrongful harm it causes artists. The question is one of
3877 balance. The law should seek that balance, and that balance will be
3878 found only with time.
3881 "But isn't the war just a war against illegal sharing? Isn't the target
3882 just what you call type A sharing?"
3885 You would think. And we should hope. But so far, it is not. The
3887 of the war purportedly on type A sharing alone has been felt far
3888 beyond that one class of sharing. That much is obvious from the
3890 case itself. When Napster told the district court that it had
3892 a technology to block the transfer of
99.4 percent of identified
3893 <!-- PAGE BREAK 87 -->
3894 infringing material, the district court told counsel for Napster
99.4
3895 percent was not good enough. Napster had to push the infringements
3896 "down to zero."
<footnote><para>
3898 See Transcript of Proceedings, In Re: Napster Copyright Litigation at
34-
3899 35 (N.D. Cal.,
11 July
2001), nos. MDL-
00-
1369 MHP, C
99-
5183
3902 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
21</ulink>. For an
3903 account of the litigation and its toll on Napster, see Joseph Menn,
3904 <citetitle>All the Rave: The Rise and Fall of Shawn Fanning's Napster
</citetitle> (New
3905 York: Crown Business,
2003),
269–82.
3909 If
99.4 percent is not good enough, then this is a war on file-sharing
3910 technologies, not a war on copyright infringement. There is no way to
3911 assure that a p2p system is used
100 percent of the time in compliance
3912 with the law, any more than there is a way to assure that
100 percent of
3913 VCRs or
100 percent of Xerox machines or
100 percent of handguns
3914 are used in compliance with the law. Zero tolerance means zero p2p.
3915 The court's ruling means that we as a society must lose the benefits of
3916 p2p, even for the totally legal and beneficial uses they serve, simply to
3917 assure that there are zero copyright infringements caused by p2p.
3920 Zero tolerance has not been our history. It has not produced the
3921 content industry that we know today. The history of American law has
3922 been a process of balance. As new technologies changed the way content
3923 was distributed, the law adjusted, after some time, to the new
3924 technology. In this adjustment, the law sought to ensure the
3925 legitimate rights of creators while protecting innovation. Sometimes
3926 this has meant more rights for creators. Sometimes less.
3929 So, as we've seen, when "mechanical reproduction" threatened the
3930 interests of composers, Congress balanced the rights of composers
3931 against the interests of the recording industry. It granted rights to
3932 composers, but also to the recording artists: Composers were to be
3933 paid, but at a price set by Congress. But when radio started
3934 broadcasting the recordings made by these recording artists, and they
3935 complained to Congress that their "creative property" was not being
3936 respected (since the radio station did not have to pay them for the
3937 creativity it broadcast), Congress rejected their claim. An indirect
3941 Cable TV followed the pattern of record albums. When the courts
3942 rejected the claim that cable broadcasters had to pay for the content
3943 they rebroadcast, Congress responded by giving broadcasters a right to
3944 compensation, but at a level set by the law. It likewise gave cable
3945 companies the right to the content, so long as they paid the statutory
3950 <!-- PAGE BREAK 88 -->
3951 This compromise, like the compromise affecting records and player
3952 pianos, served two important goals
—indeed, the two central goals
3953 of any copyright legislation. First, the law assured that new
3954 innovators would have the freedom to develop new ways to deliver
3955 content. Second, the law assured that copyright holders would be paid
3956 for the content that was distributed. One fear was that if Congress
3957 simply required cable TV to pay copyright holders whatever they
3958 demanded for their content, then copyright holders associated with
3959 broadcasters would use their power to stifle this new technology,
3960 cable. But if Congress had permitted cable to use broadcasters'
3961 content for free, then it would have unfairly subsidized cable. Thus
3962 Congress chose a path that would assure
3963 <emphasis>compensation
</emphasis> without giving the past
3964 (broadcasters) control over the future (cable).
3966 <indexterm><primary>Betamax
</primary></indexterm>
3968 In the same year that Congress struck this balance, two major
3969 producers and distributors of film content filed a lawsuit against
3970 another technology, the video tape recorder (VTR, or as we refer to
3971 them today, VCRs) that Sony had produced, the Betamax. Disney's and
3972 Universal's claim against Sony was relatively simple: Sony produced a
3973 device, Disney and Universal claimed, that enabled consumers to engage
3974 in copyright infringement. Because the device that Sony built had a
3975 "record" button, the device could be used to record copyrighted movies
3976 and shows. Sony was therefore benefiting from the copyright
3977 infringement of its customers. It should therefore, Disney and
3978 Universal claimed, be partially liable for that infringement.
3981 There was something to Disney's and Universal's claim. Sony did
3982 decide to design its machine to make it very simple to record television
3983 shows. It could have built the machine to block or inhibit any direct
3984 copying from a television broadcast. Or possibly, it could have built the
3985 machine to copy only if there were a special "copy me" signal on the
3986 line. It was clear that there were many television shows that did not
3987 grant anyone permission to copy. Indeed, if anyone had asked, no
3988 doubt the majority of shows would not have authorized copying. And
3989 <!-- PAGE BREAK 89 -->
3990 in the face of this obvious preference, Sony could have designed its
3991 system to minimize the opportunity for copyright infringement. It did
3992 not, and for that, Disney and Universal wanted to hold it responsible
3993 for the architecture it chose.
3996 MPAA president Jack Valenti became the studios' most vocal
3997 champion. Valenti called VCRs "tapeworms." He warned, "When there are
3998 20,
30,
40 million of these VCRs in the land, we will be invaded by
3999 millions of `tapeworms,' eating away at the very heart and essence of
4000 the most precious asset the copyright owner has, his
4001 copyright."
<footnote><para>
4003 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders): Hearing on
4004 S.
1758 Before the Senate Committee on the Judiciary,
97th Cong.,
1st
4005 and
2nd sess.,
459 (
1982) (testimony of Jack Valenti, president, Motion
4006 Picture Association of America, Inc.).
4008 "One does not have to be trained in sophisticated marketing and
4009 creative judgment," he told Congress, "to understand the devastation
4010 on the after-theater marketplace caused by the hundreds of millions of
4011 tapings that will adversely impact on the future of the creative
4012 community in this country. It is simply a question of basic economics
4013 and plain common sense."
<footnote><para>
4015 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders),
475.
4017 Indeed, as surveys would later show,
4018 percent of VCR owners had movie libraries of ten videos or more
<footnote><para>
4020 <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle>,
480 F. Supp.
429,
4023 — a use the Court would later hold was not "fair." By
4024 "allowing VCR owners to copy freely by the means of an exemption from
4025 copyright infringementwithout creating a mechanism to compensate
4026 copyrightowners," Valenti testified, Congress would "take from the
4027 owners the very essence of their property: the exclusive right to
4028 control who may use their work, that is, who may copy it and thereby
4029 profit from its reproduction."
<footnote><para>
4031 Copyright Infringements (Audio and Video Recorders),
485 (testimony
4036 It took eight years for this case to be resolved by the Supreme
4037 Court. In the interim, the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals, which
4038 includes Hollywood in its jurisdiction
—leading Judge Alex
4039 Kozinski, who sits on that court, refers to it as the "Hollywood
4040 Circuit"
—held that Sony would be liable for the copyright
4041 infringement made possible by its machines. Under the Ninth Circuit's
4042 rule, this totally familiar technology
—which Jack Valenti had
4043 called "the Boston Strangler of the American film industry" (worse
4044 yet, it was a
<emphasis>Japanese
</emphasis> Boston Strangler of the
4045 American film industry)
—was an illegal
4046 technology.
<footnote><para>
4048 <citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle>,
659 F.
2d
963 (
9th Cir.
4053 But the Supreme Court reversed the decision of the Ninth Circuit.
4055 <!-- PAGE BREAK 90 -->
4056 And in its reversal, the Court clearly articulated its understanding of
4057 when and whether courts should intervene in such disputes. As the
4062 Sound policy, as well as history, supports our consistent deference
4063 to Congress when major technological innovations alter the
4065 for copyrighted materials. Congress has the constitutional
4067 and the institutional ability to accommodate fully the
4068 varied permutations of competing interests that are inevitably
4070 by such new technology.
<footnote><para>
4072 <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
431 (
1984).
4077 Congress was asked to respond to the Supreme Court's decision. But as
4078 with the plea of recording artists about radio broadcasts, Congress
4079 ignored the request. Congress was convinced that American film got
4080 enough, this "taking" notwithstanding. If we put these cases
4081 together, a pattern is clear:
4085 <title>Table
</title>
4086 <tgroup cols=
"4" align=
"char">
4090 <entry>WHOSE VALUE WAS "PIRATED"
</entry>
4091 <entry>RESPONSE OF THE COURTS
</entry>
4092 <entry>RESPONSE OF CONGRESS
</entry>
4097 <entry>Recordings
</entry>
4098 <entry>Composers
</entry>
4099 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4100 <entry>Statutory license
</entry>
4103 <entry>Radio
</entry>
4104 <entry>Recording artists
</entry>
4106 <entry>Nothing
</entry>
4109 <entry>Cable TV
</entry>
4110 <entry>Broadcasters
</entry>
4111 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4112 <entry>Statutory license
</entry>
4116 <entry>Film creators
</entry>
4117 <entry>No protection
</entry>
4118 <entry>Nothing
</entry>
4125 In each case throughout our history, a new technology changed the
4126 way content was distributed.
<footnote><para>
4128 These are the most important instances in our history, but there are other
4129 cases as well. The technology of digital audio tape (DAT), for example,
4130 was regulated by Congress to minimize the risk of piracy. The remedy
4131 Congress imposed did burden DAT producers, by taxing tape sales and
4132 controlling the technology of DAT. See Audio Home Recording Act of
4133 1992 (Title
17 of the
<citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>), Pub. L. No.
102-
563,
106 Stat.
4134 4237, codified at
17 U.S.C. §
1001. Again, however, this regulation did not
4135 eliminate the opportunity for free riding in the sense I've described. See
4136 Lessig,
<citetitle>Future
</citetitle>,
71. See also Picker, "From Edison to the Broadcast Flag,"
4137 <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
293–96.
4138 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
4140 In each case, throughout our history,
4141 that change meant that someone got a "free ride" on someone else's
4145 In
<emphasis>none
</emphasis> of these cases did either the courts or
4146 Congress eliminate all free riding. In
<emphasis>none
</emphasis> of
4147 these cases did the courts or Congress insist that the law should
4148 assure that the copyright holder get all the value that his copyright
4149 created. In every case, the copyright owners complained of "piracy."
4150 In every case, Congress acted to recognize some of the legitimacy in
4151 the behavior of the "pirates." In each case, Congress allowed some new
4152 technology to benefit from content made before. It balanced the
4154 <!-- PAGE BREAK 91 -->
4157 When you think across these examples, and the other examples that
4158 make up the first four chapters of this section, this balance makes
4159 sense. Was Walt Disney a pirate? Would doujinshi be better if creators
4160 had to ask permission? Should tools that enable others to capture and
4161 spread images as a way to cultivate or criticize our culture be better
4163 Is it really right that building a search engine should expose you
4164 to $
15 million in damages? Would it have been better if Edison had
4165 controlled film? Should every cover band have to hire a lawyer to get
4166 permission to record a song?
4169 We could answer yes to each of these questions, but our tradition
4170 has answered no. In our tradition, as the Supreme Court has stated,
4171 copyright "has never accorded the copyright owner complete control
4172 over all possible uses of his work."
<footnote><para>
4174 <citetitle>Sony Corp. of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
4177 Instead, the particular uses that the law regulates have been defined
4178 by balancing the good that comes from granting an exclusive right
4179 against the burdens such an exclusive right creates. And this
4180 balancing has historically been done
<emphasis>after
</emphasis> a
4181 technology has matured, or settled into the mix of technologies that
4182 facilitate the distribution of content.
4185 We should be doing the same thing today. The technology of the
4186 Internet is changing quickly. The way people connect to the Internet
4187 (wires vs. wireless) is changing very quickly. No doubt the network
4188 should not become a tool for "stealing" from artists. But neither
4189 should the law become a tool to entrench one particular way in which
4190 artists (or more accurately, distributors) get paid. As I describe in
4191 some detail in the last chapter of this book, we should be securing
4192 income to artists while we allow the market to secure the most
4193 efficient way to promote and distribute content. This will require
4194 changes in the law, at least in the interim. These changes should be
4195 designed to balance the protection of the law against the strong
4196 public interest that innovation continue.
4200 <!-- PAGE BREAK 92 -->
4201 This is especially true when a new technology enables a vastly
4202 superior mode of distribution. And this p2p has done. P2p technologies
4203 can be ideally efficient in moving content across a widely diverse
4204 network. Left to develop, they could make the network vastly more
4205 efficient. Yet these "potential public benefits," as John Schwartz
4206 writes in
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>, "could be delayed in the P2P
4207 fight."
<footnote><para>
4209 John Schwartz, "New Economy: The Attack on Peer-to-Peer Software
4210 Echoes Past Efforts,"
<citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
22 September
2003, C3.
4212 Yet when anyone begins to talk about "balance," the copyright warriors
4213 raise a different argument. "All this hand waving about balance and
4214 incentives," they say, "misses a fundamental point. Our content," the
4215 warriors insist, "is our
<emphasis>property
</emphasis>. Why should we
4216 wait for Congress to `rebalance' our property rights? Do you have to
4217 wait before calling the police when your car has been stolen? And why
4218 should Congress deliberate at all about the merits of this theft? Do
4219 we ask whether the car thief had a good use for the car before we
4223 "It is
<emphasis>our property
</emphasis>," the warriors insist. "And
4224 it should be protected just as any other property is protected."
4226 <!-- PAGE BREAK 93 -->
4230 <part id=
"c-property">
4231 <title>"PROPERTY"</title>
4235 <!-- PAGE BREAK 94 -->
4236 The copyright warriors are right: A copyright is a kind of
4237 property. It can be owned and sold, and the law protects against its
4238 theft. Ordinarily, the copyright owner gets to hold out for any price he
4239 wants. Markets reckon the supply and demand that partially determine
4240 the price she can get.
4243 But in ordinary language, to call a copyright a "property" right is a
4244 bit misleading, for the property of copyright is an odd kind of
4245 property. Indeed, the very idea of property in any idea or any
4246 expression is very odd. I understand what I am taking when I take the
4247 picnic table you put in your backyard. I am taking a thing, the picnic
4248 table, and after I take it, you don't have it. But what am I taking
4249 when I take the good
<emphasis>idea
</emphasis> you had to put a picnic
4250 table in the backyard
—by, for example, going to Sears, buying a
4251 table, and putting it in my backyard? What is the thing I am taking
4255 The point is not just about the thingness of picnic tables versus
4256 ideas, though that's an important difference. The point instead is that
4257 <!-- PAGE BREAK 95 -->
4258 in the ordinary case
—indeed, in practically every case except for a
4260 range of exceptions
—ideas released to the world are free. I don't
4261 take anything from you when I copy the way you dress
—though I
4262 might seem weird if I did it every day, and especially weird if you are a
4263 woman. Instead, as Thomas Jefferson said (and as is especially true
4264 when I copy the way someone else dresses), "He who receives an idea
4265 from me, receives instruction himself without lessening mine; as he who
4266 lights his taper at mine, receives light without darkening me."
<footnote><para>
4268 Letter from Thomas Jefferson to Isaac McPherson (
13 August
1813) in
4269 <citetitle>The Writings of Thomas Jefferson
</citetitle>, vol.
6 (Andrew A. Lipscomb and Albert
4270 Ellery Bergh, eds.,
1903),
330,
333–34.
4274 The exceptions to free use are ideas and expressions within the
4275 reach of the law of patent and copyright, and a few other domains that
4276 I won't discuss here. Here the law says you can't take my idea or
4278 without my permission: The law turns the intangible into
4282 But how, and to what extent, and in what form
—the details,
4283 in other words
—matter. To get a good sense of how this practice
4284 of turning the intangible into property emerged, we need to place this
4285 "property" in its proper context.
<footnote><para>
4287 As the legal realists taught American law, all property rights are
4288 intangible. A property right is simply a right that an individual has
4289 against the world to do or not do certain things that may or may not
4290 attach to a physical object. The right itself is intangible, even if
4291 the object to which it is (metaphorically) attached is tangible. See
4292 Adam Mossoff, "What Is Property? Putting the Pieces Back Together,"
4293 <citetitle>Arizona Law Review
</citetitle> 45 (
2003):
373,
429 n.
241.
4297 My strategy in doing this will be the same as my strategy in the
4298 preceding part. I offer four stories to help put the idea of
4299 "copyright material is property" in context. Where did the idea come
4300 from? What are its limits? How does it function in practice? After
4301 these stories, the significance of this true
4302 statement
—"copyright material is property"
— will be a bit
4303 more clear, and its implications will be revealed as quite different
4304 from the implications that the copyright warriors would have us draw.
4308 <!-- PAGE BREAK 96 -->
4309 <chapter id=
"founders">
4310 <title>CHAPTER SIX: Founders
</title>
4312 William Shakespeare wrote
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> in
1595. The play
4313 was first published in
1597. It was the eleventh major play that
4314 Shakespeare had written. He would continue to write plays through
4315 1613, and the plays that he wrote have continued to define
4316 Anglo-American culture ever since. So deeply have the works of a
4317 sixteenth-century writer seeped into our culture that we often don't
4318 even recognize their source. I once overheard someone commenting on
4319 Kenneth Branagh's adaptation of Henry V: "I liked it, but Shakespeare
4320 is so full of clichés."
4323 In
1774, almost
180 years after
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> was written, the
4324 "copy-right" for the work was still thought by many to be the exclusive
4325 right of a single London publisher, Jacob Tonson.
<footnote><para>
4327 Jacob Tonson is typically remembered for his associations with prominent
4328 eighteenth-century literary figures, especially John Dryden, and for his
4329 handsome "definitive editions" of classic works. In addition to
<citetitle>Romeo and
4330 Juliet
</citetitle>, he published an astonishing array of works that still remain at the
4331 heart of the English canon, including collected works of Shakespeare, Ben
4332 Jonson, John Milton, and John Dryden. See Keith Walker, "Jacob Tonson,
4333 Bookseller,"
<citetitle>American Scholar
</citetitle> 61:
3 (
1992):
424–31.
4335 Tonson was the most prominent of a small group of publishers called
4336 the Conger
<footnote><para>
4338 Lyman Ray Patterson,
<citetitle>Copyright in Historical Perspective
</citetitle> (Nashville:
4339 Vanderbilt University Press,
1968),
151–52.
4341 who controlled bookselling in England during the eighteenth
4342 century. The Conger claimed a perpetual right to control the "copy" of
4343 books that they had acquired from authors. That perpetual right meant
4345 <!-- PAGE BREAK 97 -->
4346 one else could publish copies of a book to which they held the
4347 copyright. Prices of the classics were thus kept high; competition to
4348 produce better or cheaper editions was eliminated.
4351 Now, there's something puzzling about the year
1774 to anyone who
4352 knows a little about copyright law. The better-known year in the
4353 history of copyright is
1710, the year that the British Parliament
4354 adopted the first "copyright" act. Known as the Statute of Anne, the
4355 act stated that all published works would get a copyright term of
4356 fourteen years, renewable once if the author was alive, and that all
4357 works already published by
1710 would get a single term of twenty-one
4358 additional years.
<footnote><para>
4360 As Siva Vaidhyanathan nicely argues, it is erroneous to call this a
4361 "copyright law." See Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
40.
4362 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
4363 </para></footnote> Under this law,
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> should have been
4364 free in
1731. So why was there any issue about it still being under
4365 Tonson's control in
1774?
4368 The reason is that the English hadn't yet agreed on what a "copyright"
4369 was
—indeed, no one had. At the time the English passed the
4370 Statute of Anne, there was no other legislation governing copyrights.
4371 The last law regulating publishers, the Licensing Act of
1662, had
4372 expired in
1695. That law gave publishers a monopoly over publishing,
4373 as a way to make it easier for the Crown to control what was
4374 published. But after it expired, there was no positive law that said
4375 that the publishers, or "Stationers," had an exclusive right to print
4377 <indexterm><primary>Licensing Act (
1662)
</primary></indexterm>
4380 There was no
<emphasis>positive
</emphasis> law, but that didn't mean
4381 that there was no law. The Anglo-American legal tradition looks to
4382 both the words of legislatures and the words of judges to know the
4383 rules that are to govern how people are to behave. We call the words
4384 from legislatures "positive law." We call the words from judges
4385 "common law." The common law sets the background against which
4386 legislatures legislate; the legislature, ordinarily, can trump that
4387 background only if it passes a law to displace it. And so the real
4388 question after the licensing statutes had expired was whether the
4389 common law protected a copyright, independent of any positive law.
4392 This question was important to the publishers, or "booksellers," as
4393 they were called, because there was growing competition from foreign
4394 publishers. The Scottish, in particular, were increasingly publishing
4395 and exporting books to England. That competition reduced the profits
4397 <!-- PAGE BREAK 98 -->
4398 of the Conger, which reacted by demanding that Parliament pass a law
4399 to again give them exclusive control over publishing. That demand
4401 resulted in the Statute of Anne.
4404 The Statute of Anne granted the author or "proprietor" of a book an
4405 exclusive right to print that book. In an important limitation,
4406 however, and to the horror of the booksellers, the law gave the
4407 bookseller that right for a limited term. At the end of that term, the
4408 copyright "expired," and the work would then be free and could be
4409 published by anyone. Or so the legislature is thought to have
4413 Now, the thing to puzzle about for a moment is this: Why would
4414 Parliament limit the exclusive right? Not why would they limit it to
4415 the particular limit they set, but why would they limit the right
4416 <emphasis>at all?
</emphasis>
4419 For the booksellers, and the authors whom they represented, had a very
4420 strong claim. Take
<citetitle>Romeo and Juliet
</citetitle> as an example: That play
4421 was written by Shakespeare. It was his genius that brought it into the
4422 world. He didn't take anybody's property when he created this play
4423 (that's a controversial claim, but never mind), and by his creating
4424 this play, he didn't make it any harder for others to craft a play. So
4425 why is it that the law would ever allow someone else to come along and
4426 take Shakespeare's play without his, or his estate's, permission? What
4427 reason is there to allow someone else to "steal" Shakespeare's work?
4430 The answer comes in two parts. We first need to see something special
4431 about the notion of "copyright" that existed at the time of the
4432 Statute of Anne. Second, we have to see something important about
4436 First, about copyright. In the last three hundred years, we have come
4437 to apply the concept of "copyright" ever more broadly. But in
1710, it
4438 wasn't so much a concept as it was a very particular right. The
4439 copyright was born as a very specific set of restrictions: It forbade
4440 others from reprinting a book. In
1710, the "copy-right" was a right
4441 to use a particular machine to replicate a particular work. It did not
4442 go beyond that very narrow right. It did not control any more
4444 <!-- PAGE BREAK 99 -->
4445 a work could be
<emphasis>used
</emphasis>. Today the right includes a
4446 large collection of restrictions on the freedom of others: It grants
4447 the author the exclusive right to copy, the exclusive right to
4448 distribute, the exclusive right to perform, and so on.
4451 So, for example, even if the copyright to Shakespeare's works were
4452 perpetual, all that would have meant under the original meaning of the
4453 term was that no one could reprint Shakespeare's work without the
4455 of the Shakespeare estate. It would not have controlled
4457 for example, about how the work could be performed, whether
4458 the work could be translated, or whether Kenneth Branagh would be
4459 allowed to make his films. The "copy-right" was only an exclusive right
4460 to print
—no less, of course, but also no more.
4463 Even that limited right was viewed with skepticism by the British.
4464 They had had a long and ugly experience with "exclusive rights,"
4466 "exclusive rights" granted by the Crown. The English had fought
4467 a civil war in part about the Crown's practice of handing out
4468 monopolies
—especially
4469 monopolies for works that already existed. King Henry
4470 VIII granted a patent to print the Bible and a monopoly to Darcy to
4471 print playing cards. The English Parliament began to fight back
4472 against this power of the Crown. In
1656, it passed the Statute of
4474 limiting monopolies to patents for new inventions. And by
4475 1710, Parliament was eager to deal with the growing monopoly in
4479 Thus the "copy-right," when viewed as a monopoly right, was
4481 viewed as a right that should be limited. (However convincing
4482 the claim that "it's my property, and I should have it forever," try
4483 sounding convincing when uttering, "It's my monopoly, and I should
4484 have it forever.") The state would protect the exclusive right, but only
4485 so long as it benefited society. The British saw the harms from
4487 favors; they passed a law to stop them.
4490 Second, about booksellers. It wasn't just that the copyright was a
4491 monopoly. It was also that it was a monopoly held by the booksellers.
4492 Booksellers sound quaint and harmless to us. They were not viewed
4493 as harmless in seventeenth-century England. Members of the Conger
4494 <!-- PAGE BREAK 100 -->
4496 were increasingly seen as monopolists of the worst
4497 kind
—tools of the Crown's repression, selling the liberty of
4498 England to guarantee themselves a monopoly profit. The attacks against
4499 these monopolists were harsh: Milton described them as "old patentees
4500 and monopolizers in the trade of book-selling"; they were "men who do
4501 not therefore labour in an honest profession to which learning is
4502 indetted."
<footnote><para>
4505 Philip Wittenberg,
<citetitle>The Protection and Marketing of Literary
4506 Property
</citetitle> (New York: J. Messner, Inc.,
1937),
31.
4510 Many believed the power the booksellers exercised over the spread of
4511 knowledge was harming that spread, just at the time the Enlightenment
4512 was teaching the importance of education and knowledge spread
4513 generally. The idea that knowledge should be free was a hallmark of
4514 the time, and these powerful commercial interests were interfering
4518 To balance this power, Parliament decided to increase competition
4519 among booksellers, and the simplest way to do that was to spread the
4520 wealth of valuable books. Parliament therefore limited the term of
4521 copyrights, and thereby guaranteed that valuable books would become
4522 open to any publisher to publish after a limited time. Thus the setting
4523 of the term for existing works to just twenty-one years was a
4525 to fight the power of the booksellers. The limitation on terms was
4526 an indirect way to assure competition among publishers, and thus the
4527 construction and spread of culture.
4530 When
1731 (
1710 +
21) came along, however, the booksellers were
4531 getting anxious. They saw the consequences of more competition, and
4532 like every competitor, they didn't like them. At first booksellers simply
4533 ignored the Statute of Anne, continuing to insist on the perpetual right
4534 to control publication. But in
1735 and
1737, they tried to persuade
4535 Parliament to extend their terms. Twenty-one years was not enough,
4536 they said; they needed more time.
4539 Parliament rejected their requests. As one pamphleteer put it, in
4540 words that echo today,
4544 I see no Reason for granting a further Term now, which will not
4545 hold as well for granting it again and again, as often as the Old
4546 <!-- PAGE BREAK 101 -->
4547 ones Expire; so that should this Bill pass, it will in Effect be
4548 establishing a perpetual Monopoly, a Thing deservedly odious in the
4549 Eye of the Law; it will be a great Cramp to Trade, a Discouragement to
4550 Learning, no Benefit to the Authors, but a general Tax on the Publick;
4551 and all this only to increase the private Gain of the
4552 Booksellers.
<footnote><para>
4554 A Letter to a Member of Parliament concerning the Bill now depending
4555 in the House of Commons, for making more effectual an Act in the
4556 Eighth Year of the Reign of Queen Anne, entitled, An Act for the
4557 Encouragement of Learning, by Vesting the Copies of Printed Books in
4558 the Authors or Purchasers of such Copies, during the Times therein
4559 mentioned (London,
1735), in Brief Amici Curiae of Tyler T. Ochoa et
4560 al.,
8,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618).
4565 Having failed in Parliament, the publishers turned to the courts in a
4566 series of cases. Their argument was simple and direct: The Statute of
4567 Anne gave authors certain protections through positive law, but those
4568 protections were not intended as replacements for the common law.
4569 Instead, they were intended simply to supplement the common law.
4570 Under common law, it was already wrong to take another person's
4571 creative "property" and use it without his permission. The Statute of
4572 Anne, the booksellers argued, didn't change that. Therefore, just
4573 because the protections of the Statute of Anne expired, that didn't
4574 mean the protections of the common law expired: Under the common law
4575 they had the right to ban the publication of a book, even if its
4576 Statute of Anne copyright had expired. This, they argued, was the only
4577 way to protect authors.
4580 This was a clever argument, and one that had the support of some of
4581 the leading jurists of the day. It also displayed extraordinary
4582 chutzpah. Until then, as law professor Raymond Patterson has put it,
4583 "The publishers . . . had as much concern for authors as a cattle
4584 rancher has for cattle."
<footnote><para>
4586 Lyman Ray Patterson, "Free Speech, Copyright, and Fair Use,"
<citetitle>Vanderbilt
4587 Law Review
</citetitle> 40 (
1987):
28. For a wonderfully compelling account, see
4588 Vaidhyanathan,
37–48.
4589 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
4591 The bookseller didn't care squat for the rights of the author. His
4592 concern was the monopoly profit that the author's work gave.
4595 The booksellers' argument was not accepted without a fight.
4596 The hero of this fight was a Scottish bookseller named Alexander
4597 Donaldson.
<footnote><para>
4599 For a compelling account, see David Saunders,
<citetitle>Authorship and Copyright
</citetitle>
4600 (London: Routledge,
1992),
62–69.
4604 Donaldson was an outsider to the London Conger. He began his
4605 career in Edinburgh in
1750. The focus of his business was inexpensive
4606 reprints "of standard works whose copyright term had expired," at least
4607 under the Statute of Anne.
<footnote><para>
4609 Mark Rose,
<citetitle>Authors and Owners
</citetitle> (Cambridge: Harvard University Press,
4612 Donaldson's publishing house prospered
4613 <!-- PAGE BREAK 102 -->
4614 and became "something of a center for literary Scotsmen." "[A]mong
4615 them," Professor Mark Rose writes, was "the young James Boswell
4616 who, together with his friend Andrew Erskine, published an anthology
4617 of contemporary Scottish poems with Donaldson."
<footnote><para>
4621 <indexterm><primary>Erskine, Andrew
</primary></indexterm>
4624 When the London booksellers tried to shut down Donaldson's shop in
4625 Scotland, he responded by moving his shop to London, where he sold
4626 inexpensive editions "of the most popular English books, in defiance
4627 of the supposed common law right of Literary
4628 Property."
<footnote><para>
4630 Lyman Ray Patterson,
<citetitle>Copyright in Historical Perspective
</citetitle>,
167 (quoting
4633 His books undercut the Conger prices by
30 to
50 percent, and he
4634 rested his right to compete upon the ground that, under the Statute of
4635 Anne, the works he was selling had passed out of protection.
4638 The London booksellers quickly brought suit to block "piracy" like
4639 Donaldson's. A number of actions were successful against the "pirates,"
4640 the most important early victory being
<citetitle>Millar
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Taylor
</citetitle>.
4643 Millar was a bookseller who in
1729 had purchased the rights to James
4644 Thomson's poem "The Seasons." Millar complied with the requirements of
4645 the Statute of Anne, and therefore received the full protection of the
4646 statute. After the term of copyright ended, Robert Taylor began
4647 printing a competing volume. Millar sued, claiming a perpetual common
4648 law right, the Statute of Anne notwithstanding.
<footnote><para>
4650 Howard B. Abrams, "The Historic Foundation of American Copyright Law:
4651 Exploding the Myth of Common Law Copyright,"
<citetitle>Wayne Law Review
</citetitle> 29
4655 <indexterm id=
"idxmansfield2" class='startofrange'
>
4656 <primary>Mansfield, William Murray, Lord
</primary>
4659 Astonishingly to modern lawyers, one of the greatest judges in English
4660 history, Lord Mansfield, agreed with the booksellers. Whatever
4661 protection the Statute of Anne gave booksellers, it did not, he held,
4662 extinguish any common law right. The question was whether the common
4663 law would protect the author against subsequent "pirates."
4664 Mansfield's answer was yes: The common law would bar Taylor from
4665 reprinting Thomson's poem without Millar's permission. That common law
4666 rule thus effectively gave the booksellers a perpetual right to
4667 control the publication of any book assigned to them.
4670 Considered as a matter of abstract justice
—reasoning as if
4671 justice were just a matter of logical deduction from first
4672 principles
—Mansfield's conclusion might make some sense. But
4673 what it ignored was the larger issue that Parliament had struggled
4674 with in
1710: How best to limit
4675 <!-- PAGE BREAK 103 -->
4676 the monopoly power of publishers? Parliament's strategy was to offer a
4677 term for existing works that was long enough to buy peace in
1710, but
4678 short enough to assure that culture would pass into competition within
4679 a reasonable period of time. Within twenty-one years, Parliament
4680 believed, Britain would mature from the controlled culture that the
4681 Crown coveted to the free culture that we inherited.
4683 <indexterm startref=
"idxmansfield2" class='endofrange'
/>
4685 The fight to defend the limits of the Statute of Anne was not to end
4686 there, however, and it is here that Donaldson enters the mix.
4688 <indexterm><primary>Beckett, Thomas
</primary></indexterm>
4690 Millar died soon after his victory, so his case was not appealed. His
4691 estate sold Thomson's poems to a syndicate of printers that included
4692 Thomas Beckett.
<footnote><para>
4696 Donaldson then released an unauthorized edition
4697 of Thomson's works. Beckett, on the strength of the decision in
<citetitle>Millar
</citetitle>,
4698 got an injunction against Donaldson. Donaldson appealed the case to
4699 the House of Lords, which functioned much like our own Supreme
4700 Court. In February of
1774, that body had the chance to interpret the
4701 meaning of Parliament's limits from sixty years before.
4704 As few legal cases ever do,
<citetitle>Donaldson
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Beckett
</citetitle> drew an
4705 enormous amount of attention throughout Britain. Donaldson's lawyers
4706 argued that whatever rights may have existed under the common law, the
4707 Statute of Anne terminated those rights. After passage of the Statute
4708 of Anne, the only legal protection for an exclusive right to control
4709 publication came from that statute. Thus, they argued, after the term
4710 specified in the Statute of Anne expired, works that had been
4711 protected by the statute were no longer protected.
4714 The House of Lords was an odd institution. Legal questions were
4715 presented to the House and voted upon first by the "law lords,"
4716 members of special legal distinction who functioned much like the
4717 Justices in our Supreme Court. Then, after the law lords voted, the
4718 House of Lords generally voted.
4721 The reports about the law lords' votes are mixed. On some counts,
4722 it looks as if perpetual copyright prevailed. But there is no ambiguity
4723 <!-- PAGE BREAK 104 -->
4724 about how the House of Lords voted as whole. By a two-to-one majority
4725 (
22 to
11) they voted to reject the idea of perpetual copyrights.
4726 Whatever one's understanding of the common law, now a copyright was
4727 fixed for a limited time, after which the work protected by copyright
4728 passed into the public domain.
4731 "The public domain." Before the case of
<citetitle>Donaldson
</citetitle>
4732 v.
<citetitle>Beckett
</citetitle>, there was no clear idea of a public domain in
4733 England. Before
1774, there was a strong argument that common law
4734 copyrights were perpetual. After
1774, the public domain was
4735 born. For the first time in Anglo-American history, the legal control
4736 over creative works expired, and the greatest works in English
4737 history
—including those of Shakespeare, Bacon, Milton, Johnson,
4738 and Bunyan
—were free of legal restraint.
4739 <indexterm><primary>Bacon, Francis
</primary></indexterm>
4740 <indexterm><primary>Bunyan, John
</primary></indexterm>
4741 <indexterm><primary>Johnson, Samuel
</primary></indexterm>
4742 <indexterm><primary>Milton, John
</primary></indexterm>
4743 <indexterm><primary>Shakespeare, William
</primary></indexterm>
4746 It is hard for us to imagine, but this decision by the House of Lords
4747 fueled an extraordinarily popular and political reaction. In Scotland,
4748 where most of the "pirate publishers" did their work, people
4749 celebrated the decision in the streets. As the
<citetitle>Edinburgh Advertiser
</citetitle>
4750 reported, "No private cause has so much engrossed the attention of the
4751 public, and none has been tried before the House of Lords in the
4752 decision of which so many individuals were interested." "Great
4753 rejoicing in Edinburgh upon victory over literary property: bonfires
4754 and illuminations."
<footnote><para>
4760 In London, however, at least among publishers, the reaction was
4761 equally strong in the opposite direction. The
<citetitle>Morning Chronicle
</citetitle>
4766 By the above decision . . . near
200,
000 pounds worth of what was
4767 honestly purchased at public sale, and which was yesterday thought
4768 property is now reduced to nothing. The Booksellers of London and
4769 Westminster, many of whom sold estates and houses to purchase
4770 Copy-right, are in a manner ruined, and those who after many years
4771 industry thought they had acquired a competency to provide for their
4772 families now find themselves without a shilling to devise to their
4773 successors.
<footnote><para>
4780 <!-- PAGE BREAK 105 -->
4781 "Ruined" is a bit of an exaggeration. But it is not an exaggeration to
4782 say that the change was profound. The decision of the House of Lords
4783 meant that the booksellers could no longer control how culture in
4784 England would grow and develop. Culture in England was thereafter
4785 <emphasis>free
</emphasis>. Not in the sense that copyrights would not
4786 be respected, for of course, for a limited time after a work was
4787 published, the bookseller had an exclusive right to control the
4788 publication of that book. And not in the sense that books could be
4789 stolen, for even after a copyright expired, you still had to buy the
4790 book from someone. But
<emphasis>free
</emphasis> in the sense that the
4791 culture and its growth would no longer be controlled by a small group
4792 of publishers. As every free market does, this free market of free
4793 culture would grow as the consumers and producers chose. English
4794 culture would develop as the many English readers chose to let it
4795 develop
— chose in the books they bought and wrote; chose in the
4796 memes they repeated and endorsed. Chose in a
<emphasis>competitive
4797 context
</emphasis>, not a context in which the choices about what
4798 culture is available to people and how they get access to it are made
4799 by the few despite the wishes of the many.
4802 At least, this was the rule in a world where the Parliament is
4803 antimonopoly, resistant to the protectionist pleas of publishers. In a
4804 world where the Parliament is more pliant, free culture would be less
4807 <!-- PAGE BREAK 106 -->
4809 <chapter id=
"recorders">
4810 <title>CHAPTER SEVEN: Recorders
</title>
4812 Jon Else is a filmmaker. He is best known for his documentaries and
4813 has been very successful in spreading his art. He is also a teacher, and
4814 as a teacher myself, I envy the loyalty and admiration that his students
4815 feel for him. (I met, by accident, two of his students at a dinner party.
4819 Else worked on a documentary that I was involved in. At a break,
4820 he told me a story about the freedom to create with film in America
4824 In
1990, Else was working on a documentary about Wagner's Ring
4825 Cycle. The focus was stagehands at the San Francisco Opera.
4826 Stagehands are a particularly funny and colorful element of an opera.
4827 During a show, they hang out below the stage in the grips' lounge and
4828 in the lighting loft. They make a perfect contrast to the art on the
4830 <indexterm><primary>San Francisco Opera
</primary></indexterm>
4833 During one of the performances, Else was shooting some stagehands
4834 playing checkers. In one corner of the room was a television set.
4835 Playing on the television set, while the stagehands played checkers
4836 and the opera company played Wagner, was
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>. As Else judged
4837 <!-- PAGE BREAK 107 -->
4838 it, this touch of cartoon helped capture the flavor of what was special
4842 Years later, when he finally got funding to complete the film, Else
4843 attempted to clear the rights for those few seconds of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>.
4844 For of course, those few seconds are copyrighted; and of course, to use
4845 copyrighted material you need the permission of the copyright owner,
4846 unless "fair use" or some other privilege applies.
4849 Else called
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> creator Matt Groening's office to get permission.
4850 Groening approved the shot. The shot was a four-and-a-halfsecond image
4851 on a tiny television set in the corner of the room. How could it hurt?
4852 Groening was happy to have it in the film, but he told Else to contact
4853 Gracie Films, the company that produces the program.
4854 <indexterm><primary>Gracie Films
</primary></indexterm>
4857 Gracie Films was okay with it, too, but they, like Groening, wanted
4858 to be careful. So they told Else to contact Fox, Gracie's parent company.
4859 Else called Fox and told them about the clip in the corner of the one
4860 room shot of the film. Matt Groening had already given permission,
4861 Else said. He was just confirming the permission with Fox.
4862 <indexterm><primary>Gracie Films
</primary></indexterm>
4865 Then, as Else told me, "two things happened. First we discovered
4866 . . . that Matt Groening doesn't own his own creation
—or at
4867 least that someone [at Fox] believes he doesn't own his own creation."
4868 And second, Fox "wanted ten thousand dollars as a licensing fee for us
4869 to use this four-point-five seconds of . . . entirely unsolicited
4870 <citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> which was in the corner of the shot."
4873 Else was certain there was a mistake. He worked his way up to someone
4874 he thought was a vice president for licensing, Rebecca Herrera. He
4875 explained to her, "There must be some mistake here. . . . We're
4876 asking for your educational rate on this." That was the educational
4877 rate, Herrera told Else. A day or so later, Else called again to
4878 confirm what he had been told.
4881 "I wanted to make sure I had my facts straight," he told me. "Yes, you
4882 have your facts straight," she said. It would cost $
10,
000 to use the
4883 clip of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle> in the corner of a shot in a documentary film
4886 <!-- PAGE BREAK 108 -->
4887 Wagner's Ring Cycle. And then, astonishingly, Herrera told Else, "And
4888 if you quote me, I'll turn you over to our attorneys." As an assistant
4889 to Herrera told Else later on, "They don't give a shit. They just want
4893 Else didn't have the money to buy the right to replay what was playing
4894 on the television backstage at the San Francisco Opera. To reproduce
4895 this reality was beyond the documentary filmmaker's budget. At the
4896 very last minute before the film was to be released, Else digitally
4897 replaced the shot with a clip from another film that he had worked on,
4898 <citetitle>The Day After Trinity
</citetitle>, from ten years before.
4899 <indexterm><primary>San Francisco Opera
</primary></indexterm>
4900 <indexterm><primary>Day After Trinity, The
</primary></indexterm>
4903 There's no doubt that someone, whether Matt Groening or Fox, owns the
4904 copyright to
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle>. That copyright is their property. To use
4905 that copyrighted material thus sometimes requires the permission of
4906 the copyright owner. If the use that Else wanted to make of the
4907 <citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> copyright were one of the uses restricted by the law, then he
4908 would need to get the permission of the copyright owner before he
4909 could use the work in that way. And in a free market, it is the owner
4910 of the copyright who gets to set the price for any use that the law
4911 says the owner gets to control.
4914 For example, "public performance" is a use of
<citetitle>The Simpsons
</citetitle> that the
4915 copyright owner gets to control. If you take a selection of favorite
4916 episodes, rent a movie theater, and charge for tickets to come see "My
4917 Favorite
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle>," then you need to get permission from the copyright
4918 owner. And the copyright owner (rightly, in my view) can charge
4919 whatever she wants
—$
10 or $
1,
000,
000. That's her right, as set
4923 But when lawyers hear this story about Jon Else and Fox, their first
4924 thought is "fair use."
<footnote><para>
4926 For an excellent argument that such use is "fair use," but that
4927 lawyers don't permit recognition that it is "fair use," see Richard
4928 A. Posner with William F. Patry, "Fair Use and Statutory Reform in the
4929 Wake of
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle>" (draft on file with author), University of Chicago
4930 Law School, 5 August 2003.
4932 Else's use of just 4.5 seconds of an indirect shot of a <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle>
4933 episode is clearly a fair use of <citetitle>The Simpsons</citetitle>—and fair use does
4934 not require the permission of anyone.
4937 <!-- PAGE BREAK 109 -->
4938 So I asked Else why he didn't just rely upon "fair use.
" Here's his reply:
4942 The <citetitle>Simpsons</citetitle> fiasco was for me a great lesson in the gulf between what
4943 lawyers find irrelevant in some abstract sense, and what is crushingly
4944 relevant in practice to those of us actually trying to make and
4945 broadcast documentaries. I never had any doubt that it was "clearly
4946 fair use" in an absolute legal sense. But I couldn't rely on the
4947 concept in any concrete way. Here's why:
4949 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
4952 Before our films can be broadcast, the network requires that we buy
4953 Errors and Omissions insurance. The carriers require a detailed
4954 "visual cue sheet" listing the source and licensing status of each
4955 shot in the film. They take a dim view of "fair use," and a claim of
4956 "fair use" can grind the application process to a halt.
4960 I probably never should have asked Matt Groening in the first
4961 place. But I knew (at least from folklore) that Fox had a history of
4962 tracking down and stopping unlicensed
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle> usage, just as George
4963 Lucas had a very high profile litigating
<citetitle>Star Wars
</citetitle> usage. So I decided
4964 to play by the book, thinking that we would be granted free or cheap
4965 license to four seconds of
<citetitle>Simpsons
</citetitle>. As a documentary producer working
4966 to exhaustion on a shoestring, the last thing I wanted was to risk
4967 legal trouble, even nuisance legal trouble, and even to defend a
4969 <indexterm><primary>Lucas, George
</primary></indexterm>
4973 I did, in fact, speak with one of your colleagues at Stanford Law
4974 School . . . who confirmed that it was fair use. He also confirmed
4975 that Fox would "depose and litigate you to within an inch of your
4976 life," regardless of the merits of my claim. He made clear that it
4977 would boil down to who had the bigger legal department and the deeper
4978 pockets, me or them.
4979 <!-- PAGE BREAK 110 -->
4983 The question of fair use usually comes up at the end of the
4984 project, when we are up against a release deadline and out of
4990 In theory, fair use means you need no permission. The theory therefore
4991 supports free culture and insulates against a permission culture. But
4992 in practice, fair use functions very differently. The fuzzy lines of
4993 the law, tied to the extraordinary liability if lines are crossed,
4994 means that the effective fair use for many types of creators is
4995 slight. The law has the right aim; practice has defeated the aim.
4998 This practice shows just how far the law has come from its
4999 eighteenth-century roots. The law was born as a shield to protect
5000 publishers' profits against the unfair competition of a pirate. It has
5001 matured into a sword that interferes with any use, transformative or
5004 <!-- PAGE BREAK 111 -->
5006 <chapter id=
"transformers">
5007 <title>CHAPTER EIGHT: Transformers
</title>
5008 <indexterm><primary>Allen, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
5009 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5011 In
1993, Alex Alben was a lawyer working at Starwave, Inc. Starwave
5012 was an innovative company founded by Microsoft cofounder Paul Allen to
5013 develop digital entertainment. Long before the Internet became
5014 popular, Starwave began investing in new technology for delivering
5015 entertainment in anticipation of the power of networks.
5017 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5019 Alben had a special interest in new technology. He was intrigued by
5020 the emerging market for CD-ROM technology
—not to distribute
5021 film, but to do things with film that otherwise would be very
5022 difficult. In
1993, he launched an initiative to develop a product to
5023 build retrospectives on the work of particular actors. The first actor
5024 chosen was Clint Eastwood. The idea was to showcase all of the work of
5025 Eastwood, with clips from his films and interviews with figures
5026 important to his career.
5028 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5030 At that time, Eastwood had made more than fifty films, as an actor and
5031 as a director. Alben began with a series of interviews with Eastwood,
5032 asking him about his career. Because Starwave produced those
5033 interviews, it was free to include them on the CD.
5036 <!-- PAGE BREAK 112 -->
5037 That alone would not have made a very interesting product, so
5038 Starwave wanted to add content from the movies in Eastwood's career:
5039 posters, scripts, and other material relating to the films Eastwood
5040 made. Most of his career was spent at Warner Brothers, and so it was
5041 relatively easy to get permission for that content.
5043 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5045 Then Alben and his team decided to include actual film clips. "Our
5046 goal was that we were going to have a clip from every one of
5047 Eastwood's films," Alben told me. It was here that the problem
5048 arose. "No one had ever really done this before," Alben explained. "No
5049 one had ever tried to do this in the context of an artistic look at an
5052 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5054 Alben brought the idea to Michael Slade, the CEO of Starwave.
5055 Slade asked, "Well, what will it take?"
5057 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5059 Alben replied, "Well, we're going to have to clear rights from
5060 everyone who appears in these films, and the music and everything
5061 else that we want to use in these film clips." Slade said, "Great! Go
5065 Technically, the rights that Alben had to clear were mainly those of
5066 publicity
—rights an artist has to control the commercial
5067 exploitation of his image. But these rights, too, burden "Rip, Mix,
5068 Burn" creativity, as this chapter evinces.
5070 <primary>artists
</primary>
5071 <secondary>publicity rights on images of
</secondary>
5076 The problem was that neither Alben nor Slade had any idea what
5077 clearing those rights would mean. Every actor in each of the films
5078 could have a claim to royalties for the reuse of that film. But CD-
5079 ROMs had not been specified in the contracts for the actors, so there
5080 was no clear way to know just what Starwave was to do.
5083 I asked Alben how he dealt with the problem. With an obvious
5084 pride in his resourcefulness that obscured the obvious bizarreness of his
5085 tale, Alben recounted just what they did:
5089 So we very mechanically went about looking up the film clips. We made
5090 some artistic decisions about what film clips to include
—of
5091 course we were going to use the "Make my day" clip from
<citetitle>Dirty
5092 Harry
</citetitle>. But you then need to get the guy on the ground who's wiggling
5093 under the gun and you need to get his permission. And then you have
5094 to decide what you are going to pay him.
5097 <!-- PAGE BREAK 113 -->
5098 We decided that it would be fair if we offered them the dayplayer rate
5099 for the right to reuse that performance. We're talking about a clip of
5100 less than a minute, but to reuse that performance in the CD-ROM the
5101 rate at the time was about $
600. So we had to identify the
5102 people
—some of them were hard to identify because in Eastwood
5103 movies you can't tell who's the guy crashing through the
5104 glass
—is it the actor or is it the stuntman? And then we just,
5105 we put together a team, my assistant and some others, and we just
5106 started calling people.
5109 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5111 Some actors were glad to help
—Donald Sutherland, for example,
5112 followed up himself to be sure that the rights had been cleared.
5113 Others were dumbfounded at their good fortune. Alben would ask,
5114 "Hey, can I pay you $
600 or maybe if you were in two films, you
5115 know, $
1,
200?" And they would say, "Are you for real? Hey, I'd love
5116 to get $
1,
200." And some of course were a bit difficult (estranged
5117 ex-wives, in particular). But eventually, Alben and his team had
5118 cleared the rights to this retrospective CD-ROM on Clint Eastwood's
5122 It was one
<emphasis>year
</emphasis> later
—"and even then we
5123 weren't sure whether we were totally in the clear."
5125 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5127 Alben is proud of his work. The project was the first of its kind and
5128 the only time he knew of that a team had undertaken such a massive
5129 project for the purpose of releasing a retrospective.
5133 Everyone thought it would be too hard. Everyone just threw up their
5134 hands and said, "Oh, my gosh, a film, it's so many copyrights, there's
5135 the music, there's the screenplay, there's the director, there's the
5136 actors." But we just broke it down. We just put it into its
5137 constituent parts and said, "Okay, there's this many actors, this many
5138 directors, . . . this many musicians," and we just went at it very
5139 systematically and cleared the rights.
5144 <!-- PAGE BREAK 114 -->
5145 And no doubt, the product itself was exceptionally good. Eastwood
5146 loved it, and it sold very well.
5148 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5149 <indexterm><primary>Drucker, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
5151 But I pressed Alben about how weird it seems that it would have to
5152 take a year's work simply to clear rights. No doubt Alben had done
5153 this efficiently, but as Peter Drucker has famously quipped, "There is
5154 nothing so useless as doing efficiently that which should not be done
5155 at all."
<footnote><para>
5157 U.S. Department of Commerce Office of Acquisition Management,
<citetitle>Seven
5158 Steps to Performance-Based Services Acquisition
</citetitle>, available at
5159 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
22</ulink>.
5161 Did it make sense, I asked Alben, that this is the way a new work
5165 For, as he acknowledged, "very few . . . have the time and resources,
5166 and the will to do this," and thus, very few such works would ever be
5167 made. Does it make sense, I asked him, from the standpoint of what
5168 anybody really thought they were ever giving rights for originally, that
5169 you would have to go clear rights for these kinds of clips?
5173 I don't think so. When an actor renders a performance in a movie,
5174 he or she gets paid very well. . . . And then when
30 seconds of
5175 that performance is used in a new product that is a retrospective
5176 of somebody's career, I don't think that that person . . . should be
5177 compensated for that.
5181 Or at least, is this
<emphasis>how
</emphasis> the artist should be
5182 compensated? Would it make sense, I asked, for there to be some kind
5183 of statutory license that someone could pay and be free to make
5184 derivative use of clips like this? Did it really make sense that a
5185 follow-on creator would have to track down every artist, actor,
5186 director, musician, and get explicit permission from each? Wouldn't a
5187 lot more be created if the legal part of the creative process could be
5188 made to be more clean?
5192 Absolutely. I think that if there were some fair-licensing
5193 mechanism
—where you weren't subject to hold-ups and you weren't
5194 subject to estranged former spouses
—you'd see a lot more of this
5195 work, because it wouldn't be so daunting to try to put together a
5196 <!-- PAGE BREAK 115 -->
5197 retrospective of someone's career and meaningfully illustrate it with
5198 lots of media from that person's career. You'd build in a cost as the
5199 producer of one of these things. You'd build in a cost of paying X
5200 dollars to the talent that performed. But it would be a known
5201 cost. That's the thing that trips everybody up and makes this kind of
5202 product hard to get off the ground. If you knew I have a hundred
5203 minutes of film in this product and it's going to cost me X, then you
5204 build your budget around it, and you can get investments and
5205 everything else that you need to produce it. But if you say, "Oh, I
5206 want a hundred minutes of something and I have no idea what it's going
5207 to cost me, and a certain number of people are going to hold me up for
5208 money," then it becomes difficult to put one of these things together.
5211 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
5213 Alben worked for a big company. His company was backed by some of the
5214 richest investors in the world. He therefore had authority and access
5215 that the average Web designer would not have. So if it took him a
5216 year, how long would it take someone else? And how much creativity is
5217 never made just because the costs of clearing the rights are so high?
5218 These costs are the burdens of a kind of regulation. Put on a
5219 Republican hat for a moment, and get angry for a bit. The government
5220 defines the scope of these rights, and the scope defined determines
5221 how much it's going to cost to negotiate them. (Remember the idea that
5222 land runs to the heavens, and imagine the pilot purchasing flythrough
5223 rights as he negotiates to fly from Los Angeles to San Francisco.)
5224 These rights might well have once made sense; but as circumstances
5225 change, they make no sense at all. Or at least, a well-trained,
5226 regulationminimizing Republican should look at the rights and ask,
5227 "Does this still make sense?"
5230 I've seen the flash of recognition when people get this point, but only
5231 a few times. The first was at a conference of federal judges in California.
5232 The judges were gathered to discuss the emerging topic of cyber-law. I
5233 was asked to be on the panel. Harvey Saferstein, a well-respected lawyer
5235 <!-- PAGE BREAK 116 -->
5236 from an L.A. firm, introduced the panel with a video that he and a
5237 friend, Robert Fairbank, had produced.
5240 The video was a brilliant collage of film from every period in the
5241 twentieth century, all framed around the idea of a
<citetitle>60 Minutes
</citetitle> episode.
5242 The execution was perfect, down to the sixty-minute stopwatch. The
5243 judges loved every minute of it.
5245 <indexterm><primary>Nimmer, David
</primary></indexterm>
5247 When the lights came up, I looked over to my copanelist, David
5248 Nimmer, perhaps the leading copyright scholar and practitioner in the
5249 nation. He had an astonished look on his face, as he peered across the
5250 room of over
250 well-entertained judges. Taking an ominous tone, he
5251 began his talk with a question: "Do you know how many federal laws
5252 were just violated in this room?"
5254 <indexterm><primary>Boies, David
</primary></indexterm>
5256 For of course, the two brilliantly talented creators who made this
5257 film hadn't done what Alben did. They hadn't spent a year clearing the
5258 rights to these clips; technically, what they had done violated the
5259 law. Of course, it wasn't as if they or anyone were going to be
5260 prosecuted for this violation (the presence of
250 judges and a gaggle
5261 of federal marshals notwithstanding). But Nimmer was making an
5262 important point: A year before anyone would have heard of the word
5263 Napster, and two years before another member of our panel, David
5264 Boies, would defend Napster before the Ninth Circuit Court of Appeals,
5265 Nimmer was trying to get the judges to see that the law would not be
5266 friendly to the capacities that this technology would
5267 enable. Technology means you can now do amazing things easily; but you
5268 couldn't easily do them legally.
5271 We live in a "cut and paste" culture enabled by technology. Anyone
5272 building a presentation knows the extraordinary freedom that the cut
5273 and paste architecture of the Internet created
—in a second you can
5274 find just about any image you want; in another second, you can have it
5275 planted in your presentation.
5278 But presentations are just a tiny beginning. Using the Internet and
5279 <!-- PAGE BREAK 117 -->
5280 its archives, musicians are able to string together mixes of sound
5281 never before imagined; filmmakers are able to build movies out of
5282 clips on computers around the world. An extraordinary site in Sweden
5283 takes images of politicians and blends them with music to create
5284 biting political commentary. A site called Camp Chaos has produced
5285 some of the most biting criticism of the record industry that there is
5286 through the mixing of Flash! and music.
5287 <indexterm><primary>Camp Chaos
</primary></indexterm>
5290 All of these creations are technically illegal. Even if the creators
5291 wanted to be "legal," the cost of complying with the law is impossibly
5292 high. Therefore, for the law-abiding sorts, a wealth of creativity is
5293 never made. And for that part that is made, if it doesn't follow the
5294 clearance rules, it doesn't get released.
5297 To some, these stories suggest a solution: Let's alter the mix of
5298 rights so that people are free to build upon our culture. Free to add
5299 or mix as they see fit. We could even make this change without
5300 necessarily requiring that the "free" use be free as in "free beer."
5301 Instead, the system could simply make it easy for follow-on creators
5302 to compensate artists without requiring an army of lawyers to come
5303 along: a rule, for example, that says "the royalty owed the copyright
5304 owner of an unregistered work for the derivative reuse of his work
5305 will be a flat
1 percent of net revenues, to be held in escrow for the
5306 copyright owner." Under this rule, the copyright owner could benefit
5307 from some royalty, but he would not have the benefit of a full
5308 property right (meaning the right to name his own price) unless he
5312 Who could possibly object to this? And what reason would there be
5313 for objecting? We're talking about work that is not now being made;
5314 which if made, under this plan, would produce new income for artists.
5315 What reason would anyone have to oppose it?
5318 In February
2003, DreamWorks studios announced an agreement with Mike
5319 Myers, the comic genius of
<citetitle>Saturday Night Live
</citetitle> and
5320 <!-- PAGE BREAK 118 -->
5321 Austin Powers. According to the announcement, Myers and Dream-Works
5322 would work together to form a "unique filmmaking pact." Under the
5323 agreement, DreamWorks "will acquire the rights to existing motion
5324 picture hits and classics, write new storylines and
—with the use
5325 of stateof-the-art digital technology
—insert Myers and other
5326 actors into the film, thereby creating an entirely new piece of
5330 The announcement called this "film sampling." As Myers explained,
5331 "Film Sampling is an exciting way to put an original spin on existing
5332 films and allow audiences to see old movies in a new light. Rap
5333 artists have been doing this for years with music and now we are able
5334 to take that same concept and apply it to film." Steven Spielberg is
5335 quoted as saying, "If anyone can create a way to bring old films to
5336 new audiences, it is Mike."
5339 Spielberg is right. Film sampling by Myers will be brilliant. But if
5340 you don't think about it, you might miss the truly astonishing point
5341 about this announcement. As the vast majority of our film heritage
5342 remains under copyright, the real meaning of the DreamWorks
5343 announcement is just this: It is Mike Myers and only Mike Myers who is
5344 free to sample. Any general freedom to build upon the film archive of
5345 our culture, a freedom in other contexts presumed for us all, is now a
5346 privilege reserved for the funny and famous
—and presumably rich.
5349 This privilege becomes reserved for two sorts of reasons. The first
5350 continues the story of the last chapter: the vagueness of "fair use."
5351 Much of "sampling" should be considered "fair use." But few would
5352 rely upon so weak a doctrine to create. That leads to the second reason
5353 that the privilege is reserved for the few: The costs of negotiating the
5354 legal rights for the creative reuse of content are astronomically high.
5355 These costs mirror the costs with fair use: You either pay a lawyer to
5356 defend your fair use rights or pay a lawyer to track down permissions
5357 so you don't have to rely upon fair use rights. Either way, the creative
5358 process is a process of paying lawyers
—again a privilege, or perhaps a
5359 curse, reserved for the few.
5361 <!-- PAGE BREAK 119 -->
5363 <chapter id=
"collectors">
5364 <title>CHAPTER NINE: Collectors
</title>
5366 In April
1996, millions of "bots"
—computer codes designed to
5367 "spider," or automatically search the Internet and copy content
—began
5368 running across the Net. Page by page, these bots copied Internet-based
5369 information onto a small set of computers located in a basement in San
5370 Francisco's Presidio. Once the bots finished the whole of the Internet,
5371 they started again. Over and over again, once every two months, these
5372 bits of code took copies of the Internet and stored them.
5375 By October
2001, the bots had collected more than five years of
5376 copies. And at a small announcement in Berkeley, California, the
5377 archive that these copies created, the Internet Archive, was opened to
5378 the world. Using a technology called "the Way Back Machine," you could
5379 enter a Web page, and see all of its copies going back to
1996, as
5380 well as when those pages changed.
5383 This is the thing about the Internet that Orwell would have
5384 appreciated. In the dystopia described in
<citetitle>1984</citetitle>, old newspapers were
5385 constantly updated to assure that the current view of the world,
5386 approved of by the government, was not contradicted by previous news
5390 <!-- PAGE BREAK 120 -->
5391 Thousands of workers constantly reedited the past, meaning there was
5392 no way ever to know whether the story you were reading today was the
5393 story that was printed on the date published on the paper.
5396 It's the same with the Internet. If you go to a Web page today,
5397 there's no way for you to know whether the content you are reading is
5398 the same as the content you read before. The page may seem the same,
5399 but the content could easily be different. The Internet is Orwell's
5400 library
—constantly updated, without any reliable memory.
5403 Until the Way Back Machine, at least. With the Way Back Machine, and
5404 the Internet Archive underlying it, you can see what the Internet
5405 was. You have the power to see what you remember. More importantly,
5406 perhaps, you also have the power to find what you don't remember and
5407 what others might prefer you forget.
<footnote><para>
5409 The temptations remain, however. Brewster Kahle reports that the White
5410 House changes its own press releases without notice. A May
13,
2003,
5411 press release stated, "Combat Operations in Iraq Have Ended." That was
5412 later changed, without notice, to "Major Combat Operations in Iraq
5413 Have Ended." E-mail from Brewster Kahle,
1 December
2003.
5417 We take it for granted that we can go back to see what we remember
5418 reading. Think about newspapers. If you wanted to study the reaction
5419 of your hometown newspaper to the race riots in Watts in
1965, or to
5420 Bull Connor's water cannon in
1963, you could go to your public
5421 library and look at the newspapers. Those papers probably exist on
5422 microfiche. If you're lucky, they exist in paper, too. Either way, you
5423 are free, using a library, to go back and remember
—not just what
5424 it is convenient to remember, but remember something close to the
5428 It is said that those who fail to remember history are doomed to
5429 repeat it. That's not quite correct. We
<emphasis>all
</emphasis>
5430 forget history. The key is whether we have a way to go back to
5431 rediscover what we forget. More directly, the key is whether an
5432 objective past can keep us honest. Libraries help do that, by
5433 collecting content and keeping it, for schoolchildren, for
5434 researchers, for grandma. A free society presumes this knowedge.
5437 The Internet was an exception to this presumption. Until the Internet
5438 Archive, there was no way to go back. The Internet was the
5439 quintessentially transitory medium. And yet, as it becomes more
5440 important in forming and reforming society, it becomes more and more
5441 <!-- PAGE BREAK 121 -->
5442 important to maintain in some historical form. It's just bizarre to
5443 think that we have scads of archives of newspapers from tiny towns
5444 around the world, yet there is but one copy of the Internet
—the
5445 one kept by the Internet Archive.
5448 Brewster Kahle is the founder of the Internet Archive. He was a very
5449 successful Internet entrepreneur after he was a successful computer
5450 researcher. In the
1990s, Kahle decided he had had enough business
5451 success. It was time to become a different kind of success. So he
5452 launched a series of projects designed to archive human knowledge. The
5453 Internet Archive was just the first of the projects of this Andrew
5454 Carnegie of the Internet. By December of
2002, the archive had over
10
5455 billion pages, and it was growing at about a billion pages a month.
5458 The Way Back Machine is the largest archive of human knowledge in
5459 human history. At the end of
2002, it held "two hundred and thirty
5460 terabytes of material"
—and was "ten times larger than the
5461 Library of Congress." And this was just the first of the archives that
5462 Kahle set out to build. In addition to the Internet Archive, Kahle has
5463 been constructing the Television Archive. Television, it turns out, is
5464 even more ephemeral than the Internet. While much of twentieth-century
5465 culture was constructed through television, only a tiny proportion of
5466 that culture is available for anyone to see today. Three hours of news
5467 are recorded each evening by Vanderbilt University
—thanks to a
5468 specific exemption in the copyright law. That content is indexed, and
5469 is available to scholars for a very low fee. "But other than that,
5470 [television] is almost unavailable," Kahle told me. "If you were
5471 Barbara Walters you could get access to [the archives], but if you are
5472 just a graduate student?" As Kahle put it,
5476 Do you remember when Dan Quayle was interacting with Murphy Brown?
5477 Remember that back and forth surreal experience of a politician
5478 interacting with a fictional television character? If you were a
5479 graduate student wanting to study that, and you wanted to get those
5480 original back and forth exchanges between the two, the
5482 <!-- PAGE BREAK 122 -->
5483 <citetitle>60 Minutes
</citetitle> episode that came out after it . . . it would be almost
5484 impossible. . . . Those materials are almost unfindable. . . .
5488 Why is that? Why is it that the part of our culture that is recorded
5489 in newspapers remains perpetually accessible, while the part that is
5490 recorded on videotape is not? How is it that we've created a world
5491 where researchers trying to understand the effect of media on
5492 nineteenthcentury America will have an easier time than researchers
5493 trying to understand the effect of media on twentieth-century America?
5496 In part, this is because of the law. Early in American copyright law,
5497 copyright owners were required to deposit copies of their work in
5498 libraries. These copies were intended both to facilitate the spread
5499 of knowledge and to assure that a copy of the work would be around
5500 once the copyright expired, so that others might access and copy the
5504 These rules applied to film as well. But in
1915, the Library
5505 of Congress made an exception for film. Film could be copyrighted so
5506 long as such deposits were made. But the filmmaker was then allowed to
5507 borrow back the deposits
—for an unlimited time at no cost. In
5508 1915 alone, there were more than
5,
475 films deposited and "borrowed
5509 back." Thus, when the copyrights to films expire, there is no copy
5510 held by any library. The copy exists
—if it exists at
5511 all
—in the library archive of the film company.
<footnote><para>
5513 Doug Herrick, "Toward a National Film Collection: Motion Pictures at
5514 the Library of Congress,"
<citetitle>Film Library Quarterly
</citetitle> 13 nos.
2–3
5515 (
1980):
5; Anthony Slide,
<citetitle>Nitrate Won't Wait: A History of Film
5516 Preservation in the United States
</citetitle> ( Jefferson, N.C.: McFarland
&
5521 The same is generally true about television. Television broadcasts
5522 were originally not copyrighted
—there was no way to capture the
5523 broadcasts, so there was no fear of "theft." But as technology enabled
5524 capturing, broadcasters relied increasingly upon the law. The law
5525 required they make a copy of each broadcast for the work to be
5526 "copyrighted." But those copies were simply kept by the
5527 broadcasters. No library had any right to them; the government didn't
5528 demand them. The content of this part of American culture is
5529 practically invisible to anyone who would look.
5532 Kahle was eager to correct this. Before September
11,
2001, he and
5533 <!-- PAGE BREAK 123 -->
5534 his allies had started capturing television. They selected twenty
5535 stations from around the world and hit the Record button. After
5536 September
11, Kahle, working with dozens of others, selected twenty
5537 stations from around the world and, beginning October
11,
2001, made
5538 their coverage during the week of September
11 available free on-line.
5539 Anyone could see how news reports from around the world covered the
5543 Kahle had the same idea with film. Working with Rick Prelinger, whose
5544 archive of film includes close to
45,
000 "ephemeral films" (meaning
5545 films other than Hollywood movies, films that were never copyrighted),
5546 Kahle established the Movie Archive. Prelinger let Kahle digitize
5547 1,
300 films in this archive and post those films on the Internet to be
5548 downloaded for free. Prelinger's is a for-profit company. It sells
5549 copies of these films as stock footage. What he has discovered is that
5550 after he made a significant chunk available for free, his stock
5551 footage sales went up dramatically. People could easily find the
5552 material they wanted to use. Some downloaded that material and made
5553 films on their own. Others purchased copies to enable other films to
5554 be made. Either way, the archive enabled access to this important
5555 part of our culture. Want to see a copy of the "Duck and Cover" film
5556 that instructed children how to save themselves in the middle of
5557 nuclear attack? Go to archive.org, and you can download the film in a
5558 few minutes
—for free.
5559 <indexterm><primary>Movie Archive
</primary></indexterm>
5562 Here again, Kahle is providing access to a part of our culture that we
5563 otherwise could not get easily, if at all. It is yet another part of
5564 what defines the twentieth century that we have lost to history. The
5565 law doesn't require these copies to be kept by anyone, or to be
5566 deposited in an archive by anyone. Therefore, there is no simple way
5570 The key here is access, not price. Kahle wants to enable free access
5571 to this content, but he also wants to enable others to sell access to
5572 it. His aim is to ensure competition in access to this important part
5573 of our culture. Not during the commercial life of a bit of creative
5574 property, but during a second life that all creative property
5575 has
—a noncommercial life.
5578 For here is an idea that we should more clearly recognize. Every bit
5579 of creative property goes through different "lives." In its first
5582 <!-- PAGE BREAK 124 -->
5583 creator is lucky, the content is sold. In such cases the commercial
5584 market is successful for the creator. The vast majority of creative
5585 property doesn't enjoy such success, but some clearly does. For that
5586 content, commercial life is extremely important. Without this
5587 commercial market, there would be, many argue, much less creativity.
5590 After the commercial life of creative property has ended, our
5591 tradition has always supported a second life as well. A newspaper
5592 delivers the news every day to the doorsteps of America. The very next
5593 day, it is used to wrap fish or to fill boxes with fragile gifts or to
5594 build an archive of knowledge about our history. In this second life,
5595 the content can continue to inform even if that information is no
5599 The same has always been true about books. A book goes out of print
5600 very quickly (the average today is after about a year
<footnote><para>
5602 Dave Barns, "Fledgling Career in Antique Books: Woodstock Landlord,
5603 Bar Owner Starts a New Chapter by Adopting Business,"
<citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
5604 5 September
1997, at Metro Lake
1L. Of books published between
1927
5605 and
1946, only
2.2 percent were in print in
2002. R. Anthony Reese,
5606 "The First Sale Doctrine in the Era of Digital Networks,"
<citetitle>Boston
5607 College Law Review
</citetitle> 44 (
2003):
593 n.
51.
5608 </para></footnote>). After
5609 it is out of print, it can be sold in used book stores without the
5610 copyright owner getting anything and stored in libraries, where many
5611 get to read the book, also for free. Used book stores and libraries
5612 are thus the second life of a book. That second life is extremely
5613 important to the spread and stability of culture.
5616 Yet increasingly, any assumption about a stable second life for
5617 creative property does not hold true with the most important
5618 components of popular culture in the twentieth and twenty-first
5619 centuries. For these
—television, movies, music, radio, the
5620 Internet
—there is no guarantee of a second life. For these sorts
5621 of culture, it is as if we've replaced libraries with Barnes
&
5622 Noble superstores. With this culture, what's accessible is nothing but
5623 what a certain limited market demands. Beyond that, culture
5627 For most of the twentieth century, it was economics that made this
5628 so. It would have been insanely expensive to collect and make
5629 accessible all television and film and music: The cost of analog
5630 copies is extraordinarily high. So even though the law in principle
5631 would have restricted the ability of a Brewster Kahle to copy culture
5633 <!-- PAGE BREAK 125 -->
5634 real restriction was economics. The market made it impossibly
5635 difficult to do anything about this ephemeral culture; the law had
5636 little practical effect.
5639 Perhaps the single most important feature of the digital revolution is
5640 that for the first time since the Library of Alexandria, it is
5641 feasible to imagine constructing archives that hold all culture
5642 produced or distributed publicly. Technology makes it possible to
5643 imagine an archive of all books published, and increasingly makes it
5644 possible to imagine an archive of all moving images and sound.
5647 The scale of this potential archive is something we've never imagined
5648 before. The Brewster Kahles of our history have dreamed about it; but
5649 we are for the first time at a point where that dream is possible. As
5654 It looks like there's about two to three million recordings of music.
5655 Ever. There are about a hundred thousand theatrical releases of
5656 movies, . . . and about one to two million movies [distributed] during
5657 the twentieth century. There are about twenty-six million different
5658 titles of books. All of these would fit on computers that would fit in
5659 this room and be able to be afforded by a small company. So we're at
5660 a turning point in our history. Universal access is the goal. And the
5661 opportunity of leading a different life, based on this, is
5662 . . . thrilling. It could be one of the things humankind would be most
5663 proud of. Up there with the Library of Alexandria, putting a man on
5664 the moon, and the invention of the printing press.
5668 Kahle is not the only librarian. The Internet Archive is not the only
5669 archive. But Kahle and the Internet Archive suggest what the future of
5670 libraries or archives could be.
<emphasis>When
</emphasis> the
5671 commercial life of creative property ends, I don't know. But it
5672 does. And whenever it does, Kahle and his archive hint at a world
5673 where this knowledge, and culture, remains perpetually available. Some
5674 will draw upon it to understand it;
5675 <!-- PAGE BREAK 126 -->
5676 some to criticize it. Some will use it, as Walt Disney did, to
5677 re-create the past for the future. These technologies promise
5678 something that had become unimaginable for much of our past
—a
5679 future
<emphasis>for
</emphasis> our past. The technology of digital
5680 arts could make the dream of the Library of Alexandria real again.
5683 Technologists have thus removed the economic costs of building such an
5684 archive. But lawyers' costs remain. For as much as we might like to
5685 call these "archives," as warm as the idea of a "library" might seem,
5686 the "content" that is collected in these digital spaces is also
5687 someone's "property." And the law of property restricts the freedoms
5688 that Kahle and others would exercise.
5690 <!-- PAGE BREAK 127 -->
5692 <chapter id=
"property-i">
5693 <title>CHAPTER TEN: "Property"
</title>
5695 Jack Valenti has been the president of the Motion Picture Association
5696 of America since
1966. He first came to Washington, D.C., with Lyndon
5697 Johnson's administration
—literally. The famous picture of
5698 Johnson's swearing-in on Air Force One after the assassination of
5699 President Kennedy has Valenti in the background. In his almost forty
5700 years of running the MPAA, Valenti has established himself as perhaps
5701 the most prominent and effective lobbyist in Washington.
5702 <indexterm><primary>Johnson, Lyndon
</primary></indexterm>
5705 The MPAA is the American branch of the international Motion Picture
5706 Association. It was formed in
1922 as a trade association whose goal
5707 was to defend American movies against increasing domestic criticism.
5708 The organization now represents not only filmmakers but producers and
5709 distributors of entertainment for television, video, and cable. Its
5710 board is made up of the chairmen and presidents of the seven major
5711 producers and distributors of motion picture and television programs
5712 in the United States: Walt Disney, Sony Pictures Entertainment, MGM,
5713 Paramount Pictures, Twentieth Century Fox, Universal Studios, and
5715 <indexterm><primary>Disney, Inc.
</primary></indexterm>
5716 <indexterm><primary>Sony Pictures Entertainment
</primary></indexterm>
5717 <indexterm><primary>MGM
</primary></indexterm>
5718 <indexterm><primary>Paramount Pictures
</primary></indexterm>
5719 <indexterm><primary>Twentieth Century Fox
</primary></indexterm>
5720 <indexterm><primary>Universal Pictures
</primary></indexterm>
5721 <indexterm><primary>Warner Brothers
</primary></indexterm>
5724 <!-- PAGE BREAK 128 -->
5725 Valenti is only the third president of the MPAA. No president before
5726 him has had as much influence over that organization, or over
5727 Washington. As a Texan, Valenti has mastered the single most important
5728 political skill of a Southerner
—the ability to appear simple and
5729 slow while hiding a lightning-fast intellect. To this day, Valenti
5730 plays the simple, humble man. But this Harvard MBA, and author of four
5731 books, who finished high school at the age of fifteen and flew more
5732 than fifty combat missions in World War II, is no Mr. Smith. When
5733 Valenti went to Washington, he mastered the city in a quintessentially
5737 In defending artistic liberty and the freedom of speech that our
5738 culture depends upon, the MPAA has done important good. In crafting
5739 the MPAA rating system, it has probably avoided a great deal of
5740 speech-regulating harm. But there is an aspect to the organization's
5741 mission that is both the most radical and the most important. This is
5742 the organization's effort, epitomized in Valenti's every act, to
5743 redefine the meaning of "creative property."
5746 In
1982, Valenti's testimony to Congress captured the strategy
5751 No matter the lengthy arguments made, no matter the charges and the
5752 counter-charges, no matter the tumult and the shouting, reasonable men
5753 and women will keep returning to the fundamental issue, the central
5754 theme which animates this entire debate:
<emphasis>Creative property
5755 owners must be accorded the same rights and protection resident in all
5756 other property owners in the nation
</emphasis>. That is the issue.
5757 That is the question. And that is the rostrum on which this entire
5758 hearing and the debates to follow must rest.
<footnote><para>
5760 Home Recording of Copyrighted Works: Hearings on H.R.
4783, H.R.
5761 4794, H.R.
4808, H.R.
5250, H.R.
5488, and H.R.
5705 Before the
5762 Subcommittee on Courts, Civil Liberties, and the Administration of
5763 Justice of the Committee on the Judiciary of the House of
5764 Representatives,
97th Cong.,
2nd sess. (
1982):
65 (testimony of Jack
5770 The strategy of this rhetoric, like the strategy of most of Valenti's
5771 rhetoric, is brilliant and simple and brilliant because simple. The
5772 "central theme" to which "reasonable men and women" will return is
5774 <!-- PAGE BREAK 129 -->
5775 "Creative property owners must be accorded the same rights and
5776 protections resident in all other property owners in the nation."
5777 There are no second-class citizens, Valenti might have
5778 continued. There should be no second-class property owners.
5781 This claim has an obvious and powerful intuitive pull. It is stated
5782 with such clarity as to make the idea as obvious as the notion that we
5783 use elections to pick presidents. But in fact, there is no more
5784 extreme a claim made by
<emphasis>anyone
</emphasis> who is serious in
5785 this debate than this claim of Valenti's. Jack Valenti, however sweet
5786 and however brilliant, is perhaps the nation's foremost extremist when
5787 it comes to the nature and scope of "creative property." His views
5788 have
<emphasis>no
</emphasis> reasonable connection to our actual legal
5789 tradition, even if the subtle pull of his Texan charm has slowly
5790 redefined that tradition, at least in Washington.
5793 While "creative property" is certainly "property" in a nerdy and
5794 precise sense that lawyers are trained to understand,
<footnote><para>
5796 Lawyers speak of "property" not as an absolute thing, but as a bundle
5797 of rights that are sometimes associated with a particular
5798 object. Thus, my "property right" to my car gives me the right to
5799 exclusive use, but not the right to drive at
150 miles an hour. For
5800 the best effort to connect the ordinary meaning of "property" to
5801 "lawyer talk," see Bruce Ackerman,
<citetitle>Private Property and the
5802 Constitution
</citetitle> (New Haven: Yale University Press,
1977),
26–27.
5803 </para></footnote> it has never been the case, nor should it be, that
5804 "creative property owners" have been "accorded the same rights and
5805 protection resident in all other property owners." Indeed, if creative
5806 property owners were given the same rights as all other property
5807 owners, that would effect a radical, and radically undesirable, change
5811 Valenti knows this. But he speaks for an industry that cares squat for
5812 our tradition and the values it represents. He speaks for an industry
5813 that is instead fighting to restore the tradition that the British
5814 overturned in
1710. In the world that Valenti's changes would create,
5815 a powerful few would exercise powerful control over how our creative
5816 culture would develop.
5819 I have two purposes in this chapter. The first is to convince you
5820 that, historically, Valenti's claim is absolutely wrong. The second is
5821 to convince you that it would be terribly wrong for us to reject our
5822 history. We have always treated rights in creative property
5823 differently from the rights resident in all other property
5824 owners. They have never been the same. And they should never be the
5825 same, because, however counterintuitive this may seem, to make them
5826 the same would be to
5828 <!-- PAGE BREAK 130 -->
5829 fundamentally weaken the opportunity for new creators to create.
5830 Creativity depends upon the owners of creativity having less than
5834 Organizations such as the MPAA, whose board includes the most powerful
5835 of the old guard, have little interest, their rhetoric
5836 notwithstanding, in assuring that the new can displace them. No
5837 organization does. No person does. (Ask me about tenure, for example.)
5838 But what's good for the MPAA is not necessarily good for America. A
5839 society that defends the ideals of free culture must preserve
5840 precisely the opportunity for new creativity to threaten the old. To
5841 get just a hint that there is something fundamentally wrong in
5842 Valenti's argument, we need look no further than the United States
5843 Constitution itself.
5846 The framers of our Constitution loved "property." Indeed, so strongly
5847 did they love property that they built into the Constitution an
5848 important requirement. If the government takes your property
—if
5849 it condemns your house, or acquires a slice of land from your
5850 farm
—it is required, under the Fifth Amendment's "Takings
5851 Clause," to pay you "just compensation" for that taking. The
5852 Constitution thus guarantees that property is, in a certain sense,
5853 sacred. It cannot
<emphasis>ever
</emphasis> be taken from the property
5854 owner unless the government pays for the privilege.
5857 Yet the very same Constitution speaks very differently about what
5858 Valenti calls "creative property." In the clause granting Congress the
5859 power to create "creative property," the Constitution
5860 <emphasis>requires
</emphasis> that after a "limited time," Congress
5861 take back the rights that it has granted and set the "creative
5862 property" free to the public domain. Yet when Congress does this, when
5863 the expiration of a copyright term "takes" your copyright and turns it
5864 over to the public domain, Congress does not have any obligation to
5865 pay "just compensation" for this "taking." Instead, the same
5866 Constitution that requires compensation for your land
5867 <!-- PAGE BREAK 131 -->
5868 requires that you lose your "creative property" right without any
5869 compensation at all.
5872 The Constitution thus on its face states that these two forms of
5873 property are not to be accorded the same rights. They are plainly to
5874 be treated differently. Valenti is therefore not just asking for a
5875 change in our tradition when he argues that creative-property owners
5876 should be accorded the same rights as every other property-right
5877 owner. He is effectively arguing for a change in our Constitution
5881 Arguing for a change in our Constitution is not necessarily wrong.
5882 There was much in our original Constitution that was plainly wrong.
5883 The Constitution of
1789 entrenched slavery; it left senators to be
5884 appointed rather than elected; it made it possible for the electoral
5885 college to produce a tie between the president and his own vice
5886 president (as it did in
1800). The framers were no doubt
5887 extraordinary, but I would be the first to admit that they made big
5888 mistakes. We have since rejected some of those mistakes; no doubt
5889 there could be others that we should reject as well. So my argument is
5890 not simply that because Jefferson did it, we should, too.
5893 Instead, my argument is that because Jefferson did it, we should at
5894 least try to understand
<emphasis>why
</emphasis>. Why did the framers,
5895 fanatical property types that they were, reject the claim that
5896 creative property be given the same rights as all other property? Why
5897 did they require that for creative property there must be a public
5901 To answer this question, we need to get some perspective on the
5902 history of these "creative property" rights, and the control that they
5903 enabled. Once we see clearly how differently these rights have been
5904 defined, we will be in a better position to ask the question that
5905 should be at the core of this war: Not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis>
5906 creative property should be protected, but how. Not
5907 <emphasis>whether
</emphasis> we will enforce the rights the law gives
5908 to creative-property owners, but what the particular mix of rights
5909 ought to be. Not
<emphasis>whether
</emphasis> artists should be paid,
5910 but whether institutions designed to assure that artists get paid need
5911 also control how culture develops.
5915 <!-- PAGE BREAK 132 -->
5916 To answer these questions, we need a more general way to talk about
5917 how property is protected. More precisely, we need a more general way
5918 than the narrow language of the law allows. In
<citetitle>Code and Other Laws of
5919 Cyberspace
</citetitle>, I used a simple model to capture this more general
5920 perspective. For any particular right or regulation, this model asks
5921 how four different modalities of regulation interact to support or
5922 weaken the right or regulation. I represented it with this diagram:
5924 <figure id=
"fig-1331">
5925 <title>How four different modalities of regulation interact to support or weaken the right or regulation.
</title>
5926 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
5929 At the center of this picture is a regulated dot: the individual or
5930 group that is the target of regulation, or the holder of a right. (In
5931 each case throughout, we can describe this either as regulation or as
5932 a right. For simplicity's sake, I will speak only of regulations.)
5933 The ovals represent four ways in which the individual or group might
5934 be regulated
— either constrained or, alternatively, enabled. Law
5935 is the most obvious constraint (to lawyers, at least). It constrains
5936 by threatening punishments after the fact if the rules set in advance
5937 are violated. So if, for example, you willfully infringe Madonna's
5938 copyright by copying a song from her latest CD and posting it on the
5939 Web, you can be punished
5940 <!-- PAGE BREAK 133 -->
5941 with a $
150,
000 fine. The fine is an ex post punishment for violating
5942 an ex ante rule. It is imposed by the state.
5943 <indexterm><primary>Madonna
</primary></indexterm>
5946 Norms are a different kind of constraint. They, too, punish an
5947 individual for violating a rule. But the punishment of a norm is
5948 imposed by a community, not (or not only) by the state. There may be
5949 no law against spitting, but that doesn't mean you won't be punished
5950 if you spit on the ground while standing in line at a movie. The
5951 punishment might not be harsh, though depending upon the community, it
5952 could easily be more harsh than many of the punishments imposed by the
5953 state. The mark of the difference is not the severity of the rule, but
5954 the source of the enforcement.
5957 The market is a third type of constraint. Its constraint is effected
5958 through conditions: You can do X if you pay Y; you'll be paid M if you
5959 do N. These constraints are obviously not independent of law or
5960 norms
—it is property law that defines what must be bought if it
5961 is to be taken legally; it is norms that say what is appropriately
5962 sold. But given a set of norms, and a background of property and
5963 contract law, the market imposes a simultaneous constraint upon how an
5964 individual or group might behave.
5967 Finally, and for the moment, perhaps, most mysteriously,
5968 "architecture"
—the physical world as one finds it
—is a
5969 constraint on behavior. A fallen bridge might constrain your ability
5970 to get across a river. Railroad tracks might constrain the ability of
5971 a community to integrate its social life. As with the market,
5972 architecture does not effect its constraint through ex post
5973 punishments. Instead, also as with the market, architecture effects
5974 its constraint through simultaneous conditions. These conditions are
5975 imposed not by courts enforcing contracts, or by police punishing
5976 theft, but by nature, by "architecture." If a
500-pound boulder
5977 blocks your way, it is the law of gravity that enforces this
5978 constraint. If a $
500 airplane ticket stands between you and a flight
5979 to New York, it is the market that enforces this constraint.
5983 <!-- PAGE BREAK 134 -->
5984 So the first point about these four modalities of regulation is
5985 obvious: They interact. Restrictions imposed by one might be
5986 reinforced by another. Or restrictions imposed by one might be
5987 undermined by another.
5990 The second point follows directly: If we want to understand the
5991 effective freedom that anyone has at a given moment to do any
5992 particular thing, we have to consider how these four modalities
5993 interact. Whether or not there are other constraints (there may well
5994 be; my claim is not about comprehensiveness), these four are among the
5995 most significant, and any regulator (whether controlling or freeing)
5996 must consider how these four in particular interact.
5998 <indexterm id=
"idxdrivespeed" class='startofrange'
>
5999 <primary>driving speed, constraints on
</primary>
6002 So, for example, consider the "freedom" to drive a car at a high
6003 speed. That freedom is in part restricted by laws: speed limits that
6004 say how fast you can drive in particular places at particular
6005 times. It is in part restricted by architecture: speed bumps, for
6006 example, slow most rational drivers; governors in buses, as another
6007 example, set the maximum rate at which the driver can drive. The
6008 freedom is in part restricted by the market: Fuel efficiency drops as
6009 speed increases, thus the price of gasoline indirectly constrains
6010 speed. And finally, the norms of a community may or may not constrain
6011 the freedom to speed. Drive at
50 mph by a school in your own
6012 neighborhood and you're likely to be punished by the neighbors. The
6013 same norm wouldn't be as effective in a different town, or at night.
6016 The final point about this simple model should also be fairly clear:
6017 While these four modalities are analytically independent, law has a
6018 special role in affecting the three.
<footnote><para>
6020 By describing the way law affects the other three modalities, I don't
6021 mean to suggest that the other three don't affect law. Obviously, they
6022 do. Law's only distinction is that it alone speaks as if it has a
6023 right self-consciously to change the other three. The right of the
6024 other three is more timidly expressed. See Lawrence Lessig,
<citetitle>Code: And
6025 Other Laws of Cyberspace
</citetitle> (New York: Basic Books,
1999):
90–95;
6026 Lawrence Lessig, "The New Chicago School,"
<citetitle>Journal of Legal Studies
</citetitle>,
6029 The law, in other words, sometimes operates to increase or decrease
6030 the constraint of a particular modality. Thus, the law might be used
6031 to increase taxes on gasoline, so as to increase the incentives to
6032 drive more slowly. The law might be used to mandate more speed bumps,
6033 so as to increase the difficulty of driving rapidly. The law might be
6034 used to fund ads that stigmatize reckless driving. Or the law might be
6035 used to require that other laws be more
6036 <!-- PAGE BREAK 135 -->
6037 strict
—a federal requirement that states decrease the speed
6038 limit, for example
—so as to decrease the attractiveness of fast
6041 <indexterm startref=
"idxdrivespeed" class='endofrange'
/>
6043 <figure id=
"fig-1361">
6044 <title>Law has a special role in affecting the three.
</title>
6045 <graphic fileref=
"images/1361.png"></graphic>
6048 These constraints can thus change, and they can be changed. To
6049 understand the effective protection of liberty or protection of
6050 property at any particular moment, we must track these changes over
6051 time. A restriction imposed by one modality might be erased by
6052 another. A freedom enabled by one modality might be displaced by
6056 Some people object to this way of talking about "liberty." They object
6057 because their focus when considering the constraints that exist at any
6058 particular moment are constraints imposed exclusively by the
6059 government. For instance, if a storm destroys a bridge, these people
6060 think it is meaningless to say that one's liberty has been
6061 restrained. A bridge has washed out, and it's harder to get from one
6062 place to another. To talk about this as a loss of freedom, they say,
6063 is to confuse the stuff of politics with the vagaries of ordinary
6064 life. I don't mean to deny the value in this narrower view, which
6065 depends upon the context of the inquiry. I do, however, mean to argue
6066 against any insistence that this narrower view is the only proper view
6067 of liberty. As I argued in
<citetitle>Code
</citetitle>, we come from a long tradition of
6068 political thought with a broader focus than the narrow question of
6069 what the government did when. John Stuart Mill defended freedom of
6070 speech, for example, from the tyranny of narrow minds, not from the
6071 fear of government prosecution; John Stuart Mill,
<citetitle>On Liberty
</citetitle> (Indiana:
6072 Hackett Publishing Co.,
1978),
19. John R. Commons famously defended
6073 the economic freedom of labor from constraints imposed by the market;
6074 John R. Commons, "The Right to Work," in Malcom Rutherford and Warren
6075 J. Samuels, eds.,
<citetitle>John R. Commons: Selected Essays
</citetitle> (London:
6076 Routledge:
1997),
62. The Americans with Disabilities Act increases
6077 the liberty of people with physical disabilities by changing the
6078 architecture of certain public places, thereby making access to those
6079 places easier;
42 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
12101 (
2000). Each of
6080 these interventions to change existing conditions changes the liberty
6081 of a particular group. The effect of those interventions should be
6082 accounted for in order to understand the effective liberty that each
6083 of these groups might face.
6084 <indexterm><primary>Commons, John R.
</primary></indexterm>
6087 <section id=
"hollywood">
6088 <title>Why Hollywood Is Right
</title>
6090 The most obvious point that this model reveals is just why, or just
6091 how, Hollywood is right. The copyright warriors have rallied Congress
6092 and the courts to defend copyright. This model helps us see why that
6093 rallying makes sense.
6096 Let's say this is the picture of copyright's regulation before the
6099 <figure id=
"fig-1371">
6100 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.
</title>
6101 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6104 <!-- PAGE BREAK 136 -->
6105 There is balance between law, norms, market, and architecture. The law
6106 limits the ability to copy and share content, by imposing penalties on
6107 those who copy and share content. Those penalties are reinforced by
6108 technologies that make it hard to copy and share content
6109 (architecture) and expensive to copy and share content
6110 (market). Finally, those penalties are mitigated by norms we all
6111 recognize
—kids, for example, taping other kids' records. These
6112 uses of copyrighted material may well be infringement, but the norms
6113 of our society (before the Internet, at least) had no problem with
6114 this form of infringement.
6117 Enter the Internet, or, more precisely, technologies such as MP3s and
6118 p2p sharing. Now the constraint of architecture changes dramatically,
6119 as does the constraint of the market. And as both the market and
6120 architecture relax the regulation of copyright, norms pile on. The
6121 happy balance (for the warriors, at least) of life before the Internet
6122 becomes an effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
6125 Thus the sense of, and justification for, the warriors' response.
6126 Technology has changed, the warriors say, and the effect of this
6127 change, when ramified through the market and norms, is that a balance
6128 of protection for the copyright owners' rights has been lost. This is
6130 <!-- PAGE BREAK 137 -->
6131 after the fall of Saddam, but this time no government is justifying the
6132 looting that results.
6134 <figure id=
"fig-1381">
6135 <title>effective state of anarchy after the Internet.
</title>
6136 <graphic fileref=
"images/1381.png"></graphic>
6139 Neither this analysis nor the conclusions that follow are new to the
6140 warriors. Indeed, in a "White Paper" prepared by the Commerce
6141 Department (one heavily influenced by the copyright warriors) in
1995,
6142 this mix of regulatory modalities had already been identified and the
6143 strategy to respond already mapped. In response to the changes the
6144 Internet had effected, the White Paper argued (
1) Congress should
6145 strengthen intellectual property law, (
2) businesses should adopt
6146 innovative marketing techniques, (
3) technologists should push to
6147 develop code to protect copyrighted material, and (
4) educators should
6148 educate kids to better protect copyright.
6151 This mixed strategy is just what copyright needed
—if it was to
6152 preserve the particular balance that existed before the change induced
6153 by the Internet. And it's just what we should expect the content
6154 industry to push for. It is as American as apple pie to consider the
6155 happy life you have as an entitlement, and to look to the law to
6156 protect it if something comes along to change that happy
6157 life. Homeowners living in a
6159 <!-- PAGE BREAK 138 -->
6160 flood plain have no hesitation appealing to the government to rebuild
6161 (and rebuild again) when a flood (architecture) wipes away their
6162 property (law). Farmers have no hesitation appealing to the government
6163 to bail them out when a virus (architecture) devastates their
6164 crop. Unions have no hesitation appealing to the government to bail
6165 them out when imports (market) wipe out the U.S. steel industry.
6168 Thus, there's nothing wrong or surprising in the content industry's
6169 campaign to protect itself from the harmful consequences of a
6170 technological innovation. And I would be the last person to argue that
6171 the changing technology of the Internet has not had a profound effect
6172 on the content industry's way of doing business, or as John Seely
6173 Brown describes it, its "architecture of revenue."
6176 But just because a particular interest asks for government support, it
6177 doesn't follow that support should be granted. And just because
6178 technology has weakened a particular way of doing business, it doesn't
6179 follow that the government should intervene to support that old way of
6180 doing business. Kodak, for example, has lost perhaps as much as
20
6181 percent of their traditional film market to the emerging technologies
6182 of digital cameras.
<footnote><para>
6184 See Geoffrey Smith, "Film vs. Digital: Can Kodak Build a Bridge?"
6185 BusinessWeek online,
2 August
1999, available at
6186 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
23</ulink>. For a more
6187 recent analysis of Kodak's place in the market, see Chana
6188 R. Schoenberger, "Can Kodak Make Up for Lost Moments?" Forbes.com,
6
6189 October
2003, available at
6190 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
24</ulink>.
6193 Does anyone believe the government should ban digital cameras just to
6194 support Kodak? Highways have weakened the freight business for
6195 railroads. Does anyone think we should ban trucks from roads
6196 <emphasis>for the purpose of
</emphasis> protecting the railroads?
6197 Closer to the subject of this book, remote channel changers have
6198 weakened the "stickiness" of television advertising (if a boring
6199 commercial comes on the TV, the remote makes it easy to surf ), and it
6200 may well be that this change has weakened the television advertising
6201 market. But does anyone believe we should regulate remotes to
6202 reinforce commercial television? (Maybe by limiting them to function
6203 only once a second, or to switch to only ten channels within an hour?)
6206 The obvious answer to these obviously rhetorical questions is no.
6207 In a free society, with a free market, supported by free enterprise and
6208 free trade, the government's role is not to support one way of doing
6209 <!-- PAGE BREAK 139 -->
6210 business against others. Its role is not to pick winners and protect
6211 them against loss. If the government did this generally, then we would
6212 never have any progress. As Microsoft chairman Bill Gates wrote in
6213 1991, in a memo criticizing software patents, "established companies
6214 have an interest in excluding future competitors."
<footnote><para>
6216 Fred Warshofsky,
<citetitle>The Patent Wars
</citetitle> (New York: Wiley,
1994),
170–71.
6219 startup, established companies also have the means. (Think RCA and
6220 FM radio.) A world in which competitors with new ideas must fight
6221 not only the market but also the government is a world in which
6222 competitors with new ideas will not succeed. It is a world of stasis and
6223 increasingly concentrated stagnation. It is the Soviet Union under
6225 <indexterm><primary>Gates, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
6228 Thus, while it is understandable for industries threatened with new
6229 technologies that change the way they do business to look to the
6230 government for protection, it is the special duty of policy makers to
6231 guarantee that that protection not become a deterrent to progress. It
6232 is the duty of policy makers, in other words, to assure that the
6233 changes they create, in response to the request of those hurt by
6234 changing technology, are changes that preserve the incentives and
6235 opportunities for innovation and change.
6238 In the context of laws regulating speech
—which include,
6239 obviously, copyright law
—that duty is even stronger. When the
6240 industry complaining about changing technologies is asking Congress to
6241 respond in a way that burdens speech and creativity, policy makers
6242 should be especially wary of the request. It is always a bad deal for
6243 the government to get into the business of regulating speech
6244 markets. The risks and dangers of that game are precisely why our
6245 framers created the First Amendment to our Constitution: "Congress
6246 shall make no law . . . abridging the freedom of speech." So when
6247 Congress is being asked to pass laws that would "abridge" the freedom
6248 of speech, it should ask
— carefully
—whether such
6249 regulation is justified.
6252 My argument just now, however, has nothing to do with whether
6253 <!-- PAGE BREAK 140 -->
6254 the changes that are being pushed by the copyright warriors are
6255 "justified." My argument is about their effect. For before we get to
6256 the question of justification, a hard question that depends a great
6257 deal upon your values, we should first ask whether we understand the
6258 effect of the changes the content industry wants.
6261 Here's the metaphor that will capture the argument to follow.
6263 <indexterm id=
"idxddt" class='startofrange'
>
6264 <primary>DDT
</primary>
6267 In
1873, the chemical DDT was first synthesized. In
1948, Swiss
6268 chemist Paul Hermann Müller won the Nobel Prize for his work
6269 demonstrating the insecticidal properties of DDT. By the
1950s, the
6270 insecticide was widely used around the world to kill disease-carrying
6271 pests. It was also used to increase farm production.
6272 <indexterm><primary>Müller, Paul Hermann
</primary></indexterm>
6275 No one doubts that killing disease-carrying pests or increasing crop
6276 production is a good thing. No one doubts that the work of Müller was
6277 important and valuable and probably saved lives, possibly millions.
6279 <indexterm><primary>Carson, Rachel
</primary></indexterm>
6281 But in
1962, Rachel Carson published
<citetitle>Silent Spring
</citetitle>, which argued that
6282 DDT, whatever its primary benefits, was also having unintended
6283 environmental consequences. Birds were losing the ability to
6284 reproduce. Whole chains of the ecology were being destroyed.
6285 <indexterm><primary>Carson, Rachel
</primary></indexterm>
6286 <indexterm><primary>Silent Sprint (Carson)
</primary></indexterm>
6289 No one set out to destroy the environment. Paul Müller certainly did
6290 not aim to harm any birds. But the effort to solve one set of problems
6291 produced another set which, in the view of some, was far worse than
6292 the problems that were originally attacked. Or more accurately, the
6293 problems DDT caused were worse than the problems it solved, at least
6294 when considering the other, more environmentally friendly ways to
6295 solve the problems that DDT was meant to solve.
6298 It is to this image precisely that Duke University law professor James
6299 Boyle appeals when he argues that we need an "environmentalism" for
6300 culture.
<footnote><para>
6302 See, for example, James Boyle, "A Politics of Intellectual Property:
6303 Environmentalism for the Net?"
<citetitle>Duke Law Journal
</citetitle> 47 (
1997):
87.
6305 His point, and the point I want to develop in the balance of this
6306 chapter, is not that the aims of copyright are flawed. Or that authors
6307 should not be paid for their work. Or that music should be given away
6308 "for free." The point is that some of the ways in which we might
6309 protect authors will have unintended consequences for the cultural
6310 environment, much like DDT had for the natural environment. And just
6311 <!-- PAGE BREAK 141 -->
6312 as criticism of DDT is not an endorsement of malaria or an attack on
6313 farmers, so, too, is criticism of one particular set of regulations
6314 protecting copyright not an endorsement of anarchy or an attack on
6315 authors. It is an environment of creativity that we seek, and we
6316 should be aware of our actions' effects on the environment.
6319 My argument, in the balance of this chapter, tries to map exactly
6320 this effect. No doubt the technology of the Internet has had a dramatic
6321 effect on the ability of copyright owners to protect their content. But
6322 there should also be little doubt that when you add together the
6323 changes in copyright law over time, plus the change in technology that
6324 the Internet is undergoing just now, the net effect of these changes will
6325 not be only that copyrighted work is effectively protected. Also, and
6326 generally missed, the net effect of this massive increase in protection
6327 will be devastating to the environment for creativity.
6330 In a line: To kill a gnat, we are spraying DDT with consequences
6331 for free culture that will be far more devastating than that this gnat will
6334 <indexterm startref=
"idxddt" class='endofrange'
/>
6336 <section id=
"beginnings">
6337 <title>Beginnings
</title>
6339 America copied English copyright law. Actually, we copied and improved
6340 English copyright law. Our Constitution makes the purpose of "creative
6341 property" rights clear; its express limitations reinforce the English
6342 aim to avoid overly powerful publishers.
6345 The power to establish "creative property" rights is granted to
6346 Congress in a way that, for our Constitution, at least, is very
6347 odd. Article I, section
8, clause
8 of our Constitution states that:
6350 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science and
6351 useful Arts, by securing for limited Times to Authors and Inventors
6352 the exclusive Right to their respective Writings and Discoveries.
6354 <!-- PAGE BREAK 142 -->
6355 We can call this the "Progress Clause," for notice what this clause
6356 does not say. It does not say Congress has the power to grant
6357 "creative property rights." It says that Congress has the power
6358 <emphasis>to promote progress
</emphasis>. The grant of power is its
6359 purpose, and its purpose is a public one, not the purpose of enriching
6360 publishers, nor even primarily the purpose of rewarding authors.
6363 The Progress Clause expressly limits the term of copyrights. As we saw
6364 in chapter
6, the English limited the term of copyright so as to
6365 assure that a few would not exercise disproportionate control over
6366 culture by exercising disproportionate control over publishing. We can
6367 assume the framers followed the English for a similar purpose. Indeed,
6368 unlike the English, the framers reinforced that objective, by
6369 requiring that copyrights extend "to Authors" only.
6372 The design of the Progress Clause reflects something about the
6373 Constitution's design in general. To avoid a problem, the framers
6374 built structure. To prevent the concentrated power of publishers, they
6375 built a structure that kept copyrights away from publishers and kept
6376 them short. To prevent the concentrated power of a church, they banned
6377 the federal government from establishing a church. To prevent
6378 concentrating power in the federal government, they built structures
6379 to reinforce the power of the states
—including the Senate, whose
6380 members were at the time selected by the states, and an electoral
6381 college, also selected by the states, to select the president. In each
6382 case, a
<emphasis>structure
</emphasis> built checks and balances into
6383 the constitutional frame, structured to prevent otherwise inevitable
6384 concentrations of power.
6387 I doubt the framers would recognize the regulation we call "copyright"
6388 today. The scope of that regulation is far beyond anything they ever
6389 considered. To begin to understand what they did, we need to put our
6390 "copyright" in context: We need to see how it has changed in the
210
6391 years since they first struck its design.
6394 Some of these changes come from the law: some in light of changes
6395 in technology, and some in light of changes in technology given a
6396 <!-- PAGE BREAK 143 -->
6397 particular concentration of market power. In terms of our model, we
6400 <figure id=
"fig-1441">
6401 <title>Copyright's regulation before the Internet.
</title>
6402 <graphic fileref=
"images/1331.png"></graphic>
6407 <figure id=
"fig-1442">
6408 <title>"Copyright
" today.
</title>
6409 <graphic fileref=
"images/1442.png"></graphic>
6413 <!-- PAGE BREAK 144 -->
6416 <section id=
"lawduration">
6417 <title>Law: Duration
</title>
6419 When the first Congress enacted laws to protect creative property, it
6420 faced the same uncertainty about the status of creative property that
6421 the English had confronted in
1774. Many states had passed laws
6422 protecting creative property, and some believed that these laws simply
6423 supplemented common law rights that already protected creative
6424 authorship.
<footnote>
6427 William W. Crosskey,
<citetitle>Politics and the Constitution in the History of
6428 the United States
</citetitle> (London: Cambridge University Press,
1953), vol.
1,
6429 485–86: "extinguish[ing], by plain implication of `the supreme
6430 Law of the Land,'
<emphasis>the perpetual rights which authors had, or
6431 were supposed by some to have, under the Common Law
</emphasis>"
6433 <indexterm><primary>Crosskey, William W.</primary></indexterm>
6435 This meant that there was no guaranteed public domain in the United
6436 States in 1790. If copyrights were protected by the common law, then
6437 there was no simple way to know whether a work published in the United
6438 States was controlled or free. Just as in England, this lingering
6439 uncertainty would make it hard for publishers to rely upon a public
6440 domain to reprint and distribute works.
6443 That uncertainty ended after Congress passed legislation granting
6444 copyrights. Because federal law overrides any contrary state law,
6445 federal protections for copyrighted works displaced any state law
6446 protections. Just as in England the Statute of Anne eventually meant
6447 that the copyrights for all English works expired, a federal statute
6448 meant that any state copyrights expired as well.
6451 In 1790, Congress enacted the first copyright law. It created a
6452 federal copyright and secured that copyright for fourteen years. If
6453 the author was alive at the end of that fourteen years, then he could
6454 opt to renew the copyright for another fourteen years. If he did not
6455 renew the copyright, his work passed into the public domain.
6458 While there were many works created in the United States in the first
6459 ten years of the Republic, only 5 percent of the works were actually
6460 registered under the federal copyright regime. Of all the work created
6461 in the United States both before 1790 and from 1790 through 1800, 95
6462 percent immediately passed into the public domain; the balance would
6463 pass into the pubic domain within twenty-eight years at most, and more
6464 likely within fourteen years.<footnote><para>
6466 Although 13,000 titles were published in the United States from 1790
6467 to 1799, only 556 copyright registrations were filed; John Tebbel, <citetitle>A
6468 History of Book Publishing in the United States</citetitle>, vol. 1, <citetitle>The Creation
6469 of an Industry, 1630–1865</citetitle> (New York: Bowker, 1972), 141. Of the 21,000
6470 imprints recorded before 1790, only twelve were copyrighted under the
6471 1790 act; William J. Maher, <citetitle>Copyright Term, Retrospective Extension
6472 and the Copyright Law of 1790 in Historical Context</citetitle>, 7–10 (2002),
6473 available at <ulink url="http://free-culture.cc/notes/
">link
6474 #25</ulink>. Thus, the overwhelming majority of works fell
6475 immediately into the public domain. Even those works that were
6476 copyrighted fell into the public domain quickly, because the term of
6477 copyright was short. The initial term of copyright was fourteen years,
6478 with the option of renewal for an additional fourteen years. Copyright
6479 Act of May 31, 1790, §1, 1 stat. 124. </para></footnote>
6482 This system of renewal was a crucial part of the American system
6483 of copyright. It assured that the maximum terms of copyright would be
6484 <!-- PAGE BREAK 145 -->
6485 granted only for works where they were wanted. After the initial term
6486 of fourteen years, if it wasn't worth it to an author to renew his
6487 copyright, then it wasn't worth it to society to insist on the
6491 Fourteen years may not seem long to us, but for the vast majority of
6492 copyright owners at that time, it was long enough: Only a small
6493 minority of them renewed their copyright after fourteen years; the
6494 balance allowed their work to pass into the public
6495 domain.<footnote><para>
6497 Few copyright holders ever chose to renew their copyrights. For
6498 instance, of the 25,006 copyrights registered in 1883, only 894 were
6499 renewed in 1910. For a year-by-year analysis of copyright renewal
6500 rates, see Barbara A. Ringer, "Study No.
31: Renewal of Copyright,
"
6501 <citetitle>Studies on Copyright</citetitle>, vol. 1 (New York: Practicing Law Institute,
6502 1963), 618. For a more recent and comprehensive analysis, see William
6503 M. Landes and Richard A. Posner, "Indefinitely Renewable Copyright,"
6504 <citetitle>University of Chicago Law Review
</citetitle> 70 (
2003):
471,
498–501, and
6505 accompanying figures.
</para></footnote>
6508 Even today, this structure would make sense. Most creative work
6509 has an actual commercial life of just a couple of years. Most books fall
6510 out of print after one year.
<footnote><para>
6512 See Ringer, ch.
9, n.
2.
</para></footnote> When that happens, the
6513 used books are traded free of copyright regulation. Thus the books are
6514 no longer
<emphasis>effectively
</emphasis> controlled by
6515 copyright. The only practical commercial use of the books at that time
6516 is to sell the books as used books; that use
—because it does not
6517 involve publication
—is effectively free.
6520 In the first hundred years of the Republic, the term of copyright was
6521 changed once. In
1831, the term was increased from a maximum of
28
6522 years to a maximum of
42 by increasing the initial term of copyright
6523 from
14 years to
28 years. In the next fifty years of the Republic,
6524 the term increased once again. In
1909, Congress extended the renewal
6525 term of
14 years to
28 years, setting a maximum term of
56 years.
6528 Then, beginning in
1962, Congress started a practice that has defined
6529 copyright law since. Eleven times in the last forty years, Congress
6530 has extended the terms of existing copyrights; twice in those forty
6531 years, Congress extended the term of future copyrights. Initially, the
6532 extensions of existing copyrights were short, a mere one to two years.
6533 In
1976, Congress extended all existing copyrights by nineteen years.
6534 And in
1998, in the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act, Congress
6535 extended the term of existing and future copyrights by twenty years.
6538 The effect of these extensions is simply to toll, or delay, the passing
6539 of works into the public domain. This latest extension means that the
6540 public domain will have been tolled for thirty-nine out of fifty-five
6541 years, or
70 percent of the time since
1962. Thus, in the twenty years
6543 <!-- PAGE BREAK 146 -->
6544 after the Sonny Bono Act, while one million patents will pass into the
6545 public domain, zero copyrights will pass into the public domain by virtue
6546 of the expiration of a copyright term.
6549 The effect of these extensions has been exacerbated by another,
6550 little-noticed change in the copyright law. Remember I said that the
6551 framers established a two-part copyright regime, requiring a copyright
6552 owner to renew his copyright after an initial term. The requirement of
6553 renewal meant that works that no longer needed copyright protection
6554 would pass more quickly into the public domain. The works remaining
6555 under protection would be those that had some continuing commercial
6559 The United States abandoned this sensible system in
1976. For
6560 all works created after
1978, there was only one copyright term
—the
6561 maximum term. For "natural" authors, that term was life plus fifty
6562 years. For corporations, the term was seventy-five years. Then, in
1992,
6563 Congress abandoned the renewal requirement for all works created
6564 before
1978. All works still under copyright would be accorded the
6565 maximum term then available. After the Sonny Bono Act, that term
6566 was ninety-five years.
6569 This change meant that American law no longer had an automatic way to
6570 assure that works that were no longer exploited passed into the public
6571 domain. And indeed, after these changes, it is unclear whether it is
6572 even possible to put works into the public domain. The public domain
6573 is orphaned by these changes in copyright law. Despite the requirement
6574 that terms be "limited," we have no evidence that anything will limit
6578 The effect of these changes on the average duration of copyright is
6579 dramatic. In
1973, more than
85 percent of copyright owners failed to
6580 renew their copyright. That meant that the average term of copyright
6581 in
1973 was just
32.2 years. Because of the elimination of the renewal
6582 requirement, the average term of copyright is now the maximum term.
6583 In thirty years, then, the average term has tripled, from
32.2 years to
95
6584 years.
<footnote><para>
6586 These statistics are understated. Between the years
1910 and
1962 (the
6587 first year the renewal term was extended), the average term was never
6588 more than thirty-two years, and averaged thirty years. See Landes and
6589 Posner, "Indefinitely Renewable Copyright," loc. cit.
6592 <!-- PAGE BREAK 147 -->
6594 <section id=
"lawscope">
6595 <title>Law: Scope
</title>
6597 The "scope" of a copyright is the range of rights granted by the law.
6598 The scope of American copyright has changed dramatically. Those
6599 changes are not necessarily bad. But we should understand the extent
6600 of the changes if we're to keep this debate in context.
6603 In
1790, that scope was very narrow. Copyright covered only "maps,
6604 charts, and books." That means it didn't cover, for example, music or
6605 architecture. More significantly, the right granted by a copyright gave
6606 the author the exclusive right to "publish" copyrighted works. That
6607 means someone else violated the copyright only if he republished the
6608 work without the copyright owner's permission. Finally, the right granted
6609 by a copyright was an exclusive right to that particular book. The right
6610 did not extend to what lawyers call "derivative works." It would not,
6611 therefore, interfere with the right of someone other than the author to
6612 translate a copyrighted book, or to adapt the story to a different form
6613 (such as a drama based on a published book).
6616 This, too, has changed dramatically. While the contours of copyright
6617 today are extremely hard to describe simply, in general terms, the
6618 right covers practically any creative work that is reduced to a
6619 tangible form. It covers music as well as architecture, drama as well
6620 as computer programs. It gives the copyright owner of that creative
6621 work not only the exclusive right to "publish" the work, but also the
6622 exclusive right of control over any "copies" of that work. And most
6623 significant for our purposes here, the right gives the copyright owner
6624 control over not only his or her particular work, but also any
6625 "derivative work" that might grow out of the original work. In this
6626 way, the right covers more creative work, protects the creative work
6627 more broadly, and protects works that are based in a significant way
6628 on the initial creative work.
6631 At the same time that the scope of copyright has expanded, procedural
6632 limitations on the right have been relaxed. I've already described the
6633 complete removal of the renewal requirement in
1992. In addition
6634 <!-- PAGE BREAK 148 -->
6635 to the renewal requirement, for most of the history of American
6636 copyright law, there was a requirement that a work be registered
6637 before it could receive the protection of a copyright. There was also
6638 a requirement that any copyrighted work be marked either with that
6639 famous
© or the word
<emphasis>copyright
</emphasis>. And for most
6640 of the history of American copyright law, there was a requirement that
6641 works be deposited with the government before a copyright could be
6645 The reason for the registration requirement was the sensible
6646 understanding that for most works, no copyright was required. Again,
6647 in the first ten years of the Republic,
95 percent of works eligible
6648 for copyright were never copyrighted. Thus, the rule reflected the
6649 norm: Most works apparently didn't need copyright, so registration
6650 narrowed the regulation of the law to the few that did. The same
6651 reasoning justified the requirement that a work be marked as
6652 copyrighted
—that way it was easy to know whether a copyright was
6653 being claimed. The requirement that works be deposited was to assure
6654 that after the copyright expired, there would be a copy of the work
6655 somewhere so that it could be copied by others without locating the
6659 All of these "formalities" were abolished in the American system when
6660 we decided to follow European copyright law. There is no requirement
6661 that you register a work to get a copyright; the copyright now is
6662 automatic; the copyright exists whether or not you mark your work with
6663 a
©; and the copyright exists whether or not you actually make a
6664 copy available for others to copy.
6667 Consider a practical example to understand the scope of these
6671 If, in
1790, you wrote a book and you were one of the
5 percent who
6672 actually copyrighted that book, then the copyright law protected you
6673 against another publisher's taking your book and republishing it
6674 without your permission. The aim of the act was to regulate publishers
6675 so as to prevent that kind of unfair competition. In
1790, there were
6676 174 publishers in the United States.
<footnote><para>
6678 See Thomas Bender and David Sampliner, "Poets, Pirates, and the
6679 Creation of American Literature,"
29 <citetitle>New York University Journal of
6680 International Law and Politics
</citetitle> 255 (
1997), and James Gilraeth, ed.,
6681 Federal Copyright Records,
1790–1800 (U.S. G.P.O.,
1987).
6684 The Copyright Act was thus a tiny
6685 regulation of a tiny proportion of a tiny part of the creative market in
6686 the United States
—publishers.
6689 <!-- PAGE BREAK 149 -->
6690 The act left other creators totally unregulated. If I copied your poem
6691 by hand, over and over again, as a way to learn it by heart, my act
6692 was totally unregulated by the
1790 act. If I took your novel and made
6693 a play based upon it, or if I translated it or abridged it, none of
6694 those activities were regulated by the original copyright act. These
6695 creative activities remained free, while the activities of publishers
6699 Today the story is very different: If you write a book, your book is
6700 automatically protected. Indeed, not just your book. Every e-mail,
6701 every note to your spouse, every doodle,
<emphasis>every
</emphasis>
6702 creative act that's reduced to a tangible form
—all of this is
6703 automatically copyrighted. There is no need to register or mark your
6704 work. The protection follows the creation, not the steps you take to
6708 That protection gives you the right (subject to a narrow range of
6709 fair use exceptions) to control how others copy the work, whether they
6710 copy it to republish it or to share an excerpt.
6713 That much is the obvious part. Any system of copyright would
6715 competing publishing. But there's a second part to the copyright of
6716 today that is not at all obvious. This is the protection of "derivative
6717 rights." If you write a book, no one can make a movie out of your
6718 book without permission. No one can translate it without permission.
6719 CliffsNotes can't make an abridgment unless permission is granted. All
6720 of these derivative uses of your original work are controlled by the
6721 copyright holder. The copyright, in other words, is now not just an
6723 right to your writings, but an exclusive right to your writings
6724 and a large proportion of the writings inspired by them.
6727 It is this derivative right that would seem most bizarre to our
6728 framers, though it has become second nature to us. Initially, this
6730 was created to deal with obvious evasions of a narrower
6732 If I write a book, can you change one word and then claim a
6733 copyright in a new and different book? Obviously that would make a
6734 joke of the copyright, so the law was properly expanded to include
6735 those slight modifications as well as the verbatim original work.
6738 <!-- PAGE BREAK 150 -->
6739 In preventing that joke, the law created an astonishing power
6740 within a free culture
—at least, it's astonishing when you
6741 understand that the law applies not just to the commercial publisher
6742 but to anyone with a computer. I understand the wrong in duplicating
6743 and selling someone else's work. But whatever
6744 <emphasis>that
</emphasis> wrong is, transforming someone else's work
6745 is a different wrong. Some view transformation as no wrong at
6746 all
—they believe that our law, as the framers penned it, should
6747 not protect derivative rights at all.
<footnote><para>
6749 Jonathan Zittrain, "The Copyright Cage,"
<citetitle>Legal Affairs
</citetitle>, July/August
6751 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
26</ulink>.
6752 <indexterm><primary>Zittrain, Jonathan
</primary></indexterm>
6754 Whether or not you go that far, it seems
6755 plain that whatever wrong is involved is fundamentally different from
6756 the wrong of direct piracy.
6759 Yet copyright law treats these two different wrongs in the same way. I
6760 can go to court and get an injunction against your pirating my book. I
6761 can go to court and get an injunction against your transformative use
6762 of my book.
<footnote><para>
6764 Professor Rubenfeld has presented a powerful constitutional argument
6765 about the difference that copyright law should draw (from the
6766 perspective of the First Amendment) between mere "copies" and
6767 derivative works. See Jed Rubenfeld, "The Freedom of Imagination:
6768 Copyright's Constitutionality,"
<citetitle>Yale Law Journal
</citetitle> 112 (
2002):
6769 1–60 (see especially pp.
53–59).
6771 These two different uses of my creative work are
6775 This again may seem right to you. If I wrote a book, then why
6776 should you be able to write a movie that takes my story and makes
6777 money from it without paying me or crediting me? Or if Disney
6779 a creature called "Mickey Mouse," why should you be able to make
6780 Mickey Mouse toys and be the one to trade on the value that Disney
6784 These are good arguments, and, in general, my point is not that the
6785 derivative right is unjustified. My aim just now is much narrower:
6787 to make clear that this expansion is a significant change from the
6788 rights originally granted.
6791 <section id=
"lawreach">
6792 <title>Law and Architecture: Reach
</title>
6794 Whereas originally the law regulated only publishers, the change in
6795 copyright's scope means that the law today regulates publishers, users,
6796 and authors. It regulates them because all three are capable of making
6797 copies, and the core of the regulation of copyright law is copies.
<footnote><para>
6799 This is a simplification of the law, but not much of one. The law
6800 certainly regulates more than "copies"
—a public performance of a
6801 copyrighted song, for example, is regulated even though performance
6802 per se doesn't make a copy;
17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
6803 106(
4). And it certainly sometimes doesn't regulate a "copy";
17
6804 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
112(a). But the presumption under the
6805 existing law (which regulates "copies;"
17 <citetitle>United States Code
</citetitle>, section
6806 102) is that if there is a copy, there is a right.
6810 <!-- PAGE BREAK 151 -->
6811 "Copies." That certainly sounds like the obvious thing for
6812 <emphasis>copy
</emphasis>right law to regulate. But as with Jack
6813 Valenti's argument at the start of this chapter, that "creative
6814 property" deserves the "same rights" as all other property, it is the
6815 <emphasis>obvious
</emphasis> that we need to be most careful
6816 about. For while it may be obvious that in the world before the
6817 Internet, copies were the obvious trigger for copyright law, upon
6818 reflection, it should be obvious that in the world with the Internet,
6819 copies should
<emphasis>not
</emphasis> be the trigger for copyright
6820 law. More precisely, they should not
<emphasis>always
</emphasis> be
6821 the trigger for copyright law.
6824 This is perhaps the central claim of this book, so let me take this
6825 very slowly so that the point is not easily missed. My claim is that the
6826 Internet should at least force us to rethink the conditions under which
6827 the law of copyright automatically applies,
<footnote><para>
6829 Thus, my argument is not that in each place that copyright law extends,
6830 we should repeal it. It is instead that we should have a good argument for
6831 its extending where it does, and should not determine its reach on the
6833 of arbitrary and automatic changes caused by technology.
6835 because it is clear that the
6836 current reach of copyright was never contemplated, much less chosen,
6837 by the legislators who enacted copyright law.
6840 We can see this point abstractly by beginning with this largely
6843 <figure id=
"fig-1521">
6844 <title>All potential uses of a book.
</title>
6845 <graphic fileref=
"images/1521.png"></graphic>
6848 <!-- PAGE BREAK 152 -->
6849 Think about a book in real space, and imagine this circle to represent
6850 all its potential
<emphasis>uses
</emphasis>. Most of these uses are
6851 unregulated by copyright law, because the uses don't create a copy. If
6852 you read a book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If you
6853 give someone the book, that act is not regulated by copyright law. If
6854 you resell a book, that act is not regulated (copyright law expressly
6855 states that after the first sale of a book, the copyright owner can
6856 impose no further conditions on the disposition of the book). If you
6857 sleep on the book or use it to hold up a lamp or let your puppy chew
6858 it up, those acts are not regulated by copyright law, because those
6859 acts do not make a copy.
6861 <figure id=
"fig-1531">
6862 <title>Examples of unregulated uses of a book.
</title>
6863 <graphic fileref=
"images/1531.png"></graphic>
6866 Obviously, however, some uses of a copyrighted book are regulated
6867 by copyright law. Republishing the book, for example, makes a copy. It
6868 is therefore regulated by copyright law. Indeed, this particular use stands
6869 at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work. It is the
6870 paradigmatic use properly regulated by copyright regulation (see first
6871 diagram on next page).
6874 Finally, there is a tiny sliver of otherwise regulated copying uses
6875 that remain unregulated because the law considers these "fair uses."
6877 <!-- PAGE BREAK 153 -->
6878 <figure id=
"fig-1541">
6879 <title>Republishing stands at the core of this circle of possible uses of a copyrighted work.
</title>
6880 <graphic fileref=
"images/1541.png"></graphic>
6883 These are uses that themselves involve copying, but which the law treats
6884 as unregulated because public policy demands that they remain
6886 You are free to quote from this book, even in a review that
6887 is quite negative, without my permission, even though that quoting
6888 makes a copy. That copy would ordinarily give the copyright owner the
6889 exclusive right to say whether the copy is allowed or not, but the law
6890 denies the owner any exclusive right over such "fair uses" for public
6891 policy (and possibly First Amendment) reasons.
6893 <figure id=
"fig-1542">
6894 <title>Unregulated copying considered
"fair uses.
"</title>
6895 <graphic fileref=
"images/1542.png"></graphic>
6898 <figure id=
"fig-1551">
6899 <title>Uses that before were presumptively unregulated are now presumptively regulated.
</title>
6900 <graphic fileref=
"images/1551.png"></graphic>
6903 <!-- PAGE BREAK 154 -->
6904 In real space, then, the possible uses of a book are divided into three
6905 sorts: (
1) unregulated uses, (
2) regulated uses, and (
3) regulated uses that
6906 are nonetheless deemed "fair" regardless of the copyright owner's views.
6909 Enter the Internet
—a distributed, digital network where every use
6910 of a copyrighted work produces a copy.
<footnote><para>
6912 I don't mean "nature" in the sense that it couldn't be different, but rather that
6913 its present instantiation entails a copy. Optical networks need not make
6914 copies of content they transmit, and a digital network could be designed to
6915 delete anything it copies so that the same number of copies remain.
6917 And because of this single,
6918 arbitrary feature of the design of a digital network, the scope of
6920 1 changes dramatically. Uses that before were presumptively
6922 are now presumptively regulated. No longer is there a set of
6923 presumptively unregulated uses that define a freedom associated with a
6924 copyrighted work. Instead, each use is now subject to the copyright,
6925 because each use also makes a copy
—category
1 gets sucked into
6927 2. And those who would defend the unregulated uses of
6929 work must look exclusively to category
3, fair uses, to bear the
6930 burden of this shift.
6933 So let's be very specific to make this general point clear. Before the
6934 Internet, if you purchased a book and read it ten times, there would
6935 be no plausible
<emphasis>copyright
</emphasis>-related argument that
6936 the copyright owner could make to control that use of her
6937 book. Copyright law would have nothing to say about whether you read
6938 the book once, ten times, or every
6939 <!-- PAGE BREAK 155 -->
6940 night before you went to bed. None of those instances of use
—reading
—
6941 could be regulated by copyright law because none of those uses
6946 But the same book as an e-book is effectively governed by a different
6947 set of rules. Now if the copyright owner says you may read the book
6948 only once or only once a month, then
<emphasis>copyright
6949 law
</emphasis> would aid the copyright owner in exercising this degree
6950 of control, because of the accidental feature of copyright law that
6951 triggers its application upon there being a copy. Now if you read the
6952 book ten times and the license says you may read it only five times,
6953 then whenever you read the book (or any portion of it) beyond the
6954 fifth time, you are making a copy of the book contrary to the
6955 copyright owner's wish.
6958 There are some people who think this makes perfect sense. My aim
6959 just now is not to argue about whether it makes sense or not. My aim
6960 is only to make clear the change. Once you see this point, a few other
6961 points also become clear:
6964 First, making category
1 disappear is not anything any policy maker
6965 ever intended. Congress did not think through the collapse of the
6966 presumptively unregulated uses of copyrighted works. There is no
6967 evidence at all that policy makers had this idea in mind when they
6968 allowed our policy here to shift. Unregulated uses were an important
6969 part of free culture before the Internet.
6972 Second, this shift is especially troubling in the context of
6973 transformative uses of creative content. Again, we can all understand
6974 the wrong in commercial piracy. But the law now purports to regulate
6975 <emphasis>any
</emphasis> transformation you make of creative work
6976 using a machine. "Copy and paste" and "cut and paste" become
6977 crimes. Tinkering with a story and releasing it to others exposes the
6978 tinkerer to at least a requirement of justification. However
6979 troubling the expansion with respect to copying a particular work, it
6980 is extraordinarily troubling with respect to transformative uses of
6984 Third, this shift from category
1 to category
2 puts an extraordinary
6986 <!-- PAGE BREAK 156 -->
6987 burden on category
3 ("fair use") that fair use never before had to bear.
6988 If a copyright owner now tried to control how many times I could read
6989 a book on-line, the natural response would be to argue that this is a
6990 violation of my fair use rights. But there has never been any litigation
6991 about whether I have a fair use right to read, because before the
6993 reading did not trigger the application of copyright law and hence
6994 the need for a fair use defense. The right to read was effectively
6996 before because reading was not regulated.
6999 This point about fair use is totally ignored, even by advocates for
7000 free culture. We have been cornered into arguing that our rights
7001 depend upon fair use
—never even addressing the earlier question
7002 about the expansion in effective regulation. A thin protection
7003 grounded in fair use makes sense when the vast majority of uses are
7004 <emphasis>unregulated
</emphasis>. But when everything becomes
7005 presumptively regulated, then the protections of fair use are not
7009 The case of Video Pipeline is a good example. Video Pipeline was
7010 in the business of making "trailer" advertisements for movies available
7011 to video stores. The video stores displayed the trailers as a way to sell
7012 videos. Video Pipeline got the trailers from the film distributors, put
7013 the trailers on tape, and sold the tapes to the retail stores.
7016 The company did this for about fifteen years. Then, in
1997, it
7018 to think about the Internet as another way to distribute these
7020 The idea was to expand their "selling by sampling" technique by
7021 giving on-line stores the same ability to enable "browsing." Just as in a
7022 bookstore you can read a few pages of a book before you buy the book,
7023 so, too, you would be able to sample a bit from the movie on-line
7028 In
1998, Video Pipeline informed Disney and other film
7030 that it intended to distribute the trailers through the Internet
7031 (rather than sending the tapes) to distributors of their videos. Two
7032 years later, Disney told Video Pipeline to stop. The owner of Video
7033 <!-- PAGE BREAK 157 -->
7034 Pipeline asked Disney to talk about the matter
—he had built a
7036 on distributing this content as a way to help sell Disney films; he
7037 had customers who depended upon his delivering this content. Disney
7038 would agree to talk only if Video Pipeline stopped the distribution
7040 Video Pipeline thought it was within their "fair use" rights
7041 to distribute the clips as they had. So they filed a lawsuit to ask the
7042 court to declare that these rights were in fact their rights.
7045 Disney countersued
—for $
100 million in damages. Those damages
7046 were predicated upon a claim that Video Pipeline had "willfully
7048 on Disney's copyright. When a court makes a finding of
7050 infringement, it can award damages not on the basis of the actual
7051 harm to the copyright owner, but on the basis of an amount set in the
7052 statute. Because Video Pipeline had distributed seven hundred clips of
7053 Disney movies to enable video stores to sell copies of those movies,
7054 Disney was now suing Video Pipeline for $
100 million.
7057 Disney has the right to control its property, of course. But the video
7058 stores that were selling Disney's films also had some sort of right to be
7059 able to sell the films that they had bought from Disney. Disney's claim
7060 in court was that the stores were allowed to sell the films and they were
7061 permitted to list the titles of the films they were selling, but they were
7062 not allowed to show clips of the films as a way of selling them without
7063 Disney's permission.
7066 Now, you might think this is a close case, and I think the courts
7067 would consider it a close case. My point here is to map the change
7068 that gives Disney this power. Before the Internet, Disney couldn't
7069 really control how people got access to their content. Once a video
7070 was in the marketplace, the "first-sale doctrine" would free the
7071 seller to use the video as he wished, including showing portions of it
7072 in order to engender sales of the entire movie video. But with the
7073 Internet, it becomes possible for Disney to centralize control over
7074 access to this content. Because each use of the Internet produces a
7075 copy, use on the Internet becomes subject to the copyright owner's
7076 control. The technology expands the scope of effective control,
7077 because the technology builds a copy into every transaction.
7080 <!-- PAGE BREAK 158 -->
7081 No doubt, a potential is not yet an abuse, and so the potential for
7082 control is not yet the abuse of control. Barnes
& Noble has the
7083 right to say you can't touch a book in their store; property law gives
7084 them that right. But the market effectively protects against that
7085 abuse. If Barnes
& Noble banned browsing, then consumers would
7086 choose other bookstores. Competition protects against the
7087 extremes. And it may well be (my argument so far does not even
7088 question this) that competition would prevent any similar danger when
7089 it comes to copyright. Sure, publishers exercising the rights that
7090 authors have assigned to them might try to regulate how many times you
7091 read a book, or try to stop you from sharing the book with anyone. But
7092 in a competitive market such as the book market, the dangers of this
7093 happening are quite slight.
7096 Again, my aim so far is simply to map the changes that this changed
7097 architecture enables. Enabling technology to enforce the control of
7098 copyright means that the control of copyright is no longer defined by
7099 balanced policy. The control of copyright is simply what private
7100 owners choose. In some contexts, at least, that fact is harmless. But
7101 in some contexts it is a recipe for disaster.
7104 <section id=
"lawforce">
7105 <title>Architecture and Law: Force
</title>
7107 The disappearance of unregulated uses would be change enough, but a
7108 second important change brought about by the Internet magnifies its
7109 significance. This second change does not affect the reach of copyright
7110 regulation; it affects how such regulation is enforced.
7113 In the world before digital technology, it was generally the law that
7114 controlled whether and how someone was regulated by copyright law.
7115 The law, meaning a court, meaning a judge: In the end, it was a human,
7116 trained in the tradition of the law and cognizant of the balances that
7117 tradition embraced, who said whether and how the law would restrict
7120 <indexterm><primary>Casablanca
</primary></indexterm>
7121 <indexterm id=
"idxmarxbrothers" class='startofrange'
>
7122 <primary>Marx Brothers
</primary>
7124 <indexterm id=
"idxwarnerbrothers" class='startofrange'
>
7125 <primary>Warner Brothers
</primary>
7128 There's a famous story about a battle between the Marx Brothers
7129 and Warner Brothers. The Marxes intended to make a parody of
7130 <!-- PAGE BREAK 159 -->
7131 <citetitle>Casablanca
</citetitle>. Warner Brothers objected. They wrote a nasty letter to the
7132 Marxes, warning them that there would be serious legal consequences
7133 if they went forward with their plan.
<footnote><para>
7135 See David Lange, "Recognizing the Public Domain,"
<citetitle>Law and
7136 Contemporary Problems
</citetitle> 44 (
1981):
172–73.
7140 This led the Marx Brothers to respond in kind. They warned
7141 Warner Brothers that the Marx Brothers "were brothers long before
7142 you were."
<footnote><para>
7144 Ibid. See also Vaidhyanathan,
<citetitle>Copyrights and Copywrongs
</citetitle>,
1–3.
7145 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
7147 The Marx Brothers therefore owned the word
<citetitle>brothers
</citetitle>,
7148 and if Warner Brothers insisted on trying to control
<citetitle>Casablanca
</citetitle>, then
7149 the Marx Brothers would insist on control over
<citetitle>brothers
</citetitle>.
7152 An absurd and hollow threat, of course, because Warner Brothers,
7153 like the Marx Brothers, knew that no court would ever enforce such a
7154 silly claim. This extremism was irrelevant to the real freedoms anyone
7155 (including Warner Brothers) enjoyed.
7158 On the Internet, however, there is no check on silly rules, because on
7159 the Internet, increasingly, rules are enforced not by a human but by a
7160 machine: Increasingly, the rules of copyright law, as interpreted by
7161 the copyright owner, get built into the technology that delivers
7162 copyrighted content. It is code, rather than law, that rules. And the
7163 problem with code regulations is that, unlike law, code has no
7164 shame. Code would not get the humor of the Marx Brothers. The
7165 consequence of that is not at all funny.
7167 <indexterm startref=
"idxwarnerbrothers" class='endofrange'
/>
7168 <indexterm startref=
"idxmarxbrothers" class='endofrange'
/>
7170 Consider the life of my Adobe eBook Reader.
7173 An e-book is a book delivered in electronic form. An Adobe eBook
7174 is not a book that Adobe has published; Adobe simply produces the
7175 software that publishers use to deliver e-books. It provides the
7177 and the publisher delivers the content by using the technology.
7180 On the next page is a picture of an old version of my Adobe eBook
7184 As you can see, I have a small collection of e-books within this
7185 e-book library. Some of these books reproduce content that is in the
7186 public domain:
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>, for example, is in the public domain.
7187 Some of them reproduce content that is not in the public domain: My
7188 own book
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle> is not yet within the public domain.
7189 Consider
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle> first. If you click on my e-book copy of
7190 <!-- PAGE BREAK 160 -->
7191 <citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>, you'll see a fancy cover, and then a button at the bottom
7194 <figure id=
"fig-1611">
7195 <title>Picture of an old version of Adobe eBook Reader
</title>
7196 <graphic fileref=
"images/1611.png"></graphic>
7199 If you click on the Permissions button, you'll see a list of the
7200 permissions that the publisher purports to grant with this book.
7202 <figure id=
"fig-1612">
7203 <title>List of the permissions that the publisher purports to grant.
</title>
7204 <graphic fileref=
"images/1612.png"></graphic>
7207 <!-- PAGE BREAK 161 -->
7208 According to my eBook Reader, I have the permission to copy to the
7209 clipboard of the computer ten text selections every ten days. (So far,
7210 I've copied no text to the clipboard.) I also have the permission to
7211 print ten pages from the book every ten days. Lastly, I have the
7212 permission to use the Read Aloud button to hear
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle>
7213 read aloud through the computer.
7216 Here's the e-book for another work in the public domain (including the
7217 translation): Aristotle's
<citetitle>Politics
</citetitle>.
7218 <indexterm><primary>Aristotle
</primary></indexterm>
7219 <indexterm><primary><citetitle>Politics
</citetitle>, (Aristotle)
</primary></indexterm>
7221 <figure id=
"fig-1621">
7222 <title>E-book of Aristotle;s
"Politics
"</title>
7223 <graphic fileref=
"images/1621.png"></graphic>
7226 According to its permissions, no printing or copying is permitted
7227 at all. But fortunately, you can use the Read Aloud button to hear
7230 <figure id=
"fig-1622">
7231 <title>List of the permissions for Aristotle;s
"Politics
".
</title>
7232 <graphic fileref=
"images/1622.png"></graphic>
7235 Finally (and most embarrassingly), here are the permissions for the
7236 original e-book version of my last book,
<citetitle>The Future of
7239 <!-- PAGE BREAK 162 -->
7240 <figure id=
"fig-1631">
7241 <title>List of the permissions for
"The Future of Ideas
".
</title>
7242 <graphic fileref=
"images/1631.png"></graphic>
7245 No copying, no printing, and don't you dare try to listen to this book!
7248 Now, the Adobe eBook Reader calls these controls
7249 "permissions"
— as if the publisher has the power to control how
7250 you use these works. For works under copyright, the copyright owner
7251 certainly does have the power
—up to the limits of the copyright
7252 law. But for work not under copyright, there is no such copyright
7253 power.
<footnote><para>
7255 In principle, a contract might impose a requirement on me. I might,
7256 for example, buy a book from you that includes a contract that says I
7257 will read it only three times, or that I promise to read it three
7258 times. But that obligation (and the limits for creating that
7259 obligation) would come from the contract, not from copyright law, and
7260 the obligations of contract would not necessarily pass to anyone who
7261 subsequently acquired the book.
7263 When my e-book of
<citetitle>Middlemarch
</citetitle> says I have the
7264 permission to copy only ten text selections into the memory every ten
7265 days, what that really means is that the eBook Reader has enabled the
7266 publisher to control how I use the book on my computer, far beyond the
7267 control that the law would enable.
7270 The control comes instead from the code
—from the technology
7271 within which the e-book "lives." Though the e-book says that these are
7272 permissions, they are not the sort of "permissions" that most of us
7273 deal with. When a teenager gets "permission" to stay out till
7274 midnight, she knows (unless she's Cinderella) that she can stay out
7275 till
2 A.M., but will suffer a punishment if she's caught. But when
7276 the Adobe eBook Reader says I have the permission to make ten copies
7277 of the text into the computer's memory, that means that after I've
7278 made ten copies, the computer will not make any more. The same with
7279 the printing restrictions: After ten pages, the eBook Reader will not
7280 print any more pages. It's the same with the silly restriction that
7281 says that you can't use the Read Aloud button to read my book
7282 aloud
—it's not that the company will sue you if you do; instead,
7283 if you push the Read Aloud button with my book, the machine simply
7287 <!-- PAGE BREAK 163 -->
7288 These are
<emphasis>controls
</emphasis>, not permissions. Imagine a
7289 world where the Marx Brothers sold word processing software that, when
7290 you tried to type "Warner Brothers," erased "Brothers" from the
7292 <indexterm><primary>Marx Brothers
</primary></indexterm>
7295 This is the future of copyright law: not so much copyright
7296 <emphasis>law
</emphasis> as copyright
<emphasis>code
</emphasis>. The
7297 controls over access to content will not be controls that are ratified
7298 by courts; the controls over access to content will be controls that
7299 are coded by programmers. And whereas the controls that are built into
7300 the law are always to be checked by a judge, the controls that are
7301 built into the technology have no similar built-in check.
7304 How significant is this? Isn't it always possible to get around the
7305 controls built into the technology? Software used to be sold with
7306 technologies that limited the ability of users to copy the software,
7307 but those were trivial protections to defeat. Why won't it be trivial
7308 to defeat these protections as well?
7311 We've only scratched the surface of this story. Return to the Adobe
7315 Early in the life of the Adobe eBook Reader, Adobe suffered a public
7316 relations nightmare. Among the books that you could download for free
7317 on the Adobe site was a copy of
<citetitle>Alice's Adventures in
7318 Wonderland
</citetitle>. This wonderful book is in the public
7319 domain. Yet when you clicked on Permissions for that book, you got the
7322 <figure id=
"fig-1641">
7323 <title>List of the permissions for
"Alice's Adventures in
7324 Wonderland
".
</title>
7325 <graphic fileref=
"images/1641.png"></graphic>
7328 <!-- PAGE BREAK 164 -->
7329 Here was a public domain children's book that you were not
7331 to copy, not allowed to lend, not allowed to give, and, as the
7333 indicated, not allowed to "read aloud"!
7336 The public relations nightmare attached to that final permission.
7337 For the text did not say that you were not permitted to use the Read
7338 Aloud button; it said you did not have the permission to read the book
7339 aloud. That led some people to think that Adobe was restricting the
7340 right of parents, for example, to read the book to their children, which
7341 seemed, to say the least, absurd.
7344 Adobe responded quickly that it was absurd to think that it was trying
7345 to restrict the right to read a book aloud. Obviously it was only
7346 restricting the ability to use the Read Aloud button to have the book
7347 read aloud. But the question Adobe never did answer is this: Would
7348 Adobe thus agree that a consumer was free to use software to hack
7349 around the restrictions built into the eBook Reader? If some company
7350 (call it Elcomsoft) developed a program to disable the technological
7351 protection built into an Adobe eBook so that a blind person, say,
7352 could use a computer to read the book aloud, would Adobe agree that
7353 such a use of an eBook Reader was fair? Adobe didn't answer because
7354 the answer, however absurd it might seem, is no.
7357 The point is not to blame Adobe. Indeed, Adobe is among the most
7358 innovative companies developing strategies to balance open access to
7359 content with incentives for companies to innovate. But Adobe's
7360 technology enables control, and Adobe has an incentive to defend this
7361 control. That incentive is understandable, yet what it creates is
7365 To see the point in a particularly absurd context, consider a favorite
7366 story of mine that makes the same point.
7368 <indexterm id=
"idxaibo" class='startofrange'
>
7369 <primary>Aibo robotic dog
</primary>
7372 Consider the robotic dog made by Sony named "Aibo." The Aibo
7373 learns tricks, cuddles, and follows you around. It eats only electricity
7374 and that doesn't leave that much of a mess (at least in your house).
7377 The Aibo is expensive and popular. Fans from around the world
7378 have set up clubs to trade stories. One fan in particular set up a Web
7379 site to enable information about the Aibo dog to be shared. This fan set
7380 <!-- PAGE BREAK 165 -->
7381 up aibopet.com (and aibohack.com, but that resolves to the same site),
7382 and on that site he provided information about how to teach an Aibo
7383 to do tricks in addition to the ones Sony had taught it.
7386 "Teach" here has a special meaning. Aibos are just cute computers.
7387 You teach a computer how to do something by programming it
7388 differently. So to say that aibopet.com was giving information about
7389 how to teach the dog to do new tricks is just to say that aibopet.com
7390 was giving information to users of the Aibo pet about how to hack
7391 their computer "dog" to make it do new tricks (thus, aibohack.com).
7394 If you're not a programmer or don't know many programmers, the
7395 word
<citetitle>hack
</citetitle> has a particularly unfriendly connotation. Nonprogrammers
7396 hack bushes or weeds. Nonprogrammers in horror movies do even
7397 worse. But to programmers, or coders, as I call them,
<citetitle>hack
</citetitle> is a much
7398 more positive term.
<citetitle>Hack
</citetitle> just means code that enables the program to
7399 do something it wasn't originally intended or enabled to do. If you buy
7400 a new printer for an old computer, you might find the old computer
7401 doesn't run, or "drive," the printer. If you discovered that, you'd later be
7402 happy to discover a hack on the Net by someone who has written a
7403 driver to enable the computer to drive the printer you just bought.
7406 Some hacks are easy. Some are unbelievably hard. Hackers as a
7407 community like to challenge themselves and others with increasingly
7408 difficult tasks. There's a certain respect that goes with the talent to hack
7409 well. There's a well-deserved respect that goes with the talent to hack
7413 The Aibo fan was displaying a bit of both when he hacked the program
7414 and offered to the world a bit of code that would enable the Aibo to
7415 dance jazz. The dog wasn't programmed to dance jazz. It was a clever
7416 bit of tinkering that turned the dog into a more talented creature
7417 than Sony had built.
7419 <indexterm startref=
"idxaibo" class='endofrange'
/>
7421 I've told this story in many contexts, both inside and outside the
7422 United States. Once I was asked by a puzzled member of the audience,
7423 is it permissible for a dog to dance jazz in the United States? We
7424 forget that stories about the backcountry still flow across much of
7427 <!-- PAGE BREAK 166 -->
7428 world. So let's just be clear before we continue: It's not a crime
7429 anywhere (anymore) to dance jazz. Nor is it a crime to teach your dog
7430 to dance jazz. Nor should it be a crime (though we don't have a lot to
7431 go on here) to teach your robot dog to dance jazz. Dancing jazz is a
7432 completely legal activity. One imagines that the owner of aibopet.com
7433 thought,
<emphasis>What possible problem could there be with teaching
7434 a robot dog to dance?
</emphasis>
7437 Let's put the dog to sleep for a minute, and turn to a pony show
—
7438 not literally a pony show, but rather a paper that a Princeton academic
7439 named Ed Felten prepared for a conference. This Princeton academic
7440 is well known and respected. He was hired by the government in the
7441 Microsoft case to test Microsoft's claims about what could and could
7442 not be done with its own code. In that trial, he demonstrated both his
7443 brilliance and his coolness. Under heavy badgering by Microsoft
7444 lawyers, Ed Felten stood his ground. He was not about to be bullied
7445 into being silent about something he knew very well.
7448 But Felten's bravery was really tested in April
2001.
<footnote><para>
7450 See Pamela Samuelson, "Anticircumvention Rules: Threat to Science,"
7451 <citetitle>Science
</citetitle> 293 (
2001):
2028; Brendan I. Koerner,
"Play Dead: Sony Muzzles
7452 the Techies Who Teach a Robot Dog New Tricks," <citetitle>American Prospect
</citetitle>,
7453 January
2002; "Court Dismisses Computer Scientists' Challenge to
7454 DMCA,"
<citetitle>Intellectual Property Litigation Reporter
</citetitle>,
11 December
2001; Bill
7455 Holland, "Copyright Act Raising Free-Speech Concerns,"
<citetitle>Billboard
</citetitle>,
7456 May
2001; Janelle Brown, "Is the RIAA Running Scared?" Salon.com,
7457 April
2001; Electronic Frontier Foundation, "Frequently Asked
7458 Questions about
<citetitle>Felten and USENIX
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>RIAA
</citetitle> Legal Case," available at
7459 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
27</ulink>.
7460 <indexterm><primary>Electronic Frontier Foundation
</primary></indexterm>
7462 He and a group of colleagues were working on a paper to be submitted
7463 at conference. The paper was intended to describe the weakness in an
7464 encryption system being developed by the Secure Digital Music
7465 Initiative as a technique to control the distribution of music.
7468 The SDMI coalition had as its goal a technology to enable content
7469 owners to exercise much better control over their content than the
7470 Internet, as it originally stood, granted them. Using encryption, SDMI
7471 hoped to develop a standard that would allow the content owner to say
7472 "this music cannot be copied," and have a computer respect that
7473 command. The technology was to be part of a "trusted system" of
7474 control that would get content owners to trust the system of the
7478 When SDMI thought it was close to a standard, it set up a competition.
7479 In exchange for providing contestants with the code to an
7480 SDMI-encrypted bit of content, contestants were to try to crack it
7481 and, if they did, report the problems to the consortium.
7484 <!-- PAGE BREAK 167 -->
7485 Felten and his team figured out the encryption system quickly. He and
7486 the team saw the weakness of this system as a type: Many encryption
7487 systems would suffer the same weakness, and Felten and his team
7488 thought it worthwhile to point this out to those who study encryption.
7491 Let's review just what Felten was doing. Again, this is the United
7492 States. We have a principle of free speech. We have this principle not
7493 just because it is the law, but also because it is a really great
7494 idea. A strongly protected tradition of free speech is likely to
7495 encourage a wide range of criticism. That criticism is likely, in
7496 turn, to improve the systems or people or ideas criticized.
7499 What Felten and his colleagues were doing was publishing a paper
7500 describing the weakness in a technology. They were not spreading free
7501 music, or building and deploying this technology. The paper was an
7502 academic essay, unintelligible to most people. But it clearly showed the
7503 weakness in the SDMI system, and why SDMI would not, as presently
7504 constituted, succeed.
7507 What links these two, aibopet.com and Felten, is the letters they
7508 then received. Aibopet.com received a letter from Sony about the
7509 aibopet.com hack. Though a jazz-dancing dog is perfectly legal, Sony
7514 Your site contains information providing the means to circumvent
7515 AIBO-ware's copy protection protocol constituting a violation of the
7516 anti-circumvention provisions of the Digital Millennium Copyright Act.
7520 And though an academic paper describing the weakness in a system
7521 of encryption should also be perfectly legal, Felten received a letter
7522 from an RIAA lawyer that read:
7526 Any disclosure of information gained from participating in the
7527 <!-- PAGE BREAK 168 -->
7528 Public Challenge would be outside the scope of activities permitted by
7529 the Agreement and could subject you and your research team to actions
7530 under the Digital Millennium Copyright Act ("DMCA").
7534 In both cases, this weirdly Orwellian law was invoked to control the
7535 spread of information. The Digital Millennium Copyright Act made
7536 spreading such information an offense.
7539 The DMCA was enacted as a response to copyright owners' first fear
7540 about cyberspace. The fear was that copyright control was effectively
7541 dead; the response was to find technologies that might compensate.
7542 These new technologies would be copyright protection
7543 technologies
— technologies to control the replication and
7544 distribution of copyrighted material. They were designed as
7545 <emphasis>code
</emphasis> to modify the original
7546 <emphasis>code
</emphasis> of the Internet, to reestablish some
7547 protection for copyright owners.
7550 The DMCA was a bit of law intended to back up the protection of this
7551 code designed to protect copyrighted material. It was, we could say,
7552 <emphasis>legal code
</emphasis> intended to buttress
7553 <emphasis>software code
</emphasis> which itself was intended to
7554 support the
<emphasis>legal code of copyright
</emphasis>.
7557 But the DMCA was not designed merely to protect copyrighted works to
7558 the extent copyright law protected them. Its protection, that is, did
7559 not end at the line that copyright law drew. The DMCA regulated
7560 devices that were designed to circumvent copyright protection
7561 measures. It was designed to ban those devices, whether or not the use
7562 of the copyrighted material made possible by that circumvention would
7563 have been a copyright violation.
7566 Aibopet.com and Felten make the point. The Aibo hack circumvented a
7567 copyright protection system for the purpose of enabling the dog to
7568 dance jazz. That enablement no doubt involved the use of copyrighted
7569 material. But as aibopet.com's site was noncommercial, and the use did
7570 not enable subsequent copyright infringements, there's no doubt that
7571 aibopet.com's hack was fair use of Sony's copyrighted material. Yet
7572 fair use is not a defense to the DMCA. The question is not whether the
7573 <!-- PAGE BREAK 169 -->
7574 use of the copyrighted material was a copyright violation. The question
7575 is whether a copyright protection system was circumvented.
7578 The threat against Felten was more attenuated, but it followed the
7579 same line of reasoning. By publishing a paper describing how a
7580 copyright protection system could be circumvented, the RIAA lawyer
7581 suggested, Felten himself was distributing a circumvention technology.
7582 Thus, even though he was not himself infringing anyone's copyright,
7583 his academic paper was enabling others to infringe others' copyright.
7586 The bizarreness of these arguments is captured in a cartoon drawn in
7587 1981 by Paul Conrad. At that time, a court in California had held that
7588 the VCR could be banned because it was a copyright-infringing
7589 technology: It enabled consumers to copy films without the permission
7590 of the copyright owner. No doubt there were uses of the technology
7591 that were legal: Fred Rogers, aka "
<citetitle>Mr. Rogers
</citetitle>," for example, had
7592 testified in that case that he wanted people to feel free to tape
7593 Mr. Rogers' Neighborhood.
7597 Some public stations, as well as commercial stations, program the
7598 "Neighborhood" at hours when some children cannot use it. I think that
7599 it's a real service to families to be able to record such programs and
7600 show them at appropriate times. I have always felt that with the
7601 advent of all of this new technology that allows people to tape the
7602 "Neighborhood" off-the-air, and I'm speaking for the "Neighborhood"
7603 because that's what I produce, that they then become much more active
7604 in the programming of their family's television life. Very frankly, I
7605 am opposed to people being programmed by others. My whole approach in
7606 broadcasting has always been "You are an important person just the way
7607 you are. You can make healthy decisions." Maybe I'm going on too long,
7608 but I just feel that anything that allows a person to be more active
7609 in the control of his or her life, in a healthy way, is
7610 important.
<footnote><para>
7612 <citetitle>Sony Corporation of America
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Universal City Studios, Inc
</citetitle>.,
464 U.S.
417,
7613 455 fn.
27 (
1984). Rogers never changed his view about the VCR. See
7614 James Lardner,
<citetitle>Fast Forward: Hollywood, the Japanese, and the Onslaught of
7615 the VCR
</citetitle> (New York: W. W. Norton,
1987),
270–71.
7620 <!-- PAGE BREAK 170 -->
7621 Even though there were uses that were legal, because there were
7622 some uses that were illegal, the court held the companies producing
7623 the VCR responsible.
7626 This led Conrad to draw the cartoon below, which we can adopt to
7630 No argument I have can top this picture, but let me try to get close.
7633 The anticircumvention provisions of the DMCA target copyright
7634 circumvention technologies. Circumvention technologies can be used for
7635 different ends. They can be used, for example, to enable massive
7636 pirating of copyrighted material
—a bad end. Or they can be used
7637 to enable the use of particular copyrighted materials in ways that
7638 would be considered fair use
—a good end.
7641 A handgun can be used to shoot a police officer or a child. Most
7642 <!-- PAGE BREAK 171 -->
7643 would agree such a use is bad. Or a handgun can be used for target
7644 practice or to protect against an intruder. At least some would say that
7645 such a use would be good. It, too, is a technology that has both good
7648 <figure id=
"fig-1711">
7649 <title>VCR/handgun cartoon.
</title>
7650 <graphic fileref=
"images/1711.png"></graphic>
7653 The obvious point of Conrad's cartoon is the weirdness of a world
7654 where guns are legal, despite the harm they can do, while VCRs (and
7655 circumvention technologies) are illegal. Flash:
<emphasis>No one ever
7656 died from copyright circumvention
</emphasis>. Yet the law bans circumvention
7657 technologies absolutely, despite the potential that they might do some
7658 good, but permits guns, despite the obvious and tragic harm they do.
7661 The Aibo and RIAA examples demonstrate how copyright owners are
7662 changing the balance that copyright law grants. Using code, copyright
7663 owners restrict fair use; using the DMCA, they punish those who would
7664 attempt to evade the restrictions on fair use that they impose through
7665 code. Technology becomes a means by which fair use can be erased; the
7666 law of the DMCA backs up that erasing.
7669 This is how
<emphasis>code
</emphasis> becomes
7670 <emphasis>law
</emphasis>. The controls built into the technology of
7671 copy and access protection become rules the violation of which is also
7672 a violation of the law. In this way, the code extends the
7673 law
—increasing its regulation, even if the subject it regulates
7674 (activities that would otherwise plainly constitute fair use) is
7675 beyond the reach of the law. Code becomes law; code extends the law;
7676 code thus extends the control that copyright owners effect
—at
7677 least for those copyright holders with the lawyers who can write the
7678 nasty letters that Felten and aibopet.com received.
7681 There is one final aspect of the interaction between architecture and
7682 law that contributes to the force of copyright's regulation. This is
7683 the ease with which infringements of the law can be detected. For
7684 contrary to the rhetoric common at the birth of cyberspace that on the
7685 Internet, no one knows you're a dog, increasingly, given changing
7686 technologies deployed on the Internet, it is easy to find the dog who
7687 committed a legal wrong. The technologies of the Internet are open to
7688 snoops as well as sharers, and the snoops are increasingly good at
7689 tracking down the identity of those who violate the rules.
7693 <!-- PAGE BREAK 172 -->
7694 For example, imagine you were part of a
<citetitle>Star Trek
</citetitle> fan club. You
7695 gathered every month to share trivia, and maybe to enact a kind of fan
7696 fiction about the show. One person would play Spock, another, Captain
7697 Kirk. The characters would begin with a plot from a real story, then
7698 simply continue it.
<footnote><para>
7700 For an early and prescient analysis, see Rebecca Tushnet, "Legal Fictions,
7701 Copyright, Fan Fiction, and a New Common Law,"
<citetitle>Loyola of Los Angeles
7702 Entertainment Law Journal
</citetitle> 17 (
1997):
651.
7706 Before the Internet, this was, in effect, a totally unregulated
7707 activity. No matter what happened inside your club room, you would
7708 never be interfered with by the copyright police. You were free in
7709 that space to do as you wished with this part of our culture. You were
7710 allowed to build on it as you wished without fear of legal control.
7713 But if you moved your club onto the Internet, and made it generally
7714 available for others to join, the story would be very different. Bots
7715 scouring the Net for trademark and copyright infringement would
7716 quickly find your site. Your posting of fan fiction, depending upon
7717 the ownership of the series that you're depicting, could well inspire
7718 a lawyer's threat. And ignoring the lawyer's threat would be extremely
7719 costly indeed. The law of copyright is extremely efficient. The
7720 penalties are severe, and the process is quick.
7723 This change in the effective force of the law is caused by a change
7724 in the ease with which the law can be enforced. That change too shifts
7725 the law's balance radically. It is as if your car transmitted the speed at
7726 which you traveled at every moment that you drove; that would be just
7727 one step before the state started issuing tickets based upon the data you
7728 transmitted. That is, in effect, what is happening here.
7731 <section id=
"marketconcentration">
7732 <title>Market: Concentration
</title>
7734 So copyright's duration has increased dramatically
—tripled in
7735 the past thirty years. And copyright's scope has increased as
7736 well
—from regulating only publishers to now regulating just
7737 about everyone. And copyright's reach has changed, as every action
7738 becomes a copy and hence presumptively regulated. And as technologists
7740 <!-- PAGE BREAK 173 -->
7741 to control the use of content, and as copyright is increasingly
7742 enforced through technology, copyright's force changes, too. Misuse is
7743 easier to find and easier to control. This regulation of the creative
7744 process, which began as a tiny regulation governing a tiny part of the
7745 market for creative work, has become the single most important
7746 regulator of creativity there is. It is a massive expansion in the
7747 scope of the government's control over innovation and creativity; it
7748 would be totally unrecognizable to those who gave birth to copyright's
7752 Still, in my view, all of these changes would not matter much if it
7753 weren't for one more change that we must also consider. This is a
7754 change that is in some sense the most familiar, though its significance
7755 and scope are not well understood. It is the one that creates precisely the
7756 reason to be concerned about all the other changes I have described.
7759 This is the change in the concentration and integration of the media.
7760 In the past twenty years, the nature of media ownership has undergone
7761 a radical alteration, caused by changes in legal rules governing the
7762 media. Before this change happened, the different forms of media were
7763 owned by separate media companies. Now, the media is increasingly
7764 owned by only a few companies. Indeed, after the changes that the FCC
7765 announced in June
2003, most expect that within a few years, we will
7766 live in a world where just three companies control more than percent
7770 These changes are of two sorts: the scope of concentration, and its
7773 <indexterm><primary>BMG
</primary></indexterm>
7775 Changes in scope are the easier ones to describe. As Senator John
7776 McCain summarized the data produced in the FCC's review of media
7777 ownership, "five companies control
85 percent of our media sources."
<footnote><para>
7779 FCC Oversight: Hearing Before the Senate Commerce, Science and
7780 Transportation Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st sess. (
22 May
2003)
7781 (statement of Senator John McCain).
</para></footnote>
7782 The five recording labels of Universal Music Group, BMG, Sony Music
7783 Entertainment, Warner Music Group, and EMI control
84.8 percent of the
7784 U.S. music market.
<footnote><para>
7786 Lynette Holloway, "Despite a Marketing Blitz, CD Sales Continue to
7787 Slide,"
<citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
23 December
2002.
7789 The "five largest cable companies pipe
7790 programming to
74 percent of the cable subscribers nationwide."
<footnote><para>
7792 Molly Ivins, "Media Consolidation Must Be Stopped,"
<citetitle>Charleston Gazette
</citetitle>,
7795 <indexterm><primary>McCain, John
</primary></indexterm>
7798 The story with radio is even more dramatic. Before deregulation,
7799 the nation's largest radio broadcasting conglomerate owned fewer than
7800 <!-- PAGE BREAK 174 -->
7801 seventy-five stations. Today
<emphasis>one
</emphasis> company owns
7802 more than
1,
200 stations. During that period of consolidation, the
7803 total number of radio owners dropped by
34 percent. Today, in most
7804 markets, the two largest broadcasters control
74 percent of that
7805 market's revenues. Overall, just four companies control
90 percent of
7806 the nation's radio advertising revenues.
7809 Newspaper ownership is becoming more concentrated as well. Today,
7810 there are six hundred fewer daily newspapers in the United States than
7811 there were eighty years ago, and ten companies control half of the
7812 nation's circulation. There are twenty major newspaper publishers in
7813 the United States. The top ten film studios receive
99 percent of all
7814 film revenue. The ten largest cable companies account for
85 percent
7815 of all cable revenue. This is a market far from the free press the
7816 framers sought to protect. Indeed, it is a market that is quite well
7817 protected
— by the market.
7820 Concentration in size alone is one thing. The more invidious
7821 change is in the nature of that concentration. As author James Fallows
7822 put it in a recent article about Rupert Murdoch,
7823 <indexterm><primary>Fallows, James
</primary></indexterm>
7827 Murdoch's companies now constitute a production system
7828 unmatched in its integration. They supply content
—Fox movies
7829 . . . Fox TV shows . . . Fox-controlled sports broadcasts, plus
7830 newspapers and books. They sell the content to the public and to
7831 advertisers
—in newspapers, on the broadcast network, on the
7832 cable channels. And they operate the physical distribution system
7833 through which the content reaches the customers. Murdoch's satellite
7834 systems now distribute News Corp. content in Europe and Asia; if
7835 Murdoch becomes DirecTV's largest single owner, that system will serve
7836 the same function in the United States.
<footnote><para>
7838 James Fallows, "The Age of Murdoch,"
<citetitle>Atlantic Monthly
</citetitle> (September
7840 <indexterm><primary>Fallows, James
</primary></indexterm>
7845 The pattern with Murdoch is the pattern of modern media. Not
7846 just large companies owning many radio stations, but a few companies
7847 owning as many outlets of media as possible. A picture describes this
7848 pattern better than a thousand words could do:
7850 <figure id=
"fig-1761">
7851 <title>Pattern of modern media ownership.
</title>
7852 <graphic fileref=
"images/1761.png"></graphic>
7855 <!-- PAGE BREAK 175 -->
7856 Does this concentration matter? Will it affect what is made, or
7857 what is distributed? Or is it merely a more efficient way to produce and
7861 My view was that concentration wouldn't matter. I thought it was
7862 nothing more than a more efficient financial structure. But now, after
7863 reading and listening to a barrage of creators try to convince me to the
7864 contrary, I am beginning to change my mind.
7867 Here's a representative story that begins to suggest how this
7868 integration may matter.
7870 <indexterm><primary>Lear, Norman
</primary></indexterm>
7871 <indexterm><primary>ABC
</primary></indexterm>
7872 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family
</primary></indexterm>
7874 In
1969, Norman Lear created a pilot for
<citetitle>All in the Family
</citetitle>. He took
7875 the pilot to ABC. The network didn't like it. It was too edgy, they told
7876 Lear. Make it again. Lear made a second pilot, more edgy than the
7877 first. ABC was exasperated. You're missing the point, they told Lear.
7878 We wanted less edgy, not more.
7881 Rather than comply, Lear simply took the show elsewhere. CBS
7882 was happy to have the series; ABC could not stop Lear from walking.
7883 The copyrights that Lear held assured an independence from network
7884 control.
<footnote><para>
7886 Leonard Hill, "The Axis of Access," remarks before Weidenbaum Center
7887 Forum, "Entertainment Economics: The Movie Industry," St. Louis,
7889 3 April
2003 (transcript of prepared remarks available at
7890 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
28</ulink>;
7891 for the Lear story, not included in the prepared remarks, see
7892 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
29</ulink>).
7897 <!-- PAGE BREAK 176 -->
7898 The network did not control those copyrights because the law forbade
7899 the networks from controlling the content they syndicated. The law
7900 required a separation between the networks and the content producers;
7901 that separation would guarantee Lear freedom. And as late as
1992,
7902 because of these rules, the vast majority of prime time
7903 television
—75 percent of it
—was "independent" of the
7907 In
1994, the FCC abandoned the rules that required this independence.
7908 After that change, the networks quickly changed the balance. In
1985,
7909 there were twenty-five independent television production studios; in
7910 2002, only five independent television studios remained. "In
1992,
7911 only
15 percent of new series were produced for a network by a company
7912 it controlled. Last year, the percentage of shows produced by
7913 controlled companies more than quintupled to
77 percent." "In
1992,
16
7914 new series were produced independently of conglomerate control, last
7915 year there was one."
<footnote><para>
7917 NewsCorp./DirecTV Merger and Media Consolidation: Hearings on Media
7918 Ownership Before the Senate Commerce Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st
7919 sess. (
2003) (testimony of Gene Kimmelman on behalf of Consumers Union
7920 and the Consumer Federation of America), available at
7921 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
30</ulink>. Kimmelman
7922 quotes Victoria Riskin, president of Writers Guild of America, West,
7923 in her Remarks at FCC En Banc Hearing, Richmond, Virginia,
27 February
7926 In
2002,
75 percent of prime time television was owned by the networks
7927 that ran it. "In the ten-year period between
1992 and
2002, the number
7928 of prime time television hours per week produced by network studios
7929 increased over
200%, whereas the number of prime time television hours
7930 per week produced by independent studios decreased
7931 63%."
<footnote><para>
7936 <indexterm><primary>All in the Family
</primary></indexterm>
7938 Today, another Norman Lear with another
<citetitle>All in the Family
</citetitle> would
7939 find that he had the choice either to make the show less edgy or to be
7940 fired: The content of any show developed for a network is increasingly
7941 owned by the network.
7944 While the number of channels has increased dramatically, the ownership
7945 of those channels has narrowed to an ever smaller and smaller few. As
7946 Barry Diller said to Bill Moyers,
7947 <indexterm><primary>Diller, Barry
</primary></indexterm>
7948 <indexterm><primary>Moyers, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
7952 Well, if you have companies that produce, that finance, that air on
7953 their channel and then distribute worldwide everything that goes
7954 through their controlled distribution system, then what you get is
7955 fewer and fewer actual voices participating in the process. [We
7956 <!-- PAGE BREAK 177 -->
7957 u]sed to have dozens and dozens of thriving independent production
7958 companies producing television programs. Now you have less than a
7959 handful.
<footnote><para>
7961 "Barry Diller Takes on Media Deregulation,"
<citetitle>Now with Bill Moyers
</citetitle>, Bill
7962 Moyers,
25 April
2003, edited transcript available at
7963 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
31</ulink>.
7968 This narrowing has an effect on what is produced. The product of such
7969 large and concentrated networks is increasingly homogenous.
7970 Increasingly safe. Increasingly sterile. The product of news shows
7971 from networks like this is increasingly tailored to the message the
7972 network wants to convey. This is not the communist party, though from
7973 the inside, it must feel a bit like the communist party. No one can
7974 question without risk of consequence
—not necessarily banishment
7975 to Siberia, but punishment nonetheless. Independent, critical,
7976 different views are quashed. This is not the environment for a
7979 <indexterm><primary>Clark, Kim B.
</primary></indexterm>
7981 Economics itself offers a parallel that explains why this integration
7982 affects creativity. Clay Christensen has written about the "Innovator's
7983 Dilemma": the fact that large traditional firms find it rational to ignore
7984 new, breakthrough technologies that compete with their core business.
7985 The same analysis could help explain why large, traditional media
7986 companies would find it rational to ignore new cultural trends.
<footnote><para>
7988 Clayton M. Christensen,
<citetitle>The Innovator's Dilemma: The
7989 Revolutionary National Bestseller that Changed the Way We Do Business
</citetitle>
7990 (Cambridge: Harvard Business School Press,
1997). Christensen
7991 acknowledges that the idea was first suggested by Dean Kim Clark. See
7992 Kim B. Clark, "The Interaction of Design Hierarchies and Market
7993 Concepts in Technological Evolution,"
<citetitle>Research Policy
</citetitle> 14 (
1985):
7994 235–51. For a more recent study, see Richard Foster and Sarah
7995 Kaplan,
<citetitle>Creative Destruction: Why Companies That Are Built to Last
7996 Underperform the Market
—and How to Successfully Transform Them
</citetitle>
7997 (New York: Currency/Doubleday,
2001).
</para></footnote>
7999 Lumbering giants not only don't, but should not, sprint. Yet if the
8000 field is only open to the giants, there will be far too little
8002 <indexterm><primary>Christensen, Clayton M.
</primary></indexterm>
8005 I don't think we know enough about the economics of the media
8006 market to say with certainty what concentration and integration will
8007 do. The efficiencies are important, and the effect on culture is hard to
8011 But there is a quintessentially obvious example that does strongly
8012 suggest the concern.
8015 In addition to the copyright wars, we're in the middle of the drug
8016 wars. Government policy is strongly directed against the drug cartels;
8017 criminal and civil courts are filled with the consequences of this battle.
8020 Let me hereby disqualify myself from any possible appointment to
8021 any position in government by saying I believe this war is a profound
8022 mistake. I am not pro drugs. Indeed, I come from a family once
8024 <!-- PAGE BREAK 178 -->
8025 wrecked by drugs
—though the drugs that wrecked my family were
8026 all quite legal. I believe this war is a profound mistake because the
8027 collateral damage from it is so great as to make waging the war
8028 insane. When you add together the burdens on the criminal justice
8029 system, the desperation of generations of kids whose only real
8030 economic opportunities are as drug warriors, the queering of
8031 constitutional protections because of the constant surveillance this
8032 war requires, and, most profoundly, the total destruction of the legal
8033 systems of many South American nations because of the power of the
8034 local drug cartels, I find it impossible to believe that the marginal
8035 benefit in reduced drug consumption by Americans could possibly
8036 outweigh these costs.
8039 You may not be convinced. That's fine. We live in a democracy, and it
8040 is through votes that we are to choose policy. But to do that, we
8041 depend fundamentally upon the press to help inform Americans about
8045 Beginning in
1998, the Office of National Drug Control Policy launched
8046 a media campaign as part of the "war on drugs." The campaign produced
8047 scores of short film clips about issues related to illegal drugs. In
8048 one series (the Nick and Norm series) two men are in a bar, discussing
8049 the idea of legalizing drugs as a way to avoid some of the collateral
8050 damage from the war. One advances an argument in favor of drug
8051 legalization. The other responds in a powerful and effective way
8052 against the argument of the first. In the end, the first guy changes
8053 his mind (hey, it's television). The plug at the end is a damning
8054 attack on the pro-legalization campaign.
8057 Fair enough. It's a good ad. Not terribly misleading. It delivers its
8058 message well. It's a fair and reasonable message.
8061 But let's say you think it is a wrong message, and you'd like to run a
8062 countercommercial. Say you want to run a series of ads that try to
8063 demonstrate the extraordinary collateral harm that comes from the drug
8067 Well, obviously, these ads cost lots of money. Assume you raise the
8068 <!-- PAGE BREAK 179 -->
8069 money. Assume a group of concerned citizens donates all the money in
8070 the world to help you get your message out. Can you be sure your
8071 message will be heard then?
8074 No. You cannot. Television stations have a general policy of avoiding
8075 "controversial" ads. Ads sponsored by the government are deemed
8076 uncontroversial; ads disagreeing with the government are
8077 controversial. This selectivity might be thought inconsistent with
8078 the First Amendment, but the Supreme Court has held that stations have
8079 the right to choose what they run. Thus, the major channels of
8080 commercial media will refuse one side of a crucial debate the
8081 opportunity to present its case. And the courts will defend the
8082 rights of the stations to be this biased.
<footnote><para>
8084 The Marijuana Policy Project, in February
2003, sought to place ads
8085 that directly responded to the Nick and Norm series on stations within
8086 the Washington, D.C., area. Comcast rejected the ads as "against
8087 [their] policy." The local NBC affiliate, WRC, rejected the ads
8088 without reviewing them. The local ABC affiliate, WJOA, originally
8089 agreed to run the ads and accepted payment to do so, but later decided
8090 not to run the ads and returned the collected fees. Interview with
8091 Neal Levine,
15 October
2003. These restrictions are, of course, not
8092 limited to drug policy. See, for example, Nat Ives, "On the Issue of
8093 an Iraq War, Advocacy Ads Meet with Rejection from TV Networks,"
<citetitle>New
8094 York Times
</citetitle>,
13 March
2003, C4. Outside of election-related air time
8095 there is very little that the FCC or the courts are willing to do to
8096 even the playing field. For a general overview, see Rhonda Brown, "Ad
8097 Hoc Access: The Regulation of Editorial Advertising on Television and
8098 Radio,"
<citetitle>Yale Law and Policy Review
</citetitle> 6 (
1988):
449–79, and for a
8099 more recent summary of the stance of the FCC and the courts, see
8100 <citetitle>Radio-Television News Directors Association
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>FCC
</citetitle>,
184 F.
3d
872
8101 (D.C. Cir.
1999). Municipal authorities exercise the same authority as
8102 the networks. In a recent example from San Francisco, the San
8103 Francisco transit authority rejected an ad that criticized its Muni
8104 diesel buses. Phillip Matier and Andrew Ross, "Antidiesel Group Fuming
8105 After Muni Rejects Ad," SFGate.com,
16 June
2003, available at
8106 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
32</ulink>. The ground
8107 was that the criticism was "too controversial."
8108 <indexterm><primary>Comcast
</primary></indexterm>
8109 <indexterm><primary>Marijuana Policy Project
</primary></indexterm>
8110 <indexterm><primary>WJOA
</primary></indexterm>
8114 I'd be happy to defend the networks' rights, as well
—if we lived
8115 in a media market that was truly diverse. But concentration in the
8116 media throws that condition into doubt. If a handful of companies
8117 control access to the media, and that handful of companies gets to
8118 decide which political positions it will allow to be promoted on its
8119 channels, then in an obvious and important way, concentration
8120 matters. You might like the positions the handful of companies
8121 selects. But you should not like a world in which a mere few get to
8122 decide which issues the rest of us get to know about.
8125 <section id=
"together">
8126 <title>Together
</title>
8128 There is something innocent and obvious about the claim of the
8129 copyright warriors that the government should "protect my property."
8130 In the abstract, it is obviously true and, ordinarily, totally
8131 harmless. No sane sort who is not an anarchist could disagree.
8134 But when we see how dramatically this "property" has changed
—
8135 when we recognize how it might now interact with both technology and
8136 markets to mean that the effective constraint on the liberty to
8137 cultivate our culture is dramatically different
—the claim begins
8140 <!-- PAGE BREAK 180 -->
8141 less innocent and obvious. Given (
1) the power of technology to
8142 supplement the law's control, and (
2) the power of concentrated
8143 markets to weaken the opportunity for dissent, if strictly enforcing
8144 the massively expanded "property" rights granted by copyright
8145 fundamentally changes the freedom within this culture to cultivate and
8146 build upon our past, then we have to ask whether this property should
8150 Not starkly. Or absolutely. My point is not that we should abolish
8151 copyright or go back to the eighteenth century. That would be a total
8152 mistake, disastrous for the most important creative enterprises within
8156 But there is a space between zero and one, Internet culture
8157 notwithstanding. And these massive shifts in the effective power of
8158 copyright regulation, tied to increased concentration of the content
8159 industry and resting in the hands of technology that will increasingly
8160 enable control over the use of culture, should drive us to consider
8161 whether another adjustment is called for. Not an adjustment that
8162 increases copyright's power. Not an adjustment that increases its
8163 term. Rather, an adjustment to restore the balance that has
8164 traditionally defined copyright's regulation
—a weakening of that
8165 regulation, to strengthen creativity.
8168 Copyright law has not been a rock of Gibraltar. It's not a set of
8169 constant commitments that, for some mysterious reason, teenagers and
8170 geeks now flout. Instead, copyright power has grown dramatically in a
8171 short period of time, as the technologies of distribution and creation
8172 have changed and as lobbyists have pushed for more control by
8173 copyright holders. Changes in the past in response to changes in
8174 technology suggest that we may well need similar changes in the
8175 future. And these changes have to be
<emphasis>reductions
</emphasis>
8176 in the scope of copyright, in response to the extraordinary increase
8177 in control that technology and the market enable.
8180 For the single point that is lost in this war on pirates is a point that
8181 we see only after surveying the range of these changes. When you add
8182 <!-- PAGE BREAK 181 -->
8183 together the effect of changing law, concentrated markets, and
8184 changing technology, together they produce an astonishing conclusion:
8185 <emphasis>Never in our history have fewer had a legal right to control
8186 more of the development of our culture than now
</emphasis>.
8189 Not when copyrights were perpetual, for when copyrights were
8190 perpetual, they affected only that precise creative work. Not when
8191 only publishers had the tools to publish, for the market then was much
8192 more diverse. Not when there were only three television networks, for
8193 even then, newspapers, film studios, radio stations, and publishers
8194 were independent of the networks.
<emphasis>Never
</emphasis> has
8195 copyright protected such a wide range of rights, against as broad a
8196 range of actors, for a term that was remotely as long. This form of
8197 regulation
—a tiny regulation of a tiny part of the creative
8198 energy of a nation at the founding
—is now a massive regulation
8199 of the overall creative process. Law plus technology plus the market
8200 now interact to turn this historically benign regulation into the most
8201 significant regulation of culture that our free society has
8202 known.
<footnote><para>
8204 Siva Vaidhyanathan captures a similar point in his "four surrenders" of
8205 copyright law in the digital age. See Vaidhyanathan,
159–60.
8206 <indexterm><primary>Vaidhyanathan, Siva
</primary></indexterm>
8210 This has been a long chapter. Its point can now be briefly stated.
8213 At the start of this book, I distinguished between commercial and
8214 noncommercial culture. In the course of this chapter, I have
8215 distinguished between copying a work and transforming it. We can now
8216 combine these two distinctions and draw a clear map of the changes
8217 that copyright law has undergone. In
1790, the law looked like this:
8222 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8226 <entry>PUBLISH
</entry>
8227 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8232 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8233 <entry>©</entry>
8237 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8246 The act of publishing a map, chart, and book was regulated by
8247 copyright law. Nothing else was. Transformations were free. And as
8248 copyright attached only with registration, and only those who intended
8250 <!-- PAGE BREAK 182 -->
8251 to benefit commercially would register, copying through publishing of
8252 noncommercial work was also free.
8255 By the end of the nineteenth century, the law had changed to this:
8260 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8264 <entry>PUBLISH
</entry>
8265 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8270 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8271 <entry>©</entry>
8272 <entry>©</entry>
8275 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8284 Derivative works were now regulated by copyright law
—if
8285 published, which again, given the economics of publishing at the time,
8286 means if offered commercially. But noncommercial publishing and
8287 transformation were still essentially free.
8290 In
1909 the law changed to regulate copies, not publishing, and after
8291 this change, the scope of the law was tied to technology. As the
8292 technology of copying became more prevalent, the reach of the law
8293 expanded. Thus by
1975, as photocopying machines became more common,
8294 we could say the law began to look like this:
8299 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8304 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8309 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8310 <entry>©</entry>
8311 <entry>©</entry>
8314 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8315 <entry>©/Free
</entry>
8323 The law was interpreted to reach noncommercial copying through, say,
8324 copy machines, but still much of copying outside of the commercial
8325 market remained free. But the consequence of the emergence of digital
8326 technologies, especially in the context of a digital network, means
8327 that the law now looks like this:
8332 <tgroup cols=
"3" align=
"char">
8337 <entry>TRANSFORM
</entry>
8342 <entry>Commercial
</entry>
8343 <entry>©</entry>
8344 <entry>©</entry>
8347 <entry>Noncommercial
</entry>
8348 <entry>©</entry>
8349 <entry>©</entry>
8356 Every realm is governed by copyright law, whereas before most
8357 creativity was not. The law now regulates the full range of
8359 <!-- PAGE BREAK 183 -->
8360 commercial or not, transformative or not
—with the same rules
8361 designed to regulate commercial publishers.
8364 Obviously, copyright law is not the enemy. The enemy is regulation
8365 that does no good. So the question that we should be asking just now
8366 is whether extending the regulations of copyright law into each of
8367 these domains actually does any good.
8370 I have no doubt that it does good in regulating commercial copying.
8371 But I also have no doubt that it does more harm than good when
8372 regulating (as it regulates just now) noncommercial copying and,
8373 especially, noncommercial transformation. And increasingly, for the
8374 reasons sketched especially in chapters
7 and
8, one might well wonder
8375 whether it does more harm than good for commercial transformation.
8376 More commercial transformative work would be created if derivative
8377 rights were more sharply restricted.
8380 The issue is therefore not simply whether copyright is property. Of
8381 course copyright is a kind of "property," and of course, as with any
8382 property, the state ought to protect it. But first impressions
8383 notwithstanding, historically, this property right (as with all
8384 property rights
<footnote><para>
8386 It was the single most important contribution of the legal realist
8387 movement to demonstrate that all property rights are always crafted to
8388 balance public and private interests. See Thomas C. Grey, "The
8389 Disintegration of Property," in
<citetitle>Nomos XXII: Property
</citetitle>, J. Roland
8390 Pennock and John W. Chapman, eds. (New York: New York University
8393 has been crafted to balance the important need to give authors and
8394 artists incentives with the equally important need to assure access to
8395 creative work. This balance has always been struck in light of new
8396 technologies. And for almost half of our tradition, the "copyright"
8397 did not control
<emphasis>at all
</emphasis> the freedom of others to
8398 build upon or transform a creative work. American culture was born
8399 free, and for almost
180 years our country consistently protected a
8400 vibrant and rich free culture.
8403 We achieved that free culture because our law respected important
8404 limits on the scope of the interests protected by "property." The very
8405 birth of "copyright" as a statutory right recognized those limits, by
8406 granting copyright owners protection for a limited time only (the
8407 story of chapter
6). The tradition of "fair use" is animated by a
8408 similar concern that is increasingly under strain as the costs of
8409 exercising any fair use right become unavoidably high (the story of
8411 <!-- PAGE BREAK 184 -->
8412 statutory rights where markets might stifle innovation is another
8413 familiar limit on the property right that copyright is (chapter
8414 8). And granting archives and libraries a broad freedom to collect,
8415 claims of property notwithstanding, is a crucial part of guaranteeing
8416 the soul of a culture (chapter
9). Free cultures, like free markets,
8417 are built with property. But the nature of the property that builds a
8418 free culture is very different from the extremist vision that
8419 dominates the debate today.
8422 Free culture is increasingly the casualty in this war on piracy. In
8423 response to a real, if not yet quantified, threat that the
8424 technologies of the Internet present to twentieth-century business
8425 models for producing and distributing culture, the law and technology
8426 are being transformed in a way that will undermine our tradition of
8427 free culture. The property right that is copyright is no longer the
8428 balanced right that it was, or was intended to be. The property right
8429 that is copyright has become unbalanced, tilted toward an extreme. The
8430 opportunity to create and transform becomes weakened in a world in
8431 which creation requires permission and creativity must check with a
8434 <!-- PAGE BREAK 185 -->
8438 <part id=
"c-puzzles">
8439 <title>PUZZLES
</title>
8441 <!-- PAGE BREAK 186 -->
8442 <chapter id=
"chimera">
8443 <title>CHAPTER ELEVEN: Chimera
</title>
8444 <indexterm id=
"idxchimera" class='startofrange'
>
8445 <primary>chimeras
</primary>
8447 <indexterm id=
"idxwells" class='startofrange'
>
8448 <primary>Wells, H. G.
</primary>
8450 <indexterm id=
"idxtcotb" class='startofrange'
>
8451 <primary>"Country of the Blind, The
" (Wells)
</primary>
8455 In a well-known short story by H. G. Wells, a mountain climber
8456 named Nunez trips (literally, down an ice slope) into an unknown and
8457 isolated valley in the Peruvian Andes.
<footnote><para>
8459 H. G. Wells, "The Country of the Blind" (
1904,
1911). See H. G. Wells,
8460 <citetitle>The Country of the Blind and Other Stories
</citetitle>, Michael Sherborne, ed. (New
8461 York: Oxford University Press,
1996).
8463 The valley is extraordinarily beautiful, with "sweet water, pasture,
8464 an even climate, slopes of rich brown soil with tangles of a shrub
8465 that bore an excellent fruit." But the villagers are all blind. Nunez
8466 takes this as an opportunity. "In the Country of the Blind," he tells
8467 himself, "the One-Eyed Man is King." So he resolves to live with the
8468 villagers to explore life as a king.
8471 Things don't go quite as he planned. He tries to explain the idea of
8472 sight to the villagers. They don't understand. He tells them they are
8473 "blind." They don't have the word
<citetitle>blind
</citetitle>. They think he's just thick.
8474 Indeed, as they increasingly notice the things he can't do (hear the
8475 sound of grass being stepped on, for example), they increasingly try
8476 to control him. He, in turn, becomes increasingly frustrated. "`You
8477 don't understand,' he cried, in a voice that was meant to be great and
8478 resolute, and which broke. `You are blind and I can see. Leave me
8482 <!-- PAGE BREAK 187 -->
8483 The villagers don't leave him alone. Nor do they see (so to speak) the
8484 virtue of his special power. Not even the ultimate target of his
8485 affection, a young woman who to him seems "the most beautiful thing in
8486 the whole of creation," understands the beauty of sight. Nunez's
8487 description of what he sees "seemed to her the most poetical of
8488 fancies, and she listened to his description of the stars and the
8489 mountains and her own sweet white-lit beauty as though it was a guilty
8490 indulgence." "She did not believe," Wells tells us, and "she could
8491 only half understand, but she was mysteriously delighted."
8494 When Nunez announces his desire to marry his "mysteriously delighted"
8495 love, the father and the village object. "You see, my dear," her
8496 father instructs, "he's an idiot. He has delusions. He can't do
8497 anything right." They take Nunez to the village doctor.
8500 After a careful examination, the doctor gives his opinion. "His brain
8501 is affected," he reports.
8504 "What affects it?" the father asks. "Those queer things that are
8505 called the eyes . . . are diseased . . . in such a way as to affect
8509 The doctor continues: "I think I may say with reasonable certainty
8510 that in order to cure him completely, all that we need to do is a
8511 simple and easy surgical operation
—namely, to remove these
8512 irritant bodies [the eyes]."
8515 "Thank Heaven for science!" says the father to the doctor. They inform
8516 Nunez of this condition necessary for him to be allowed his bride.
8517 (You'll have to read the original to learn what happens in the end. I
8518 believe in free culture, but never in giving away the end of a story.)
8519 It sometimes happens that the eggs of twins fuse in the mother's
8520 womb. That fusion produces a "chimera." A chimera is a single creature
8521 with two sets of DNA. The DNA in the blood, for example, might be
8522 different from the DNA of the skin. This possibility is an underused
8524 <!-- PAGE BREAK 188 -->
8525 plot for murder mysteries. "But the DNA shows with
100 percent
8526 certainty that she was not the person whose blood was at the
8529 <indexterm startref=
"idxtcotb" class='endofrange'
/>
8530 <indexterm startref=
"idxwells" class=
"endofrange"/>
8532 Before I had read about chimeras, I would have said they were
8533 impossible. A single person can't have two sets of DNA. The very idea
8534 of DNA is that it is the code of an individual. Yet in fact, not only
8535 can two individuals have the same set of DNA (identical twins), but
8536 one person can have two different sets of DNA (a chimera). Our
8537 understanding of a "person" should reflect this reality.
8540 The more I work to understand the current struggle over copyright and
8541 culture, which I've sometimes called unfairly, and sometimes not
8542 unfairly enough, "the copyright wars," the more I think we're dealing
8543 with a chimera. For example, in the battle over the question "What is
8544 p2p file sharing?" both sides have it right, and both sides have it
8545 wrong. One side says, "File sharing is just like two kids taping each
8546 others' records
—the sort of thing we've been doing for the last
8547 thirty years without any question at all." That's true, at least in
8548 part. When I tell my best friend to try out a new CD that I've bought,
8549 but rather than just send the CD, I point him to my p2p server, that
8550 is, in all relevant respects, just like what every executive in every
8551 recording company no doubt did as a kid: sharing music.
8554 But the description is also false in part. For when my p2p server is
8555 on a p2p network through which anyone can get access to my music, then
8556 sure, my friends can get access, but it stretches the meaning of
8557 "friends" beyond recognition to say "my ten thousand best friends" can
8558 get access. Whether or not sharing my music with my best friend is
8559 what "we have always been allowed to do," we have not always been
8560 allowed to share music with "our ten thousand best friends."
8563 Likewise, when the other side says, "File sharing is just like walking
8564 into a Tower Records and taking a CD off the shelf and walking out
8565 with it," that's true, at least in part. If, after Lyle Lovett
8566 (finally) releases a new album, rather than buying it, I go to Kazaa
8567 and find a free copy to take, that is very much like stealing a copy
8569 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
8573 <!-- PAGE BREAK 189 -->
8574 But it is not quite stealing from Tower. After all, when I take a CD
8575 from Tower Records, Tower has one less CD to sell. And when I take a
8576 CD from Tower Records, I get a bit of plastic and a cover, and
8577 something to show on my shelves. (And, while we're at it, we could
8578 also note that when I take a CD from Tower Records, the maximum fine
8579 that might be imposed on me, under California law, at least, is
8580 $
1,
000. According to the RIAA, by contrast, if I download a ten-song
8581 CD, I'm liable for $
1,
500,
000 in damages.)
8584 The point is not that it is as neither side describes. The point is
8585 that it is both
—both as the RIAA describes it and as Kazaa
8586 describes it. It is a chimera. And rather than simply denying what the
8587 other side asserts, we need to begin to think about how we should
8588 respond to this chimera. What rules should govern it?
8591 We could respond by simply pretending that it is not a chimera. We
8592 could, with the RIAA, decide that every act of file sharing should be
8593 a felony. We could prosecute families for millions of dollars in
8594 damages just because file sharing occurred on a family computer. And
8595 we can get universities to monitor all computer traffic to make sure
8596 that no computer is used to commit this crime. These responses might
8597 be extreme, but each of them has either been proposed or actually
8598 implemented.
<footnote><para>
8600 For an excellent summary, see the report prepared by GartnerG2 and the
8601 Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School,
8602 "Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,"
27 June
2003,
8604 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
8605 #
33</ulink>. Reps. John Conyers Jr. (D-Mich.) and Howard L. Berman
8606 (D-Calif.) have introduced a bill that would treat unauthorized
8607 on-line copying as a felony offense with punishments ranging as high
8608 as five years imprisonment; see Jon Healey, "House Bill Aims to Up
8609 Stakes on Piracy,"
<citetitle>Los Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
17 July
2003, available at
8610 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
34</ulink>. Civil
8611 penalties are currently set at $
150,
000 per copied song. For a recent
8612 (and unsuccessful) legal challenge to the RIAA's demand that an ISP
8613 reveal the identity of a user accused of sharing more than
600 songs
8614 through a family computer, see
<citetitle>RIAA
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Verizon Internet Services (In
8615 re. Verizon Internet Services)
</citetitle>,
240 F. Supp.
2d
24
8616 (D.D.C.
2003). Such a user could face liability ranging as high as $
90
8617 million. Such astronomical figures furnish the RIAA with a powerful
8618 arsenal in its prosecution of file sharers. Settlements ranging from
8619 $
12,
000 to $
17,
500 for four students accused of heavy file sharing on
8620 university networks must have seemed a mere pittance next to the $
98
8621 billion the RIAA could seek should the matter proceed to court. See
8622 Elizabeth Young, "Downloading Could Lead to Fines," redandblack.com,
8623 August
2003, available at
8624 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
35</ulink>. For an
8625 example of the RIAA's targeting of student file sharing, and of the
8626 subpoenas issued to universities to reveal student file-sharer
8627 identities, see James Collins, "RIAA Steps Up Bid to Force BC, MIT to
8628 Name Students,"
<citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
8 August
2003, D3, available at
8629 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
36</ulink>.
8630 <indexterm><primary>Berman, Howard L.
</primary></indexterm>
8634 <indexterm startref=
"idxchimera" class='endofrange'
/>
8636 Alternatively, we could respond to file sharing the way many kids act
8637 as though we've responded. We could totally legalize it. Let there be
8638 no copyright liability, either civil or criminal, for making
8639 copyrighted content available on the Net. Make file sharing like
8640 gossip: regulated, if at all, by social norms but not by law.
8643 Either response is possible. I think either would be a mistake.
8644 Rather than embrace one of these two extremes, we should embrace
8645 something that recognizes the truth in both. And while I end this book
8646 with a sketch of a system that does just that, my aim in the next
8647 chapter is to show just how awful it would be for us to adopt the
8648 zero-tolerance extreme. I believe
<emphasis>either
</emphasis> extreme
8649 would be worse than a reasonable alternative. But I believe the
8650 zero-tolerance solution would be the worse of the two extremes.
8654 <!-- PAGE BREAK 190 -->
8655 Yet zero tolerance is increasingly our government's policy. In the
8656 middle of the chaos that the Internet has created, an extraordinary
8657 land grab is occurring. The law and technology are being shifted to
8658 give content holders a kind of control over our culture that they have
8659 never had before. And in this extremism, many an opportunity for new
8660 innovation and new creativity will be lost.
8663 I'm not talking about the opportunities for kids to "steal" music. My
8664 focus instead is the commercial and cultural innovation that this war
8665 will also kill. We have never seen the power to innovate spread so
8666 broadly among our citizens, and we have just begun to see the
8667 innovation that this power will unleash. Yet the Internet has already
8668 seen the passing of one cycle of innovation around technologies to
8669 distribute content. The law is responsible for this passing. As the
8670 vice president for global public policy at one of these new
8671 innovators, eMusic.com, put it when criticizing the DMCA's added
8672 protection for copyrighted material,
8676 eMusic opposes music piracy. We are a distributor of copyrighted
8677 material, and we want to protect those rights.
8680 But building a technology fortress that locks in the clout of
8681 the major labels is by no means the only way to protect copyright
8682 interests, nor is it necessarily the best. It is simply too early to
8684 that question. Market forces operating naturally may very
8685 well produce a totally different industry model.
8688 This is a critical point. The choices that industry sectors make
8689 with respect to these systems will in many ways directly shape the
8690 market for digital media and the manner in which digital media
8691 are distributed. This in turn will directly influence the options
8692 that are available to consumers, both in terms of the ease with
8693 which they will be able to access digital media and the equipment
8694 that they will require to do so. Poor choices made this early in the
8695 game will retard the growth of this market, hurting everyone's
8696 interests.
<footnote><para>
8698 WIPO and the DMCA One Year Later: Assessing Consumer Access to Digital
8699 Entertainment on the Internet and Other Media: Hearing Before the
8700 Subcommittee on Telecommunications, Trade, and Consumer Protection,
8701 House Committee on Commerce,
106th Cong.
29 (
1999) (statement of Peter
8702 Harter, vice president, Global Public Policy and Standards,
8703 EMusic.com), available in LEXIS, Federal Document Clearing House
8704 Congressional Testimony File.
</para></footnote>
8707 <!-- PAGE BREAK 191 -->
8709 In April
2001, eMusic.com was purchased by Vivendi Universal,
8710 one of "the major labels." Its position on these matters has now
8712 <indexterm><primary>Vivendi Universal
</primary></indexterm>
8715 Reversing our tradition of tolerance now will not merely quash
8716 piracy. It will sacrifice values that are important to this culture,
8717 and will kill opportunities that could be extraordinarily valuable.
8720 <!-- PAGE BREAK 192 -->
8722 <chapter id=
"harms">
8723 <title>CHAPTER TWELVE: Harms
</title>
8726 To fight "piracy," to protect "property," the content industry has
8727 launched a war. Lobbying and lots of campaign contributions have
8728 now brought the government into this war. As with any war, this one
8729 will have both direct and collateral damage. As with any war of
8731 these damages will be suffered most by our own people.
8734 My aim so far has been to describe the consequences of this war, in
8735 particular, the consequences for "free culture." But my aim now is to
8737 this description of consequences into an argument. Is this war
8741 In my view, it is not. There is no good reason why this time, for the
8742 first time, the law should defend the old against the new, just when the
8743 power of the property called "intellectual property" is at its greatest in
8746 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
8747 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
8749 Yet "common sense" does not see it this way. Common sense is still on
8750 the side of the Causbys and the content industry. The extreme claims
8751 of control in the name of property still resonate; the uncritical
8752 rejection of "piracy" still has play.
8755 <!-- PAGE BREAK 193 -->
8756 There will be many consequences of continuing this war. I want to
8757 describe just three. All three might be said to be unintended. I am quite
8758 confident the third is unintended. I'm less sure about the first two. The
8759 first two protect modern RCAs, but there is no Howard Armstrong in
8760 the wings to fight today's monopolists of culture.
8762 <section id=
"constrain">
8763 <title>Constraining Creators
</title>
8765 In the next ten years we will see an explosion of digital
8766 technologies. These technologies will enable almost anyone to capture
8767 and share content. Capturing and sharing content, of course, is what
8768 humans have done since the dawn of man. It is how we learn and
8769 communicate. But capturing and sharing through digital technology is
8770 different. The fidelity and power are different. You could send an
8771 e-mail telling someone about a joke you saw on Comedy Central, or you
8772 could send the clip. You could write an essay about the
8773 inconsistencies in the arguments of the politician you most love to
8774 hate, or you could make a short film that puts statement against
8775 statement. You could write a poem to express your love, or you could
8776 weave together a string
—a mash-up
— of songs from your
8777 favorite artists in a collage and make it available on the Net.
8780 This digital "capturing and sharing" is in part an extension of the
8781 capturing and sharing that has always been integral to our culture,
8782 and in part it is something new. It is continuous with the Kodak, but
8783 it explodes the boundaries of Kodak-like technologies. The technology
8784 of digital "capturing and sharing" promises a world of extraordinarily
8785 diverse creativity that can be easily and broadly shared. And as that
8786 creativity is applied to democracy, it will enable a broad range of
8787 citizens to use technology to express and criticize and contribute to
8788 the culture all around.
8791 Technology has thus given us an opportunity to do something with
8792 culture that has only ever been possible for individuals in small groups,
8794 <!-- PAGE BREAK 194 -->
8796 isolated from others. Think about an old man telling a story to a
8797 collection of neighbors in a small town. Now imagine that same
8798 storytelling extended across the globe.
8801 Yet all this is possible only if the activity is presumptively legal. In
8802 the current regime of legal regulation, it is not. Forget file sharing for
8803 a moment. Think about your favorite amazing sites on the Net. Web
8804 sites that offer plot summaries from forgotten television shows; sites
8805 that catalog cartoons from the
1960s; sites that mix images and sound
8806 to criticize politicians or businesses; sites that gather newspaper articles
8807 on remote topics of science or culture. There is a vast amount of creative
8808 work spread across the Internet. But as the law is currently crafted, this
8809 work is presumptively illegal.
8812 That presumption will increasingly chill creativity, as the
8813 examples of extreme penalties for vague infringements continue to
8814 proliferate. It is impossible to get a clear sense of what's allowed
8815 and what's not, and at the same time, the penalties for crossing the
8816 line are astonishingly harsh. The four students who were threatened
8817 by the RIAA ( Jesse Jordan of chapter
3 was just one) were threatened
8818 with a $
98 billion lawsuit for building search engines that permitted
8819 songs to be copied. Yet World-Com
—which defrauded investors of
8820 $
11 billion, resulting in a loss to investors in market capitalization
8821 of over $
200 billion
—received a fine of a mere $
750
8822 million.
<footnote><para>
8824 See Lynne W. Jeter,
<citetitle>Disconnected: Deceit and Betrayal at WorldCom
</citetitle>
8825 (Hoboken, N.J.: John Wiley
& Sons,
2003),
176,
204; for details of
8826 the settlement, see MCI press release, "MCI Wins U.S. District Court
8827 Approval for SEC Settlement" (
7 July
2003), available at
8828 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
37</ulink>.
8829 <indexterm><primary>Worldcom
</primary></indexterm>
8831 And under legislation being pushed in Congress right now, a doctor who
8832 negligently removes the wrong leg in an operation would be liable for
8833 no more than $
250,
000 in damages for pain and
8834 suffering.
<footnote>
8836 <!-- f2. --> The bill, modeled after California's tort reform model, was passed in the
8837 House of Representatives but defeated in a Senate vote in July
2003. For
8838 an overview, see Tanya Albert, "Measure Stalls in Senate: `We'll Be Back,'
8839 Say Tort Reformers," amednews.com,
28 July
2003, available at
8840 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
38</ulink>,
8841 and "Senate Turns Back Malpractice Caps," CBSNews.com,
9 July
2003,
8843 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
39</ulink>. President Bush has continued to urge tort reform in
8845 <indexterm><primary>Bush, George W.
</primary></indexterm>
8847 Can common sense recognize the absurdity in a world where
8848 the maximum fine for downloading two songs off the Internet is more
8849 than the fine for a doctor's negligently butchering a patient?
8850 <indexterm><primary>Worldcom
</primary></indexterm>
8853 The consequence of this legal uncertainty, tied to these extremely
8854 high penalties, is that an extraordinary amount of creativity will
8855 either never be exercised, or never be exercised in the open. We drive
8856 this creative process underground by branding the modern-day Walt
8857 Disneys "pirates." We make it impossible for businesses to rely upon a
8858 public domain, because the boundaries of the public domain are
8861 <!-- PAGE BREAK 195 -->
8862 be unclear. It never pays to do anything except pay for the right
8863 to create, and hence only those who can pay are allowed to create. As
8864 was the case in the Soviet Union, though for very different reasons,
8865 we will begin to see a world of underground art
—not because the
8866 message is necessarily political, or because the subject is
8867 controversial, but because the very act of creating the art is legally
8868 fraught. Already, exhibits of "illegal art" tour the United
8869 States.
<footnote><para>
8872 See Danit Lidor, "Artists Just Wanna Be Free,"
<citetitle>Wired
</citetitle>,
7 July
8874 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
40</ulink>. For an overview of the exhibition, see
8875 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
41</ulink>.
8877 In what does their "illegality" consist?
8878 In the act of mixing the culture around us with an expression that is
8879 critical or reflective.
8882 Part of the reason for this fear of illegality has to do with the
8883 changing law. I described that change in detail in chapter
10. But an
8884 even bigger part has to do with the increasing ease with which
8885 infractions can be tracked. As users of file-sharing systems
8886 discovered in
2002, it is a trivial matter for copyright owners to get
8887 courts to order Internet service providers to reveal who has what
8888 content. It is as if your cassette tape player transmitted a list of
8889 the songs that you played in the privacy of your own home that anyone
8890 could tune into for whatever reason they chose.
8893 Never in our history has a painter had to worry about whether
8894 his painting infringed on someone else's work; but the modern-day
8895 painter, using the tools of Photoshop, sharing content on the Web,
8896 must worry all the time. Images are all around, but the only safe images
8897 to use in the act of creation are those purchased from Corbis or another
8898 image farm. And in purchasing, censoring happens. There is a free
8899 market in pencils; we needn't worry about its effect on creativity. But
8900 there is a highly regulated, monopolized market in cultural icons; the
8901 right to cultivate and transform them is not similarly free.
8904 Lawyers rarely see this because lawyers are rarely empirical. As I
8905 described in chapter
7, in response to the story about documentary
8906 filmmaker Jon Else, I have been lectured again and again by lawyers
8907 who insist Else's use was fair use, and hence I am wrong to say that the
8908 law regulates such a use.
8912 <!-- PAGE BREAK 196 -->
8913 But fair use in America simply means the right to hire a lawyer to
8914 defend your right to create. And as lawyers love to forget, our system
8915 for defending rights such as fair use is astonishingly bad
—in
8916 practically every context, but especially here. It costs too much, it
8917 delivers too slowly, and what it delivers often has little connection
8918 to the justice underlying the claim. The legal system may be tolerable
8919 for the very rich. For everyone else, it is an embarrassment to a
8920 tradition that prides itself on the rule of law.
8923 Judges and lawyers can tell themselves that fair use provides adequate
8924 "breathing room" between regulation by the law and the access the law
8925 should allow. But it is a measure of how out of touch our legal system
8926 has become that anyone actually believes this. The rules that
8927 publishers impose upon writers, the rules that film distributors
8928 impose upon filmmakers, the rules that newspapers impose upon
8929 journalists
— these are the real laws governing creativity. And
8930 these rules have little relationship to the "law" with which judges
8934 For in a world that threatens $
150,
000 for a single willful
8935 infringement of a copyright, and which demands tens of thousands of
8936 dollars to even defend against a copyright infringement claim, and
8937 which would never return to the wrongfully accused defendant anything
8938 of the costs she suffered to defend her right to speak
—in that
8939 world, the astonishingly broad regulations that pass under the name
8940 "copyright" silence speech and creativity. And in that world, it takes
8941 a studied blindness for people to continue to believe they live in a
8942 culture that is free.
8945 As Jed Horovitz, the businessman behind Video Pipeline, said to me,
8949 We're losing [creative] opportunities right and left. Creative people
8950 are being forced not to express themselves. Thoughts are not being
8951 expressed. And while a lot of stuff may [still] be created, it still
8952 won't get distributed. Even if the stuff gets made . . . you're not
8953 going to get it distributed in the mainstream media unless
8954 <!-- PAGE BREAK 197 -->
8955 you've got a little note from a lawyer saying, "This has been
8956 cleared." You're not even going to get it on PBS without that kind of
8957 permission. That's the point at which they control it.
8961 <section id=
"innovators">
8962 <title>Constraining Innovators
</title>
8964 The story of the last section was a crunchy-lefty
8965 story
—creativity quashed, artists who can't speak, yada yada
8966 yada. Maybe that doesn't get you going. Maybe you think there's enough
8967 weird art out there, and enough expression that is critical of what
8968 seems to be just about everything. And if you think that, you might
8969 think there's little in this story to worry you.
8972 But there's an aspect of this story that is not lefty in any sense.
8973 Indeed, it is an aspect that could be written by the most extreme
8974 promarket ideologue. And if you're one of these sorts (and a special
8975 one at that,
188 pages into a book like this), then you can see this
8976 other aspect by substituting "free market" every place I've spoken of
8977 "free culture." The point is the same, even if the interests
8978 affecting culture are more fundamental.
8981 The charge I've been making about the regulation of culture is the
8982 same charge free marketers make about regulating markets. Everyone, of
8983 course, concedes that some regulation of markets is necessary
—at
8984 a minimum, we need rules of property and contract, and courts to
8985 enforce both. Likewise, in this culture debate, everyone concedes that
8986 at least some framework of copyright is also required. But both
8987 perspectives vehemently insist that just because some regulation is
8988 good, it doesn't follow that more regulation is better. And both
8989 perspectives are constantly attuned to the ways in which regulation
8990 simply enables the powerful industries of today to protect themselves
8991 against the competitors of tomorrow.
8993 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank
</primary></indexterm>
8995 This is the single most dramatic effect of the shift in regulatory
8996 <!-- PAGE BREAK 198 -->
8997 strategy that I described in chapter
10. The consequence of this
8998 massive threat of liability tied to the murky boundaries of copyright
8999 law is that innovators who want to innovate in this space can safely
9000 innovate only if they have the sign-off from last generation's
9001 dominant industries. That lesson has been taught through a series of
9002 cases that were designed and executed to teach venture capitalists a
9003 lesson. That lesson
—what former Napster CEO Hank Barry calls a
9004 "nuclear pall" that has fallen over the Valley
—has been learned.
9007 Consider one example to make the point, a story whose beginning
9008 I told in
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle> and which has progressed in a way that
9009 even I (pessimist extraordinaire) would never have predicted.
9012 In
1997, Michael Roberts launched a company called MP3.com. MP3.com
9013 was keen to remake the music business. Their goal was not just to
9014 facilitate new ways to get access to content. Their goal was also to
9015 facilitate new ways to create content. Unlike the major labels,
9016 MP3.com offered creators a venue to distribute their creativity,
9017 without demanding an exclusive engagement from the creators.
9020 To make this system work, however, MP3.com needed a reliable way to
9021 recommend music to its users. The idea behind this alternative was to
9022 leverage the revealed preferences of music listeners to recommend new
9023 artists. If you like Lyle Lovett, you're likely to enjoy Bonnie
9025 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
9028 This idea required a simple way to gather data about user preferences.
9029 MP3.com came up with an extraordinarily clever way to gather this
9030 preference data. In January
2000, the company launched a service
9031 called my.mp3.com. Using software provided by MP3.com, a user would
9032 sign into an account and then insert into her computer a CD. The
9033 software would identify the CD, and then give the user access to that
9034 content. So, for example, if you inserted a CD by Jill Sobule, then
9035 wherever you were
—at work or at home
—you could get access
9036 to that music once you signed into your account. The system was
9037 therefore a kind of music-lockbox.
9040 No doubt some could use this system to illegally copy content. But
9041 that opportunity existed with or without MP3.com. The aim of the
9043 <!-- PAGE BREAK 199 -->
9044 my.mp3.com service was to give users access to their own content, and
9045 as a by-product, by seeing the content they already owned, to discover
9046 the kind of content the users liked.
9049 To make this system function, however, MP3.com needed to copy
50,
000
9050 CDs to a server. (In principle, it could have been the user who
9051 uploaded the music, but that would have taken a great deal of time,
9052 and would have produced a product of questionable quality.) It
9053 therefore purchased
50,
000 CDs from a store, and started the process
9054 of making copies of those CDs. Again, it would not serve the content
9055 from those copies to anyone except those who authenticated that they
9056 had a copy of the CD they wanted to access. So while this was
50,
000
9057 copies, it was
50,
000 copies directed at giving customers something
9058 they had already bought.
9060 <indexterm id=
"idxvivendiuniversal" class='startofrange'
>
9061 <primary>Vivendi Universal
</primary>
9064 Nine days after MP3.com launched its service, the five major labels,
9065 headed by the RIAA, brought a lawsuit against MP3.com. MP3.com settled
9066 with four of the five. Nine months later, a federal judge found
9067 MP3.com to have been guilty of willful infringement with respect to
9068 the fifth. Applying the law as it is, the judge imposed a fine against
9069 MP3.com of $
118 million. MP3.com then settled with the remaining
9070 plaintiff, Vivendi Universal, paying over $
54 million. Vivendi
9071 purchased MP3.com just about a year later.
9074 That part of the story I have told before. Now consider its conclusion.
9077 After Vivendi purchased MP3.com, Vivendi turned around and filed a
9078 malpractice lawsuit against the lawyers who had advised it that they
9079 had a good faith claim that the service they wanted to offer would be
9080 considered legal under copyright law. This lawsuit alleged that it
9081 should have been obvious that the courts would find this behavior
9082 illegal; therefore, this lawsuit sought to punish any lawyer who had
9083 dared to suggest that the law was less restrictive than the labels
9087 The clear purpose of this lawsuit (which was settled for an
9088 unspecified amount shortly after the story was no longer covered in
9089 the press) was to send an unequivocal message to lawyers advising
9091 <!-- PAGE BREAK 200 -->
9092 space: It is not just your clients who might suffer if the content
9093 industry directs its guns against them. It is also you. So those of
9094 you who believe the law should be less restrictive should realize that
9095 such a view of the law will cost you and your firm dearly.
9097 <indexterm startref=
"idxvivendiuniversal" class='endofrange'
/>
9098 <indexterm><primary>Hummer, John
</primary></indexterm>
9099 <indexterm><primary>Barry, Hank
</primary></indexterm>
9101 This strategy is not just limited to the lawyers. In April
2003,
9102 Universal and EMI brought a lawsuit against Hummer Winblad, the
9103 venture capital firm (VC) that had funded Napster at a certain stage of
9104 its development, its cofounder ( John Hummer), and general partner
9105 (Hank Barry).
<footnote><para>
9107 See Joseph Menn, "Universal, EMI Sue Napster Investor,"
<citetitle>Los Angeles
9108 Times
</citetitle>,
23 April
2003. For a parallel argument about the effects on
9109 innovation in the distribution of music, see Janelle Brown, "The Music
9110 Revolution Will Not Be Digitized," Salon.com,
1 June
2001, available
9111 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
42</ulink>.
9112 See also Jon Healey, "Online Music Services Besieged,"
<citetitle>Los Angeles
9113 Times
</citetitle>,
28 May
2001.
9115 The claim here, as well, was that the VC should have recognized the
9116 right of the content industry to control how the industry should
9117 develop. They should be held personally liable for funding a company
9118 whose business turned out to be beyond the law. Here again, the aim of
9119 the lawsuit is transparent: Any VC now recognizes that if you fund a
9120 company whose business is not approved of by the dinosaurs, you are at
9121 risk not just in the marketplace, but in the courtroom as well. Your
9122 investment buys you not only a company, it also buys you a lawsuit.
9123 So extreme has the environment become that even car manufacturers are
9124 afraid of technologies that touch content. In an article in
<citetitle>Business
9125 2.0</citetitle>, Rafe Needleman describes a discussion with BMW:
9128 <indexterm><primary>BMW
</primary></indexterm>
9130 I asked why, with all the storage capacity and computer power in
9131 the car, there was no way to play MP3 files. I was told that BMW
9132 engineers in Germany had rigged a new vehicle to play MP3s via
9133 the car's built-in sound system, but that the company's marketing
9134 and legal departments weren't comfortable with pushing this
9135 forward for release stateside. Even today, no new cars are sold in the
9136 United States with bona fide MP3 players. . . .
<footnote>
9139 Rafe Needleman, "Driving in Cars with MP3s,"
<citetitle>Business
2.0</citetitle>,
16 June
9141 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
43</ulink>. I am grateful
9142 to Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli for this example.
9143 <indexterm><primary>Needleman, Rafe
</primary></indexterm>
9148 This is the world of the mafia
—filled with "your money or your
9149 life" offers, governed in the end not by courts but by the threats
9150 that the law empowers copyright holders to exercise. It is a system
9151 that will obviously and necessarily stifle new innovation. It is hard
9152 enough to start a company. It is impossibly hard if that company is
9153 constantly threatened by litigation.
9157 <!-- PAGE BREAK 201 -->
9158 The point is not that businesses should have a right to start illegal
9159 enterprises. The point is the definition of "illegal." The law is a mess of
9160 uncertainty. We have no good way to know how it should apply to new
9161 technologies. Yet by reversing our tradition of judicial deference, and
9162 by embracing the astonishingly high penalties that copyright law
9164 that uncertainty now yields a reality which is far more
9166 than is right. If the law imposed the death penalty for parking
9167 tickets, we'd not only have fewer parking tickets, we'd also have much
9168 less driving. The same principle applies to innovation. If innovation is
9169 constantly checked by this uncertain and unlimited liability, we will
9170 have much less vibrant innovation and much less creativity.
9173 The point is directly parallel to the crunchy-lefty point about fair
9174 use. Whatever the "real" law is, realism about the effect of law in
9175 both contexts is the same. This wildly punitive system of regulation
9176 will systematically stifle creativity and innovation. It will protect
9177 some industries and some creators, but it will harm industry and
9178 creativity generally. Free market and free culture depend upon vibrant
9179 competition. Yet the effect of the law today is to stifle just this
9180 kind of competition. The effect is to produce an overregulated
9181 culture, just as the effect of too much control in the market is to
9182 produce an overregulatedregulated market.
9185 The building of a permission culture, rather than a free culture, is
9186 the first important way in which the changes I have described will
9187 burden innovation. A permission culture means a lawyer's
9188 culture
—a culture in which the ability to create requires a call
9189 to your lawyer. Again, I am not antilawyer, at least when they're kept
9190 in their proper place. I am certainly not antilaw. But our profession
9191 has lost the sense of its limits. And leaders in our profession have
9192 lost an appreciation of the high costs that our profession imposes
9193 upon others. The inefficiency of the law is an embarrassment to our
9194 tradition. And while I believe our profession should therefore do
9195 everything it can to make the law more efficient, it should at least
9196 do everything it can to limit the reach of the
9197 <!-- PAGE BREAK 202 -->
9198 law where the law is not doing any good. The transaction costs buried
9199 within a permission culture are enough to bury a wide range of
9200 creativity. Someone needs to do a lot of justifying to justify that
9201 result. The uncertainty of the law is one burden on innovation. There
9202 is a second burden that operates more directly. This is the effort by
9203 many in the content industry to use the law to directly regulate the
9204 technology of the Internet so that it better protects their content.
9207 The motivation for this response is obvious. The Internet enables the
9208 efficient spread of content. That efficiency is a feature of the
9209 Internet's design. But from the perspective of the content industry,
9210 this feature is a "bug." The efficient spread of content means that
9211 content distributors have a harder time controlling the distribution
9212 of content. One obvious response to this efficiency is thus to make
9213 the Internet less efficient. If the Internet enables "piracy," then,
9214 this response says, we should break the kneecaps of the Internet.
9217 The examples of this form of legislation are many. At the urging of
9218 the content industry, some in Congress have threatened legislation that
9219 would require computers to determine whether the content they access
9220 is protected or not, and to disable the spread of protected content.
<footnote><para>
9221 <!-- f6. --> "Copyright and Digital Media in a Post-Napster World," GartnerG2 and
9222 the Berkman Center for Internet and Society at Harvard Law School
9223 (
2003),
33–35, available at
9224 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
44</ulink>.
9228 has already launched proceedings to explore a mandatory
9230 flag" that would be required on any device capable of transmitting
9231 digital video (i.e., a computer), and that would disable the copying of
9232 any content that is marked with a broadcast flag. Other members of
9233 Congress have proposed immunizing content providers from liability
9234 for technology they might deploy that would hunt down copyright
9236 and disable their machines.
<footnote><para>
9237 <!-- f7. --> GartnerG2,
26–27.
9242 In one sense, these solutions seem sensible. If the problem is the
9243 code, why not regulate the code to remove the problem. But any
9245 of technical infrastructure will always be tuned to the particular
9246 technology of the day. It will impose significant burdens and costs on
9248 <!-- PAGE BREAK 203 -->
9249 the technology, but will likely be eclipsed by advances around exactly
9253 In March
2002, a broad coalition of technology companies, led by
9254 Intel, tried to get Congress to see the harm that such legislation would
9255 impose.
<footnote><para>
9256 <!-- f8. --> See David McGuire, "Tech Execs Square Off Over Piracy," Newsbytes,
9257 February
2002 (Entertainment).
9259 Their argument was obviously not that copyright should not
9260 be protected. Instead, they argued, any protection should not do more
9264 There is one more obvious way in which this war has harmed
9265 innovation
—again,
9266 a story that will be quite familiar to the free market
9270 Copyright may be property, but like all property, it is also a form
9271 of regulation. It is a regulation that benefits some and harms others.
9272 When done right, it benefits creators and harms leeches. When done
9273 wrong, it is regulation the powerful use to defeat competitors.
9276 As I described in chapter
10, despite this feature of copyright as
9277 regulation, and subject to important qualifications outlined by Jessica
9278 Litman in her book
<citetitle>Digital Copyright
</citetitle>,
<footnote><para>
9279 <!-- f9. --> Jessica Litman,
<citetitle>Digital Copyright
</citetitle> (Amherst, N.Y.: Prometheus Books,
9281 <indexterm><primary>Litman, Jessica
</primary></indexterm>
9283 overall this history of copyright
9284 is not bad. As chapter
10 details, when new technologies have come
9285 along, Congress has struck a balance to assure that the new is protected
9286 from the old. Compulsory, or statutory, licenses have been one part of
9287 that strategy. Free use (as in the case of the VCR) has been another.
9290 But that pattern of deference to new technologies has now changed
9291 with the rise of the Internet. Rather than striking a balance between
9292 the claims of a new technology and the legitimate rights of content
9293 creators, both the courts and Congress have imposed legal restrictions
9294 that will have the effect of smothering the new to benefit the old.
9297 The response by the courts has been fairly universal.
<footnote><para>
9299 The only circuit court exception is found in
<citetitle>Recording Industry
9300 Association of America (RIAA)
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Diamond Multimedia Systems
</citetitle>,
180 F.
3d
9301 1072 (
9th Cir.
1999). There the court of appeals for the Ninth Circuit
9302 reasoned that makers of a portable MP3 player were not liable for
9303 contributory copyright infringement for a device that is unable to
9304 record or redistribute music (a device whose only copying function is
9305 to render portable a music file already stored on a user's hard
9306 drive). At the district court level, the only exception is found in
9307 <citetitle>Metro-Goldwyn-Mayer Studios, Inc
</citetitle>. v.
<citetitle>Grokster, Ltd
</citetitle>.,
259 F. Supp.
2d
9308 1029 (C.D. Cal.,
2003), where the court found the link between the
9309 distributor and any given user's conduct too attenuated to make the
9310 distributor liable for contributory or vicarious infringement
9313 It has been mirrored in the responses threatened and actually
9314 implemented by Congress. I won't catalog all of those responses
9315 here.
<footnote><para>
9317 For example, in July
2002, Representative Howard Berman introduced the
9318 Peer-to-Peer Piracy Prevention Act (H.R.
5211), which would immunize
9319 copyright holders from liability for damage done to computers when the
9320 copyright holders use technology to stop copyright infringement. In
9321 August
2002, Representative Billy Tauzin introduced a bill to mandate
9322 that technologies capable of rebroadcasting digital copies of films
9323 broadcast on TV (i.e., computers) respect a "broadcast flag" that
9324 would disable copying of that content. And in March of the same year,
9325 Senator Fritz Hollings introduced the Consumer Broadband and Digital
9326 Television Promotion Act, which mandated copyright protection
9327 technology in all digital media devices. See GartnerG2, "Copyright and
9328 Digital Media in a Post-Napster World,"
27 June
2003,
33–34,
9330 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
44</ulink>.
9331 <indexterm><primary>Berman, Howard L.
</primary></indexterm>
9333 But there is one example that captures the flavor of them all. This is
9334 the story of the demise of Internet radio.
9338 <!-- PAGE BREAK 204 -->
9339 As I described in chapter
4, when a radio station plays a song, the
9340 recording artist doesn't get paid for that "radio performance" unless
9341 he or she is also the composer. So, for example if Marilyn Monroe had
9342 recorded a version of "Happy Birthday"
—to memorialize her famous
9343 performance before President Kennedy at Madison Square Garden
—
9344 then whenever that recording was played on the radio, the current
9345 copyright owners of "Happy Birthday" would get some money, whereas
9346 Marilyn Monroe would not.
9349 The reasoning behind this balance struck by Congress makes some
9350 sense. The justification was that radio was a kind of advertising. The
9351 recording artist thus benefited because by playing her music, the
9352 radio station was making it more likely that her records would be
9353 purchased. Thus, the recording artist got something, even if only
9354 indirectly. Probably this reasoning had less to do with the result
9355 than with the power of radio stations: Their lobbyists were quite good
9356 at stopping any efforts to get Congress to require compensation to the
9360 Enter Internet radio. Like regular radio, Internet radio is a
9361 technology to stream content from a broadcaster to a listener. The
9362 broadcast travels across the Internet, not across the ether of radio
9363 spectrum. Thus, I can "tune in" to an Internet radio station in
9364 Berlin while sitting in San Francisco, even though there's no way for
9365 me to tune in to a regular radio station much beyond the San Francisco
9369 This feature of the architecture of Internet radio means that there
9370 are potentially an unlimited number of radio stations that a user
9371 could tune in to using her computer, whereas under the existing
9372 architecture for broadcast radio, there is an obvious limit to the
9373 number of broadcasters and clear broadcast frequencies. Internet radio
9374 could therefore be more competitive than regular radio; it could
9375 provide a wider range of selections. And because the potential
9376 audience for Internet radio is the whole world, niche stations could
9377 easily develop and market their content to a relatively large number
9378 of users worldwide. According to some estimates, more than eighty
9379 million users worldwide have tuned in to this new form of radio.
9383 <!-- PAGE BREAK 205 -->
9384 Internet radio is thus to radio what FM was to AM. It is an
9385 improvement potentially vastly more significant than the FM
9386 improvement over AM, since not only is the technology better, so, too,
9387 is the competition. Indeed, there is a direct parallel between the
9388 fight to establish FM radio and the fight to protect Internet
9389 radio. As one author describes Howard Armstrong's struggle to enable
9394 An almost unlimited number of FM stations was possible in the
9395 shortwaves, thus ending the unnatural restrictions imposed on radio in
9396 the crowded longwaves. If FM were freely developed, the number of
9397 stations would be limited only by economics and competition rather
9398 than by technical restrictions. . . . Armstrong likened the situation
9399 that had grown up in radio to that following the invention of the
9400 printing press, when governments and ruling interests attempted to
9401 control this new instrument of mass communications by imposing
9402 restrictive licenses on it. This tyranny was broken only when it
9403 became possible for men freely to acquire printing presses and freely
9404 to run them. FM in this sense was as great an invention as the
9405 printing presses, for it gave radio the opportunity to strike off its
9406 shackles.
<footnote><para>
9413 This potential for FM radio was never realized
—not
9414 because Armstrong was wrong about the technology, but because he
9415 underestimated the power of "vested interests, habits, customs and
9416 legislation"
<footnote><para>
9420 to retard the growth of this competing technology.
9423 Now the very same claim could be made about Internet radio. For
9424 again, there is no technical limitation that could restrict the number of
9425 Internet radio stations. The only restrictions on Internet radio are
9426 those imposed by the law. Copyright law is one such law. So the first
9427 question we should ask is, what copyright rules would govern Internet
9431 But here the power of the lobbyists is reversed. Internet radio is a
9432 new industry. The recording artists, on the other hand, have a very
9434 <!-- PAGE BREAK 206 -->
9435 powerful lobby, the RIAA. Thus when Congress considered the phenomenon
9436 of Internet radio in
1995, the lobbyists had primed Congress to adopt
9437 a different rule for Internet radio than the rule that applies to
9438 terrestrial radio. While terrestrial radio does not have to pay our
9439 hypothetical Marilyn Monroe when it plays her hypothetical recording
9440 of "Happy Birthday" on the air,
<emphasis>Internet radio
9441 does
</emphasis>. Not only is the law not neutral toward Internet
9442 radio
—the law actually burdens Internet radio more than it
9443 burdens terrestrial radio.
9446 This financial burden is not slight. As Harvard law professor
9447 William Fisher estimates, if an Internet radio station distributed adfree
9448 popular music to (on average) ten thousand listeners, twenty-four
9449 hours a day, the total artist fees that radio station would owe would be
9450 over $
1 million a year.
<footnote>
9453 This example was derived from fees set by the original Copyright
9454 Arbitration Royalty Panel (CARP) proceedings, and is drawn from an
9455 example offered by Professor William Fisher. Conference Proceedings,
9456 iLaw (Stanford),
3 July
2003, on file with author. Professors Fisher
9457 and Zittrain submitted testimony in the CARP proceeding that was
9458 ultimately rejected. See Jonathan Zittrain, Digital Performance Right
9459 in Sound Recordings and Ephemeral Recordings, Docket No.
2000-
9, CARP
9460 DTRA
1 and
2, available at
9461 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
45</ulink>.
9462 For an excellent analysis making a similar point, see Randal
9463 C. Picker, "Copyright as Entry Policy: The Case of Digital
9464 Distribution,"
<citetitle>Antitrust Bulletin
</citetitle> (Summer/Fall
2002):
461: "This was
9465 not confusion, these are just old-fashioned entry barriers. Analog
9466 radio stations are protected from digital entrants, reducing entry in
9467 radio and diversity. Yes, this is done in the name of getting
9468 royalties to copyright holders, but, absent the play of powerful
9469 interests, that could have been done in a media-neutral way."
9470 <indexterm><primary>CARP (Copyright Arbitration Royalty Panel)
</primary></indexterm>
9471 <indexterm><primary>Picker, Randal C.
</primary></indexterm>
9473 A regular radio station broadcasting the same content would pay no
9477 The burden is not financial only. Under the original rules that were
9478 proposed, an Internet radio station (but not a terrestrial radio
9479 station) would have to collect the following data from
<emphasis>every
9480 listening transaction
</emphasis>:
9482 <!-- PAGE BREAK 207 -->
9483 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
9485 name of the service;
9488 channel of the program (AM/FM stations use station ID);
9491 type of program (archived/looped/live);
9494 date of transmission;
9497 time of transmission;
9500 time zone of origination of transmission;
9503 numeric designation of the place of the sound recording within the program;
9506 duration of transmission (to nearest second);
9509 sound recording title;
9512 ISRC code of the recording;
9515 release year of the album per copyright notice and in the case of compilation albums, the release year of the album and copy- right date of the track;
9518 featured recording artist;
9527 UPC code of the retail album;
9533 copyright owner information;
9536 musical genre of the channel or program (station format);
9539 name of the service or entity;
9545 date and time that the user logged in (in the user's time zone);
9548 date and time that the user logged out (in the user's time zone);
9551 time zone where the signal was received (user);
9554 Unique User identifier;
9557 the country in which the user received the transmissions.
9562 The Librarian of Congress eventually suspended these reporting
9563 requirements, pending further study. And he also changed the original
9564 rates set by the arbitration panel charged with setting rates. But the
9565 basic difference between Internet radio and terrestrial radio remains:
9566 Internet radio has to pay a
<emphasis>type of copyright fee
</emphasis>
9567 that terrestrial radio does not.
9570 Why? What justifies this difference? Was there any study of the
9571 economic consequences from Internet radio that would justify these
9572 differences? Was the motive to protect artists against piracy?
9574 <indexterm><primary>Alben, Alex
</primary></indexterm>
9576 In a rare bit of candor, one RIAA expert admitted what seemed obvious
9577 to everyone at the time. As Alex Alben, vice president for Public
9578 Policy at Real Networks, told me,
9582 The RIAA, which was representing the record labels, presented
9583 some testimony about what they thought a willing buyer would
9584 pay to a willing seller, and it was much higher. It was ten times
9585 higher than what radio stations pay to perform the same songs for
9586 the same period of time. And so the attorneys representing the
9587 webcasters asked the RIAA, . . . "How do you come up with a
9589 <!-- PAGE BREAK 208 -->
9590 rate that's so much higher? Why is it worth more than radio?
9592 here we have hundreds of thousands of webcasters who
9593 want to pay, and that should establish the market rate, and if you
9594 set the rate so high, you're going to drive the small webcasters out
9598 And the RIAA experts said, "Well, we don't really model this as an
9599 industry with thousands of webcasters,
<emphasis>we think it should be
9600 an industry with, you know, five or seven big players who can pay a
9601 high rate and it's a stable, predictable market
</emphasis>." (Emphasis
9606 Translation: The aim is to use the law to eliminate competition, so
9607 that this platform of potentially immense competition, which would
9608 cause the diversity and range of content available to explode, would not
9609 cause pain to the dinosaurs of old. There is no one, on either the right
9610 or the left, who should endorse this use of the law. And yet there is
9611 practically no one, on either the right or the left, who is doing anything
9612 effective to prevent it.
9615 <section id=
"corruptingcitizens">
9616 <title>Corrupting Citizens
</title>
9618 Overregulation stifles creativity. It smothers innovation. It gives
9620 a veto over the future. It wastes the extraordinary opportunity
9621 for a democratic creativity that digital technology enables.
9624 In addition to these important harms, there is one more that was
9625 important to our forebears, but seems forgotten today. Overregulation
9626 corrupts citizens and weakens the rule of law.
9629 The war that is being waged today is a war of prohibition. As with
9630 every war of prohibition, it is targeted against the behavior of a very
9631 large number of citizens. According to
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>,
43 million
9632 Americans downloaded music in May
2002.
<footnote><para>
9633 <!-- f15. --> Mike Graziano and Lee Rainie, "The Music Downloading Deluge," Pew
9634 Internet and American Life Project (
24 April
2001), available at
9635 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
46</ulink>.
9636 The Pew Internet and American Life Project reported that
37 million
9637 Americans had downloaded music files from the Internet by early
2001.
9639 According to the RIAA,
9640 the behavior of those
43 million Americans is a felony. We thus have a
9641 set of rules that transform
20 percent of America into criminals. As the
9643 <!-- PAGE BREAK 209 -->
9644 RIAA launches lawsuits against not only the Napsters and Kazaas of
9645 the world, but against students building search engines, and
9647 against ordinary users downloading content, the technologies for
9648 sharing will advance to further protect and hide illegal use. It is an arms
9649 race or a civil war, with the extremes of one side inviting a more
9651 response by the other.
9654 The content industry's tactics exploit the failings of the American
9655 legal system. When the RIAA brought suit against Jesse Jordan, it
9656 knew that in Jordan it had found a scapegoat, not a defendant. The
9657 threat of having to pay either all the money in the world in damages
9658 ($
15,
000,
000) or almost all the money in the world to defend against
9659 paying all the money in the world in damages ($
250,
000 in legal fees)
9660 led Jordan to choose to pay all the money he had in the world
9661 ($
12,
000) to make the suit go away. The same strategy animates the
9662 RIAA's suits against individual users. In September
2003, the RIAA
9663 sued
261 individuals
—including a twelve-year-old girl living in public
9664 housing and a seventy-year-old man who had no idea what file sharing
9665 was.
<footnote><para>
9667 Alex Pham, "The Labels Strike Back: N.Y. Girl Settles RIAA Case,"
<citetitle>Los
9668 Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, Business.
9670 As these scapegoats discovered, it will always cost more to defend
9671 against these suits than it would cost to simply settle. (The twelve
9672 year old, for example, like Jesse Jordan, paid her life savings of $
2,
000
9673 to settle the case.) Our law is an awful system for defending rights. It
9674 is an embarrassment to our tradition. And the consequence of our law
9675 as it is, is that those with the power can use the law to quash any rights
9679 Wars of prohibition are nothing new in America. This one is just
9680 something more extreme than anything we've seen before. We
9681 experimented with alcohol prohibition, at a time when the per capita
9682 consumption of alcohol was
1.5 gallons per capita per year. The war
9683 against drinking initially reduced that consumption to just
30 percent
9684 of its preprohibition levels, but by the end of prohibition,
9685 consumption was up to
70 percent of the preprohibition
9686 level. Americans were drinking just about as much, but now, a vast
9687 number were criminals.
<footnote><para>
9689 Jeffrey A. Miron and Jeffrey Zwiebel, "Alcohol Consumption During
9690 Prohibition,"
<citetitle>American Economic Review
</citetitle> 81, no.
2 (
1991):
242.
9693 <!-- PAGE BREAK 210 -->
9694 launched a war on drugs aimed at reducing the consumption of regulated
9695 narcotics that
7 percent (or
16 million) Americans now use.
<footnote><para>
9697 National Drug Control Policy: Hearing Before the House Government
9698 Reform Committee,
108th Cong.,
1st sess. (
5 March
2003) (statement of
9699 John P. Walters, director of National Drug Control Policy).
9701 That is a drop from the high (so to speak) in
1979 of
14 percent of
9702 the population. We regulate automobiles to the point where the vast
9703 majority of Americans violate the law every day. We run such a complex
9704 tax system that a majority of cash businesses regularly
9705 cheat.
<footnote><para>
9707 See James Andreoni, Brian Erard, and Jonathon Feinstein, "Tax
9708 Compliance,"
<citetitle>Journal of Economic Literature
</citetitle> 36 (
1998):
818 (survey of
9709 compliance literature).
9711 We pride ourselves on our "free society," but an endless array of
9712 ordinary behavior is regulated within our society. And as a result, a
9713 huge proportion of Americans regularly violate at least some law.
9716 This state of affairs is not without consequence. It is a particularly
9717 salient issue for teachers like me, whose job it is to teach law
9718 students about the importance of "ethics." As my colleague Charlie
9719 Nesson told a class at Stanford, each year law schools admit thousands
9720 of students who have illegally downloaded music, illegally consumed
9721 alcohol and sometimes drugs, illegally worked without paying taxes,
9722 illegally driven cars. These are kids for whom behaving illegally is
9723 increasingly the norm. And then we, as law professors, are supposed to
9724 teach them how to behave ethically
—how to say no to bribes, or
9725 keep client funds separate, or honor a demand to disclose a document
9726 that will mean that your case is over. Generations of
9727 Americans
—more significantly in some parts of America than in
9728 others, but still, everywhere in America today
—can't live their
9729 lives both normally and legally, since "normally" entails a certain
9730 degree of illegality.
9733 The response to this general illegality is either to enforce the law
9734 more severely or to change the law. We, as a society, have to learn
9735 how to make that choice more rationally. Whether a law makes sense
9736 depends, in part, at least, upon whether the costs of the law, both
9737 intended and collateral, outweigh the benefits. If the costs, intended
9738 and collateral, do outweigh the benefits, then the law ought to be
9739 changed. Alternatively, if the costs of the existing system are much
9740 greater than the costs of an alternative, then we have a good reason
9741 to consider the alternative.
9745 <!-- PAGE BREAK 211 -->
9746 My point is not the idiotic one: Just because people violate a law, we
9747 should therefore repeal it. Obviously, we could reduce murder statistics
9748 dramatically by legalizing murder on Wednesdays and Fridays. But
9749 that wouldn't make any sense, since murder is wrong every day of the
9750 week. A society is right to ban murder always and everywhere.
9753 My point is instead one that democracies understood for generations,
9754 but that we recently have learned to forget. The rule of law depends
9755 upon people obeying the law. The more often, and more repeatedly, we
9756 as citizens experience violating the law, the less we respect the
9757 law. Obviously, in most cases, the important issue is the law, not
9758 respect for the law. I don't care whether the rapist respects the law
9759 or not; I want to catch and incarcerate the rapist. But I do care
9760 whether my students respect the law. And I do care if the rules of law
9761 sow increasing disrespect because of the extreme of regulation they
9762 impose. Twenty million Americans have come of age since the Internet
9763 introduced this different idea of "sharing." We need to be able to
9764 call these twenty million Americans "citizens," not "felons."
9767 When at least forty-three million citizens download content from the
9768 Internet, and when they use tools to combine that content in ways
9769 unauthorized by copyright holders, the first question we should be
9770 asking is not how best to involve the FBI. The first question should
9771 be whether this particular prohibition is really necessary in order to
9772 achieve the proper ends that copyright law serves. Is there another
9773 way to assure that artists get paid without transforming forty-three
9774 million Americans into felons? Does it make sense if there are other
9775 ways to assure that artists get paid without transforming America into
9779 This abstract point can be made more clear with a particular example.
9782 We all own CDs. Many of us still own phonograph records. These pieces
9783 of plastic encode music that in a certain sense we have bought. The
9784 law protects our right to buy and sell that plastic: It is not a
9785 copyright infringement for me to sell all my classical records at a
9788 <!-- PAGE BREAK 212 -->
9789 record store and buy jazz records to replace them. That "use" of the
9793 But as the MP3 craze has demonstrated, there is another use of
9794 phonograph records that is effectively free. Because these recordings
9795 were made without copy-protection technologies, I am "free" to copy,
9796 or "rip," music from my records onto a computer hard disk. Indeed,
9797 Apple Corporation went so far as to suggest that "freedom" was a
9798 right: In a series of commercials, Apple endorsed the "Rip, Mix, Burn"
9799 capacities of digital technologies.
9801 <indexterm><primary>Adromeda
</primary></indexterm>
9803 This "use" of my records is certainly valuable. I have begun a large
9804 process at home of ripping all of my and my wife's CDs, and storing
9805 them in one archive. Then, using Apple's iTunes, or a wonderful
9806 program called Andromeda, we can build different play lists of our
9807 music: Bach, Baroque, Love Songs, Love Songs of Significant
9808 Others
—the potential is endless. And by reducing the costs of
9809 mixing play lists, these technologies help build a creativity with
9810 play lists that is itself independently valuable. Compilations of
9811 songs are creative and meaningful in their own right.
9814 This use is enabled by unprotected media
—either CDs or records.
9815 But unprotected media also enable file sharing. File sharing threatens
9816 (or so the content industry believes) the ability of creators to earn
9817 a fair return from their creativity. And thus, many are beginning to
9818 experiment with technologies to eliminate unprotected media. These
9819 technologies, for example, would enable CDs that could not be
9820 ripped. Or they might enable spy programs to identify ripped content
9821 on people's machines.
9824 If these technologies took off, then the building of large archives of
9825 your own music would become quite difficult. You might hang in hacker
9826 circles, and get technology to disable the technologies that protect
9827 the content. Trading in those technologies is illegal, but maybe that
9828 doesn't bother you much. In any case, for the vast majority of people,
9829 these protection technologies would effectively destroy the archiving
9831 <!-- PAGE BREAK 213 -->
9832 use of CDs. The technology, in other words, would force us all back to
9833 the world where we either listened to music by manipulating pieces of
9834 plastic or were part of a massively complex "digital rights
9838 If the only way to assure that artists get paid were the elimination
9839 of the ability to freely move content, then these technologies to
9840 interfere with the freedom to move content would be justifiable. But
9841 what if there were another way to assure that artists are paid,
9842 without locking down any content? What if, in other words, a different
9843 system could assure compensation to artists while also preserving the
9844 freedom to move content easily?
9847 My point just now is not to prove that there is such a system. I offer
9848 a version of such a system in the last chapter of this book. For now,
9849 the only point is the relatively uncontroversial one: If a different
9850 system achieved the same legitimate objectives that the existing
9851 copyright system achieved, but left consumers and creators much more
9852 free, then we'd have a very good reason to pursue this
9853 alternative
—namely, freedom. The choice, in other words, would
9854 not be between property and piracy; the choice would be between
9855 different property systems and the freedoms each allowed.
9858 I believe there is a way to assure that artists are paid without
9859 turning forty-three million Americans into felons. But the salient
9860 feature of this alternative is that it would lead to a very different
9861 market for producing and distributing creativity. The dominant few,
9862 who today control the vast majority of the distribution of content in
9863 the world, would no longer exercise this extreme of control. Rather,
9864 they would go the way of the horse-drawn buggy.
9867 Except that this generation's buggy manufacturers have already saddled
9868 Congress, and are riding the law to protect themselves against this
9869 new form of competition. For them the choice is between fortythree
9870 million Americans as criminals and their own survival.
9873 It is understandable why they choose as they do. It is not
9874 understandable why we as a democracy continue to choose as we do. Jack
9876 <!-- PAGE BREAK 214 -->
9878 Valenti is charming; but not so charming as to justify giving up a
9879 tradition as deep and important as our tradition of free culture.
9880 There's one more aspect to this corruption that is particularly
9881 important to civil liberties, and follows directly from any war of
9882 prohibition. As Electronic Frontier Foundation attorney Fred von
9883 Lohmann describes, this is the "collateral damage" that "arises
9884 whenever you turn a very large percentage of the population into
9885 criminals." This is the collateral damage to civil liberties
9887 <indexterm><primary>Electronic Frontier Foundation
</primary></indexterm>
9890 "If you can treat someone as a putative lawbreaker," von Lohmann
9892 <indexterm><primary>von Lohmann, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
9896 then all of a sudden a lot of basic civil liberty protections
9897 evaporate to one degree or another. . . . If you're a copyright
9898 infringer, how can you hope to have any privacy rights? If you're a
9899 copyright infringer, how can you hope to be secure against seizures of
9900 your computer? How can you hope to continue to receive Internet
9901 access? . . . Our sensibilities change as soon as we think, "Oh, well,
9902 but that person's a criminal, a lawbreaker." Well, what this campaign
9903 against file sharing has done is turn a remarkable percentage of the
9904 American Internet-using population into "lawbreakers."
9908 And the consequence of this transformation of the American public
9909 into criminals is that it becomes trivial, as a matter of due process, to
9910 effectively erase much of the privacy most would presume.
9913 Users of the Internet began to see this generally in
2003 as the RIAA
9914 launched its campaign to force Internet service providers to turn over
9915 the names of customers who the RIAA believed were violating copyright
9916 law. Verizon fought that demand and lost. With a simple request to a
9917 judge, and without any notice to the customer at all, the identity of
9918 an Internet user is revealed.
9921 <!-- PAGE BREAK 215 -->
9922 The RIAA then expanded this campaign, by announcing a general strategy
9923 to sue individual users of the Internet who are alleged to have
9924 downloaded copyrighted music from file-sharing systems. But as we've
9925 seen, the potential damages from these suits are astronomical: If a
9926 family's computer is used to download a single CD's worth of music,
9927 the family could be liable for $
2 million in damages. That didn't stop
9928 the RIAA from suing a number of these families, just as they had sued
9929 Jesse Jordan.
<footnote><para>
9931 See Frank Ahrens, "RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised Targets; Single
9932 Mother in Calif.,
12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among Defendants,"
9933 <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, E1; Chris Cobbs, "Worried Parents
9934 Pull Plug on File `Stealing'; With the Music Industry Cracking Down on
9935 File Swapping, Parents are Yanking Software from Home PCs to Avoid
9936 Being Sued,"
<citetitle>Orlando Sentinel Tribune
</citetitle>,
30 August
2003, C1; Jefferson
9937 Graham, "Recording Industry Sues Parents,"
<citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
15 September
9938 2003,
4D; John Schwartz, "She Says She's No Music Pirate. No Snoop
9939 Fan, Either,"
<citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
25 September
2003, C1; Margo Varadi, "Is
9940 Brianna a Criminal?"
<citetitle>Toronto Star
</citetitle>,
18 September
2003, P7.
9945 Even this understates the espionage that is being waged by the
9946 RIAA. A report from CNN late last summer described a strategy the
9947 RIAA had adopted to track Napster users.
<footnote><para>
9949 See "Revealed: How RIAA Tracks Downloaders: Music Industry Discloses
9950 Some Methods Used," CNN.com, available at
9951 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
47</ulink>.
9953 Using a sophisticated hashing algorithm, the RIAA took what is in
9954 effect a fingerprint of every song in the Napster catalog. Any copy of
9955 one of those MP3s will have the same "fingerprint."
9958 So imagine the following not-implausible scenario: Imagine a
9959 friend gives a CD to your daughter
—a collection of songs just
9960 like the cassettes you used to make as a kid. You don't know, and
9961 neither does your daughter, where these songs came from. But she
9962 copies these songs onto her computer. She then takes her computer to
9963 college and connects it to a college network, and if the college
9964 network is "cooperating" with the RIAA's espionage, and she hasn't
9965 properly protected her content from the network (do you know how to do
9966 that yourself ?), then the RIAA will be able to identify your daughter
9967 as a "criminal." And under the rules that universities are beginning
9968 to deploy,
<footnote><para>
9970 See Jeff Adler, "Cambridge: On Campus, Pirates Are Not Penitent,"
9971 <citetitle>Boston Globe
</citetitle>,
18 May
2003, City Weekly,
1; Frank Ahrens, "Four
9972 Students Sued over Music Sites; Industry Group Targets File Sharing at
9973 Colleges,"
<citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
4 April
2003, E1; Elizabeth Armstrong,
9974 "Students `Rip, Mix, Burn' at Their Own Risk,"
<citetitle>Christian Science
9975 Monitor
</citetitle>,
2 September
2003,
20; Robert Becker and Angela Rozas, "Music
9976 Pirate Hunt Turns to Loyola; Two Students Names Are Handed Over;
9977 Lawsuit Possible,"
<citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
16 July
2003,
1C; Beth Cox, "RIAA
9978 Trains Antipiracy Guns on Universities,"
<citetitle>Internet News
</citetitle>,
30 January
9979 2003, available at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link
9980 #
48</ulink>; Benny Evangelista, "Download Warning
101: Freshman
9981 Orientation This Fall to Include Record Industry Warnings Against File
9982 Sharing,"
<citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
11 August
2003, E11; "Raid, Letters
9983 Are Weapons at Universities,"
<citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
26 September
2000,
3D.
9985 your daughter can lose the right to use the university's computer
9986 network. She can, in some cases, be expelled.
9989 Now, of course, she'll have the right to defend herself. You can hire
9990 a lawyer for her (at $
300 per hour, if you're lucky), and she can
9991 plead that she didn't know anything about the source of the songs or
9992 that they came from Napster. And it may well be that the university
9993 believes her. But the university might not believe her. It might treat
9994 this "contraband" as presumptive of guilt. And as any number of
9997 <!-- PAGE BREAK 216 -->
9998 have already learned, our presumptions about innocence disappear in
9999 the middle of wars of prohibition. This war is no different.
10001 <indexterm><primary>von Lohmann, Fred
</primary></indexterm>
10005 So when we're talking about numbers like forty to sixty million
10006 Americans that are essentially copyright infringers, you create a
10007 situation where the civil liberties of those people are very much in
10008 peril in a general matter. [I don't] think [there is any] analog where
10009 you could randomly choose any person off the street and be confident
10010 that they were committing an unlawful act that could put them on the
10011 hook for potential felony liability or hundreds of millions of dollars
10012 of civil liability. Certainly we all speed, but speeding isn't the
10013 kind of an act for which we routinely forfeit civil liberties. Some
10014 people use drugs, and I think that's the closest analog, [but] many
10015 have noted that the war against drugs has eroded all of our civil
10016 liberties because it's treated so many Americans as criminals. Well, I
10017 think it's fair to say that file sharing is an order of magnitude
10018 larger number of Americans than drug use. . . . If forty to sixty
10019 million Americans have become lawbreakers, then we're really on a
10020 slippery slope to lose a lot of civil liberties for all forty to sixty
10025 When forty to sixty million Americans are considered "criminals" under
10026 the law, and when the law could achieve the same objective
—
10027 securing rights to authors
—without these millions being
10028 considered "criminals," who is the villain? Americans or the law?
10029 Which is American, a constant war on our own people or a concerted
10030 effort through our democracy to change our law?
10033 <!-- PAGE BREAK 217 -->
10037 <part id=
"c-balances">
10038 <title>BALANCES
</title>
10041 <!-- PAGE BREAK 218 -->
10043 So here's the picture: You're standing at the side of the road. Your
10044 car is on fire. You are angry and upset because in part you helped start
10045 the fire. Now you don't know how to put it out. Next to you is a bucket,
10046 filled with gasoline. Obviously, gasoline won't put the fire out.
10049 As you ponder the mess, someone else comes along. In a panic, she
10050 grabs the bucket. Before you have a chance to tell her to
10051 stop
—or before she understands just why she should
10052 stop
—the bucket is in the air. The gasoline is about to hit the
10053 blazing car. And the fire that gasoline will ignite is about to ignite
10057 A war about copyright rages all around
—and we're all focusing on
10058 the wrong thing. No doubt, current technologies threaten existing
10059 businesses. No doubt they may threaten artists. But technologies
10060 change. The industry and technologists have plenty of ways to use
10061 technology to protect themselves against the current threats of the
10062 Internet. This is a fire that if let alone would burn itself out.
10065 <!-- PAGE BREAK 219 -->
10066 Yet policy makers are not willing to leave this fire to itself. Primed
10067 with plenty of lobbyists' money, they are keen to intervene to
10068 eliminate the problem they perceive. But the problem they perceive is
10069 not the real threat this culture faces. For while we watch this small
10070 fire in the corner, there is a massive change in the way culture is
10071 made that is happening all around.
10074 Somehow we have to find a way to turn attention to this more important
10075 and fundamental issue. Somehow we have to find a way to avoid pouring
10076 gasoline onto this fire.
10079 We have not found that way yet. Instead, we seem trapped in a simpler,
10080 binary view. However much many people push to frame this debate more
10081 broadly, it is the simple, binary view that remains. We rubberneck to
10082 look at the fire when we should be keeping our eyes on the road.
10085 This challenge has been my life these last few years. It has also been
10086 my failure. In the two chapters that follow, I describe one small
10087 brace of efforts, so far failed, to find a way to refocus this
10088 debate. We must understand these failures if we're to understand what
10089 success will require.
10093 <!-- PAGE BREAK 220 -->
10094 <chapter id=
"eldred">
10095 <title>CHAPTER THIRTEEN: Eldred
</title>
10097 In
1995, a father was frustrated that his daughters didn't seem to
10098 like Hawthorne. No doubt there was more than one such father, but at
10099 least one did something about it. Eric Eldred, a retired computer
10100 programmer living in New Hampshire, decided to put Hawthorne on the
10101 Web. An electronic version, Eldred thought, with links to pictures and
10102 explanatory text, would make this nineteenth-century author's work
10106 It didn't work
—at least for his daughters. They didn't find
10107 Hawthorne any more interesting than before. But Eldred's experiment
10108 gave birth to a hobby, and his hobby begat a cause: Eldred would build
10109 a library of public domain works by scanning these works and making
10110 them available for free.
10113 Eldred's library was not simply a copy of certain public domain
10114 works, though even a copy would have been of great value to people
10115 across the world who can't get access to printed versions of these
10116 works. Instead, Eldred was producing derivative works from these
10117 public domain works. Just as Disney turned Grimm into stories more
10118 <!-- PAGE BREAK 221 -->
10119 accessible to the twentieth century, Eldred transformed Hawthorne, and
10120 many others, into a form more accessible
—technically
10121 accessible
—today.
10124 Eldred's freedom to do this with Hawthorne's work grew from the same
10125 source as Disney's. Hawthorne's
<citetitle>Scarlet Letter
</citetitle> had passed into the
10126 public domain in
1907. It was free for anyone to take without the
10127 permission of the Hawthorne estate or anyone else. Some, such as Dover
10128 Press and Penguin Classics, take works from the public domain and
10129 produce printed editions, which they sell in bookstores across the
10130 country. Others, such as Disney, take these stories and turn them into
10131 animated cartoons, sometimes successfully (
<citetitle>Cinderella
</citetitle>), sometimes not
10132 (
<citetitle>The Hunchback of Notre Dame
</citetitle>,
<citetitle>Treasure Planet
</citetitle>). These are all
10133 commercial publications of public domain works.
10136 The Internet created the possibility of noncommercial publications of
10137 public domain works. Eldred's is just one example. There are literally
10138 thousands of others. Hundreds of thousands from across the world have
10139 discovered this platform of expression and now use it to share works
10140 that are, by law, free for the taking. This has produced what we might
10141 call the "noncommercial publishing industry," which before the
10142 Internet was limited to people with large egos or with political or
10143 social causes. But with the Internet, it includes a wide range of
10144 individuals and groups dedicated to spreading culture
10145 generally.
<footnote><para>
10147 There's a parallel here with pornography that is a bit hard to
10148 describe, but it's a strong one. One phenomenon that the Internet
10149 created was a world of noncommercial pornographers
—people who
10150 were distributing porn but were not making money directly or
10151 indirectly from that distribution. Such a class didn't exist before
10152 the Internet came into being because the costs of distributing porn
10153 were so high. Yet this new class of distributors got special attention
10154 in the Supreme Court, when the Court struck down the Communications
10155 Decency Act of
1996. It was partly because of the burden on
10156 noncommercial speakers that the statute was found to exceed Congress's
10157 power. The same point could have been made about noncommercial
10158 publishers after the advent of the Internet. The Eric Eldreds of the
10159 world before the Internet were extremely few. Yet one would think it
10160 at least as important to protect the Eldreds of the world as to
10161 protect noncommercial pornographers.
</para></footnote>
10164 As I said, Eldred lives in New Hampshire. In
1998, Robert Frost's
10165 collection of poems
<citetitle>New Hampshire
</citetitle> was slated to pass into the public
10166 domain. Eldred wanted to post that collection in his free public
10167 library. But Congress got in the way. As I described in chapter
10,
10168 in
1998, for the eleventh time in forty years, Congress extended the
10169 terms of existing copyrights
—this time by twenty years. Eldred
10170 would not be free to add any works more recent than
1923 to his
10171 collection until
2019. Indeed, no copyrighted work would pass into
10172 the public domain until that year (and not even then, if Congress
10173 extends the term again). By contrast, in the same period, more than
1
10174 million patents will pass into the public domain.
10178 <!-- PAGE BREAK 222 -->
10179 This was the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act
10180 (CTEA), enacted in memory of the congressman and former musician
10181 Sonny Bono, who, his widow, Mary Bono, says, believed that
10182 "copyrights should be forever."
<footnote><para>
10184 The full text is: "Sonny [Bono] wanted the term of copyright
10185 protection to last forever. I am informed by staff that such a change
10186 would violate the Constitution. I invite all of you to work with me to
10187 strengthen our copyright laws in all of the ways available to us. As
10188 you know, there is also Jack Valenti's proposal for a term to last
10189 forever less one day. Perhaps the Committee may look at that next
10190 Congress,"
144 Cong. Rec. H9946,
9951-
2 (October
7,
1998).
10195 Eldred decided to fight this law. He first resolved to fight it through
10196 civil disobedience. In a series of interviews, Eldred announced that he
10197 would publish as planned, CTEA notwithstanding. But because of a
10198 second law passed in
1998, the NET (No Electronic Theft) Act, his act
10199 of publishing would make Eldred a felon
—whether or not anyone
10200 complained. This was a dangerous strategy for a disabled programmer
10204 It was here that I became involved in Eldred's battle. I was a
10206 scholar whose first passion was constitutional
10208 And though constitutional law courses never focus upon the
10209 Progress Clause of the Constitution, it had always struck me as
10211 different. As you know, the Constitution says,
10215 Congress has the power to promote the Progress of Science . . .
10216 by securing for limited Times to Authors . . . exclusive Right to
10217 their . . . Writings. . . .
10221 As I've described, this clause is unique within the power-granting
10222 clause of Article I, section
8 of our Constitution. Every other clause
10223 granting power to Congress simply says Congress has the power to do
10224 something
—for example, to regulate "commerce among the several
10225 states" or "declare War." But here, the "something" is something quite
10226 specific
—to "promote . . . Progress"
—through means that
10227 are also specific
— by "securing" "exclusive Rights" (i.e.,
10228 copyrights) "for limited Times."
10231 In the past forty years, Congress has gotten into the practice of
10232 extending existing terms of copyright protection. What puzzled me
10233 about this was, if Congress has the power to extend existing terms,
10234 then the Constitution's requirement that terms be "limited" will have
10235 <!-- PAGE BREAK 223 -->
10236 no practical effect. If every time a copyright is about to expire,
10237 Congress has the power to extend its term, then Congress can achieve
10238 what the Constitution plainly forbids
—perpetual terms "on the
10239 installment plan," as Professor Peter Jaszi so nicely put it.
10240 <indexterm><primary>Jaszi, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
10243 As an academic, my first response was to hit the books. I remember
10244 sitting late at the office, scouring on-line databases for any serious
10245 consideration of the question. No one had ever challenged Congress's
10246 practice of extending existing terms. That failure may in part be why
10247 Congress seemed so untroubled in its habit. That, and the fact that
10248 the practice had become so lucrative for Congress. Congress knows that
10249 copyright owners will be willing to pay a great deal of money to see
10250 their copyright terms extended. And so Congress is quite happy to keep
10251 this gravy train going.
10254 For this is the core of the corruption in our present system of
10255 government. "Corruption" not in the sense that representatives are
10256 bribed. Rather, "corruption" in the sense that the system induces the
10257 beneficiaries of Congress's acts to raise and give money to Congress
10258 to induce it to act. There's only so much time; there's only so much
10259 Congress can do. Why not limit its actions to those things it must
10260 do
—and those things that pay? Extending copyright terms pays.
10263 If that's not obvious to you, consider the following: Say you're one
10264 of the very few lucky copyright owners whose copyright continues to
10265 make money one hundred years after it was created. The Estate of
10266 Robert Frost is a good example. Frost died in
1963. His poetry
10267 continues to be extraordinarily valuable. Thus the Robert Frost estate
10268 benefits greatly from any extension of copyright, since no publisher
10269 would pay the estate any money if the poems Frost wrote could be
10270 published by anyone for free.
10273 So imagine the Robert Frost estate is earning $
100,
000 a year from
10274 three of Frost's poems. And imagine the copyright for those poems
10275 is about to expire. You sit on the board of the Robert Frost estate.
10276 Your financial adviser comes to your board meeting with a very grim
10280 "Next year," the adviser announces, "our copyrights in works A, B,
10282 <!-- PAGE BREAK 224 -->
10283 and C will expire. That means that after next year, we will no longer be
10284 receiving the annual royalty check of $
100,
000 from the publishers of
10288 "There's a proposal in Congress, however," she continues, "that
10289 could change this. A few congressmen are floating a bill to extend the
10290 terms of copyright by twenty years. That bill would be extraordinarily
10291 valuable to us. So we should hope this bill passes."
10294 "Hope?" a fellow board member says. "Can't we be doing something
10298 "Well, obviously, yes," the adviser responds. "We could contribute
10299 to the campaigns of a number of representatives to try to assure that
10300 they support the bill."
10303 You hate politics. You hate contributing to campaigns. So you want
10304 to know whether this disgusting practice is worth it. "How much
10305 would we get if this extension were passed?" you ask the adviser. "How
10309 "Well," the adviser says, "if you're confident that you will continue
10310 to get at least $
100,
000 a year from these copyrights, and you use the
10311 `discount rate' that we use to evaluate estate investments (
6 percent),
10312 then this law would be worth $
1,
146,
000 to the estate."
10315 You're a bit shocked by the number, but you quickly come to the
10316 correct conclusion:
10319 "So you're saying it would be worth it for us to pay more than
10320 $
1,
000,
000 in campaign contributions if we were confident those
10322 would assure that the bill was passed?"
10325 "Absolutely," the adviser responds. "It is worth it to you to
10327 up to the `present value' of the income you expect from these
10328 copyrights. Which for us means over $
1,
000,
000."
10331 You quickly get the point
—you as the member of the board and, I
10332 trust, you the reader. Each time copyrights are about to expire, every
10333 beneficiary in the position of the Robert Frost estate faces the same
10334 choice: If they can contribute to get a law passed to extend copyrights,
10335 <!-- PAGE BREAK 225 -->
10336 they will benefit greatly from that extension. And so each time
10338 are about to expire, there is a massive amount of lobbying to get
10339 the copyright term extended.
10342 Thus a congressional perpetual motion machine: So long as legislation
10343 can be bought (albeit indirectly), there will be all the incentive in
10344 the world to buy further extensions of copyright.
10347 In the lobbying that led to the passage of the Sonny Bono
10349 Term Extension Act, this "theory" about incentives was proved
10350 real. Ten of the thirteen original sponsors of the act in the House
10351 received the maximum contribution from Disney's political action
10352 committee; in the Senate, eight of the twelve sponsors received
10353 contributions.
<footnote><para>
10354 <!-- f3. --> Associated Press, "Disney Lobbying for Copyright Extension No Mickey
10355 Mouse Effort; Congress OKs Bill Granting Creators
20 More Years,"
10356 <citetitle>Chicago Tribune
</citetitle>,
17 October
1998,
22.
10358 The RIAA and the MPAA are estimated to have spent over
10359 $
1.5 million lobbying in the
1998 election cycle. They paid out more
10360 than $
200,
000 in campaign contributions.
<footnote><para>
10361 <!-- f4. --> See Nick Brown, "Fair Use No More?: Copyright in the Information
10363 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
49</ulink>.
10365 Disney is estimated to have
10366 contributed more than $
800,
000 to reelection campaigns in the
10367 cycle.
<footnote><para>
10369 Alan K. Ota, "Disney in Washington: The Mouse That Roars,"
10370 <citetitle>Congressional Quarterly This Week
</citetitle>,
8 August
1990, available at
10371 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
50</ulink>.
10376 Constitutional law is not oblivious to the obvious. Or at least,
10377 it need not be. So when I was considering Eldred's complaint, this
10379 about the never-ending incentives to increase the copyright term
10380 was central to my thinking. In my view, a pragmatic court committed
10381 to interpreting and applying the Constitution of our framers would see
10382 that if Congress has the power to extend existing terms, then there
10383 would be no effective constitutional requirement that terms be
10385 If they could extend it once, they would extend it again and again
10389 It was also my judgment that
<emphasis>this
</emphasis> Supreme Court
10390 would not allow Congress to extend existing terms. As anyone close to
10391 the Supreme Court's work knows, this Court has increasingly restricted
10392 the power of Congress when it has viewed Congress's actions as
10393 exceeding the power granted to it by the Constitution. Among
10394 constitutional scholars, the most famous example of this trend was the
10397 <!-- PAGE BREAK 226 -->
10398 decision in
1995 to strike down a law that banned the possession of
10402 Since
1937, the Supreme Court had interpreted Congress's granted
10403 powers very broadly; so, while the Constitution grants Congress the
10404 power to regulate only "commerce among the several states" (aka
10406 commerce"), the Supreme Court had interpreted that power to
10407 include the power to regulate any activity that merely affected
10412 As the economy grew, this standard increasingly meant that there was
10413 no limit to Congress's power to regulate, since just about every
10414 activity, when considered on a national scale, affects interstate
10415 commerce. A Constitution designed to limit Congress's power was
10416 instead interpreted to impose no limit.
10419 The Supreme Court, under Chief Justice Rehnquist's command, changed
10420 that in
<citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. The government had
10421 argued that possessing guns near schools affected interstate
10422 commerce. Guns near schools increase crime, crime lowers property
10423 values, and so on. In the oral argument, the Chief Justice asked the
10424 government whether there was any activity that would not affect
10425 interstate commerce under the reasoning the government advanced. The
10426 government said there was not; if Congress says an activity affects
10427 interstate commerce, then that activity affects interstate
10428 commerce. The Supreme Court, the government said, was not in the
10429 position to second-guess Congress.
10432 "We pause to consider the implications of the government's arguments,"
10433 the Chief Justice wrote.
<footnote><para>
10434 <!-- f6. --> <citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>,
514 U.S.
549,
564 (
1995).
10436 If anything Congress says is interstate commerce must therefore be
10437 considered interstate commerce, then there would be no limit to
10438 Congress's power. The decision in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> was reaffirmed five years
10439 later in
<citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Morrison
</citetitle>.
<footnote><para>
10441 <citetitle>United States
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Morrison
</citetitle>,
529 U.S.
598 (
2000).
10445 If a principle were at work here, then it should apply to the Progress
10446 Clause as much as the Commerce Clause.
<footnote><para>
10448 If it is a principle about enumerated powers, then the principle
10449 carries from one enumerated power to another. The animating point in
10450 the context of the Commerce Clause was that the interpretation offered
10451 by the government would allow the government unending power to
10452 regulate commerce
—the limitation to interstate commerce
10453 notwithstanding. The same point is true in the context of the
10454 Copyright Clause. Here, too, the government's interpretation would
10455 allow the government unending power to regulate copyrights
—the
10456 limitation to "limited times" notwithstanding.
10458 And if it is applied to the Progress Clause, the principle should
10459 yield the conclusion that Congress
10460 <!-- PAGE BREAK 227 -->
10461 can't extend an existing term. If Congress could extend an existing
10462 term, then there would be no "stopping point" to Congress's power over
10463 terms, though the Constitution expressly states that there is such a
10464 limit. Thus, the same principle applied to the power to grant
10465 copyrights should entail that Congress is not allowed to extend the
10466 term of existing copyrights.
10469 <emphasis>If
</emphasis>, that is, the principle announced in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>
10470 stood for a principle. Many believed the decision in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> stood for
10471 politics
—a conservative Supreme Court, which believed in states'
10472 rights, using its power over Congress to advance its own personal
10473 political preferences. But I rejected that view of the Supreme Court's
10474 decision. Indeed, shortly after the decision, I wrote an article
10475 demonstrating the "fidelity" in such an interpretation of the
10476 Constitution. The idea that the Supreme Court decides cases based upon
10477 its politics struck me as extraordinarily boring. I was not going to
10478 devote my life to teaching constitutional law if these nine Justices
10479 were going to be petty politicians.
10482 Now let's pause for a moment to make sure we understand what the
10483 argument in
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was not about. By insisting on the
10484 Constitution's limits to copyright, obviously Eldred was not endorsing
10485 piracy. Indeed, in an obvious sense, he was fighting a kind of
10486 piracy
—piracy of the public domain. When Robert Frost wrote his
10487 work and when Walt Disney created Mickey Mouse, the maximum copyright
10488 term was just fifty-six years. Because of interim changes, Frost and
10489 Disney had already enjoyed a seventy-five-year monopoly for their
10490 work. They had gotten the benefit of the bargain that the Constitution
10491 envisions: In exchange for a monopoly protected for fifty-six years,
10492 they created new work. But now these entities were using their
10493 power
—expressed through the power of lobbyists' money
—to
10494 get another twenty-year dollop of monopoly. That twenty-year dollop
10495 would be taken from the public domain. Eric Eldred was fighting a
10496 piracy that affects us all.
10499 Some people view the public domain with contempt. In their brief
10501 <!-- PAGE BREAK 228 -->
10502 before the Supreme Court, the Nashville Songwriters Association
10503 wrote that the public domain is nothing more than "legal piracy."
<footnote><para>
10505 Brief of the Nashville Songwriters Association,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle>
10506 v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618), n
.10, available
10507 at
<ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
51</ulink>.
10509 But it is not piracy when the law allows it; and in our constitutional
10510 system, our law requires it. Some may not like the Constitution's
10511 requirements, but that doesn't make the Constitution a pirate's
10515 As we've seen, our constitutional system requires limits on
10517 as a way to assure that copyright holders do not too heavily
10519 the development and distribution of our culture. Yet, as Eric
10520 Eldred discovered, we have set up a system that assures that copyright
10521 terms will be repeatedly extended, and extended, and extended. We
10522 have created the perfect storm for the public domain. Copyrights have
10523 not expired, and will not expire, so long as Congress is free to be
10524 bought to extend them again.
10527 It is valuable copyrights that are responsible for terms being
10529 Mickey Mouse and "Rhapsody in Blue." These works are too
10530 valuable for copyright owners to ignore. But the real harm to our
10532 from copyright extensions is not that Mickey Mouse remains
10534 Forget Mickey Mouse. Forget Robert Frost. Forget all the works
10535 from the
1920s and
1930s that have continuing commercial value. The
10536 real harm of term extension comes not from these famous works. The
10537 real harm is to the works that are not famous, not commercially
10539 and no longer available as a result.
10542 If you look at the work created in the first twenty years (
1923 to
10543 1942) affected by the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act,
10544 2 percent of that work has any continuing commercial value. It was the
10545 copyright holders for that
2 percent who pushed the CTEA through.
10546 But the law and its effect were not limited to that
2 percent. The law
10547 extended the terms of copyright generally.
<footnote><para>
10548 <!-- f10. --> The figure of
2 percent is an extrapolation from the study by the
10550 Research Service, in light of the estimated renewal ranges. See Brief
10551 of Petitioners,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
7, available at
10552 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
52</ulink>.
10557 Think practically about the consequence of this
10558 extension
—practically,
10559 as a businessperson, and not as a lawyer eager for more legal
10561 <!-- PAGE BREAK 229 -->
10562 work. In
1930,
10,
047 books were published. In
2000,
174 of those
10563 books were still in print. Let's say you were Brewster Kahle, and you
10564 wanted to make available to the world in your iArchive project the
10566 9,
873. What would you have to do?
10569 Well, first, you'd have to determine which of the
9,
873 books were
10570 still under copyright. That requires going to a library (these data are
10571 not on-line) and paging through tomes of books, cross-checking the
10572 titles and authors of the
9,
873 books with the copyright registration
10573 and renewal records for works published in
1930. That will produce a
10574 list of books still under copyright.
10577 Then for the books still under copyright, you would need to locate
10578 the current copyright owners. How would you do that?
10581 Most people think that there must be a list of these copyright
10583 somewhere. Practical people think this way. How could there be
10584 thousands and thousands of government monopolies without there
10585 being at least a list?
10588 But there is no list. There may be a name from
1930, and then in
10589 1959, of the person who registered the copyright. But just think
10591 about how impossibly difficult it would be to track down
10593 of such records
—especially since the person who registered is
10594 not necessarily the current owner. And we're just talking about
1930!
10597 "But there isn't a list of who owns property generally," the
10598 apologists for the system respond. "Why should there be a list of
10602 Well, actually, if you think about it, there
<emphasis>are
</emphasis>
10603 plenty of lists of who owns what property. Think about deeds on
10604 houses, or titles to cars. And where there isn't a list, the code of
10605 real space is pretty good at suggesting who the owner of a bit of
10606 property is. (A swing set in your backyard is probably yours.) So
10607 formally or informally, we have a pretty good way to know who owns
10608 what tangible property.
10611 So: You walk down a street and see a house. You can know who
10612 owns the house by looking it up in the courthouse registry. If you see
10613 a car, there is ordinarily a license plate that will link the owner to the
10615 <!-- PAGE BREAK 230 -->
10616 car. If you see a bunch of children's toys sitting on the front lawn of a
10617 house, it's fairly easy to determine who owns the toys. And if you
10619 to see a baseball lying in a gutter on the side of the road, look
10620 around for a second for some kids playing ball. If you don't see any
10621 kids, then okay: Here's a bit of property whose owner we can't easily
10622 determine. It is the exception that proves the rule: that we ordinarily
10623 know quite well who owns what property.
10626 Compare this story to intangible property. You go into a library.
10627 The library owns the books. But who owns the copyrights? As I've
10629 described, there's no list of copyright owners. There are authors'
10630 names, of course, but their copyrights could have been assigned, or
10631 passed down in an estate like Grandma's old jewelry. To know who
10632 owns what, you would have to hire a private detective. The bottom
10633 line: The owner cannot easily be located. And in a regime like ours, in
10634 which it is a felony to use such property without the property owner's
10635 permission, the property isn't going to be used.
10638 The consequence with respect to old books is that they won't be
10639 digitized, and hence will simply rot away on shelves. But the
10641 for other creative works is much more dire.
10643 <indexterm><primary>Agee, Michael
</primary></indexterm>
10645 Consider the story of Michael Agee, chairman of Hal Roach Studios,
10646 which owns the copyrights for the Laurel and Hardy films. Agee is a
10647 direct beneficiary of the Bono Act. The Laurel and Hardy films were
10648 made between
1921 and
1951. Only one of these films,
<citetitle>The Lucky Dog
</citetitle>, is
10649 currently out of copyright. But for the CTEA, films made after
1923
10650 would have begun entering the public domain. Because Agee controls the
10651 exclusive rights for these popular films, he makes a great deal of
10652 money. According to one estimate, "Roach has sold about
60,
000
10653 videocassettes and
50,
000 DVDs of the duo's silent
10654 films."
<footnote><para>
10656 See David G. Savage, "High Court Scene of Showdown on Copyright Law,"
10657 <citetitle>Los Angeles Times
</citetitle>,
6 October
2002; David Streitfeld, "Classic Movies,
10658 Songs, Books at Stake; Supreme Court Hears Arguments Today on Striking
10659 Down Copyright Extension,"
<citetitle>Orlando Sentinel Tribune
</citetitle>,
9 October
2002.
10662 <indexterm><primary>Lucky Dog, The
</primary></indexterm>
10665 Yet Agee opposed the CTEA. His reasons demonstrate a rare virtue in
10666 this culture: selflessness. He argued in a brief before the Supreme
10667 Court that the Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act will, if left
10668 standing, destroy a whole generation of American film.
10671 His argument is straightforward. A tiny fraction of this work has
10673 <!-- PAGE BREAK 231 -->
10674 any continuing commercial value. The rest
—to the extent it
10675 survives at all
—sits in vaults gathering dust. It may be that
10676 some of this work not now commercially valuable will be deemed to be
10677 valuable by the owners of the vaults. For this to occur, however, the
10678 commercial benefit from the work must exceed the costs of making the
10679 work available for distribution.
10682 We can't know the benefits, but we do know a lot about the costs.
10683 For most of the history of film, the costs of restoring film were very
10684 high; digital technology has lowered these costs substantially. While
10685 it cost more than $
10,
000 to restore a ninety-minute black-and-white
10686 film in
1993, it can now cost as little as $
100 to digitize one hour of
10687 mm film.
<footnote><para>
10689 Brief of Hal Roach Studios and Michael Agee as Amicus Curiae
10690 Supporting the Petitoners,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537
10691 U.S.
186 (
2003) (No.
01-
618),
12. See also Brief of Amicus Curiae
10692 filed on behalf of Petitioners by the Internet Archive,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle>
10693 v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>, available at
10694 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
53</ulink>.
10699 Restoration technology is not the only cost, nor the most
10701 Lawyers, too, are a cost, and increasingly, a very important one. In
10702 addition to preserving the film, a distributor needs to secure the rights.
10703 And to secure the rights for a film that is under copyright, you need to
10704 locate the copyright owner.
10707 Or more accurately,
<emphasis>owners
</emphasis>. As we've seen, there
10708 isn't only a single copyright associated with a film; there are
10709 many. There isn't a single person whom you can contact about those
10710 copyrights; there are as many as can hold the rights, which turns out
10711 to be an extremely large number. Thus the costs of clearing the rights
10712 to these films is exceptionally high.
10715 "But can't you just restore the film, distribute it, and then pay the
10716 copyright owner when she shows up?" Sure, if you want to commit a
10717 felony. And even if you're not worried about committing a felony, when
10718 she does show up, she'll have the right to sue you for all the profits you
10719 have made. So, if you're successful, you can be fairly confident you'll be
10720 getting a call from someone's lawyer. And if you're not successful, you
10721 won't make enough to cover the costs of your own lawyer. Either way,
10722 you have to talk to a lawyer. And as is too often the case, saying you have
10723 to talk to a lawyer is the same as saying you won't make any money.
10726 For some films, the benefit of releasing the film may well exceed
10728 <!-- PAGE BREAK 232 -->
10729 these costs. But for the vast majority of them, there is no way the
10731 would outweigh the legal costs. Thus, for the vast majority of old
10732 films, Agee argued, the film will not be restored and distributed until
10733 the copyright expires.
10736 But by the time the copyright for these films expires, the film will
10737 have expired. These films were produced on nitrate-based stock, and
10738 nitrate stock dissolves over time. They will be gone, and the metal
10740 in which they are now stored will be filled with nothing more
10744 Of all the creative work produced by humans anywhere, a tiny
10745 fraction has continuing commercial value. For that tiny fraction, the
10746 copyright is a crucially important legal device. For that tiny fraction,
10747 the copyright creates incentives to produce and distribute the
10749 work. For that tiny fraction, the copyright acts as an "engine of
10753 But even for that tiny fraction, the actual time during which the
10754 creative work has a commercial life is extremely short. As I've
10756 most books go out of print within one year. The same is true of
10757 music and film. Commercial culture is sharklike. It must keep moving.
10758 And when a creative work falls out of favor with the commercial
10760 the commercial life ends.
10763 Yet that doesn't mean the life of the creative work ends. We don't
10764 keep libraries of books in order to compete with Barnes
& Noble, and
10765 we don't have archives of films because we expect people to choose
10767 spending Friday night watching new movies and spending
10769 night watching a
1930 news documentary. The noncommercial life
10770 of culture is important and valuable
—for entertainment but also, and
10771 more importantly, for knowledge. To understand who we are, and
10772 where we came from, and how we have made the mistakes that we
10773 have, we need to have access to this history.
10776 Copyrights in this context do not drive an engine of free expression.
10778 <!-- PAGE BREAK 233 -->
10779 In this context, there is no need for an exclusive right. Copyrights in
10780 this context do no good.
10783 Yet, for most of our history, they also did little harm. For most of
10784 our history, when a work ended its commercial life, there was no
10785 <emphasis>copyright-related use
</emphasis> that would be inhibited by
10786 an exclusive right. When a book went out of print, you could not buy
10787 it from a publisher. But you could still buy it from a used book
10788 store, and when a used book store sells it, in America, at least,
10789 there is no need to pay the copyright owner anything. Thus, the
10790 ordinary use of a book after its commercial life ended was a use that
10791 was independent of copyright law.
10794 The same was effectively true of film. Because the costs of restoring
10795 a film
—the real economic costs, not the lawyer costs
—were
10796 so high, it was never at all feasible to preserve or restore
10797 film. Like the remains of a great dinner, when it's over, it's
10798 over. Once a film passed out of its commercial life, it may have been
10799 archived for a bit, but that was the end of its life so long as the
10800 market didn't have more to offer.
10803 In other words, though copyright has been relatively short for most
10804 of our history, long copyrights wouldn't have mattered for the works
10805 that lost their commercial value. Long copyrights for these works
10806 would not have interfered with anything.
10809 But this situation has now changed.
10812 One crucially important consequence of the emergence of digital
10813 technologies is to enable the archive that Brewster Kahle dreams of.
10814 Digital technologies now make it possible to preserve and give access
10815 to all sorts of knowledge. Once a book goes out of print, we can now
10816 imagine digitizing it and making it available to everyone,
10817 forever. Once a film goes out of distribution, we could digitize it
10818 and make it available to everyone, forever. Digital technologies give
10819 new life to copyrighted material after it passes out of its commercial
10820 life. It is now possible to preserve and assure universal access to
10821 this knowledge and culture, whereas before it was not.
10824 <!-- PAGE BREAK 234 -->
10825 And now copyright law does get in the way. Every step of producing
10826 this digital archive of our culture infringes on the exclusive right
10827 of copyright. To digitize a book is to copy it. To do that requires
10828 permission of the copyright owner. The same with music, film, or any
10829 other aspect of our culture protected by copyright. The effort to make
10830 these things available to history, or to researchers, or to those who
10831 just want to explore, is now inhibited by a set of rules that were
10832 written for a radically different context.
10835 Here is the core of the harm that comes from extending terms: Now that
10836 technology enables us to rebuild the library of Alexandria, the law
10837 gets in the way. And it doesn't get in the way for any useful
10838 <emphasis>copyright
</emphasis> purpose, for the purpose of copyright
10839 is to enable the commercial market that spreads culture. No, we are
10840 talking about culture after it has lived its commercial life. In this
10841 context, copyright is serving no purpose
<emphasis>at all
</emphasis>
10842 related to the spread of knowledge. In this context, copyright is not
10843 an engine of free expression. Copyright is a brake.
10846 You may well ask, "But if digital technologies lower the costs for
10847 Brewster Kahle, then they will lower the costs for Random House, too.
10848 So won't Random House do as well as Brewster Kahle in spreading
10852 Maybe. Someday. But there is absolutely no evidence to suggest that
10853 publishers would be as complete as libraries. If Barnes
& Noble
10854 offered to lend books from its stores for a low price, would that
10855 eliminate the need for libraries? Only if you think that the only role
10856 of a library is to serve what "the market" would demand. But if you
10857 think the role of a library is bigger than this
—if you think its
10858 role is to archive culture, whether there's a demand for any
10859 particular bit of that culture or not
—then we can't count on the
10860 commercial market to do our library work for us.
10863 I would be the first to agree that it should do as much as it can: We
10864 should rely upon the market as much as possible to spread and enable
10865 culture. My message is absolutely not antimarket. But where we see the
10866 market is not doing the job, then we should allow nonmarket forces the
10868 <!-- PAGE BREAK 235 -->
10869 freedom to fill the gaps. As one researcher calculated for American
10870 culture,
94 percent of the films, books, and music produced between
10871 and
1946 is not commercially available. However much you love the
10872 commercial market, if access is a value, then
6 percent is a failure
10873 to provide that value.
<footnote><para>
10875 Jason Schultz, "The Myth of the
1976 Copyright `Chaos' Theory,"
20
10876 December
2002, available at
10877 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
54</ulink>.
10882 In January
1999, we filed a lawsuit on Eric Eldred's behalf in federal
10883 district court in Washington, D.C., asking the court to declare the
10884 Sonny Bono Copyright Term Extension Act unconstitutional. The two
10885 central claims that we made were (
1) that extending existing terms
10886 violated the Constitution's "limited Times" requirement, and (
2) that
10887 extending terms by another twenty years violated the First Amendment.
10890 The district court dismissed our claims without even hearing an
10891 argument. A panel of the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit also
10892 dismissed our claims, though after hearing an extensive argument. But
10893 that decision at least had a dissent, by one of the most conservative
10894 judges on that court. That dissent gave our claims life.
10897 Judge David Sentelle said the CTEA violated the requirement that
10898 copyrights be for "limited Times" only. His argument was as elegant as
10899 it was simple: If Congress can extend existing terms, then there is no
10900 "stopping point" to Congress's power under the Copyright Clause. The
10901 power to extend existing terms means Congress is not required to grant
10902 terms that are "limited." Thus, Judge Sentelle argued, the court had
10903 to interpret the term "limited Times" to give it meaning. And the best
10904 interpretation, Judge Sentelle argued, would be to deny Congress the
10905 power to extend existing terms.
10908 We asked the Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit as a whole to
10909 hear the case. Cases are ordinarily heard in panels of three, except for
10910 important cases or cases that raise issues specific to the circuit as a
10911 whole, where the court will sit "en banc" to hear the case.
10914 The Court of Appeals rejected our request to hear the case en banc.
10915 This time, Judge Sentelle was joined by the most liberal member of the
10917 <!-- PAGE BREAK 236 -->
10918 D.C. Circuit, Judge David Tatel. Both the most conservative and the
10919 most liberal judges in the D.C. Circuit believed Congress had
10920 overstepped its bounds.
10923 It was here that most expected Eldred v. Ashcroft would die, for the
10924 Supreme Court rarely reviews any decision by a court of appeals. (It
10925 hears about one hundred cases a year, out of more than five thousand
10926 appeals.) And it practically never reviews a decision that upholds a
10927 statute when no other court has yet reviewed the statute.
10930 But in February
2002, the Supreme Court surprised the world by
10931 granting our petition to review the D.C. Circuit opinion. Argument
10932 was set for October of
2002. The summer would be spent writing
10933 briefs and preparing for argument.
10936 It is over a year later as I write these words. It is still
10937 astonishingly hard. If you know anything at all about this story, you
10938 know that we lost the appeal. And if you know something more than just
10939 the minimum, you probably think there was no way this case could have
10940 been won. After our defeat, I received literally thousands of missives
10941 by well-wishers and supporters, thanking me for my work on behalf of
10942 this noble but doomed cause. And none from this pile was more
10943 significant to me than the e-mail from my client, Eric Eldred.
10946 But my client and these friends were wrong. This case could have
10947 been won. It should have been won. And no matter how hard I try to
10948 retell this story to myself, I can never escape believing that my own
10951 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey
</primary></indexterm>
10953 The mistake was made early, though it became obvious only at the very
10954 end. Our case had been supported from the very beginning by an
10955 extraordinary lawyer, Geoffrey Stewart, and by the law firm he had
10956 moved to, Jones, Day, Reavis and Pogue. Jones Day took a great deal of
10958 <!-- PAGE BREAK 237 -->
10959 from its copyright-protectionist clients for supporting us. They
10960 ignored this pressure (something that few law firms today would ever
10961 do), and throughout the case, they gave it everything they could.
10963 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
10964 <indexterm><primary>Bromberg, Dan
</primary></indexterm>
10965 <indexterm><primary>Steward, Geoffrey
</primary></indexterm>
10967 There were three key lawyers on the case from Jones Day. Geoff
10968 Stewart was the first, but then Dan Bromberg and Don Ayer became
10969 quite involved. Bromberg and Ayer in particular had a common view
10970 about how this case would be won: We would only win, they repeatedly
10971 told me, if we could make the issue seem "important" to the Supreme
10972 Court. It had to seem as if dramatic harm were being done to free
10973 speech and free culture; otherwise, they would never vote against "the
10974 most powerful media companies in the world."
10977 I hate this view of the law. Of course I thought the Sonny Bono Act
10978 was a dramatic harm to free speech and free culture. Of course I still
10979 think it is. But the idea that the Supreme Court decides the law based
10980 on how important they believe the issues are is just wrong. It might be
10981 "right" as in "true," I thought, but it is "wrong" as in "it just shouldn't be
10982 that way." As I believed that any faithful interpretation of what the
10983 framers of our Constitution did would yield the conclusion that the
10984 CTEA was unconstitutional, and as I believed that any faithful
10986 of what the First Amendment means would yield the
10987 conclusion that the power to extend existing copyright terms is
10989 I was not persuaded that we had to sell our case like soap.
10990 Just as a law that bans the swastika is unconstitutional not because the
10991 Court likes Nazis but because such a law would violate the
10993 so too, in my view, would the Court decide whether Congress's
10994 law was constitutional based on the Constitution, not based on whether
10995 they liked the values that the framers put in the Constitution.
10998 In any case, I thought, the Court must already see the danger and
10999 the harm caused by this sort of law. Why else would they grant review?
11000 There was no reason to hear the case in the Supreme Court if they
11001 weren't convinced that this regulation was harmful. So in my view, we
11002 didn't need to persuade them that this law was bad, we needed to show
11003 why it was unconstitutional.
11006 There was one way, however, in which I felt politics would matter
11008 <!-- PAGE BREAK 238 -->
11009 and in which I thought a response was appropriate. I was convinced
11010 that the Court would not hear our arguments if it thought these were
11011 just the arguments of a group of lefty loons. This Supreme Court was
11012 not about to launch into a new field of judicial review if it seemed
11013 that this field of review was simply the preference of a small
11014 political minority. Although my focus in the case was not to
11015 demonstrate how bad the Sonny Bono Act was but to demonstrate that it
11016 was unconstitutional, my hope was to make this argument against a
11017 background of briefs that covered the full range of political
11018 views. To show that this claim against the CTEA was grounded in
11019 <emphasis>law
</emphasis> and not politics, then, we tried to gather
11020 the widest range of credible critics
—credible not because they
11021 were rich and famous, but because they, in the aggregate, demonstrated
11022 that this law was unconstitutional regardless of one's politics.
11025 The first step happened all by itself. Phyllis Schlafly's
11026 organization, Eagle Forum, had been an opponent of the CTEA from the
11027 very beginning. Mrs. Schlafly viewed the CTEA as a sellout by
11028 Congress. In November
1998, she wrote a stinging editorial attacking
11029 the Republican Congress for allowing the law to pass. As she wrote,
11030 "Do you sometimes wonder why bills that create a financial windfall to
11031 narrow special interests slide easily through the intricate
11032 legislative process, while bills that benefit the general public seem
11033 to get bogged down?" The answer, as the editorial documented, was the
11034 power of money. Schlafly enumerated Disney's contributions to the key
11035 players on the committees. It was money, not justice, that gave Mickey
11036 Mouse twenty more years in Disney's control, Schlafly argued.
11037 <indexterm><primary>Eagle Forum
</primary></indexterm>
11038 <indexterm><primary>Schlafly, Phyllis
</primary></indexterm>
11041 In the Court of Appeals, Eagle Forum was eager to file a brief
11042 supporting our position. Their brief made the argument that became the
11043 core claim in the Supreme Court: If Congress can extend the term of
11044 existing copyrights, there is no limit to Congress's power to set
11045 terms. That strong conservative argument persuaded a strong
11046 conservative judge, Judge Sentelle.
11049 In the Supreme Court, the briefs on our side were about as diverse as
11050 it gets. They included an extraordinary historical brief by the Free
11052 <!-- PAGE BREAK 239 -->
11053 Software Foundation (home of the GNU project that made GNU/ Linux
11054 possible). They included a powerful brief about the costs of
11055 uncertainty by Intel. There were two law professors' briefs, one by
11056 copyright scholars and one by First Amendment scholars. There was an
11057 exhaustive and uncontroverted brief by the world's experts in the
11058 history of the Progress Clause. And of course, there was a new brief
11059 by Eagle Forum, repeating and strengthening its arguments.
11060 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
11061 <indexterm><primary>Eagle Forum
</primary></indexterm>
11064 Those briefs framed a legal argument. Then to support the legal
11065 argument, there were a number of powerful briefs by libraries and
11066 archives, including the Internet Archive, the American Association of
11067 Law Libraries, and the National Writers Union.
11070 But two briefs captured the policy argument best. One made the
11071 argument I've already described: A brief by Hal Roach Studios argued
11072 that unless the law was struck, a whole generation of American film
11073 would disappear. The other made the economic argument absolutely
11076 <indexterm><primary>Akerlof, George
</primary></indexterm>
11077 <indexterm><primary>Arrow, Kenneth
</primary></indexterm>
11078 <indexterm><primary>Buchanan, James
</primary></indexterm>
11079 <indexterm><primary>Coase, Ronald
</primary></indexterm>
11080 <indexterm><primary>Friedman, Milton
</primary></indexterm>
11082 This economists' brief was signed by seventeen economists, including
11083 five Nobel Prize winners, including Ronald Coase, James Buchanan,
11084 Milton Friedman, Kenneth Arrow, and George Akerlof. The economists, as
11085 the list of Nobel winners demonstrates, spanned the political
11086 spectrum. Their conclusions were powerful: There was no plausible
11087 claim that extending the terms of existing copyrights would do
11088 anything to increase incentives to create. Such extensions were
11089 nothing more than "rent-seeking"
—the fancy term economists use
11090 to describe special-interest legislation gone wild.
11093 The same effort at balance was reflected in the legal team we gathered
11094 to write our briefs in the case. The Jones Day lawyers had been with
11095 us from the start. But when the case got to the Supreme Court, we
11096 added three lawyers to help us frame this argument to this Court: Alan
11097 Morrison, a lawyer from Public Citizen, a Washington group that had
11098 made constitutional history with a series of seminal victories in the
11099 Supreme Court defending individual rights; my colleague and dean,
11100 Kathleen Sullivan, who had argued many cases in the Court, and
11102 <!-- PAGE BREAK 240 -->
11103 who had advised us early on about a First Amendment strategy; and
11104 finally, former solicitor general Charles Fried.
11105 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11108 Fried was a special victory for our side. Every other former solicitor
11109 general was hired by the other side to defend Congress's power to give
11110 media companies the special favor of extended copyright terms. Fried
11111 was the only one who turned down that lucrative assignment to stand up
11112 for something he believed in. He had been Ronald Reagan's chief lawyer
11113 in the Supreme Court. He had helped craft the line of cases that
11114 limited Congress's power in the context of the Commerce Clause. And
11115 while he had argued many positions in the Supreme Court that I
11116 personally disagreed with, his joining the cause was a vote of
11117 confidence in our argument.
11118 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11121 The government, in defending the statute, had its collection of
11122 friends, as well. Significantly, however, none of these "friends" included
11123 historians or economists. The briefs on the other side of the case were
11124 written exclusively by major media companies, congressmen, and
11128 The media companies were not surprising. They had the most to gain
11129 from the law. The congressmen were not surprising either
—they
11130 were defending their power and, indirectly, the gravy train of
11131 contributions such power induced. And of course it was not surprising
11132 that the copyright holders would defend the idea that they should
11133 continue to have the right to control who did what with content they
11137 Dr. Seuss's representatives, for example, argued that it was
11138 better for the Dr. Seuss estate to control what happened to
11139 Dr. Seuss's work
— better than allowing it to fall into the
11140 public domain
—because if this creativity were in the public
11141 domain, then people could use it to "glorify drugs or to create
11142 pornography."
<footnote><para>
11144 Brief of Amici Dr. Seuss Enterprise et al.,
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>,
537
11145 U.S. (
2003) (No.
01-
618),
19.
11147 That was also the motive of the Gershwin estate, which defended its
11148 "protection" of the work of George Gershwin. They refuse, for example,
11149 to license
<citetitle>Porgy and Bess
</citetitle> to anyone who refuses to use African
11150 Americans in the cast.
<footnote><para>
11152 Dinitia Smith, "Immortal Words, Immortal Royalties? Even Mickey
11153 Mouse Joins the Fray,"
<citetitle>New York Times
</citetitle>,
28 March
1998, B7.
11156 <!-- PAGE BREAK 241 -->
11157 their view of how this part of American culture should be controlled,
11158 and they wanted this law to help them effect that control.
11159 <indexterm><primary>Gershwin, George
</primary></indexterm>
11162 This argument made clear a theme that is rarely noticed in this
11163 debate. When Congress decides to extend the term of existing
11164 copyrights, Congress is making a choice about which speakers it will
11165 favor. Famous and beloved copyright owners, such as the Gershwin
11166 estate and Dr. Seuss, come to Congress and say, "Give us twenty years
11167 to control the speech about these icons of American culture. We'll do
11168 better with them than anyone else." Congress of course likes to reward
11169 the popular and famous by giving them what they want. But when
11170 Congress gives people an exclusive right to speak in a certain way,
11171 that's just what the First Amendment is traditionally meant to block.
11174 We argued as much in a final brief. Not only would upholding the CTEA
11175 mean that there was no limit to the power of Congress to extend
11176 copyrights
—extensions that would further concentrate the market;
11177 it would also mean that there was no limit to Congress's power to play
11178 favorites, through copyright, with who has the right to speak.
11179 Between February and October, there was little I did beyond preparing
11180 for this case. Early on, as I said, I set the strategy.
11183 The Supreme Court was divided into two important camps. One
11184 camp we called "the Conservatives." The other we called "the Rest."
11185 The Conservatives included Chief Justice Rehnquist, Justice O'Connor,
11186 Justice Scalia, Justice Kennedy, and Justice Thomas. These five had
11187 been the most consistent in limiting Congress's power. They were the
11188 five who had supported the
<citetitle>Lopez/Morrison
</citetitle> line of cases that said that
11189 an enumerated power had to be interpreted to assure that Congress's
11192 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11194 The Rest were the four Justices who had strongly opposed limits on
11195 Congress's power. These four
—Justice Stevens, Justice Souter,
11196 Justice Ginsburg, and Justice Breyer
—had repeatedly argued that
11198 <!-- PAGE BREAK 242 -->
11199 gives Congress broad discretion to decide how best to implement its
11200 powers. In case after case, these justices had argued that the Court's
11201 role should be one of deference. Though the votes of these four
11202 justices were the votes that I personally had most consistently agreed
11203 with, they were also the votes that we were least likely to get.
11206 In particular, the least likely was Justice Ginsburg's. In addition to
11207 her general view about deference to Congress (except where issues of
11208 gender are involved), she had been particularly deferential in the
11209 context of intellectual property protections. She and her daughter (an
11210 excellent and well-known intellectual property scholar) were cut from
11211 the same intellectual property cloth. We expected she would agree with
11212 the writings of her daughter: that Congress had the power in this
11213 context to do as it wished, even if what Congress wished made little
11216 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11218 Close behind Justice Ginsburg were two justices whom we also viewed as
11219 unlikely allies, though possible surprises. Justice Souter strongly
11220 favored deference to Congress, as did Justice Breyer. But both were
11221 also very sensitive to free speech concerns. And as we strongly
11222 believed, there was a very important free speech argument against
11223 these retrospective extensions.
11226 The only vote we could be confident about was that of Justice
11227 Stevens. History will record Justice Stevens as one of the greatest
11228 judges on this Court. His votes are consistently eclectic, which just
11229 means that no simple ideology explains where he will stand. But he
11230 had consistently argued for limits in the context of intellectual property
11231 generally. We were fairly confident he would recognize limits here.
11234 This analysis of "the Rest" showed most clearly where our focus
11235 had to be: on the Conservatives. To win this case, we had to crack open
11236 these five and get at least a majority to go our way. Thus, the single
11238 argument that animated our claim rested on the Conservatives'
11239 most important jurisprudential innovation
—the argument that Judge
11240 Sentelle had relied upon in the Court of Appeals, that Congress's power
11241 must be interpreted so that its enumerated powers have limits.
11244 This then was the core of our strategy
—a strategy for which I am
11245 responsible. We would get the Court to see that just as with the
11246 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>
11248 <!-- PAGE BREAK 243 -->
11249 case, under the government's argument here, Congress would always have
11250 unlimited power to extend existing terms. If anything was plain about
11251 Congress's power under the Progress Clause, it was that this power was
11252 supposed to be "limited." Our aim would be to get the Court to
11253 reconcile
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> with
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>: If Congress's power to
11254 regulate commerce was limited, then so, too, must Congress's power to
11255 regulate copyright be limited.
11258 The argument on the government's side came down to this: Congress has
11259 done it before. It should be allowed to do it again. The government
11260 claimed that from the very beginning, Congress has been extending the
11261 term of existing copyrights. So, the government argued, the Court
11262 should not now say that practice is unconstitutional.
11265 There was some truth to the government's claim, but not much. We
11266 certainly agreed that Congress had extended existing terms in
11267 and in
1909. And of course, in
1962, Congress began extending
11269 terms regularly
—eleven times in forty years.
11272 But this "consistency" should be kept in perspective. Congress
11274 existing terms once in the first hundred years of the Republic.
11275 It then extended existing terms once again in the next fifty. Those rare
11276 extensions are in contrast to the now regular practice of extending
11278 terms. Whatever restraint Congress had had in the past, that
11280 was now gone. Congress was now in a cycle of extensions; there
11281 was no reason to expect that cycle would end. This Court had not
11283 to intervene where Congress was in a similar cycle of extension.
11284 There was no reason it couldn't intervene here.
11285 Oral argument was scheduled for the first week in October. I
11287 in D.C. two weeks before the argument. During those two
11288 weeks, I was repeatedly "mooted" by lawyers who had volunteered to
11290 <!-- PAGE BREAK 244 -->
11291 help in the case. Such "moots" are basically practice rounds, where
11292 wannabe justices fire questions at wannabe winners.
11295 I was convinced that to win, I had to keep the Court focused on a
11296 single point: that if this extension is permitted, then there is no limit to
11297 the power to set terms. Going with the government would mean that
11298 terms would be effectively unlimited; going with us would give
11300 a clear line to follow: Don't extend existing terms. The moots
11301 were an effective practice; I found ways to take every question back to
11304 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11306 One moot was before the lawyers at Jones Day. Don Ayer was the
11307 skeptic. He had served in the Reagan Justice Department with Solicitor
11308 General Charles Fried. He had argued many cases before the Supreme
11309 Court. And in his review of the moot, he let his concern speak:
11310 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11313 "I'm just afraid that unless they really see the harm, they won't be
11314 willing to upset this practice that the government says has been a
11315 consistent practice for two hundred years. You have to make them see
11316 the harm
—passionately get them to see the harm. For if they
11317 don't see that, then we haven't any chance of winning."
11319 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11321 He may have argued many cases before this Court, I thought, but
11322 he didn't understand its soul. As a clerk, I had seen the Justices do the
11323 right thing
—not because of politics but because it was right. As a law
11324 professor, I had spent my life teaching my students that this Court
11325 does the right thing
—not because of politics but because it is right. As
11326 I listened to Ayer's plea for passion in pressing politics, I understood
11327 his point, and I rejected it. Our argument was right. That was enough.
11328 Let the politicians learn to see that it was also good.
11329 The night before the argument, a line of people began to form
11330 in front of the Supreme Court. The case had become a focus of the
11331 press and of the movement to free culture. Hundreds stood in line
11333 <!-- PAGE BREAK 245 -->
11334 for the chance to see the proceedings. Scores spent the night on the
11335 Supreme Court steps so that they would be assured a seat.
11338 Not everyone has to wait in line. People who know the Justices can
11339 ask for seats they control. (I asked Justice Scalia's chambers for seats for
11340 my parents, for example.) Members of the Supreme Court bar can get
11341 a seat in a special section reserved for them. And senators and
11343 have a special place where they get to sit, too. And finally, of
11344 course, the press has a gallery, as do clerks working for the Justices on
11345 the Court. As we entered that morning, there was no place that was
11346 not taken. This was an argument about intellectual property law, yet
11347 the halls were filled. As I walked in to take my seat at the front of the
11348 Court, I saw my parents sitting on the left. As I sat down at the table,
11349 I saw Jack Valenti sitting in the special section ordinarily reserved for
11350 family of the Justices.
11353 When the Chief Justice called me to begin my argument, I began
11354 where I intended to stay: on the question of the limits on Congress's
11355 power. This was a case about enumerated powers, I said, and whether
11356 those enumerated powers had any limit.
11359 Justice O'Connor stopped me within one minute of my opening.
11360 The history was bothering her.
11364 justice o'connor: Congress has extended the term so often
11365 through the years, and if you are right, don't we run the risk of
11366 upsetting previous extensions of time? I mean, this seems to be a
11367 practice that began with the very first act.
11371 She was quite willing to concede "that this flies directly in the face
11372 of what the framers had in mind." But my response again and again
11373 was to emphasize limits on Congress's power.
11377 mr. lessig: Well, if it flies in the face of what the framers had in
11378 mind, then the question is, is there a way of interpreting their
11379 <!-- PAGE BREAK 246 -->
11380 words that gives effect to what they had in mind, and the answer
11385 There were two points in this argument when I should have seen
11386 where the Court was going. The first was a question by Justice
11387 Kennedy, who observed,
11391 justice kennedy: Well, I suppose implicit in the argument that
11392 the '
76 act, too, should have been declared void, and that we
11393 might leave it alone because of the disruption, is that for all these
11394 years the act has impeded progress in science and the useful arts.
11395 I just don't see any empirical evidence for that.
11399 Here follows my clear mistake. Like a professor correcting a
11405 mr. lessig: Justice, we are not making an empirical claim at all.
11406 Nothing in our Copyright Clause claim hangs upon the empirical
11407 assertion about impeding progress. Our only argument is this is a
11408 structural limit necessary to assure that what would be an effectively
11409 perpetual term not be permitted under the copyright laws.
11412 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11414 That was a correct answer, but it wasn't the right answer. The right
11415 answer was instead that there was an obvious and profound harm. Any
11416 number of briefs had been written about it. He wanted to hear it. And
11417 here was the place Don Ayer's advice should have mattered. This was a
11418 softball; my answer was a swing and a miss.
11421 The second came from the Chief, for whom the whole case had been
11422 crafted. For the Chief Justice had crafted the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> ruling,
11423 and we hoped that he would see this case as its second cousin.
11426 It was clear a second into his question that he wasn't at all
11427 sympathetic. To him, we were a bunch of anarchists. As he asked:
11429 <!-- PAGE BREAK 247 -->
11433 chief justice: Well, but you want more than that. You want the
11434 right to copy verbatim other people's books, don't you?
11437 mr. lessig: We want the right to copy verbatim works that
11438 should be in the public domain and would be in the public
11440 but for a statute that cannot be justified under ordinary First
11441 Amendment analysis or under a proper reading of the limits built
11442 into the Copyright Clause.
11446 Things went better for us when the government gave its argument;
11447 for now the Court picked up on the core of our claim. As Justice Scalia
11448 asked Solicitor General Olson,
11452 justice scalia: You say that the functional equivalent of an unlimited
11453 time would be a violation [of the Constitution], but that's precisely
11454 the argument that's being made by petitioners here, that a limited
11455 time which is extendable is the functional equivalent of an unlimited
11460 When Olson was finished, it was my turn to give a closing rebuttal.
11461 Olson's flailing had revived my anger. But my anger still was directed
11462 to the academic, not the practical. The government was arguing as if
11463 this were the first case ever to consider limits on Congress's
11464 Copyright and Patent Clause power. Ever the professor and not the
11465 advocate, I closed by pointing out the long history of the Court
11466 imposing limits on Congress's power in the name of the Copyright and
11467 Patent Clause
— indeed, the very first case striking a law of
11468 Congress as exceeding a specific enumerated power was based upon the
11469 Copyright and Patent Clause. All true. But it wasn't going to move the
11473 As I left the court that day, I knew there were a hundred points I
11474 wished I could remake. There were a hundred questions I wished I had
11476 <!-- PAGE BREAK 248 -->
11477 answered differently. But one way of thinking about this case left me
11481 The government had been asked over and over again, what is the limit?
11482 Over and over again, it had answered there is no limit. This was
11483 precisely the answer I wanted the Court to hear. For I could not
11484 imagine how the Court could understand that the government believed
11485 Congress's power was unlimited under the terms of the Copyright
11486 Clause, and sustain the government's argument. The solicitor general
11487 had made my argument for me. No matter how often I tried, I could not
11488 understand how the Court could find that Congress's power under the
11489 Commerce Clause was limited, but under the Copyright Clause,
11490 unlimited. In those rare moments when I let myself believe that we may
11491 have prevailed, it was because I felt this Court
—in particular,
11492 the Conservatives
—would feel itself constrained by the rule of
11493 law that it had established elsewhere.
11496 The morning of January
15,
2003, I was five minutes late to the office
11497 and missed the
7:
00 A.M. call from the Supreme Court clerk. Listening to
11498 the message, I could tell in an instant that she had bad news to report.The
11499 Supreme Court had affirmed the decision of the Court of Appeals. Seven
11500 justices had voted in the majority. There were two dissents.
11503 A few seconds later, the opinions arrived by e-mail. I took the
11504 phone off the hook, posted an announcement to our blog, and sat
11505 down to see where I had been wrong in my reasoning.
11508 My
<emphasis>reasoning
</emphasis>. Here was a case that pitted all the
11509 money in the world against
<emphasis>reasoning
</emphasis>. And here
11510 was the last naïve law professor, scouring the pages, looking for
11514 I first scoured the opinion, looking for how the Court would
11515 distinguish the principle in this case from the principle in
11516 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. The argument was nowhere to be found. The case was not even
11517 cited. The argument that was the core argument of our case did not
11518 even appear in the Court's opinion.
11522 <!-- PAGE BREAK 249 -->
11523 Justice Ginsburg simply ignored the enumerated powers argument.
11524 Consistent with her view that Congress's power was not limited
11525 generally, she had found Congress's power not limited here.
11528 Her opinion was perfectly reasonable
—for her, and for Justice
11529 Souter. Neither believes in
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle>. It would be too much to expect them
11530 to write an opinion that recognized, much less explained, the doctrine
11531 they had worked so hard to defeat.
11534 But as I realized what had happened, I couldn't quite believe what I
11535 was reading. I had said there was no way this Court could reconcile
11536 limited powers with the Commerce Clause and unlimited powers with the
11537 Progress Clause. It had never even occurred to me that they could
11538 reconcile the two simply
<emphasis>by not addressing the
11539 argument
</emphasis>. There was no inconsistency because they would not
11540 talk about the two together. There was therefore no principle that
11541 followed from the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> case: In that context, Congress's power would
11542 be limited, but in this context it would not.
11545 Yet by what right did they get to choose which of the framers' values
11546 they would respect? By what right did they
—the silent
11547 five
—get to select the part of the Constitution they would
11548 enforce based on the values they thought important? We were right back
11549 to the argument that I said I hated at the start: I had failed to
11550 convince them that the issue here was important, and I had failed to
11551 recognize that however much I might hate a system in which the Court
11552 gets to pick the constitutional values that it will respect, that is
11553 the system we have.
11555 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11557 Justices Breyer and Stevens wrote very strong dissents. Stevens's
11558 opinion was crafted internal to the law: He argued that the tradition
11559 of intellectual property law should not support this unjustified
11560 extension of terms. He based his argument on a parallel analysis that
11561 had governed in the context of patents (so had we). But the rest of
11562 the Court discounted the parallel
—without explaining how the
11563 very same words in the Progress Clause could come to mean totally
11564 different things depending upon whether the words were about patents
11565 or copyrights. The Court let Justice Stevens's charge go unanswered.
11567 <indexterm><primary>Breyer, Stephen
</primary></indexterm>
11569 <!-- PAGE BREAK 250 -->
11570 Justice Breyer's opinion, perhaps the best opinion he has ever
11571 written, was external to the Constitution. He argued that the term of
11572 copyrights has become so long as to be effectively unlimited. We had
11573 said that under the current term, a copyright gave an author
99.8
11574 percent of the value of a perpetual term. Breyer said we were wrong,
11575 that the actual number was
99.9997 percent of a perpetual term. Either
11576 way, the point was clear: If the Constitution said a term had to be
11577 "limited," and the existing term was so long as to be effectively
11578 unlimited, then it was unconstitutional.
11581 These two justices understood all the arguments we had made. But
11582 because neither believed in the
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> case, neither was willing to push
11583 it as a reason to reject this extension. The case was decided without
11584 anyone having addressed the argument that we had carried from Judge
11585 Sentelle. It was
<citetitle>Hamlet
</citetitle> without the Prince.
11588 Defeat brings depression. They say it is a sign of health when
11589 depression gives way to anger. My anger came quickly, but it didn't cure
11590 the depression. This anger was of two sorts.
11593 It was first anger with the five "Conservatives." It would have been
11594 one thing for them to have explained why the principle of
<citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> didn't
11595 apply in this case. That wouldn't have been a very convincing
11596 argument, I don't believe, having read it made by others, and having
11597 tried to make it myself. But it at least would have been an act of
11598 integrity. These justices in particular have repeatedly said that the
11599 proper mode of interpreting the Constitution is "originalism"
—to
11600 first understand the framers' text, interpreted in their context, in
11601 light of the structure of the Constitution. That method had produced
11602 <citetitle>Lopez
</citetitle> and many other "originalist" rulings. Where was their
11606 Here, they had joined an opinion that never once tried to explain
11607 what the framers had meant by crafting the Progress Clause as they
11608 did; they joined an opinion that never once tried to explain how the
11609 structure of that clause would affect the interpretation of Congress's
11611 <!-- PAGE BREAK 251 -->
11612 power. And they joined an opinion that didn't even try to explain why
11613 this grant of power could be unlimited, whereas the Commerce Clause
11614 would be limited. In short, they had joined an opinion that did not
11615 apply to, and was inconsistent with, their own method for interpreting
11616 the Constitution. This opinion may well have yielded a result that
11617 they liked. It did not produce a reason that was consistent with their
11621 My anger with the Conservatives quickly yielded to anger with
11623 For I had let a view of the law that I liked interfere with a view of
11626 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11628 Most lawyers, and most law professors, have little patience for
11629 idealism about courts in general and this Supreme Court in particular.
11630 Most have a much more pragmatic view. When Don Ayer said that this
11631 case would be won based on whether I could convince the Justices that
11632 the framers' values were important, I fought the idea, because I
11633 didn't want to believe that that is how this Court decides. I insisted
11634 on arguing this case as if it were a simple application of a set of
11635 principles. I had an argument that followed in logic. I didn't need
11636 to waste my time showing it should also follow in popularity.
11639 As I read back over the transcript from that argument in October, I
11640 can see a hundred places where the answers could have taken the
11641 conversation in different directions, where the truth about the harm
11642 that this unchecked power will cause could have been made clear to
11643 this Court. Justice Kennedy in good faith wanted to be shown. I,
11644 idiotically, corrected his question. Justice Souter in good faith
11645 wanted to be shown the First Amendment harms. I, like a math teacher,
11646 reframed the question to make the logical point. I had shown them how
11647 they could strike this law of Congress if they wanted to. There were a
11648 hundred places where I could have helped them want to, yet my
11649 stubbornness, my refusal to give in, stopped me. I have stood before
11650 hundreds of audiences trying to persuade; I have used passion in that
11651 effort to persuade; but I
11652 <!-- PAGE BREAK 252 -->
11653 refused to stand before this audience and try to persuade with the
11654 passion I had used elsewhere. It was not the basis on which a court
11655 should decide the issue.
11657 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11659 Would it have been different if I had argued it differently? Would it
11660 have been different if Don Ayer had argued it? Or Charles Fried? Or
11662 <indexterm><primary>Fried, Charles
</primary></indexterm>
11665 My friends huddled around me to insist it would not. The Court
11666 was not ready, my friends insisted. This was a loss that was destined. It
11667 would take a great deal more to show our society why our framers were
11668 right. And when we do that, we will be able to show that Court.
11671 Maybe, but I doubt it. These Justices have no financial interest in
11672 doing anything except the right thing. They are not lobbied. They have
11673 little reason to resist doing right. I can't help but think that if I had
11674 stepped down from this pretty picture of dispassionate justice, I could
11678 And even if I couldn't, then that doesn't excuse what happened in
11679 January. For at the start of this case, one of America's leading
11680 intellectual property professors stated publicly that my bringing this
11681 case was a mistake. "The Court is not ready," Peter Jaszi said; this
11682 issue should not be raised until it is.
11683 <indexterm><primary>Jaszi, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
11686 After the argument and after the decision, Peter said to me, and
11687 publicly, that he was wrong. But if indeed that Court could not have
11688 been persuaded, then that is all the evidence that's needed to know that
11689 here again Peter was right. Either I was not ready to argue this case in
11690 a way that would do some good or they were not ready to hear this case
11691 in a way that would do some good. Either way, the decision to bring
11692 this case
—a decision I had made four years before
—was wrong.
11693 While the reaction to the Sonny Bono Act itself was almost
11694 unanimously negative, the reaction to the Court's decision was mixed.
11695 No one, at least in the press, tried to say that extending the term of
11696 copyright was a good idea. We had won that battle over ideas. Where
11698 <!-- PAGE BREAK 253 -->
11699 the decision was praised, it was praised by papers that had been
11700 skeptical of the Court's activism in other cases. Deference was a good
11701 thing, even if it left standing a silly law. But where the decision
11702 was attacked, it was attacked because it left standing a silly and
11703 harmful law.
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle> wrote in its editorial,
11707 In effect, the Supreme Court's decision makes it likely that we are
11708 seeing the beginning of the end of public domain and the birth of
11709 copyright perpetuity. The public domain has been a grand experiment,
11710 one that should not be allowed to die. The ability to draw freely on
11711 the entire creative output of humanity is one of the reasons we live
11712 in a time of such fruitful creative ferment.
11716 The best responses were in the cartoons. There was a gaggle of
11717 hilarious images
—of Mickey in jail and the like. The best, from
11718 my view of the case, was Ruben Bolling's, reproduced on the next
11719 page. The "powerful and wealthy" line is a bit unfair. But the punch
11720 in the face felt exactly like that.
11721 <indexterm><primary>Bolling, Ruben
</primary></indexterm>
11724 The image that will always stick in my head is that evoked by the
11725 quote from
<citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle>. That "grand experiment" we call the
11726 "public domain" is over? When I can make light of it, I think, "Honey,
11727 I shrunk the Constitution." But I can rarely make light of it. We had
11728 in our Constitution a commitment to free culture. In the case that I
11729 fathered, the Supreme Court effectively renounced that commitment. A
11730 better lawyer would have made them see differently.
11732 <!-- PAGE BREAK 254 -->
11734 <chapter id=
"eldred-ii">
11735 <title>CHAPTER FOURTEEN: Eldred II
</title>
11737 The day
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was decided, fate would have it that I was to travel to
11738 Washington, D.C. (The day the rehearing petition in
<citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> was
11739 denied
—meaning the case was really finally over
—fate would
11740 have it that I was giving a speech to technologists at Disney World.)
11741 This was a particularly long flight to my least favorite city. The
11742 drive into the city from Dulles was delayed because of traffic, so I
11743 opened up my computer and wrote an op-ed piece.
11745 <indexterm><primary>Ayer, Don
</primary></indexterm>
11747 It was an act of contrition. During the whole of the flight from San
11748 Francisco to Washington, I had heard over and over again in my head
11749 the same advice from Don Ayer: You need to make them see why it is
11750 important. And alternating with that command was the question of
11751 Justice Kennedy: "For all these years the act has impeded progress in
11752 science and the useful arts. I just don't see any empirical evidence for
11753 that." And so, having failed in the argument of constitutional principle,
11754 finally, I turned to an argument of politics.
11757 <citetitle>The New York Times
</citetitle> published the piece. In it, I proposed a simple
11758 fix: Fifty years after a work has been published, the copyright owner
11759 <!-- PAGE BREAK 256 -->
11760 would be required to register the work and pay a small fee. If he paid
11761 the fee, he got the benefit of the full term of copyright. If he did not,
11762 the work passed into the public domain.
11765 We called this the Eldred Act, but that was just to give it a name.
11766 Eric Eldred was kind enough to let his name be used once again, but as
11767 he said early on, it won't get passed unless it has another name.
11770 Or another two names. For depending upon your perspective, this
11771 is either the "Public Domain Enhancement Act" or the "Copyright
11772 Term Deregulation Act." Either way, the essence of the idea is clear
11773 and obvious: Remove copyright where it is doing nothing except
11774 blocking access and the spread of knowledge. Leave it for as long as
11775 Congress allows for those works where its worth is at least $
1. But for
11776 everything else, let the content go.
11778 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
11780 The reaction to this idea was amazingly strong. Steve Forbes endorsed
11781 it in an editorial. I received an avalanche of e-mail and letters
11782 expressing support. When you focus the issue on lost creativity,
11783 people can see the copyright system makes no sense. As a good
11784 Republican might say, here government regulation is simply getting in
11785 the way of innovation and creativity. And as a good Democrat might
11786 say, here the government is blocking access and the spread of
11787 knowledge for no good reason. Indeed, there is no real difference
11788 between Democrats and Republicans on this issue. Anyone can recognize
11789 the stupid harm of the present system.
11792 Indeed, many recognized the obvious benefit of the registration
11793 requirement. For one of the hardest things about the current system
11794 for people who want to license content is that there is no obvious
11795 place to look for the current copyright owners. Since registration is
11796 not required, since marking content is not required, since no
11797 formality at all is required, it is often impossibly hard to locate
11798 copyright owners to ask permission to use or license their work. This
11799 system would lower these costs, by establishing at least one registry
11800 where copyright owners could be identified.
11802 <indexterm><primary>Berlin Act (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
11803 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
11805 <!-- PAGE BREAK 257 -->
11806 As I described in chapter
10, formalities in copyright law were
11807 removed in
1976, when Congress followed the Europeans by abandoning
11808 any formal requirement before a copyright is granted.
<footnote><para>
11810 Until the
1908 Berlin Act of the Berne Convention, national copyright
11811 legislation sometimes made protection depend upon compliance with
11812 formalities such as registration, deposit, and affixation of notice of
11813 the author's claim of copyright. However, starting with the
1908 act,
11814 every text of the Convention has provided that "the enjoyment and the
11815 exercise" of rights guaranteed by the Convention "shall not be subject
11816 to any formality." The prohibition against formalities is presently
11817 embodied in Article
5(
2) of the Paris Text of the Berne
11818 Convention. Many countries continue to impose some form of deposit or
11819 registration requirement, albeit not as a condition of
11820 copyright. French law, for example, requires the deposit of copies of
11821 works in national repositories, principally the National Museum.
11822 Copies of books published in the United Kingdom must be deposited in
11823 the British Library. The German Copyright Act provides for a Registrar
11824 of Authors where the author's true name can be filed in the case of
11825 anonymous or pseudonymous works. Paul Goldstein,
<citetitle>International
11826 Intellectual Property Law, Cases and Materials
</citetitle> (New York: Foundation
11827 Press,
2001),
153–54.
</para></footnote>
11828 The Europeans are said to view copyright as a "natural right." Natural
11829 rights don't need forms to exist. Traditions, like the Anglo-American
11830 tradition that required copyright owners to follow form if their
11831 rights were to be protected, did not, the Europeans thought, properly
11832 respect the dignity of the author. My right as a creator turns on my
11833 creativity, not upon the special favor of the government.
11836 That's great rhetoric. It sounds wonderfully romantic. But it is
11837 absurd copyright policy. It is absurd especially for authors, because
11838 a world without formalities harms the creator. The ability to spread
11839 "Walt Disney creativity" is destroyed when there is no simple way to
11840 know what's protected and what's not.
11842 <indexterm><primary>Berne Convention (
1908)
</primary></indexterm>
11844 The fight against formalities achieved its first real victory in
11845 Berlin in
1908. International copyright lawyers amended the Berne
11846 Convention in
1908, to require copyright terms of life plus fifty
11847 years, as well as the abolition of copyright formalities. The
11848 formalities were hated because the stories of inadvertent loss were
11849 increasingly common. It was as if a Charles Dickens character ran all
11850 copyright offices, and the failure to dot an
<citetitle>i
</citetitle> or cross a
11851 <citetitle>t
</citetitle> resulted in the loss of widows' only income.
11854 These complaints were real and sensible. And the strictness of the
11855 formalities, especially in the United States, was absurd. The law
11856 should always have ways of forgiving innocent mistakes. There is no
11857 reason copyright law couldn't, as well. Rather than abandoning
11858 formalities totally, the response in Berlin should have been to
11859 embrace a more equitable system of registration.
11862 Even that would have been resisted, however, because registration
11863 in the nineteenth and twentieth centuries was still expensive. It was
11864 also a hassle. The abolishment of formalities promised not only to save
11865 the starving widows, but also to lighten an unnecessary regulatory
11867 imposed upon creators.
11870 In addition to the practical complaint of authors in
1908, there was
11871 a moral claim as well. There was no reason that creative property
11873 <!-- PAGE BREAK 258 -->
11874 should be a second-class form of property. If a carpenter builds a
11875 table, his rights over the table don't depend upon filing a form with
11876 the government. He has a property right over the table "naturally,"
11877 and he can assert that right against anyone who would steal the table,
11878 whether or not he has informed the government of his ownership of the
11882 This argument is correct, but its implications are misleading. For the
11883 argument in favor of formalities does not depend upon creative
11884 property being second-class property. The argument in favor of
11885 formalities turns upon the special problems that creative property
11886 presents. The law of formalities responds to the special physics of
11887 creative property, to assure that it can be efficiently and fairly
11891 No one thinks, for example, that land is second-class property just
11892 because you have to register a deed with a court if your sale of land
11893 is to be effective. And few would think a car is second-class property
11894 just because you must register the car with the state and tag it with
11895 a license. In both of those cases, everyone sees that there is an
11896 important reason to secure registration
—both because it makes
11897 the markets more efficient and because it better secures the rights of
11898 the owner. Without a registration system for land, landowners would
11899 perpetually have to guard their property. With registration, they can
11900 simply point the police to a deed. Without a registration system for
11901 cars, auto theft would be much easier. With a registration system, the
11902 thief has a high burden to sell a stolen car. A slight burden is
11903 placed on the property owner, but those burdens produce a much better
11904 system of protection for property generally.
11907 It is similarly special physics that makes formalities important in
11908 copyright law. Unlike a carpenter's table, there's nothing in nature that
11909 makes it relatively obvious who might own a particular bit of creative
11910 property. A recording of Lyle Lovett's latest album can exist in a billion
11911 places without anything necessarily linking it back to a particular
11912 owner. And like a car, there's no way to buy and sell creative property
11913 with confidence unless there is some simple way to authenticate who is
11914 the author and what rights he has. Simple transactions are destroyed in
11916 <!-- PAGE BREAK 259 -->
11917 a world without formalities. Complex, expensive,
11918 <emphasis>lawyer
</emphasis> transactions take their place.
11919 <indexterm><primary>Lovett, Lyle
</primary></indexterm>
11922 This was the understanding of the problem with the Sonny Bono
11923 Act that we tried to demonstrate to the Court. This was the part it
11924 didn't "get." Because we live in a system without formalities, there is no
11925 way easily to build upon or use culture from our past. If copyright
11926 terms were, as Justice Story said they would be, "short," then this
11927 wouldn't matter much. For fourteen years, under the framers' system, a
11928 work would be presumptively controlled. After fourteen years, it would
11929 be presumptively uncontrolled.
11932 But now that copyrights can be just about a century long, the
11933 inability to know what is protected and what is not protected becomes
11934 a huge and obvious burden on the creative process. If the only way a
11935 library can offer an Internet exhibit about the New Deal is to hire a
11936 lawyer to clear the rights to every image and sound, then the
11937 copyright system is burdening creativity in a way that has never been
11938 seen before
<emphasis>because there are no formalities
</emphasis>.
11941 The Eldred Act was designed to respond to exactly this problem. If
11942 it is worth $
1 to you, then register your work and you can get the
11943 longer term. Others will know how to contact you and, therefore, how
11944 to get your permission if they want to use your work. And you will get
11945 the benefit of an extended copyright term.
11948 If it isn't worth it to you to register to get the benefit of an extended
11949 term, then it shouldn't be worth it for the government to defend your
11950 monopoly over that work either. The work should pass into the public
11951 domain where anyone can copy it, or build archives with it, or create a
11952 movie based on it. It should become free if it is not worth $
1 to you.
11955 Some worry about the burden on authors. Won't the burden of
11956 registering the work mean that the $
1 is really misleading? Isn't the
11957 hassle worth more than $
1? Isn't that the real problem with
11961 It is. The hassle is terrible. The system that exists now is awful. I
11962 completely agree that the Copyright Office has done a terrible job (no
11963 doubt because they are terribly funded) in enabling simple and cheap
11965 <!-- PAGE BREAK 260 -->
11966 registrations. Any real solution to the problem of formalities must
11967 address the real problem of
<emphasis>governments
</emphasis> standing
11968 at the core of any system of formalities. In this book, I offer such a
11969 solution. That solution essentially remakes the Copyright Office. For
11970 now, assume it was Amazon that ran the registration system. Assume it
11971 was one-click registration. The Eldred Act would propose a simple,
11972 one-click registration fifty years after a work was published. Based
11973 upon historical data, that system would move up to
98 percent of
11974 commercial work, commercial work that no longer had a commercial life,
11975 into the public domain within fifty years. What do you think?
11977 <indexterm><primary>Forbes, Steve
</primary></indexterm>
11979 When Steve Forbes endorsed the idea, some in Washington began to pay
11980 attention. Many people contacted me pointing to representatives who
11981 might be willing to introduce the Eldred Act. And I had a few who
11982 directly suggested that they might be willing to take the first step.
11985 One representative, Zoe Lofgren of California, went so far as to get
11986 the bill drafted. The draft solved any problem with international
11987 law. It imposed the simplest requirement upon copyright owners
11988 possible. In May
2003, it looked as if the bill would be
11989 introduced. On May
16, I posted on the Eldred Act blog, "we are
11990 close." There was a general reaction in the blog community that
11991 something good might happen here.
11992 <indexterm><primary>Lofgren, Zoe
</primary></indexterm>
11995 But at this stage, the lobbyists began to intervene. Jack Valenti and
11996 the MPAA general counsel came to the congresswoman's office to give
11997 the view of the MPAA. Aided by his lawyer, as Valenti told me, Valenti
11998 informed the congresswoman that the MPAA would oppose the Eldred
11999 Act. The reasons are embarrassingly thin. More importantly, their
12000 thinness shows something clear about what this debate is really about.
12003 The MPAA argued first that Congress had "firmly rejected the central
12004 concept in the proposed bill"
—that copyrights be renewed. That
12005 was true, but irrelevant, as Congress's "firm rejection" had occurred
12006 <!-- PAGE BREAK 261 -->
12007 long before the Internet made subsequent uses much more likely.
12008 Second, they argued that the proposal would harm poor copyright
12009 owners
—apparently those who could not afford the $
1 fee. Third,
12010 they argued that Congress had determined that extending a copyright
12011 term would encourage restoration work. Maybe in the case of the small
12012 percentage of work covered by copyright law that is still commercially
12013 valuable, but again this was irrelevant, as the proposal would not cut
12014 off the extended term unless the $
1 fee was not paid. Fourth, the MPAA
12015 argued that the bill would impose "enormous" costs, since a
12016 registration system is not free. True enough, but those costs are
12017 certainly less than the costs of clearing the rights for a copyright
12018 whose owner is not known. Fifth, they worried about the risks if the
12019 copyright to a story underlying a film were to pass into the public
12020 domain. But what risk is that? If it is in the public domain, then the
12021 film is a valid derivative use.
12024 Finally, the MPAA argued that existing law enabled copyright owners to
12025 do this if they wanted. But the whole point is that there are
12026 thousands of copyright owners who don't even know they have a
12027 copyright to give. Whether they are free to give away their copyright
12028 or not
—a controversial claim in any case
—unless they know
12029 about a copyright, they're not likely to.
12032 At the beginning of this book, I told two stories about the law
12033 reacting to changes in technology. In the one, common sense prevailed.
12034 In the other, common sense was delayed. The difference between the two
12035 stories was the power of the opposition
—the power of the side
12036 that fought to defend the status quo. In both cases, a new technology
12037 threatened old interests. But in only one case did those interest's
12038 have the power to protect themselves against this new competitive
12042 I used these two cases as a way to frame the war that this book has
12043 been about. For here, too, a new technology is forcing the law to react.
12044 And here, too, we should ask, is the law following or resisting common
12045 sense? If common sense supports the law, what explains this common
12050 <!-- PAGE BREAK 262 -->
12051 When the issue is piracy, it is right for the law to back the
12052 copyright owners. The commercial piracy that I described is wrong and
12053 harmful, and the law should work to eliminate it. When the issue is
12054 p2p sharing, it is easy to understand why the law backs the owners
12055 still: Much of this sharing is wrong, even if much is harmless. When
12056 the issue is copyright terms for the Mickey Mouses of the world, it is
12057 possible still to understand why the law favors Hollywood: Most people
12058 don't recognize the reasons for limiting copyright terms; it is thus
12059 still possible to see good faith within the resistance.
12062 But when the copyright owners oppose a proposal such as the Eldred
12063 Act, then, finally, there is an example that lays bare the naked
12064 selfinterest driving this war. This act would free an extraordinary
12065 range of content that is otherwise unused. It wouldn't interfere with
12066 any copyright owner's desire to exercise continued control over his
12067 content. It would simply liberate what Kevin Kelly calls the "Dark
12068 Content" that fills archives around the world. So when the warriors
12069 oppose a change like this, we should ask one simple question:
12072 What does this industry really want?
12075 With very little effort, the warriors could protect their content. So
12076 the effort to block something like the Eldred Act is not really about
12077 protecting
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> content. The effort to block the
12078 Eldred Act is an effort to assure that nothing more passes into the
12079 public domain. It is another step to assure that the public domain
12080 will never compete, that there will be no use of content that is not
12081 commercially controlled, and that there will be no commercial use of
12082 content that doesn't require
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> permission
12086 The opposition to the Eldred Act reveals how extreme the other side
12087 is. The most powerful and sexy and well loved of lobbies really has as
12088 its aim not the protection of "property" but the rejection of a
12089 tradition. Their aim is not simply to protect what is
12090 theirs.
<emphasis>Their aim is to assure that all there is is what is
12094 It is not hard to understand why the warriors take this view. It is not
12095 hard to see why it would benefit them if the competition of the public
12097 <!-- PAGE BREAK 263 -->
12098 domain tied to the Internet could somehow be quashed. Just as RCA
12099 feared the competition of FM, they fear the competition of a public
12100 domain connected to a public that now has the means to create with it
12101 and to share its own creation.
12103 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
12104 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
12106 What is hard to understand is why the public takes this view. It is
12107 as if the law made airplanes trespassers. The MPAA stands with the
12108 Causbys and demands that their remote and useless property rights be
12109 respected, so that these remote and forgotten copyright holders might
12110 block the progress of others.
12113 All this seems to follow easily from this untroubled acceptance of the
12114 "property" in intellectual property. Common sense supports it, and so
12115 long as it does, the assaults will rain down upon the technologies of
12116 the Internet. The consequence will be an increasing "permission
12117 society." The past can be cultivated only if you can identify the
12118 owner and gain permission to build upon his work. The future will be
12119 controlled by this dead (and often unfindable) hand of the past.
12121 <!-- PAGE BREAK 264 -->
12124 <part id=
"c-conclusion">
12125 <title>CONCLUSION
</title>
12128 There are more than
35 million people with the AIDS virus
12129 worldwide. Twenty-five million of them live in sub-Saharan Africa.
12130 Seventeen million have already died. Seventeen million Africans
12131 is proportional percentage-wise to seven million Americans. More
12132 importantly, it is seventeen million Africans.
12135 There is no cure for AIDS, but there are drugs to slow its
12136 progression. These antiretroviral therapies are still experimental,
12137 but they have already had a dramatic effect. In the United States,
12138 AIDS patients who regularly take a cocktail of these drugs increase
12139 their life expectancy by ten to twenty years. For some, the drugs make
12140 the disease almost invisible.
12143 These drugs are expensive. When they were first introduced in the
12144 United States, they cost between $
10,
000 and $
15,
000 per person per
12145 year. Today, some cost $
25,
000 per year. At these prices, of course, no
12146 African nation can afford the drugs for the vast majority of its
12148 $
15,
000 is thirty times the per capita gross national product of
12149 Zimbabwe. At these prices, the drugs are totally unavailable.
<footnote><para>
12150 <!-- f1. --> Commission on Intellectual Property Rights, "Final Report: Integrating
12151 Intellectual Property Rights and Development Policy" (London,
2002),
12153 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
55</ulink>. According to a World Health Organization press
12155 issued
9 July
2002, only
230,
000 of the
6 million who need drugs in
12156 the developing world receive them
—and half of them are in Brazil.
12160 <!-- PAGE BREAK 265 -->
12161 These prices are not high because the ingredients of the drugs are
12162 expensive. These prices are high because the drugs are protected by
12163 patents. The drug companies that produced these life-saving mixes
12164 enjoy at least a twenty-year monopoly for their inventions. They use
12165 that monopoly power to extract the most they can from the market. That
12166 power is in turn used to keep the prices high.
12169 There are many who are skeptical of patents, especially drug
12170 patents. I am not. Indeed, of all the areas of research that might be
12171 supported by patents, drug research is, in my view, the clearest case
12172 where patents are needed. The patent gives the drug company some
12173 assurance that if it is successful in inventing a new drug to treat a
12174 disease, it will be able to earn back its investment and more. This is
12175 socially an extremely valuable incentive. I am the last person who
12176 would argue that the law should abolish it, at least without other
12180 But it is one thing to support patents, even drug patents. It is
12181 another thing to determine how best to deal with a crisis. And as
12182 African leaders began to recognize the devastation that AIDS was
12183 bringing, they started looking for ways to import HIV treatments at
12184 costs significantly below the market price.
12187 In
1997, South Africa tried one tack. It passed a law to allow the
12188 importation of patented medicines that had been produced or sold in
12189 another nation's market with the consent of the patent owner. For
12190 example, if the drug was sold in India, it could be imported into
12191 Africa from India. This is called "parallel importation," and it is
12192 generally permitted under international trade law and is specifically
12193 permitted within the European Union.
<footnote>
12196 See Peter Drahos with John Braithwaite,
<citetitle>Information Feudalism: Who
12197 Owns the Knowledge Economy?
</citetitle> (New York: The New Press,
2003),
37.
12198 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John
</primary></indexterm>
12199 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12203 However, the United States government opposed the bill. Indeed, more
12204 than opposed. As the International Intellectual Property Association
12205 characterized it, "The U.S. government pressured South Africa . . .
12206 not to permit compulsory licensing or parallel
12207 imports."
<footnote><para>
12209 International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI),
<citetitle>Patent
12210 Protection and Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan
12211 Africa, a Report Prepared for the World Intellectual Property
12212 Organization
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.,
2000),
14, available at
12213 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
56</ulink>. For a
12214 firsthand account of the struggle over South Africa, see Hearing
12215 Before the Subcommittee on Criminal Justice, Drug Policy, and Human
12216 Resources, House Committee on Government Reform, H. Rep.,
1st sess.,
12217 Ser. No.
106-
126 (
22 July
1999),
150–57 (statement of James
12220 Through the Office of the United States Trade Representative, the
12221 government asked South Africa to change the law
—and to add
12222 pressure to that request, in
1998, the USTR listed South Africa for
12223 possible trade sanctions.
12224 <!-- PAGE BREAK 266 -->
12225 That same year, more than forty pharmaceutical companies began
12226 proceedings in the South African courts to challenge the government's
12227 actions. The United States was then joined by other governments from
12228 the EU. Their claim, and the claim of the pharmaceutical companies,
12229 was that South Africa was violating its obligations under
12230 international law by discriminating against a particular kind of
12231 patent
— pharmaceutical patents. The demand of these governments,
12232 with the United States in the lead, was that South Africa respect
12233 these patents as it respects any other patent, regardless of any
12234 effect on the treatment of AIDS within South Africa.
<footnote><para>
12236 International Intellectual Property Institute (IIPI),
<citetitle>Patent
12237 Protection and Access to HIV/AIDS Pharmaceuticals in Sub-Saharan
12238 Africa, a Report Prepared for the World Intellectual Property
12239 Organization
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.,
2000),
15.
</para></footnote>
12242 We should place the intervention by the United States in context. No
12243 doubt patents are not the most important reason that Africans don't
12244 have access to drugs. Poverty and the total absence of an effective
12245 health care infrastructure matter more. But whether patents are the
12246 most important reason or not, the price of drugs has an effect on
12247 their demand, and patents affect price. And so, whether massive or
12248 marginal, there was an effect from our government's intervention to
12249 stop the flow of medications into Africa.
12252 By stopping the flow of HIV treatment into Africa, the United
12253 States government was not saving drugs for United States citizens.
12254 This is not like wheat (if they eat it, we can't); instead, the flow that the
12255 United States intervened to stop was, in effect, a flow of knowledge:
12256 information about how to take chemicals that exist within Africa, and
12257 turn those chemicals into drugs that would save
15 to
30 million lives.
12260 Nor was the intervention by the United States going to protect the
12261 profits of United States drug companies
—at least, not substantially. It
12262 was not as if these countries were in the position to buy the drugs for
12263 the prices the drug companies were charging. Again, the Africans are
12264 wildly too poor to afford these drugs at the offered prices. Stopping the
12265 parallel import of these drugs would not substantially increase the sales
12269 Instead, the argument in favor of restricting this flow of
12270 information, which was needed to save the lives of millions, was an
12272 <!-- PAGE BREAK 267 -->
12273 about the sanctity of property.
<footnote><para>
12275 See Sabin Russell, "New Crusade to Lower AIDS Drug Costs: Africa's
12276 Needs at Odds with Firms' Profit Motive,"
<citetitle>San Francisco Chronicle
</citetitle>,
24
12277 May
1999, A1, available at
12278 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
57</ulink>
12279 ("compulsory licenses and gray markets pose a threat to the entire
12280 system of intellectual property protection"); Robert Weissman, "AIDS
12281 and Developing Countries: Democratizing Access to Essential
12282 Medicines,"
<citetitle>Foreign Policy in Focus
</citetitle> 4:
23 (August
1999), available at
12283 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
58</ulink>
12284 (describing U.S. policy); John A. Harrelson, "TRIPS, Pharmaceutical
12285 Patents, and the HIV/AIDS Crisis: Finding the Proper Balance Between
12286 Intellectual Property Rights and Compassion, a Synopsis,"
<citetitle>Widener Law
12287 Symposium Journal
</citetitle> (Spring
2001):
175.
12288 <!-- PAGE BREAK 333 -->
12290 It was because "intellectual property" would be violated that these
12291 drugs should not flow into Africa. It was a principle about the
12292 importance of "intellectual property" that led these government actors
12293 to intervene against the South African response to AIDS.
12296 Now just step back for a moment. There will be a time thirty years
12297 from now when our children look back at us and ask, how could we have
12298 let this happen? How could we allow a policy to be pursued whose
12299 direct cost would be to speed the death of
15 to
30 million Africans,
12300 and whose only real benefit would be to uphold the "sanctity" of an
12301 idea? What possible justification could there ever be for a policy
12302 that results in so many deaths? What exactly is the insanity that
12303 would allow so many to die for such an abstraction?
12306 Some blame the drug companies. I don't. They are corporations.
12307 Their managers are ordered by law to make money for the corporation.
12308 They push a certain patent policy not because of ideals, but because it is
12309 the policy that makes them the most money. And it only makes them the
12310 most money because of a certain corruption within our political system
—
12311 a corruption the drug companies are certainly not responsible for.
12314 The corruption is our own politicians' failure of integrity. For the
12315 drug companies would love
—they say, and I believe them
—to
12316 sell their drugs as cheaply as they can to countries in Africa and
12317 elsewhere. There are issues they'd have to resolve to make sure the
12318 drugs didn't get back into the United States, but those are mere
12319 problems of technology. They could be overcome.
12322 A different problem, however, could not be overcome. This is the
12323 fear of the grandstanding politician who would call the presidents of
12324 the drug companies before a Senate or House hearing, and ask, "How
12325 is it you can sell this HIV drug in Africa for only $
1 a pill, but the same
12326 drug would cost an American $
1,
500?" Because there is no "sound
12327 bite" answer to that question, its effect would be to induce regulation
12328 of prices in America. The drug companies thus avoid this spiral by
12329 avoiding the first step. They reinforce the idea that property should be
12330 <!-- PAGE BREAK 268 -->
12331 sacred. They adopt a rational strategy in an irrational context, with the
12332 unintended consequence that perhaps millions die. And that rational
12333 strategy thus becomes framed in terms of this ideal
—the sanctity of an
12334 idea called "intellectual property."
12337 So when the common sense of your child confronts you, what will
12338 you say? When the common sense of a generation finally revolts
12339 against what we have done, how will we justify what we have done?
12340 What is the argument?
12343 A sensible patent policy could endorse and strongly support the patent
12344 system without having to reach everyone everywhere in exactly the same
12345 way. Just as a sensible copyright policy could endorse and strongly
12346 support a copyright system without having to regulate the spread of
12347 culture perfectly and forever, a sensible patent policy could endorse
12348 and strongly support a patent system without having to block the
12349 spread of drugs to a country not rich enough to afford market prices
12350 in any case. A sensible policy, in other words, could be a balanced
12351 policy. For most of our history, both copyright and patent policies
12352 were balanced in just this sense.
12355 But we as a culture have lost this sense of balance. We have lost the
12356 critical eye that helps us see the difference between truth and
12357 extremism. A certain property fundamentalism, having no connection to
12358 our tradition, now reigns in this culture
—bizarrely, and with
12359 consequences more grave to the spread of ideas and culture than almost
12360 any other single policy decision that we as a democracy will make. A
12361 simple idea blinds us, and under the cover of darkness, much happens
12362 that most of us would reject if any of us looked. So uncritically do
12363 we accept the idea of property in ideas that we don't even notice how
12364 monstrous it is to deny ideas to a people who are dying without
12365 them. So uncritically do we accept the idea of property in culture
12366 that we don't even question when the control of that property removes
12368 <!-- PAGE BREAK 269 -->
12369 ability, as a people, to develop our culture democratically. Blindness
12370 becomes our common sense. And the challenge for anyone who would
12371 reclaim the right to cultivate our culture is to find a way to make
12372 this common sense open its eyes.
12375 So far, common sense sleeps. There is no revolt. Common sense
12376 does not yet see what there could be to revolt about. The extremism
12377 that now dominates this debate fits with ideas that seem natural, and
12378 that fit is reinforced by the RCAs of our day. They wage a frantic war
12379 to fight "piracy," and devastate a culture for creativity. They defend
12380 the idea of "creative property," while transforming real creators into
12381 modern-day sharecroppers. They are insulted by the idea that rights
12382 should be balanced, even though each of the major players in this
12383 content war was itself a beneficiary of a more balanced ideal. The
12384 hypocrisy reeks. Yet in a city like Washington, hypocrisy is not even
12385 noticed. Powerful lobbies, complex issues, and MTV attention spans
12386 produce the "perfect storm" for free culture.
12389 In August
2003, a fight broke out in the United States about a
12390 decision by the World Intellectual Property Organization to cancel a
12391 meeting.
<footnote><para>
12392 <!-- f6. --> Jonathan Krim, "The Quiet War over Open-Source,"
<citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
12393 August
2003, E1, available at
12394 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
59</ulink>; William New, "Global Group's
12395 Shift on `Open Source' Meeting Spurs Stir,"
<citetitle>National Journal's Technology
12396 Daily
</citetitle>,
19 August
2003, available at
12397 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
60</ulink>; William New, "U.S. Official
12398 Opposes `Open Source' Talks at WIPO,"
<citetitle>National Journal's Technology
12399 Daily
</citetitle>,
19 August
2003, available at
12400 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
61</ulink>.
12402 At the request of a wide range of interests, WIPO had decided to hold
12403 a meeting to discuss "open and collaborative projects to create public
12404 goods." These are projects that have been successful in producing
12405 public goods without relying exclusively upon a proprietary use of
12406 intellectual property. Examples include the Internet and the World
12407 Wide Web, both of which were developed on the basis of protocols in
12408 the public domain. It included an emerging trend to support open
12409 academic journals, including the Public Library of Science project
12410 that I describe in the Afterword. It included a project to develop
12411 single nucleotide polymorphisms (SNPs), which are thought to have
12412 great significance in biomedical research. (That nonprofit project
12413 comprised a consortium of the Wellcome Trust and pharmaceutical and
12414 technological companies, including Amersham Biosciences, AstraZeneca,
12415 <!-- PAGE BREAK 270 -->
12416 Aventis, Bayer, Bristol-Myers Squibb, Hoffmann-La Roche,
12417 Glaxo-SmithKline, IBM, Motorola, Novartis, Pfizer, and Searle.) It
12418 included the Global Positioning System, which Ronald Reagan set free
12419 in the early
1980s. And it included "open source and free software."
12420 <indexterm><primary>PLoS (Public Library of Science)
</primary></indexterm>
12423 The aim of the meeting was to consider this wide range of projects
12424 from one common perspective: that none of these projects relied upon
12425 intellectual property extremism. Instead, in all of them, intellectual
12426 property was balanced by agreements to keep access open or to impose
12427 limitations on the way in which proprietary claims might be used.
12430 From the perspective of this book, then, the conference was ideal.
<footnote><para>
12431 <!-- f7. --> I should disclose that I was one of the people who asked WIPO for the
12434 The projects within its scope included both commercial and
12435 noncommercial work. They primarily involved science, but from many
12436 perspectives. And WIPO was an ideal venue for this discussion, since
12437 WIPO is the preeminent international body dealing with intellectual
12441 Indeed, I was once publicly scolded for not recognizing this fact
12442 about WIPO. In February
2003, I delivered a keynote address to a
12443 preparatory conference for the World Summit on the Information Society
12444 (WSIS). At a press conference before the address, I was asked what I
12445 would say. I responded that I would be talking a little about the
12446 importance of balance in intellectual property for the development of
12447 an information society. The moderator for the event then promptly
12448 interrupted to inform me and the assembled reporters that no question
12449 about intellectual property would be discussed by WSIS, since those
12450 questions were the exclusive domain of WIPO. In the talk that I had
12451 prepared, I had actually made the issue of intellectual property
12452 relatively minor. But after this astonishing statement, I made
12453 intellectual property the sole focus of my talk. There was no way to
12454 talk about an "Information Society" unless one also talked about the
12455 range of information and culture that would be free. My talk did not
12456 make my immoderate moderator very happy. And she was no doubt correct
12457 that the scope of intellectual property protections was ordinarily the
12459 <!-- PAGE BREAK 271 -->
12460 WIPO. But in my view, there couldn't be too much of a conversation
12461 about how much intellectual property is needed, since in my view, the
12462 very idea of balance in intellectual property had been lost.
12465 So whether or not WSIS can discuss balance in intellectual property, I
12466 had thought it was taken for granted that WIPO could and should. And
12467 thus the meeting about "open and collaborative projects to create
12468 public goods" seemed perfectly appropriate within the WIPO agenda.
12471 But there is one project within that list that is highly
12472 controversial, at least among lobbyists. That project is "open source
12473 and free software." Microsoft in particular is wary of discussion of
12474 the subject. From its perspective, a conference to discuss open source
12475 and free software would be like a conference to discuss Apple's
12476 operating system. Both open source and free software compete with
12477 Microsoft's software. And internationally, many governments have begun
12478 to explore requirements that they use open source or free software,
12479 rather than "proprietary software," for their own internal uses.
12482 I don't mean to enter that debate here. It is important only to
12483 make clear that the distinction is not between commercial and
12484 noncommercial software. There are many important companies that depend
12485 fundamentally upon open source and free software, IBM being the most
12486 prominent. IBM is increasingly shifting its focus to the GNU/Linux
12487 operating system, the most famous bit of "free software"
—and IBM
12488 is emphatically a commercial entity. Thus, to support "open source and
12489 free software" is not to oppose commercial entities. It is, instead,
12490 to support a mode of software development that is different from
12491 Microsoft's.
<footnote><para>
12493 Microsoft's position about free and open source software is more
12494 sophisticated. As it has repeatedly asserted, it has no problem with
12495 "open source" software or software in the public domain. Microsoft's
12496 principal opposition is to "free software" licensed under a "copyleft"
12497 license, meaning a license that requires the licensee to adopt the
12498 same terms on any derivative work. See Bradford L. Smith, "The Future
12499 of Software: Enabling the Marketplace to Decide,"
<citetitle>Government Policy
12500 Toward Open Source Software
</citetitle> (Washington, D.C.: AEI-Brookings Joint
12501 Center for Regulatory Studies, American Enterprise Institute for
12502 Public Policy Research,
2002),
69, available at
12503 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
62</ulink>. See also
12504 Craig Mundie, Microsoft senior vice president,
<citetitle>The Commercial Software
12505 Model
</citetitle>, discussion at New York University Stern School of Business (
3
12506 May
2001), available at
12507 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
63</ulink>.
12509 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
12512 More important for our purposes, to support "open source and free
12513 software" is not to oppose copyright. "Open source and free software"
12514 is not software in the public domain. Instead, like Microsoft's
12515 software, the copyright owners of free and open source software insist
12516 quite strongly that the terms of their software license be respected
12518 <!-- PAGE BREAK 272 -->
12519 adopters of free and open source software. The terms of that license
12520 are no doubt different from the terms of a proprietary software
12521 license. Free software licensed under the General Public License
12522 (GPL), for example, requires that the source code for the software be
12523 made available by anyone who modifies and redistributes the
12524 software. But that requirement is effective only if copyright governs
12525 software. If copyright did not govern software, then free software
12526 could not impose the same kind of requirements on its adopters. It
12527 thus depends upon copyright law just as Microsoft does.
12530 It is therefore understandable that as a proprietary software
12531 developer, Microsoft would oppose this WIPO meeting, and
12532 understandable that it would use its lobbyists to get the United
12533 States government to oppose it, as well. And indeed, that is just what
12534 was reported to have happened. According to Jonathan Krim of the
12535 <citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>, Microsoft's lobbyists succeeded in getting the United
12536 States government to veto the meeting.
<footnote><para>
12538 Krim, "The Quiet War over Open-Source," available at
<ulink
12539 url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
64</ulink>.
12541 And without U.S. backing, the meeting was canceled.
12544 I don't blame Microsoft for doing what it can to advance its own
12545 interests, consistent with the law. And lobbying governments is
12546 plainly consistent with the law. There was nothing surprising about
12547 its lobbying here, and nothing terribly surprising about the most
12548 powerful software producer in the United States having succeeded in
12549 its lobbying efforts.
12552 What was surprising was the United States government's reason for
12553 opposing the meeting. Again, as reported by Krim, Lois Boland, acting
12554 director of international relations for the U.S. Patent and Trademark
12555 Office, explained that "open-source software runs counter to the
12556 mission of WIPO, which is to promote intellectual-property rights."
12557 She is quoted as saying, "To hold a meeting which has as its purpose
12558 to disclaim or waive such rights seems to us to be contrary to the
12562 These statements are astonishing on a number of levels.
12564 <!-- PAGE BREAK 273 -->
12566 First, they are just flat wrong. As I described, most open source and
12567 free software relies fundamentally upon the intellectual property
12568 right called "copyright". Without it, restrictions imposed by those
12569 licenses wouldn't work. Thus, to say it "runs counter" to the mission
12570 of promoting intellectual property rights reveals an extraordinary gap
12571 in understanding
—the sort of mistake that is excusable in a
12572 first-year law student, but an embarrassment from a high government
12573 official dealing with intellectual property issues.
12576 Second, who ever said that WIPO's exclusive aim was to "promote"
12577 intellectual property maximally? As I had been scolded at the
12578 preparatory conference of WSIS, WIPO is to consider not only how best
12579 to protect intellectual property, but also what the best balance of
12580 intellectual property is. As every economist and lawyer knows, the
12581 hard question in intellectual property law is to find that
12582 balance. But that there should be limits is, I had thought,
12583 uncontested. One wants to ask Ms. Boland, are generic drugs (drugs
12584 based on drugs whose patent has expired) contrary to the WIPO mission?
12585 Does the public domain weaken intellectual property? Would it have
12586 been better if the protocols of the Internet had been patented?
12589 Third, even if one believed that the purpose of WIPO was to maximize
12590 intellectual property rights, in our tradition, intellectual property
12591 rights are held by individuals and corporations. They get to decide
12592 what to do with those rights because, again, they are
12593 <emphasis>their
</emphasis> rights. If they want to "waive" or
12594 "disclaim" their rights, that is, within our tradition, totally
12595 appropriate. When Bill Gates gives away more than $
20 billion to do
12596 good in the world, that is not inconsistent with the objectives of the
12597 property system. That is, on the contrary, just what a property system
12598 is supposed to be about: giving individuals the right to decide what
12599 to do with
<emphasis>their
</emphasis> property.
12600 <indexterm><primary>Gates, Bill
</primary></indexterm>
12603 When Ms. Boland says that there is something wrong with a meeting
12604 "which has as its purpose to disclaim or waive such rights," she's
12605 saying that WIPO has an interest in interfering with the choices of
12606 <!-- PAGE BREAK 274 -->
12607 the individuals who own intellectual property rights. That somehow,
12608 WIPO's objective should be to stop an individual from "waiving" or
12609 "disclaiming" an intellectual property right. That the interest of
12610 WIPO is not just that intellectual property rights be maximized, but
12611 that they also should be exercised in the most extreme and restrictive
12615 There is a history of just such a property system that is well known
12616 in the Anglo-American tradition. It is called "feudalism." Under
12617 feudalism, not only was property held by a relatively small number of
12618 individuals and entities. And not only were the rights that ran with
12619 that property powerful and extensive. But the feudal system had a
12620 strong interest in assuring that property holders within that system
12621 not weaken feudalism by liberating people or property within their
12622 control to the free market. Feudalism depended upon maximum control
12623 and concentration. It fought any freedom that might interfere with
12626 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12627 <indexterm><primary>Braithwaite, John
</primary></indexterm>
12629 As Peter Drahos and John Braithwaite relate, this is precisely the
12630 choice we are now making about intellectual property.
<footnote><para>
12632 See Drahos with Braithwaite,
<citetitle>Information Feudalism
</citetitle>,
210–20.
12633 <indexterm><primary>Drahos, Peter
</primary></indexterm>
12635 We will have an information society. That much is certain. Our only
12636 choice now is whether that information society will be
12637 <emphasis>free
</emphasis> or
<emphasis>feudal
</emphasis>. The trend is
12641 When this battle broke, I blogged it. A spirited debate within the
12642 comment section ensued. Ms. Boland had a number of supporters who
12643 tried to show why her comments made sense. But there was one comment
12644 that was particularly depressing for me. An anonymous poster wrote,
12648 George, you misunderstand Lessig: He's only talking about the world as
12649 it should be ("the goal of WIPO, and the goal of any government,
12650 should be to promote the right balance of intellectual property rights,
12651 not simply to promote intellectual property rights"), not as it is. If
12652 we were talking about the world as it is, then of course Boland didn't
12653 say anything wrong. But in the world
12654 <!-- PAGE BREAK 275 -->
12655 as Lessig would have it, then of course she did. Always pay attention
12656 to the distinction between Lessig's world and ours.
12660 I missed the irony the first time I read it. I read it quickly and
12661 thought the poster was supporting the idea that seeking balance was
12662 what our government should be doing. (Of course, my criticism of Ms.
12663 Boland was not about whether she was seeking balance or not; my
12664 criticism was that her comments betrayed a first-year law student's
12665 mistake. I have no illusion about the extremism of our government,
12666 whether Republican or Democrat. My only illusion apparently is about
12667 whether our government should speak the truth or not.)
12670 Obviously, however, the poster was not supporting that idea. Instead,
12671 the poster was ridiculing the very idea that in the real world, the
12672 "goal" of a government should be "to promote the right balance" of
12673 intellectual property. That was obviously silly to him. And it
12674 obviously betrayed, he believed, my own silly utopianism. "Typical for
12675 an academic," the poster might well have continued.
12678 I understand criticism of academic utopianism. I think utopianism is
12679 silly, too, and I'd be the first to poke fun at the absurdly
12680 unrealistic ideals of academics throughout history (and not just in
12681 our own country's history).
12684 But when it has become silly to suppose that the role of our
12685 government should be to "seek balance," then count me with the silly,
12686 for that means that this has become quite serious indeed. If it should
12687 be obvious to everyone that the government does not seek balance, that
12688 the government is simply the tool of the most powerful lobbyists, that
12689 the idea of holding the government to a different standard is absurd,
12690 that the idea of demanding of the government that it speak truth and
12691 not lies is just na
ïve, then who have we, the most powerful
12692 democracy in the world, become?
12695 It might be crazy to expect a high government official to speak
12696 the truth. It might be crazy to believe that government policy will be
12697 something more than the handmaiden of the most powerful interests.
12698 <!-- PAGE BREAK 276 -->
12699 It might be crazy to argue that we should preserve a tradition that has
12700 been part of our tradition for most of our history
—free culture.
12702 <indexterm><primary>CodePink Women in Peace
</primary></indexterm>
12704 If this is crazy, then let there be more crazies. Soon. There are
12705 moments of hope in this struggle. And moments that surprise. When the
12706 FCC was considering relaxing ownership rules, which would thereby
12707 further increase the concentration in media ownership, an
12708 extraordinary bipartisan coalition formed to fight this change. For
12709 perhaps the first time in history, interests as diverse as the NRA,
12710 the ACLU, Moveon.org, William Safire, Ted Turner, and CodePink Women
12711 for Peace organized to oppose this change in FCC policy. An
12712 astonishing
700,
000 letters were sent to the FCC, demanding more
12713 hearings and a different result.
12714 <indexterm><primary>Turner, Ted
</primary></indexterm>
12715 <indexterm><primary>Safire, William
</primary></indexterm>
12718 This activism did not stop the FCC, but soon after, a broad coalition
12719 in the Senate voted to reverse the FCC decision. The hostile hearings
12720 leading up to that vote revealed just how powerful this movement had
12721 become. There was no substantial support for the FCC's decision, and
12722 there was broad and sustained support for fighting further
12723 concentration in the media.
12726 But even this movement misses an important piece of the puzzle.
12727 Largeness as such is not bad. Freedom is not threatened just because
12728 some become very rich, or because there are only a handful of big
12729 players. The poor quality of Big Macs or Quarter Pounders does not
12730 mean that you can't get a good hamburger from somewhere else.
12733 The danger in media concentration comes not from the concentration,
12734 but instead from the feudalism that this concentration, tied to the
12735 change in copyright, produces. It is not just that there are a few
12736 powerful companies that control an ever expanding slice of the
12737 media. It is that this concentration can call upon an equally bloated
12738 range of rights
—property rights of a historically extreme
12739 form
—that makes their bigness bad.
12741 <!-- PAGE BREAK 277 -->
12743 It is therefore significant that so many would rally to demand
12744 competition and increased diversity. Still, if the rally is understood
12745 as being about bigness alone, it is not terribly surprising. We
12746 Americans have a long history of fighting "big," wisely or not. That
12747 we could be motivated to fight "big" again is not something new.
12750 It would be something new, and something very important, if an equal
12751 number could be rallied to fight the increasing extremism built within
12752 the idea of "intellectual property." Not because balance is alien to
12753 our tradition; indeed, as I've argued, balance is our tradition. But
12754 because the muscle to think critically about the scope of anything
12755 called "property" is not well exercised within this tradition anymore.
12758 If we were Achilles, this would be our heel. This would be the place
12761 <indexterm><primary>Dylan, Bob
</primary></indexterm>
12763 As I write these final words, the news is filled with stories about
12764 the RIAA lawsuits against almost three hundred individuals.
<footnote><para>
12766 John Borland, "RIAA Sues
261 File Swappers," CNET News.com, September
12768 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
65</ulink>; Paul
12769 R. La Monica, "Music Industry Sues Swappers," CNN/Money,
8 September
12771 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
66</ulink>; Soni
12772 Sangha and Phyllis Furman with Robert Gearty, "Sued for a Song,
12773 N.Y.C.
12-Yr-Old Among
261 Cited as Sharers,"
<citetitle>New York Daily News
</citetitle>,
9
12774 September
2003,
3; Frank Ahrens, "RIAA's Lawsuits Meet Surprised
12775 Targets; Single Mother in Calif.,
12-Year-Old Girl in N.Y. Among
12776 Defendants,"
<citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003, E1; Katie Dean,
12777 "Schoolgirl Settles with RIAA,"
<citetitle>Wired News
</citetitle>,
10 September
2003,
12779 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
67</ulink>.
12781 Eminem has just been sued for "sampling" someone else's
12782 music.
<footnote><para>
12784 Jon Wiederhorn, "Eminem Gets Sued . . . by a Little Old Lady,"
12785 mtv.com,
17 September
2003, available at
12786 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
68</ulink>.
12788 The story about Bob Dylan "stealing" from a Japanese author has just
12789 finished making the rounds.
<footnote><para>
12791 Kenji Hall, Associated Press, "Japanese Book May Be Inspiration for
12792 Dylan Songs," Kansascity.com,
9 July
2003, available at
12793 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
69</ulink>.
12794 <!-- PAGE BREAK 334 -->
12796 An insider from Hollywood
—who insists he must remain
12797 anonymous
—reports "an amazing conversation with these studio
12798 guys. They've got extraordinary [old] content that they'd love to use
12799 but can't because they can't begin to clear the rights. They've got
12800 scores of kids who could do amazing things with the content, but it
12801 would take scores of lawyers to clean it first." Congressmen are
12802 talking about deputizing computer viruses to bring down computers
12803 thought to violate the law. Universities are threatening expulsion for
12804 kids who use a computer to share content.
12806 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Thomas Lee
</primary></indexterm>
12807 <indexterm><primary>Causby, Tinie
</primary></indexterm>
12808 <indexterm><primary>Creative Commons
</primary></indexterm>
12809 <indexterm><primary>Gil, Gilberto
</primary></indexterm>
12811 Yet on the other side of the Atlantic, the BBC has just announced
12812 that it will build a "Creative Archive," from which British citizens can
12813 download BBC content, and rip, mix, and burn it.
<footnote><para>
12814 <!-- f14. --> "BBC Plans to Open Up Its Archive to the Public," BBC press release,
12815 24 August
2003, available at
12816 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
70</ulink>.
12818 And in Brazil, the culture minister, Gilberto Gil, himself a folk hero
12819 of Brazilian music, has joined with Creative Commons to release
12820 content and free licenses in that Latin American
12821 country.
<footnote><para>
12823 "Creative Commons and Brazil," Creative Commons Weblog,
6 August
2003,
12825 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
71</ulink>.
12827 <!-- PAGE BREAK 278 -->
12828 I've told a dark story. The truth is more mixed. A technology has
12829 given us a new freedom. Slowly, some begin to understand that this
12830 freedom need not mean anarchy. We can carry a free culture into the
12831 twenty-first century, without artists losing and without the potential of
12832 digital technology being destroyed. It will take some thought, and
12833 more importantly, it will take some will to transform the RCAs of our
12834 day into the Causbys.
12837 Common sense must revolt. It must act to free culture. Soon, if this
12838 potential is ever to be realized.
12840 <!-- PAGE BREAK 279 -->
12844 <chapter><title></title><para></para></chapter>
12846 <part id=
"c-afterword">
12847 <title>AFTERWORD
</title>
12851 <!-- PAGE BREAK 280 -->
12852 At least some who have read this far will agree with me that something
12853 must be done to change where we are heading. The balance of this book
12854 maps what might be done.
12857 I divide this map into two parts: that which anyone can do now,
12858 and that which requires the help of lawmakers. If there is one lesson
12859 that we can draw from the history of remaking common sense, it is that
12860 it requires remaking how many people think about the very same issue.
12863 That means this movement must begin in the streets. It must recruit a
12864 significant number of parents, teachers, librarians, creators,
12865 authors, musicians, filmmakers, scientists
—all to tell this
12866 story in their own words, and to tell their neighbors why this battle
12870 Once this movement has its effect in the streets, it has some hope of
12871 having an effect in Washington. We are still a democracy. What people
12872 think matters. Not as much as it should, at least when an RCA stands
12873 opposed, but still, it matters. And thus, in the second part below, I
12874 sketch changes that Congress could make to better secure a free culture.
12876 <!-- PAGE BREAK 281 -->
12878 <section id=
"usnow">
12879 <title>US, NOW
</title>
12881 Common sense is with the copyright warriors because the debate so far
12882 has been framed at the extremes
—as a grand either/or: either
12883 property or anarchy, either total control or artists won't be paid. If
12884 that really is the choice, then the warriors should win.
12887 The mistake here is the error of the excluded middle. There are
12888 extremes in this debate, but the extremes are not all that there
12889 is. There are those who believe in maximal copyright
—"All Rights
12890 Reserved"
— and those who reject copyright
—"No Rights
12891 Reserved." The "All Rights Reserved" sorts believe that you should ask
12892 permission before you "use" a copyrighted work in any way. The "No
12893 Rights Reserved" sorts believe you should be able to do with content
12894 as you wish, regardless of whether you have permission or not.
12897 When the Internet was first born, its initial architecture effectively
12898 tilted in the "no rights reserved" direction. Content could be copied
12899 perfectly and cheaply; rights could not easily be controlled. Thus,
12900 regardless of anyone's desire, the effective regime of copyright under
12903 <!-- PAGE BREAK 282 -->
12904 original design of the Internet was "no rights reserved." Content was
12905 "taken" regardless of the rights. Any rights were effectively
12909 This initial character produced a reaction (opposite, but not quite
12910 equal) by copyright owners. That reaction has been the topic of this
12911 book. Through legislation, litigation, and changes to the network's
12912 design, copyright holders have been able to change the essential
12913 character of the environment of the original Internet. If the original
12914 architecture made the effective default "no rights reserved," the
12915 future architecture will make the effective default "all rights
12916 reserved." The architecture and law that surround the Internet's
12917 design will increasingly produce an environment where all use of
12918 content requires permission. The "cut and paste" world that defines
12919 the Internet today will become a "get permission to cut and paste"
12920 world that is a creator's nightmare.
12923 What's needed is a way to say something in the middle
—neither
12924 "all rights reserved" nor "no rights reserved" but "some rights
12925 reserved"
— and thus a way to respect copyrights but enable
12926 creators to free content as they see fit. In other words, we need a
12927 way to restore a set of freedoms that we could just take for granted
12931 <section id=
"examples">
12932 <title>Rebuilding Freedoms Previously Presumed: Examples
</title>
12934 If you step back from the battle I've been describing here, you will
12935 recognize this problem from other contexts. Think about
12936 privacy. Before the Internet, most of us didn't have to worry much
12937 about data about our lives that we broadcast to the world. If you
12938 walked into a bookstore and browsed through some of the works of Karl
12939 Marx, you didn't need to worry about explaining your browsing habits
12940 to your neighbors or boss. The "privacy" of your browsing habits was
12944 What made it assured?
12946 <!-- PAGE BREAK 283 -->
12948 Well, if we think in terms of the modalities I described in chapter
12949 10, your privacy was assured because of an inefficient architecture
12950 for gathering data and hence a market constraint (cost) on anyone who
12951 wanted to gather that data. If you were a suspected spy for North
12952 Korea, working for the CIA, no doubt your privacy would not be
12953 assured. But that's because the CIA would (we hope) find it valuable
12954 enough to spend the thousands required to track you. But for most of
12955 us (again, we can hope), spying doesn't pay. The highly inefficient
12956 architecture of real space means we all enjoy a fairly robust amount
12957 of privacy. That privacy is guaranteed to us by friction. Not by law
12958 (there is no law protecting "privacy" in public places), and in many
12959 places, not by norms (snooping and gossip are just fun), but instead,
12960 by the costs that friction imposes on anyone who would want to spy.
12962 <indexterm><primary>Amazon
</primary></indexterm>
12964 Enter the Internet, where the cost of tracking browsing in particular
12965 has become quite tiny. If you're a customer at Amazon, then as you
12966 browse the pages, Amazon collects the data about what you've looked
12967 at. You know this because at the side of the page, there's a list of
12968 "recently viewed" pages. Now, because of the architecture of the Net
12969 and the function of cookies on the Net, it is easier to collect the
12970 data than not. The friction has disappeared, and hence any "privacy"
12971 protected by the friction disappears, too.
12974 Amazon, of course, is not the problem. But we might begin to worry
12975 about libraries. If you're one of those crazy lefties who thinks that
12976 people should have the "right" to browse in a library without the
12977 government knowing which books you look at (I'm one of those lefties,
12978 too), then this change in the technology of monitoring might concern
12979 you. If it becomes simple to gather and sort who does what in
12980 electronic spaces, then the friction-induced privacy of yesterday
12984 It is this reality that explains the push of many to define "privacy"
12985 on the Internet. It is the recognition that technology can remove what
12986 friction before gave us that leads many to push for laws to do what
12987 friction did.
<footnote><para>
12990 See, for example, Marc Rotenberg, "Fair Information Practices and the
12991 Architecture of Privacy (What Larry Doesn't Get),"
<citetitle>Stanford Technology
12992 Law Review
</citetitle> 1 (
2001): par.
6–18, available at
12994 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
72</ulink>
12995 (describing examples in which technology defines privacy policy). See
12996 also Jeffrey Rosen,
<citetitle>The Naked Crowd: Reclaiming Security and Freedom
12997 in an Anxious Age
</citetitle> (New York: Random House,
2004) (mapping tradeoffs
12998 between technology and privacy).
</para></footnote>
12999 And whether you're in favor of those laws or not, it is the pattern
13000 that is important here. We must take affirmative steps to secure a
13002 <!-- PAGE BREAK 284 -->
13003 kind of freedom that was passively provided before. A change in
13004 technology now forces those who believe in privacy to affirmatively
13005 act where, before, privacy was given by default.
13008 A similar story could be told about the birth of the free software
13009 movement. When computers with software were first made available
13010 commercially, the software
—both the source code and the
13011 binaries
— was free. You couldn't run a program written for a
13012 Data General machine on an IBM machine, so Data General and IBM didn't
13013 care much about controlling their software.
13015 <indexterm><primary>Stallman, Richard
</primary></indexterm>
13017 That was the world Richard Stallman was born into, and while he was a
13018 researcher at MIT, he grew to love the community that developed when
13019 one was free to explore and tinker with the software that ran on
13020 machines. Being a smart sort himself, and a talented programmer,
13021 Stallman grew to depend upon the freedom to add to or modify other
13025 In an academic setting, at least, that's not a terribly radical
13026 idea. In a math department, anyone would be free to tinker with a
13027 proof that someone offered. If you thought you had a better way to
13028 prove a theorem, you could take what someone else did and change
13029 it. In a classics department, if you believed a colleague's
13030 translation of a recently discovered text was flawed, you were free to
13031 improve it. Thus, to Stallman, it seemed obvious that you should be
13032 free to tinker with and improve the code that ran a machine. This,
13033 too, was knowledge. Why shouldn't it be open for criticism like
13037 No one answered that question. Instead, the architecture of revenue
13038 for computing changed. As it became possible to import programs from
13039 one system to another, it became economically attractive (at least in
13040 the view of some) to hide the code of your program. So, too, as
13041 companies started selling peripherals for mainframe systems. If I
13042 could just take your printer driver and copy it, then that would make
13043 it easier for me to sell a printer to the market than it was for you.
13046 Thus, the practice of proprietary code began to spread, and by the
13047 early
1980s, Stallman found himself surrounded by proprietary code.
13048 <!-- PAGE BREAK 285 -->
13049 The world of free software had been erased by a change in the
13050 economics of computing. And as he believed, if he did nothing about
13051 it, then the freedom to change and share software would be
13052 fundamentally weakened.
13055 Therefore, in
1984, Stallman began a project to build a free operating
13056 system, so that at least a strain of free software would survive. That
13057 was the birth of the GNU project, into which Linus Torvalds's "Linux"
13058 kernel was added to produce the GNU/Linux operating system.
13059 <indexterm><primary>Linux operating system
</primary></indexterm>
13062 Stallman's technique was to use copyright law to build a world of
13063 software that must be kept free. Software licensed under the Free
13064 Software Foundation's GPL cannot be modified and distributed unless
13065 the source code for that software is made available as well. Thus,
13066 anyone building upon GPL'd software would have to make their buildings
13067 free as well. This would assure, Stallman believed, that an ecology of
13068 code would develop that remained free for others to build upon. His
13069 fundamental goal was freedom; innovative creative code was a
13073 Stallman was thus doing for software what privacy advocates now
13074 do for privacy. He was seeking a way to rebuild a kind of freedom that
13075 was taken for granted before. Through the affirmative use of licenses
13076 that bind copyrighted code, Stallman was affirmatively reclaiming a
13077 space where free software would survive. He was actively protecting
13078 what before had been passively guaranteed.
13081 Finally, consider a very recent example that more directly resonates
13082 with the story of this book. This is the shift in the way academic and
13083 scientific journals are produced.
13086 As digital technologies develop, it is becoming obvious to many that
13087 printing thousands of copies of journals every month and sending them
13088 to libraries is perhaps not the most efficient way to distribute
13089 knowledge. Instead, journals are increasingly becoming electronic, and
13090 libraries and their users are given access to these electronic
13091 journals through password-protected sites. Something similar to this
13092 has been happening in law for almost thirty years: Lexis and Westlaw
13093 have had electronic versions of case reports available to subscribers
13094 to their service. Although a Supreme Court opinion is not
13095 copyrighted, and anyone is free to go to a library and read it, Lexis
13096 and Westlaw are also free
13097 <!-- PAGE BREAK 286 -->
13098 to charge users for the privilege of gaining access to that Supreme
13099 Court opinion through their respective services.
13102 There's nothing wrong in general with this, and indeed, the ability to
13103 charge for access to even public domain materials is a good incentive
13104 for people to develop new and innovative ways to spread knowledge.
13105 The law has agreed, which is why Lexis and Westlaw have been allowed
13106 to flourish. And if there's nothing wrong with selling the public
13107 domain, then there could be nothing wrong, in principle, with selling
13108 access to material that is not in the public domain.
13111 But what if the only way to get access to social and scientific data
13112 was through proprietary services? What if no one had the ability to
13113 browse this data except by paying for a subscription?
13116 As many are beginning to notice, this is increasingly the reality with
13117 scientific journals. When these journals were distributed in paper
13118 form, libraries could make the journals available to anyone who had
13119 access to the library. Thus, patients with cancer could become cancer
13120 experts because the library gave them access. Or patients trying to
13121 understand the risks of a certain treatment could research those risks
13122 by reading all available articles about that treatment. This freedom
13123 was therefore a function of the institution of libraries (norms) and
13124 the technology of paper journals (architecture)
—namely, that it
13125 was very hard to control access to a paper journal.
13128 As journals become electronic, however, the publishers are demanding
13129 that libraries not give the general public access to the
13130 journals. This means that the freedoms provided by print journals in
13131 public libraries begin to disappear. Thus, as with privacy and with
13132 software, a changing technology and market shrink a freedom taken for
13136 This shrinking freedom has led many to take affirmative steps to
13137 restore the freedom that has been lost. The Public Library of Science
13138 (PLoS), for example, is a nonprofit corporation dedicated to making
13139 scientific research available to anyone with a Web connection. Authors
13140 <!-- PAGE BREAK 287 -->
13141 of scientific work submit that work to the Public Library of Science.
13142 That work is then subject to peer review. If accepted, the work is
13143 then deposited in a public, electronic archive and made permanently
13144 available for free. PLoS also sells a print version of its work, but
13145 the copyright for the print journal does not inhibit the right of
13146 anyone to redistribute the work for free.
13147 <indexterm><primary>PLoS (Public Library of Science)
</primary></indexterm>
13150 This is one of many such efforts to restore a freedom taken for
13151 granted before, but now threatened by changing technology and markets.
13152 There's no doubt that this alternative competes with the traditional
13153 publishers and their efforts to make money from the exclusive
13154 distribution of content. But competition in our tradition is
13155 presumptively a good
—especially when it helps spread knowledge
13160 <section id=
"oneidea">
13161 <title>Rebuilding Free Culture: One Idea
</title>
13162 <indexterm id=
"idxcc" class='startofrange'
>
13163 <primary>Creative Commons
</primary>
13166 The same strategy could be applied to culture, as a response to the
13167 increasing control effected through law and technology.
13170 Enter the Creative Commons. The Creative Commons is a nonprofit
13171 corporation established in Massachusetts, but with its home at
13172 Stanford University. Its aim is to build a layer of
13173 <emphasis>reasonable
</emphasis> copyright on top of the extremes that
13174 now reign. It does this by making it easy for people to build upon
13175 other people's work, by making it simple for creators to express the
13176 freedom for others to take and build upon their work. Simple tags,
13177 tied to human-readable descriptions, tied to bulletproof licenses,
13178 make this possible.
13181 <emphasis>Simple
</emphasis>—which means without a middleman, or
13182 without a lawyer. By developing a free set of licenses that people
13183 can attach to their content, Creative Commons aims to mark a range of
13184 content that can easily, and reliably, be built upon. These tags are
13185 then linked to machine-readable versions of the license that enable
13186 computers automatically to identify content that can easily be
13187 shared. These three expressions together
—a legal license, a
13188 human-readable description, and
13189 <!-- PAGE BREAK 288 -->
13190 machine-readable tags
—constitute a Creative Commons license. A
13191 Creative Commons license constitutes a grant of freedom to anyone who
13192 accesses the license, and more importantly, an expression of the ideal
13193 that the person associated with the license believes in something
13194 different than the "All" or "No" extremes. Content is marked with the
13195 CC mark, which does not mean that copyright is waived, but that
13196 certain freedoms are given.
13199 These freedoms are beyond the freedoms promised by fair use. Their
13200 precise contours depend upon the choices the creator makes. The
13201 creator can choose a license that permits any use, so long as
13202 attribution is given. She can choose a license that permits only
13203 noncommercial use. She can choose a license that permits any use so
13204 long as the same freedoms are given to other uses ("share and share
13205 alike"). Or any use so long as no derivative use is made. Or any use
13206 at all within developing nations. Or any sampling use, so long as full
13207 copies are not made. Or lastly, any educational use.
13210 These choices thus establish a range of freedoms beyond the default of
13211 copyright law. They also enable freedoms that go beyond traditional
13212 fair use. And most importantly, they express these freedoms in a way
13213 that subsequent users can use and rely upon without the need to hire a
13214 lawyer. Creative Commons thus aims to build a layer of content,
13215 governed by a layer of reasonable copyright law, that others can build
13216 upon. Voluntary choice of individuals and creators will make this
13217 content available. And that content will in turn enable us to rebuild
13221 This is just one project among many within the Creative Commons. And
13222 of course, Creative Commons is not the only organization pursuing such
13223 freedoms. But the point that distinguishes the Creative Commons from
13224 many is that we are not interested only in talking about a public
13225 domain or in getting legislators to help build a public domain. Our
13226 aim is to build a movement of consumers and producers
13227 <!-- PAGE BREAK 289 -->
13228 of content ("content conducers," as attorney Mia Garlick calls them)
13229 who help build the public domain and, by their work, demonstrate the
13230 importance of the public domain to other creativity.
13231 <indexterm><primary>Garlick, Mia
</primary></indexterm>
13234 The aim is not to fight the "All Rights Reserved" sorts. The aim is to
13235 complement them. The problems that the law creates for us as a culture
13236 are produced by insane and unintended consequences of laws written
13237 centuries ago, applied to a technology that only Jefferson could have
13238 imagined. The rules may well have made sense against a background of
13239 technologies from centuries ago, but they do not make sense against
13240 the background of digital technologies. New rules
—with different
13241 freedoms, expressed in ways so that humans without lawyers can use
13242 them
—are needed. Creative Commons gives people a way effectively
13243 to begin to build those rules.
13246 Why would creators participate in giving up total control? Some
13247 participate to better spread their content. Cory Doctorow, for
13248 example, is a science fiction author. His first novel,
<citetitle>Down and Out in
13249 the Magic Kingdom
</citetitle>, was released on-line and for free, under a Creative
13250 Commons license, on the same day that it went on sale in bookstores.
13253 Why would a publisher ever agree to this? I suspect his publisher
13254 reasoned like this: There are two groups of people out there: (
1)
13255 those who will buy Cory's book whether or not it's on the Internet,
13256 and (
2) those who may never hear of Cory's book, if it isn't made
13257 available for free on the Internet. Some part of (
1) will download
13258 Cory's book instead of buying it. Call them bad-(
1)s. Some part of (
2)
13259 will download Cory's book, like it, and then decide to buy it. Call
13260 them (
2)-goods. If there are more (
2)-goods than bad-(
1)s, the
13261 strategy of releasing Cory's book free on-line will probably
13262 <emphasis>increase
</emphasis> sales of Cory's book.
13265 Indeed, the experience of his publisher clearly supports that
13266 conclusion. The book's first printing was exhausted months before the
13267 publisher had expected. This first novel of a science fiction author
13268 was a total success.
13271 The idea that free content might increase the value of nonfree content
13272 was confirmed by the experience of another author. Peter Wayner,
13273 <!-- PAGE BREAK 290 -->
13274 who wrote a book about the free software movement titled
<citetitle>Free for All
</citetitle>,
13275 made an electronic version of his book free on-line under a Creative
13276 Commons license after the book went out of print. He then monitored
13277 used book store prices for the book. As predicted, as the number of
13278 downloads increased, the used book price for his book increased, as
13282 These are examples of using the Commons to better spread proprietary
13283 content. I believe that is a wonderful and common use of the
13284 Commons. There are others who use Creative Commons licenses for other
13285 reasons. Many who use the "sampling license" do so because anything
13286 else would be hypocritical. The sampling license says that others are
13287 free, for commercial or noncommercial purposes, to sample content from
13288 the licensed work; they are just not free to make full copies of the
13289 licensed work available to others. This is consistent with their own
13290 art
—they, too, sample from others. Because the
13291 <emphasis>legal
</emphasis> costs of sampling are so high (Walter
13292 Leaphart, manager of the rap group Public Enemy, which was born
13293 sampling the music of others, has stated that he does not "allow"
13294 Public Enemy to sample anymore, because the legal costs are so
13295 high
<footnote><para>
13298 <citetitle>Willful Infringement: A Report from the Front Lines of the Real
13299 Culture Wars
</citetitle> (
2003), produced by Jed Horovitz, directed by Greg
13300 Hittelman, a Fiat Lucre production, available at
13301 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
72</ulink>.
13302 </para></footnote>),
13303 these artists release into the creative environment content
13304 that others can build upon, so that their form of creativity might grow.
13307 Finally, there are many who mark their content with a Creative Commons
13308 license just because they want to express to others the importance of
13309 balance in this debate. If you just go along with the system as it is,
13310 you are effectively saying you believe in the "All Rights Reserved"
13311 model. Good for you, but many do not. Many believe that however
13312 appropriate that rule is for Hollywood and freaks, it is not an
13313 appropriate description of how most creators view the rights
13314 associated with their content. The Creative Commons license expresses
13315 this notion of "Some Rights Reserved," and gives many the chance to
13319 In the first six months of the Creative Commons experiment, over
13320 1 million objects were licensed with these free-culture licenses. The next
13321 step is partnerships with middleware content providers to help them
13322 build into their technologies simple ways for users to mark their content
13324 <!-- PAGE BREAK 291 -->
13325 with Creative Commons freedoms. Then the next step is to watch and
13326 celebrate creators who build content based upon content set free.
13329 These are first steps to rebuilding a public domain. They are not
13330 mere arguments; they are action. Building a public domain is the first
13331 step to showing people how important that domain is to creativity and
13332 innovation. Creative Commons relies upon voluntary steps to achieve
13333 this rebuilding. They will lead to a world in which more than voluntary
13334 steps are possible.
13337 Creative Commons is just one example of voluntary efforts by
13338 individuals and creators to change the mix of rights that now govern
13339 the creative field. The project does not compete with copyright; it
13340 complements it. Its aim is not to defeat the rights of authors, but to
13341 make it easier for authors and creators to exercise their rights more
13342 flexibly and cheaply. That difference, we believe, will enable
13343 creativity to spread more easily.
13345 <indexterm startref=
"idxcc" class='endofrange'
/>
13347 <!-- PAGE BREAK 292 -->
13350 <section id=
"themsoon">
13351 <title>THEM, SOON
</title>
13353 We will not reclaim a free culture by individual action alone. It will
13354 also take important reforms of laws. We have a long way to go before
13355 the politicians will listen to these ideas and implement these reforms.
13356 But that also means that we have time to build awareness around the
13357 changes that we need.
13360 In this chapter, I outline five kinds of changes: four that are general,
13361 and one that's specific to the most heated battle of the day, music. Each
13362 is a step, not an end. But any of these steps would carry us a long way
13366 <section id=
"formalities">
13367 <title>1. More Formalities
</title>
13369 If you buy a house, you have to record the sale in a deed. If you buy land
13370 upon which to build a house, you have to record the purchase in a deed.
13371 If you buy a car, you get a bill of sale and register the car. If you buy an
13372 airplane ticket, it has your name on it.
13375 <!-- PAGE BREAK 293 -->
13376 These are all formalities associated with property. They are
13377 requirements that we all must bear if we want our property to be
13381 In contrast, under current copyright law, you automatically get a
13382 copyright, regardless of whether you comply with any formality. You
13383 don't have to register. You don't even have to mark your content. The
13384 default is control, and "formalities" are banished.
13390 As I suggested in chapter
10, the motivation to abolish formalities
13391 was a good one. In the world before digital technologies, formalities
13392 imposed a burden on copyright holders without much benefit. Thus, it
13393 was progress when the law relaxed the formal requirements that a
13394 copyright owner must bear to protect and secure his work. Those
13395 formalities were getting in the way.
13398 But the Internet changes all this. Formalities today need not be a
13399 burden. Rather, the world without formalities is the world that
13400 burdens creativity. Today, there is no simple way to know who owns
13401 what, or with whom one must deal in order to use or build upon the
13402 creative work of others. There are no records, there is no system to
13403 trace
— there is no simple way to know how to get permission. Yet
13404 given the massive increase in the scope of copyright's rule, getting
13405 permission is a necessary step for any work that builds upon our
13406 past. And thus, the
<emphasis>lack
</emphasis> of formalities forces
13407 many into silence where they otherwise could speak.
13410 The law should therefore change this requirement
<footnote><para>
13412 The proposal I am advancing here would apply to American works only.
13413 Obviously, I believe it would be beneficial for the same idea to be
13414 adopted by other countries as well.
</para></footnote>—but it
13415 should not change it by going back to the old, broken system. We
13416 should require formalities, but we should establish a system that will
13417 create the incentives to minimize the burden of these formalities.
13420 The important formalities are three: marking copyrighted work,
13421 registering copyrights, and renewing the claim to
13422 copyright. Traditionally, the first of these three was something the
13423 copyright owner did; the second two were something the government
13424 did. But a revised system of formalities would banish the government
13425 from the process, except for the sole purpose of approving standards
13426 developed by others.
13429 <!-- PAGE BREAK 294 -->
13431 <section id=
"registration">
13432 <title>REGISTRATION AND RENEWAL
</title>
13434 Under the old system, a copyright owner had to file a registration
13435 with the Copyright Office to register or renew a copyright. When
13436 filing that registration, the copyright owner paid a fee. As with most
13437 government agencies, the Copyright Office had little incentive to
13438 minimize the burden of registration; it also had little incentive to
13439 minimize the fee. And as the Copyright Office is not a main target of
13440 government policymaking, the office has historically been terribly
13441 underfunded. Thus, when people who know something about the process
13442 hear this idea about formalities, their first reaction is
13443 panic
—nothing could be worse than forcing people to deal with
13444 the mess that is the Copyright Office.
13447 Yet it is always astonishing to me that we, who come from a tradition
13448 of extraordinary innovation in governmental design, can no longer
13449 think innovatively about how governmental functions can be designed.
13450 Just because there is a public purpose to a government role, it
13451 doesn't follow that the government must actually administer the
13452 role. Instead, we should be creating incentives for private parties to
13453 serve the public, subject to standards that the government sets.
13456 In the context of registration, one obvious model is the Internet.
13457 There are at least
32 million Web sites registered around the world.
13458 Domain name owners for these Web sites have to pay a fee to keep their
13459 registration alive. In the main top-level domains (.com, .org, .net),
13460 there is a central registry. The actual registrations are, however,
13461 performed by many competing registrars. That competition drives the
13462 cost of registering down, and more importantly, it drives the ease
13463 with which registration occurs up.
13466 We should adopt a similar model for the registration and renewal of
13467 copyrights. The Copyright Office may well serve as the central
13468 registry, but it should not be in the registrar business. Instead, it
13469 should establish a database, and a set of standards for registrars. It
13470 should approve registrars that meet its standards. Those registrars
13471 would then compete with one another to deliver the cheapest and
13472 simplest systems for registering and renewing copyrights. That
13473 competition would substantially lower the burden of this
13474 formality
—while producing a database
13475 <!-- PAGE BREAK 295 -->
13476 of registrations that would facilitate the licensing of content.
13480 <section id=
"marking">
13481 <title>MARKING
</title>
13483 It used to be that the failure to include a copyright notice on a
13484 creative work meant that the copyright was forfeited. That was a harsh
13485 punishment for failing to comply with a regulatory rule
—akin to
13486 imposing the death penalty for a parking ticket in the world of
13487 creative rights. Here again, there is no reason that a marking
13488 requirement needs to be enforced in this way. And more importantly,
13489 there is no reason a marking requirement needs to be enforced
13490 uniformly across all media.
13493 The aim of marking is to signal to the public that this work is
13494 copyrighted and that the author wants to enforce his rights. The mark
13495 also makes it easy to locate a copyright owner to secure permission to
13499 One of the problems the copyright system confronted early on was
13500 that different copyrighted works had to be differently marked. It wasn't
13501 clear how or where a statue was to be marked, or a record, or a film. A
13502 new marking requirement could solve these problems by recognizing
13503 the differences in media, and by allowing the system of marking to
13504 evolve as technologies enable it to. The system could enable a special
13505 signal from the failure to mark
—not the loss of the copyright, but the
13506 loss of the right to punish someone for failing to get permission first.
13509 Let's start with the last point. If a copyright owner allows his work
13510 to be published without a copyright notice, the consequence of that
13511 failure need not be that the copyright is lost. The consequence could
13512 instead be that anyone has the right to use this work, until the
13513 copyright owner complains and demonstrates that it is his work and he
13514 doesn't give permission.
<footnote><para>
13516 There would be a complication with derivative works that I have not
13517 solved here. In my view, the law of derivatives creates a more complicated
13518 system than is justified by the marginal incentive it creates.
13520 The meaning of an unmarked work would therefore be "use unless someone
13521 complains." If someone does complain, then the obligation would be to
13522 stop using the work in any new
13523 <!-- PAGE BREAK 296 -->
13524 work from then on though no penalty would attach for existing uses.
13525 This would create a strong incentive for copyright owners to mark
13529 That in turn raises the question about how work should best be
13530 marked. Here again, the system needs to adjust as the technologies
13531 evolve. The best way to ensure that the system evolves is to limit the
13532 Copyright Office's role to that of approving standards for marking
13533 content that have been crafted elsewhere.
13536 For example, if a recording industry association devises a method for
13537 marking CDs, it would propose that to the Copyright Office. The
13538 Copyright Office would hold a hearing, at which other proposals could
13539 be made. The Copyright Office would then select the proposal that it
13540 judged preferable, and it would base that choice
13541 <emphasis>solely
</emphasis> upon the consideration of which method
13542 could best be integrated into the registration and renewal system. We
13543 would not count on the government to innovate; but we would count on
13544 the government to keep the product of innovation in line with its
13545 other important functions.
13548 Finally, marking content clearly would simplify registration
13549 requirements. If photographs were marked by author and year, there
13550 would be little reason not to allow a photographer to reregister, for
13551 example, all photographs taken in a particular year in one quick
13552 step. The aim of the formality is not to burden the creator; the
13553 system itself should be kept as simple as possible.
13556 The objective of formalities is to make things clear. The existing
13557 system does nothing to make things clear. Indeed, it seems designed to
13558 make things unclear.
13561 If formalities such as registration were reinstated, one of the most
13562 difficult aspects of relying upon the public domain would be removed.
13563 It would be simple to identify what content is presumptively free; it
13564 would be simple to identify who controls the rights for a particular
13565 kind of content; it would be simple to assert those rights, and to renew
13566 that assertion at the appropriate time.
13569 <!-- PAGE BREAK 297 -->
13572 <section id=
"shortterms">
13573 <title>2. Shorter Terms
</title>
13575 The term of copyright has gone from fourteen years to ninety-five
13576 years for corporate authors, and life of the author plus seventy years for
13580 In
<citetitle>The Future of Ideas
</citetitle>, I proposed a seventy-five-year term,
13581 granted in five-year increments with a requirement of renewal every
13582 five years. That seemed radical enough at the time. But after we lost
13583 <citetitle>Eldred
</citetitle> v.
<citetitle>Ashcroft
</citetitle>, the proposals became even more
13584 radical.
<citetitle>The Economist
</citetitle> endorsed a proposal for a fourteen-year
13585 copyright term.
<footnote><para>
13588 "A Radical Rethink,"
<citetitle>Economist
</citetitle>,
366:
8308 (
25 January
2003):
15,
13590 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
74</ulink>.
13592 Others have proposed tying the term to the term for patents.
13595 I agree with those who believe that we need a radical change in
13596 copyright's term. But whether fourteen years or seventy-five, there
13597 are four principles that are important to keep in mind about copyright
13600 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
13603 <emphasis>Keep it short:
</emphasis> The term should be as long as
13604 necessary to give incentives to create, but no longer. If it were tied
13605 to very strong protections for authors (so authors were able to
13606 reclaim rights from publishers), rights to the same work (not
13607 derivative works) might be extended further. The key is not to tie the
13608 work up with legal regulations when it no longer benefits an author.
13612 <emphasis>Keep it simple:
</emphasis> The line between the public
13613 domain and protected content must be kept clear. Lawyers like the
13614 fuzziness of "fair use," and the distinction between "ideas" and
13615 "expression." That kind of law gives them lots of work. But our
13616 framers had a simpler idea in mind: protected versus unprotected. The
13617 value of short terms is that there is little need to build exceptions
13618 into copyright when the term itself is kept short. A clear and active
13619 "lawyer-free zone" makes the complexities of "fair use" and
13620 "idea/expression" less necessary to navigate.
13621 <!-- PAGE BREAK 298 -->
13625 <emphasis>Keep it alive:
</emphasis> Copyright should have to be
13626 renewed. Especially if the maximum term is long, the copyright owner
13627 should be required to signal periodically that he wants the protection
13628 continued. This need not be an onerous burden, but there is no reason
13629 this monopoly protection has to be granted for free. On average, it
13630 takes ninety minutes for a veteran to apply for a
13631 pension.
<footnote><para>
13633 Department of Veterans Affairs, Veteran's Application for Compensation
13634 and/or Pension, VA Form
21-
526 (OMB Approved No.
2900-
0001),
13636 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
75</ulink>.
13638 If we make veterans suffer that burden, I don't see why we couldn't
13639 require authors to spend ten minutes every fifty years to file a
13641 <indexterm><primary>veterans' pensions
</primary></indexterm>
13645 <emphasis>Keep it prospective:
</emphasis> Whatever the term of
13646 copyright should be, the clearest lesson that economists teach is that
13647 a term once given should not be extended. It might have been a mistake
13648 in
1923 for the law to offer authors only a fifty-six-year term. I
13649 don't think so, but it's possible. If it was a mistake, then the
13650 consequence was that we got fewer authors to create in
1923 than we
13651 otherwise would have. But we can't correct that mistake today by
13652 increasing the term. No matter what we do today, we will not increase
13653 the number of authors who wrote in
1923. Of course, we can increase
13654 the reward that those who write now get (or alternatively, increase
13655 the copyright burden that smothers many works that are today
13656 invisible). But increasing their reward will not increase their
13657 creativity in
1923. What's not done is not done, and there's nothing
13658 we can do about that now.
</para></listitem>
13661 These changes together should produce an
<emphasis>average
</emphasis>
13662 copyright term that is much shorter than the current term. Until
1976,
13663 the average term was just
32.2 years. We should be aiming for the
13667 No doubt the extremists will call these ideas "radical." (After all, I
13668 call them "extremists.") But again, the term I recommended was longer
13669 than the term under Richard Nixon. How "radical" can it be to ask for
13670 a more generous copyright law than Richard Nixon presided over?
13673 <!-- PAGE BREAK 299 -->
13676 <section id=
"freefairuse">
13677 <title>3. Free Use Vs. Fair Use
</title>
13679 As I observed at the beginning of this book, property law originally
13680 granted property owners the right to control their property from the
13681 ground to the heavens. The airplane came along. The scope of property
13682 rights quickly changed. There was no fuss, no constitutional
13683 challenge. It made no sense anymore to grant that much control, given
13684 the emergence of that new technology.
13687 Our Constitution gives Congress the power to give authors "exclusive
13688 right" to "their writings." Congress has given authors an exclusive
13689 right to "their writings" plus any derivative writings (made by
13690 others) that are sufficiently close to the author's original
13691 work. Thus, if I write a book, and you base a movie on that book, I
13692 have the power to deny you the right to release that movie, even
13693 though that movie is not "my writing."
13696 Congress granted the beginnings of this right in
1870, when it
13697 expanded the exclusive right of copyright to include a right to
13698 control translations and dramatizations of a work.
<footnote><para>
13700 Benjamin Kaplan,
<citetitle>An Unhurried View of Copyright
</citetitle> (New York: Columbia
13701 University Press,
1967),
32.
13703 The courts have expanded it slowly through judicial interpretation
13704 ever since. This expansion has been commented upon by one of the law's
13705 greatest judges, Judge Benjamin Kaplan.
13709 So inured have we become to the extension of the monopoly to a
13710 large range of so-called derivative works, that we no longer sense
13711 the oddity of accepting such an enlargement of copyright while
13712 yet intoning the abracadabra of idea and expression.
<footnote><para>
13713 <!-- f6. --> Ibid.,
56.
13718 I think it's time to recognize that there are airplanes in this field and
13719 the expansiveness of these rights of derivative use no longer make
13720 sense. More precisely, they don't make sense for the period of time that
13721 a copyright runs. And they don't make sense as an amorphous grant.
13722 Consider each limitation in turn.
13725 <emphasis>Term:
</emphasis> If Congress wants to grant a derivative
13726 right, then that right should be for a much shorter term. It makes
13727 sense to protect John
13729 <!-- PAGE BREAK 300 -->
13730 Grisham's right to sell the movie rights to his latest novel (or at least
13731 I'm willing to assume it does); but it does not make sense for that right
13732 to run for the same term as the underlying copyright. The derivative
13733 right could be important in inducing creativity; it is not important long
13734 after the creative work is done.
13735 <indexterm><primary>Grisham, John
</primary></indexterm>
13738 <emphasis>Scope:
</emphasis> Likewise should the scope of derivative
13739 rights be narrowed. Again, there are some cases in which derivative
13740 rights are important. Those should be specified. But the law should
13741 draw clear lines around regulated and unregulated uses of copyrighted
13742 material. When all "reuse" of creative material was within the control
13743 of businesses, perhaps it made sense to require lawyers to negotiate
13744 the lines. It no longer makes sense for lawyers to negotiate the
13745 lines. Think about all the creative possibilities that digital
13746 technologies enable; now imagine pouring molasses into the
13747 machines. That's what this general requirement of permission does to
13748 the creative process. Smothers it.
13751 This was the point that Alben made when describing the making of the
13752 Clint Eastwood CD. While it makes sense to require negotiation for
13753 foreseeable derivative rights
—turning a book into a movie, or a
13754 poem into a musical score
—it doesn't make sense to require
13755 negotiation for the unforeseeable. Here, a statutory right would make
13759 In each of these cases, the law should mark the uses that are
13760 protected, and the presumption should be that other uses are not
13761 protected. This is the reverse of the recommendation of my colleague
13762 Paul Goldstein.
<footnote>
13765 Paul Goldstein,
<citetitle>Copyright's Highway: From Gutenberg to the Celestial
13766 Jukebox
</citetitle> (Stanford: Stanford University Press,
2003),
187–216.
13767 <indexterm><primary>Goldstein, Paul
</primary></indexterm>
13769 His view is that the law should be written so that
13770 expanded protections follow expanded uses.
13773 Goldstein's analysis would make perfect sense if the cost of the legal
13774 system were small. But as we are currently seeing in the context of
13775 the Internet, the uncertainty about the scope of protection, and the
13776 incentives to protect existing architectures of revenue, combined with
13777 a strong copyright, weaken the process of innovation.
13780 The law could remedy this problem either by removing protection
13781 <!-- PAGE BREAK 301 -->
13782 beyond the part explicitly drawn or by granting reuse rights upon
13783 certain statutory conditions. Either way, the effect would be to free
13784 a great deal of culture to others to cultivate. And under a statutory
13785 rights regime, that reuse would earn artists more income.
13789 <section id=
"liberatemusic">
13790 <title>4. Liberate the Music
—Again
</title>
13792 The battle that got this whole war going was about music, so it
13793 wouldn't be fair to end this book without addressing the issue that
13794 is, to most people, most pressing
—music. There is no other
13795 policy issue that better teaches the lessons of this book than the
13796 battles around the sharing of music.
13799 The appeal of file-sharing music was the crack cocaine of the
13800 Internet's growth. It drove demand for access to the Internet more
13801 powerfully than any other single application. It was the Internet's
13802 killer app
—possibly in two senses of that word. It no doubt was
13803 the application that drove demand for bandwidth. It may well be the
13804 application that drives demand for regulations that in the end kill
13805 innovation on the network.
13808 The aim of copyright, with respect to content in general and music in
13809 particular, is to create the incentives for music to be composed,
13810 performed, and, most importantly, spread. The law does this by giving
13811 an exclusive right to a composer to control public performances of his
13812 work, and to a performing artist to control copies of her performance.
13815 File-sharing networks complicate this model by enabling the
13816 spread of content for which the performer has not been paid. But of
13817 course, that's not all the file-sharing networks do. As I described in
13818 chapter
5, they enable four different kinds of sharing:
13820 <orderedlist numeration=
"upperalpha">
13823 There are some who are using sharing networks as substitutes
13824 for purchasing CDs.
13828 There are also some who are using sharing networks to sample,
13829 on the way to purchasing CDs.
13832 <!-- PAGE BREAK 302 -->
13834 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
13835 content that is no longer sold but is still under copyright or that
13836 would have been too cumbersome to buy off the Net.
13840 There are many who are using file-sharing networks to get access to
13841 content that is not copyrighted or to get access that the copyright
13842 owner plainly endorses.
13846 Any reform of the law needs to keep these different uses in focus. It
13847 must avoid burdening type D even if it aims to eliminate type A. The
13848 eagerness with which the law aims to eliminate type A, moreover,
13849 should depend upon the magnitude of type B. As with VCRs, if the net
13850 effect of sharing is actually not very harmful, the need for regulation is
13851 significantly weakened.
13854 As I said in chapter
5, the actual harm caused by sharing is
13855 controversial. For the purposes of this chapter, however, I assume
13856 the harm is real. I assume, in other words, that type A sharing is
13857 significantly greater than type B, and is the dominant use of sharing
13861 Nonetheless, there is a crucial fact about the current technological
13862 context that we must keep in mind if we are to understand how the law
13866 Today, file sharing is addictive. In ten years, it won't be. It is
13867 addictive today because it is the easiest way to gain access to a
13868 broad range of content. It won't be the easiest way to get access to
13869 a broad range of content in ten years. Today, access to the Internet
13870 is cumbersome and slow
—we in the United States are lucky to have
13871 broadband service at
1.5 MBs, and very rarely do we get service at
13872 that speed both up and down. Although wireless access is growing, most
13873 of us still get access across wires. Most only gain access through a
13874 machine with a keyboard. The idea of the always on, always connected
13875 Internet is mainly just an idea.
13878 But it will become a reality, and that means the way we get access to
13879 the Internet today is a technology in transition. Policy makers should
13880 not make policy on the basis of technology in transition. They should
13881 <!-- PAGE BREAK 303 -->
13882 make policy on the basis of where the technology is going. The
13883 question should not be, how should the law regulate sharing in this
13884 world? The question should be, what law will we require when the
13885 network becomes the network it is clearly becoming? That network is
13886 one in which every machine with electricity is essentially on the Net;
13887 where everywhere you are
—except maybe the desert or the
13888 Rockies
—you can instantaneously be connected to the
13889 Internet. Imagine the Internet as ubiquitous as the best cell-phone
13890 service, where with the flip of a device, you are connected.
13893 In that world, it will be extremely easy to connect to services that
13894 give you access to content on the fly
—such as Internet radio,
13895 content that is streamed to the user when the user demands. Here,
13896 then, is the critical point: When it is
<emphasis>extremely
</emphasis>
13897 easy to connect to services that give access to content, it will be
13898 <emphasis>easier
</emphasis> to connect to services that give you
13899 access to content than it will be to download and store content
13900 <emphasis>on the many devices you will have for playing
13901 content
</emphasis>. It will be easier, in other words, to subscribe
13902 than it will be to be a database manager, as everyone in the
13903 download-sharing world of Napster-like technologies essentially
13904 is. Content services will compete with content sharing, even if the
13905 services charge money for the content they give access to. Already
13906 cell-phone services in Japan offer music (for a fee) streamed over
13907 cell phones (enhanced with plugs for headphones). The Japanese are
13908 paying for this content even though "free" content is available in the
13909 form of MP3s across the Web.
<footnote><para>
13911 See, for example, "Music Media Watch," The J@pan Inc. Newsletter,
3
13912 April
2002, available at
13913 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
76</ulink>.
13918 This point about the future is meant to suggest a perspective on the
13919 present: It is emphatically temporary. The "problem" with file
13920 sharing
—to the extent there is a real problem
—is a problem
13921 that will increasingly disappear as it becomes easier to connect to
13922 the Internet. And thus it is an extraordinary mistake for policy
13923 makers today to be "solving" this problem in light of a technology
13924 that will be gone tomorrow. The question should not be how to
13925 regulate the Internet to eliminate file sharing (the Net will evolve
13926 that problem away). The question instead should be how to assure that
13927 artists get paid, during
13929 <!-- PAGE BREAK 304 -->
13930 this transition between twentieth-century models for doing business
13931 and twenty-first-century technologies.
13934 The answer begins with recognizing that there are different "problems"
13935 here to solve. Let's start with type D content
—uncopyrighted
13936 content or copyrighted content that the artist wants shared. The
13937 "problem" with this content is to make sure that the technology that
13938 would enable this kind of sharing is not rendered illegal. You can
13939 think of it this way: Pay phones are used to deliver ransom demands,
13940 no doubt. But there are many who need to use pay phones who have
13941 nothing to do with ransoms. It would be wrong to ban pay phones in
13942 order to eliminate kidnapping.
13945 Type C content raises a different "problem." This is content that was,
13946 at one time, published and is no longer available. It may be
13947 unavailable because the artist is no longer valuable enough for the
13948 record label he signed with to carry his work. Or it may be
13949 unavailable because the work is forgotten. Either way, the aim of the
13950 law should be to facilitate the access to this content, ideally in a
13951 way that returns something to the artist.
13954 Again, the model here is the used book store. Once a book goes out of
13955 print, it may still be available in libraries and used book
13956 stores. But libraries and used book stores don't pay the copyright
13957 owner when someone reads or buys an out-of-print book. That makes
13958 total sense, of course, since any other system would be so burdensome
13959 as to eliminate the possibility of used book stores' existing. But
13960 from the author's perspective, this "sharing" of his content without
13961 his being compensated is less than ideal.
13964 The model of used book stores suggests that the law could simply deem
13965 out-of-print music fair game. If the publisher does not make copies of
13966 the music available for sale, then commercial and noncommercial
13967 providers would be free, under this rule, to "share" that content,
13968 even though the sharing involved making a copy. The copy here would be
13969 incidental to the trade; in a context where commercial publishing has
13970 ended, trading music should be as free as trading books.
13974 <!-- PAGE BREAK 305 -->
13975 Alternatively, the law could create a statutory license that would
13976 ensure that artists get something from the trade of their work. For
13977 example, if the law set a low statutory rate for the commercial
13978 sharing of content that was not offered for sale by a commercial
13979 publisher, and if that rate were automatically transferred to a trust
13980 for the benefit of the artist, then businesses could develop around
13981 the idea of trading this content, and artists would benefit from this
13985 This system would also create an incentive for publishers to keep
13986 works available commercially. Works that are available commercially
13987 would not be subject to this license. Thus, publishers could protect
13988 the right to charge whatever they want for content if they kept the
13989 work commercially available. But if they don't keep it available, and
13990 instead, the computer hard disks of fans around the world keep it
13991 alive, then any royalty owed for such copying should be much less than
13992 the amount owed a commercial publisher.
13995 The hard case is content of types A and B, and again, this case is
13996 hard only because the extent of the problem will change over time, as
13997 the technologies for gaining access to content change. The law's
13998 solution should be as flexible as the problem is, understanding that
13999 we are in the middle of a radical transformation in the technology for
14000 delivering and accessing content.
14003 So here's a solution that will at first seem very strange to both sides
14004 in this war, but which upon reflection, I suggest, should make some sense.
14007 Stripped of the rhetoric about the sanctity of property, the basic
14008 claim of the content industry is this: A new technology (the Internet)
14009 has harmed a set of rights that secure copyright. If those rights are to
14010 be protected, then the content industry should be compensated for that
14011 harm. Just as the technology of tobacco harmed the health of millions
14012 of Americans, or the technology of asbestos caused grave illness to
14013 thousands of miners, so, too, has the technology of digital networks
14014 harmed the interests of the content industry.
14017 <!-- PAGE BREAK 306 -->
14018 I love the Internet, and so I don't like likening it to tobacco or
14019 asbestos. But the analogy is a fair one from the perspective of the
14020 law. And it suggests a fair response: Rather than seeking to destroy
14021 the Internet, or the p2p technologies that are currently harming
14022 content providers on the Internet, we should find a relatively simple
14023 way to compensate those who are harmed.
14026 The idea would be a modification of a proposal that has been
14027 floated by Harvard law professor William Fisher.
<footnote>
14030 William Fisher,
<citetitle>Digital Music: Problems and Possibilities
</citetitle> (last
14031 revised:
10 October
2000), available at
14032 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
77</ulink>; William
14033 Fisher,
<citetitle>Promises to Keep: Technology, Law, and the Future of
14034 Entertainment
</citetitle> (forthcoming) (Stanford: Stanford University Press,
14035 2004), ch.
6, available at
14036 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
78</ulink>. Professor
14037 Netanel has proposed a related idea that would exempt noncommercial
14038 sharing from the reach of copyright and would establish compensation
14039 to artists to balance any loss. See Neil Weinstock Netanel, "Impose a
14040 Noncommercial Use Levy to Allow Free P2P File Sharing," available at
14041 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
79</ulink>. For other proposals, see Lawrence Lessig, "Who's Holding Back
14042 Broadband?"
<citetitle>Washington Post
</citetitle>,
8 January
2002, A17; Philip S. Corwin on
14043 behalf of Sharman Networks, A Letter to Senator Joseph R. Biden, Jr.,
14044 Chairman of the Senate Foreign Relations Committee,
26 February
2002,
14046 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
80</ulink>; Serguei Osokine,
<citetitle>A Quick Case for Intellectual Property
14047 Use Fee (IPUF)
</citetitle>,
3 March
2002, available at
14048 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
81</ulink>; Jefferson Graham,
14049 "Kazaa, Verizon Propose to Pay Artists Directly,"
<citetitle>USA Today
</citetitle>,
13 May
14051 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
82</ulink>; Steven M. Cherry, "Getting Copyright Right,"
14052 IEEE Spectrum Online,
1 July
2002, available at
14053 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
83</ulink>; Declan
14054 McCullagh, "Verizon's Copyright Campaign," CNET News.com,
27 August
14056 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
84</ulink>.
14057 Fisher's proposal is very similar to Richard Stallman's proposal for
14058 DAT. Unlike Fisher's, Stallman's proposal would not pay artists directly
14059 proportionally, though more popular artists would get more than the less
14060 popular. As is typical with Stallman, his proposal predates the current
14061 debate by about a decade. See
14062 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
85</ulink>.
14063 <indexterm><primary>Netanel, Neil Weinstock
</primary></indexterm>
14064 <indexterm><primary>Fisher, William
</primary></indexterm>
14066 Fisher suggests a very clever way around the current impasse of the
14067 Internet. Under his plan, all content capable of digital transmission
14068 would (
1) be marked with a digital watermark (don't worry about how
14069 easy it is to evade these marks; as you'll see, there's no incentive
14070 to evade them). Once the content is marked, then entrepreneurs would
14071 develop (
2) systems to monitor how many items of each content were
14072 distributed. On the basis of those numbers, then (
3) artists would be
14073 compensated. The compensation would be paid for by (
4) an appropriate
14077 Fisher's proposal is careful and comprehensive. It raises a million
14078 questions, most of which he answers well in his upcoming book,
14079 <citetitle>Promises to Keep
</citetitle>. The modification that I would make is relatively
14080 simple: Fisher imagines his proposal replacing the existing copyright
14081 system. I imagine it complementing the existing system. The aim of
14082 the proposal would be to facilitate compensation to the extent that
14083 harm could be shown. This compensation would be temporary, aimed at
14084 facilitating a transition between regimes. And it would require
14085 renewal after a period of years. If it continues to make sense to
14086 facilitate free exchange of content, supported through a taxation
14087 system, then it can be continued. If this form of protection is no
14088 longer necessary, then the system could lapse into the old system of
14089 controlling access.
14092 Fisher would balk at the idea of allowing the system to lapse. His aim
14093 is not just to ensure that artists are paid, but also to ensure that
14094 the system supports the widest range of "semiotic democracy"
14095 possible. But the aims of semiotic democracy would be satisfied if the
14096 other changes I described were accomplished
—in particular, the
14097 limits on derivative
14099 <!-- PAGE BREAK 307 -->
14100 uses. A system that simply charges for access would not greatly burden
14101 semiotic democracy if there were few limitations on what one was
14102 allowed to do with the content itself.
14105 No doubt it would be difficult to calculate the proper measure of
14106 "harm" to an industry. But the difficulty of making that calculation
14107 would be outweighed by the benefit of facilitating innovation. This
14108 background system to compensate would also not need to interfere with
14109 innovative proposals such as Apple's MusicStore. As experts predicted
14110 when Apple launched the MusicStore, it could beat "free" by being
14111 easier than free is. This has proven correct: Apple has sold millions
14112 of songs at even the very high price of
99 cents a song. (At
99 cents,
14113 the cost is the equivalent of a per-song CD price, though the labels
14114 have none of the costs of a CD to pay.) Apple's move was countered by
14115 Real Networks, offering music at just
79 cents a song. And no doubt
14116 there will be a great deal of competition to offer and sell music
14120 This competition has already occurred against the background of "free"
14121 music from p2p systems. As the sellers of cable television have known
14122 for thirty years, and the sellers of bottled water for much more than
14123 that, there is nothing impossible at all about "competing with free."
14124 Indeed, if anything, the competition spurs the competitors to offer
14125 new and better products. This is precisely what the competitive market
14126 was to be about. Thus in Singapore, though piracy is rampant, movie
14127 theaters are often luxurious
—with "first class" seats, and meals
14128 served while you watch a movie
—as they struggle and succeed in
14129 finding ways to compete with "free."
14132 This regime of competition, with a backstop to assure that artists
14133 don't lose, would facilitate a great deal of innovation in the
14134 delivery of content. That competition would continue to shrink type A
14135 sharing. It would inspire an extraordinary range of new
14136 innovators
—ones who would have a right to the content, and would
14137 no longer fear the uncertain and barbarically severe punishments of
14141 In summary, then, my proposal is this:
14145 <!-- PAGE BREAK 308 -->
14146 The Internet is in transition. We should not be regulating a
14147 technology in transition. We should instead be regulating to minimize
14148 the harm to interests affected by this technological change, while
14149 enabling, and encouraging, the most efficient technology we can
14153 We can minimize that harm while maximizing the benefit to innovation
14156 <orderedlist numeration=
"arabic">
14159 guaranteeing the right to engage in type D sharing;
14163 permitting noncommercial type C sharing without liability,
14164 and commercial type C sharing at a low and fixed rate set by
14169 while in this transition, taxing and compensating for type A
14170 sharing, to the extent actual harm is demonstrated.
14174 But what if "piracy" doesn't disappear? What if there is a competitive
14175 market providing content at a low cost, but a significant number of
14176 consumers continue to "take" content for nothing? Should the law do
14180 Yes, it should. But, again, what it should do depends upon how the
14181 facts develop. These changes may not eliminate type A sharing. But the
14182 real issue is not whether it eliminates sharing in the abstract. The
14183 real issue is its effect on the market. Is it better (a) to have a
14184 technology that is
95 percent secure and produces a market of size
<citetitle>x
</citetitle>,
14185 or (b) to have a technology that is
50 percent secure but produces a
14186 market of five times
<citetitle>x
</citetitle>? Less secure might produce more unauthorized
14187 sharing, but it is likely to also produce a much bigger market in
14188 authorized sharing. The most important thing is to assure artists'
14189 compensation without breaking the Internet. Once that's assured, then
14190 it may well be appropriate to find ways to track down the petty
14194 But we're a long way away from whittling the problem down to this
14195 subset of type A sharers. And our focus until we're there should not
14196 be on finding ways to break the Internet. Our focus until we're there
14198 <!-- PAGE BREAK 309 -->
14199 should be on how to make sure the artists are paid, while protecting
14200 the space for innovation and creativity that the Internet is.
14204 <section id=
"firelawyers">
14205 <title>5. Fire Lots of Lawyers
</title>
14207 I'm a lawyer. I make lawyers for a living. I believe in the law. I believe
14208 in the law of copyright. Indeed, I have devoted my life to working in
14209 law, not because there are big bucks at the end but because there are
14210 ideals at the end that I would love to live.
14213 Yet much of this book has been a criticism of lawyers, or the role
14214 lawyers have played in this debate. The law speaks to ideals, but it
14215 is my view that our profession has become too attuned to the
14216 client. And in a world where the rich clients have one strong view,
14217 the unwillingness of the profession to question or counter that one
14218 strong view queers the law.
14221 The evidence of this bending is compelling. I'm attacked as a
14222 "radical" by many within the profession, yet the positions that I am
14223 advocating are precisely the positions of some of the most moderate
14224 and significant figures in the history of this branch of the
14225 law. Many, for example, thought crazy the challenge that we brought to
14226 the Copyright Term Extension Act. Yet just thirty years ago, the
14227 dominant scholar and practitioner in the field of copyright, Melville
14228 Nimmer, thought it obvious.
<footnote><para>
14230 Lawrence Lessig, "Copyright's First Amendment" (Melville B. Nimmer
14231 Memorial Lecture),
<citetitle>UCLA Law Review
</citetitle> 48 (
2001):
1057,
1069–70.
14236 However, my criticism of the role that lawyers have played in this
14237 debate is not just about a professional bias. It is more importantly
14238 about our failure to actually reckon the costs of the law.
14241 Economists are supposed to be good at reckoning costs and benefits.
14242 But more often than not, economists, with no clue about how the legal
14243 system actually functions, simply assume that the transaction costs of
14244 the legal system are slight.
<footnote><para>
14246 A good example is the work of Professor Stan Liebowitz. Liebowitz is
14247 to be commended for his careful review of data about infringement,
14248 leading him to question his own publicly stated
14249 position
—twice. He initially predicted that downloading would
14250 substantially harm the industry. He then revised his view in light of
14251 the data, and he has since revised his view again. Compare Stan
14252 J. Liebowitz,
<citetitle>Rethinking the Network Economy: The True Forces That
14253 Drive the Digital Marketplace
</citetitle> (New York: Amacom,
2002), (reviewing his
14254 original view but expressing skepticism) with Stan J. Liebowitz,
14255 "Will MP3s Annihilate the Record Industry?" working paper, June
2003,
14257 <ulink url=
"http://free-culture.cc/notes/">link #
86</ulink>.
14258 Liebowitz's careful analysis is extremely valuable in estimating the
14259 effect of file-sharing technology. In my view, however, he
14260 underestimates the costs of the legal system. See, for example,
14261 <citetitle>Rethinking
</citetitle>,
174–76.
14262 <indexterm><primary>Liebowitz, Stan
</primary></indexterm>
14264 They see a system that has been around for hundreds of years, and they
14265 assume it works the way their elementary school civics class taught
14269 <!-- PAGE BREAK 310 -->
14270 But the legal system doesn't work. Or more accurately, it doesn't work
14271 for anyone except those with the most resources. Not because the
14272 system is corrupt. I don't think our legal system (at the federal
14273 level, at least) is at all corrupt. I mean simply because the costs of
14274 our legal system are so astonishingly high that justice can
14275 practically never be done.
14278 These costs distort free culture in many ways. A lawyer's time is
14279 billed at the largest firms at more than $
400 per hour. How much time
14280 should such a lawyer spend reading cases carefully, or researching
14281 obscure strands of authority? The answer is the increasing reality:
14282 very little. The law depended upon the careful articulation and
14283 development of doctrine, but the careful articulation and development
14284 of legal doctrine depends upon careful work. Yet that careful work
14285 costs too much, except in the most high-profile and costly cases.
14288 The costliness and clumsiness and randomness of this system mock
14289 our tradition. And lawyers, as well as academics, should consider it
14290 their duty to change the way the law works
—or better, to change the
14291 law so that it works. It is wrong that the system works well only for the
14292 top
1 percent of the clients. It could be made radically more efficient,
14293 and inexpensive, and hence radically more just.
14296 But until that reform is complete, we as a society should keep the law
14297 away from areas that we know it will only harm. And that is precisely
14298 what the law will too often do if too much of our culture is left to
14302 Think about the amazing things your kid could do or make with digital
14303 technology
—the film, the music, the Web page, the blog. Or think
14304 about the amazing things your community could facilitate with digital
14305 technology
—a wiki, a barn raising, activism to change something.
14306 Think about all those creative things, and then imagine cold molasses
14307 poured onto the machines. This is what any regime that requires
14308 permission produces. Again, this is the reality of Brezhnev's Russia.
14311 The law should regulate in certain areas of culture
—but it should
14312 regulate culture only where that regulation does good. Yet lawyers
14314 <!-- PAGE BREAK 311 -->
14315 rarely test their power, or the power they promote, against this
14316 simple pragmatic question: "Will it do good?" When challenged about
14317 the expanding reach of the law, the lawyer answers, "Why not?"
14320 We should ask, "Why?" Show me why your regulation of culture is
14321 needed. Show me how it does good. And until you can show me both,
14322 keep your lawyers away.
14324 <!-- PAGE BREAK 312 -->
14328 <chapter><title></title><para></para></chapter>
14330 <chapter id=
"c-notes">
14331 <title>NOTES
</title>
14333 Throughout this text, there are references to links on the World Wide
14334 Web. As anyone who has tried to use the Web knows, these links can be
14335 highly unstable. I have tried to remedy the instability by redirecting
14336 readers to the original source through the Web site associated with
14337 this book. For each link below, you can go to
14338 http://free-culture.cc/notes and locate the original source by
14339 clicking on the number after the # sign. If the original link remains
14340 alive, you will be redirected to that link. If the original link has
14341 disappeared, you will be redirected to an appropriate reference for
14344 <!-- PAGE BREAK 336 -->
14347 <chapter id=
"c-acknowledgments">
14348 <title>ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
</title>
14350 This book is the product of a long and as yet unsuccessful struggle that
14351 began when I read of Eric Eldred's war to keep books free. Eldred's
14352 work helped launch a movement, the free culture movement, and it is
14353 to him that this book is dedicated.
14356 I received guidance in various places from friends and academics,
14357 including Glenn Brown, Peter DiCola, Jennifer Mnookin, Richard Posner,
14358 Mark Rose, and Kathleen Sullivan. And I received correction and
14359 guidance from many amazing students at Stanford Law School and
14360 Stanford University. They included Andrew B. Coan, John Eden, James
14361 P. Fellers, Christopher Guzelian, Erica Goldberg, Robert Hallman,
14362 Andrew Harris, Matthew Kahn, Brian Link, Ohad Mayblum, Alina Ng, and
14363 Erica Platt. I am particularly grateful to Catherine Crump and Harry
14364 Surden, who helped direct their research, and to Laura Lynch, who
14365 brilliantly managed the army that they assembled, and provided her own
14366 critical eye on much of this.
14369 Yuko Noguchi helped me to understand the laws of Japan as well as
14370 its culture. I am thankful to her, and to the many in Japan who helped
14371 me prepare this book: Joi Ito, Takayuki Matsutani, Naoto Misaki,
14372 Michihiro Sasaki, Hiromichi Tanaka, Hiroo Yamagata, and Yoshihiro
14373 <!-- PAGE BREAK 337 -->
14374 Yonezawa. I am thankful as well as to Professor Nobuhiro Nakayama,
14375 and the Tokyo University Business Law Center, for giving me the
14376 chance to spend time in Japan, and to Tadashi Shiraishi and Kiyokazu
14377 Yamagami for their generous help while I was there.
14380 These are the traditional sorts of help that academics regularly draw
14381 upon. But in addition to them, the Internet has made it possible to
14382 receive advice and correction from many whom I have never even
14383 met. Among those who have responded with extremely helpful advice to
14384 requests on my blog about the book are Dr. Mohammad Al-Ubaydli, David
14385 Gerstein, and Peter DiMauro, as well as a long list of those who had
14386 specific ideas about ways to develop my argument. They included
14387 Richard Bondi, Steven Cherry, David Coe, Nik Cubrilovic, Bob Devine,
14388 Charles Eicher, Thomas Guida, Elihu M. Gerson, Jeremy Hunsinger,
14389 Vaughn Iverson, John Karabaic, Jeff Keltner, James Lindenschmidt,
14390 K. L. Mann, Mark Manning, Nora McCauley, Jeffrey McHugh, Evan
14391 McMullen, Fred Norton, John Pormann, Pedro A. D. Rezende, Shabbir
14392 Safdar, Saul Schleimer, Clay Shirky, Adam Shostack, Kragen Sitaker,
14393 Chris Smith, Bruce Steinberg, Andrzej Jan Taramina, Sean Walsh, Matt
14394 Wasserman, Miljenko Williams, "Wink," Roger Wood, "Ximmbo da Jazz,"
14395 and Richard Yanco. (I apologize if I have missed anyone; with
14396 computers come glitches, and a crash of my e-mail system meant I lost
14397 a bunch of great replies.)
14400 Richard Stallman and Michael Carroll each read the whole book in
14401 draft, and each provided extremely helpful correction and advice.
14402 Michael helped me to see more clearly the significance of the
14403 regulation of derivitive works. And Richard corrected an
14404 embarrassingly large number of errors. While my work is in part
14405 inspired by Stallman's, he does not agree with me in important places
14406 throughout this book.
14409 Finally, and forever, I am thankful to Bettina, who has always
14410 insisted that there would be unending happiness away from these
14411 battles, and who has always been right. This slow learner is, as ever,
14412 grateful for her perpetual patience and love.
14414 <!-- PAGE BREAK 338 -->